NXP MMC2114 32-bit Microcontroller Data Sheet

Add to my manuals
654 Pages

advertisement

NXP MMC2114 32-bit Microcontroller Data Sheet | Manualzz
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
MMC2114
MMC2113
MMC2112
Advance Information
M•CORE
Microcontrollers
MMC2114/D
Rev. 1, 4/2002
WWW.MOTOROLA.COM/SEMICONDUCTORS
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
MMC2114
MMC2113
MMC2112
Advance Information
To provide the most up-to-date information, the revision of our
documents on the World Wide Web will be the most current. Your printed
copy may be an earlier revision. To verify you have the latest information
available, refer to:
http://www.motorola.com/semiconductors/
The following revision history table summarizes changes contained in
this document. For your convenience, the page number designators
have been linked to the appropriate location.
Motorola and the Stylized M Logo are registered trademarks of Motorola, Inc.
DigitalDNA is a trademark of Motorola, Inc.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
© Motorola, Inc., 2002
Advance Information
3
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Revision History
Date
Revision
Level
March, 2002
N/A
April, 2002
Advance Information
Description
Page
Number(s)
Original release
N/A
Figure 4-4. Chip Identification Register (CIR) —
Corrrected reset condition for bits 11 and 8
131
20.9.3 Show Strobe (SHS) — Corrected description in first
paragraph
542
23.5 Junction Temperature Determination — Changed
subsection title from Power Dissipation to Junction
Temperature Determination
614
23.7 DC Electrical Specifications — Under operating
supply current, external oscillator clocking changed stop
mode maximum value from 10 µA to 200 µA
616
23.7 DC Electrical Specifications — Under operating
supply current, crystal/PLL clock changed maximum value
for OSC and PLL disabled from 150 µA to 200 µA
617
Appendix A. Security — Updated for clarity
649
1.0
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
4
MOTOROLA
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
List of Sections
Section 1. General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Section 2. System Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Section 3. Signal Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Section 4. Chip Configuration Module (CCM) . . . . . . . 121
Section 5. Reset Controller Module. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
Section 6. Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Section 7. M•CORE M210 Central Processor
Unit (CPU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
Section 8. Interrupt Controller Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Section 9. Static Random Access Memory
(SRAM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Section 10. Second Generation FLASH
for M•CORE (SGFM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Section 11. Clock Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Section 12. Ports Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
Section 13. Edge Port Module (EPORT) . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Section 14. Watchdog Timer Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
Section 15. Programmable Interrupt Timer
Modules (PIT1 and PIT2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
Section 16. Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2). . . . . . . . . 317
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
List of Sections
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
5
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Sections
Section 17. Serial Communications Interface
Modules (SCI1 and SCI2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
Section 18. Serial Peripheral Interface
Module (SPI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397
Section 19. Queued Analog-to-Digital
Converter (QADC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Section 20. External Bus Interface Module (EBI) . . . . . 527
Section 21. Chip Select Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547
Section 22. JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE . . . . . . 559
Section 23. Preliminary Electrical Specifications . . . . 611
Section 24. Mechanical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . 639
Section 25. Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 647
Appendix A. Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 649
Advance Information
6
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
List of Sections
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Table of Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Section 1. General Description
1.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
1.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
1.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
1.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
Section 2. System Memory Map
2.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
2.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
2.3
Address Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
2.4
Register Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
Section 3. Signal Description
3.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
3.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
3.3
Package Pinout Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
3.4
Chip Specific Implementation Signal Issues. . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
3.4.1
RSTOUT Signal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
3.4.2
INT Signal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
3.4.3
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Pin Functions . . . . . . . . .110
3.4.4
Serial Communications Interface (SCI1 and SCI2)
Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
3.4.5
Timer 1 and Timer 2 Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
3.4.6
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
7
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
3.5
Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
3.5.1
Reset Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.5.1.1
Reset In (RESET) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.5.1.2
Reset Out (RSTOUT). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.5.2
Phase-Lock Loop (PLL) and Clock Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.5.2.1
External Clock In (EXTAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
3.5.2.2
Crystal (XTAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
3.5.2.3
Clock Out (CLKOUT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
3.5.2.4
PLL Enable (PLLEN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
3.5.3
External Memory Interface Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
3.5.3.1
Data Bus (D[31:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
3.5.3.2
Show Cycle Strobe (SHS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
3.5.3.3
Transfer Acknowledge (TA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
3.5.3.4
Transfer Error Acknowledge (TEA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
3.5.3.5
Emulation Mode Chip Selects (CSE[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . 115
3.5.3.6
Transfer Code (TC[2:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
3.5.3.7
Read/Write (R/W). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
3.5.3.8
Address Bus (A[22:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
3.5.3.9
Enable Byte (EB[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
3.5.3.10
Chip Select (CS[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
3.5.3.11
Output Enable (OE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
3.5.4
Edge Port Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
3.5.4.1
External Interrupts (INT[7:6]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
3.5.4.2
External Interrupts (INT[5:2]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
3.5.4.3
External Interrupts (INT[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
3.5.5
Serial Peripheral Interface Module Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
3.5.5.1
Master Out/Slave In (MOSI). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
3.5.5.2
Master In/Slave Out (MISO). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
3.5.5.3
Serial Clock (SCK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
3.5.5.4
Slave Select (SS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
3.5.6
Serial Communications Interface Module Signals . . . . . . . 117
3.5.6.1
Receive Data (RXD1 and RXD2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
3.5.6.2
Transmit Data (TXD1 and TXD2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
3.5.7
Timer Signals (ICOC1[3:0] and ICOC2[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Advance Information
8
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
3.5.8
3.5.8.1
3.5.8.2
3.5.8.3
3.5.8.4
3.5.9
3.5.9.1
3.5.9.2
3.5.9.3
3.5.9.4
3.5.9.5
3.5.9.6
3.5.10
3.5.11
3.5.11.1
3.5.11.2
3.5.11.3
Analog-to-Digital Converter Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Analog Inputs (PQA[4:3], PQA[1:0], and PQB[3:0]) . . . . 118
Analog Reference (VRH and VRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Analog Supply (VDDA and VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Positive Supply (VDDH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Debug and Emulation Support Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Reset (TRST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Clock (TCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Mode Select (TMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Data Input (TDI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Data Output (TDO). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Debug Event (DE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Signal (TEST). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Power and Ground Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Standby Power (VSTBY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Positive Supply (VDD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Ground (VSS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
Section 4. Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
4.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
4.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
4.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
4.4
Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122
4.4.1
Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
4.4.2
Single-Chip Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
4.4.3
Emulation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
4.4.4
Factory Access Slave Test (FAST) Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
4.5
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
4.6
Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
4.7
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
4.7.1
Programming Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
4.7.2
Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
4.7.3
Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
4.7.3.1
Chip Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
4.7.3.2
Reset Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
4.7.3.3
Chip Identification Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
4.7.3.4
Chip Test Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
9
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
4.8
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
4.8.1
Reset Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
4.8.2
Chip Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
4.8.3
Boot Device Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
4.8.4
Output Pad Strength Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
4.8.5
Clock Mode Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
4.8.6
Internal FLASH Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
4.9
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
4.10
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Section 5. Reset Controller Module
5.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
5.2
Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
5.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
5.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
5.5
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
5.5.1
RESET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
5.5.2
RSTOUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
5.6
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
5.6.1
Reset Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
5.6.2
Reset Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
5.7
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
5.7.1
Reset Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
5.7.1.1
Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
5.7.1.2
External Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
5.7.1.3
Watchdog Timer Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
5.7.1.4
Loss of Clock Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
5.7.1.5
Loss of Lock Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
5.7.1.6
Software Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
5.7.1.7
LVD Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
5.7.2
Reset Control Flow. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
5.7.2.1
Synchronous Reset Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
5.7.2.2
Internal Reset Request . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
5.7.2.3
Power-On Reset/Low-Voltage Detect Reset . . . . . . . . .151
Advance Information
10
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
5.7.3
5.7.3.1
5.7.3.2
Concurrent Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Reset Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Reset Status Flags. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Section 6. Power Management
6.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
6.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
6.3
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
6.3.1
Run Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
6.3.2
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
6.3.3
Doze Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
6.3.4
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
6.3.5
Peripheral Shut Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
6.4
Peripheral Behavior in Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
6.4.1
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
6.4.2
Clocks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
6.4.3
OnCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
6.4.4
JTAG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
6.4.5
Interrupt Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
6.4.6
Edge Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
6.4.7
Random-Access Memory (RAM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
6.4.8
FLASH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
6.4.9
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC) . . . . . . . . . . 161
6.4.10 Watchdog Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
6.4.11 Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT1 and PIT2). . . . . . . . 162
6.4.12 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
6.4.13 Serial Communication Interfaces (SCI1 and SCI2) . . . . . . 162
6.4.14 Timers (TIM1 and TIM2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
6.5
Summary of Peripheral State During Low-Power Modes . . . . 163
Section 7. M•CORE M210 Central Processor
Unit (CPU)
7.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
7.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
7.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
7.4
Microarchitecture Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
11
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
7.5
Programming Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
7.6
Data Format Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
7.7
Operand Addressing Capabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
7.8
Instruction Set Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Section 8. Interrupt Controller Module
8.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
8.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
8.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
8.4
Low-Power Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
8.5
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
8.6
External Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
8.7
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
8.7.1
Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
8.7.2
Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
8.7.2.1
Interrupt Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
8.7.2.2
Interrupt Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
8.7.2.3
Interrupt Force Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
8.7.2.4
Interrupt Pending Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
8.7.2.5
Normal Interrupt Enable Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
8.7.2.6
Normal Interrupt Pending Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
8.7.2.7
Fast Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
8.7.2.8
Fast Interrupt Pending Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
8.7.2.9
Priority Level Select Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
8.8
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
8.8.1
Interrupt Sources and Prioritization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
8.8.2
Fast and Normal Interrupt Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
8.8.3
Autovectored and Vectored Interrupt Requests . . . . . . . . .193
8.8.4
Interrupt Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
8.8.4.1
CPU Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
8.8.4.2
Interrupt Controller Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
8.8.4.3
Interrupt Source Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
8.8.5
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Advance Information
12
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Section 9. Static Random Access Memory (SRAM)
9.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
9.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
9.3
Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
9.4
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
9.5
Standby Power Supply Pin (VSTBY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
9.6
Standby Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
9.7
Reset Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
9.8
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
Section 10. Second Generation FLASH
for M•CORE (SGFM)
10.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
10.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
10.3
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
10.4
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
10.5
Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
10.6
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
10.7 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
10.7.1 Unbanked Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
10.7.1.1
SGFM Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
10.7.1.2
SGFM Clock Divider Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
10.7.1.3
SGFM Test Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
10.7.1.4
SGFM Security Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
10.7.1.5
SGFM Monitor Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
10.7.2 Banked Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
10.7.2.1
SGFM Protection Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
10.7.2.2
SGFM Supervisor Access Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
10.7.2.3
SGFM Data Access Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
10.7.2.4
SGFM Test Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
10.7.2.5
SGFM User Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
10.7.2.6
SGFM Command Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
10.7.2.7
SGFM Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
10.7.2.8
SGFM Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
10.7.2.9
SGFM Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
13
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
10.8 SGFM User Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
10.8.1 Read Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
10.8.2 Write Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
10.8.3 Program and Erase Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
10.8.3.1
Setting the SGFMCLKD Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
10.8.3.2
Program, Erase, and Verify Sequences. . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
10.8.3.3
FLASH User Mode Valid Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
10.8.3.4
FLASH User Mode Illegal Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
10.8.4 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
10.8.5 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
10.8.6 Emulation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
10.8.7 Debug Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
10.9 FLASH Security Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
10.9.1 Back Door Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
10.9.2 Erase Verify Check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
10.10 Resets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
10.11 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Section 11. Clock Module
11.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
11.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
11.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
11.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
11.4.1 Normal PLL Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
11.4.2 1:1 PLL Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
11.4.3 External Clock Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
11.4.4 Low-Power Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
11.4.4.1
Wait and Doze Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
11.4.4.2
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
11.5
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
11.6 Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
11.6.1 EXTAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
11.6.2 XTAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
11.6.3 CLKOUT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
11.6.4 PLLEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
11.6.5 RSTOUT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Advance Information
14
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
11.7 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
11.7.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
11.7.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
11.7.2.1
Synthesizer Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
11.7.2.2
Synthesizer Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
11.7.2.3
Synthesizer Test Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
11.7.2.4
Synthesizer Test Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
11.8 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
11.8.1 System Clock Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
11.8.2 System Clocks Generation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
11.8.3 PLL Lock Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
11.8.3.1
PLL Loss of Lock Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
11.8.3.2
PLL Loss of Lock Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
11.8.4 Loss of Clock Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
11.8.4.1
Alternate Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
11.8.4.2
Loss-of-Clock Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
11.8.5 Clock Operation During Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
11.8.6 PLL Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
11.8.6.1
Phase and Frequency Detector (PFD). . . . . . . . . . . . . .268
11.8.6.2
Charge Pump/Loop Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
11.8.6.3
Voltage Control Output (VCO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
11.8.6.4
Multiplication Factor Divider (MFD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
11.9
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
11.10 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Section 12. Ports Module
12.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
12.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
12.3
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
12.4 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
12.4.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
12.4.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
12.4.2.1
Port Output Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
12.4.2.2
Port Data Direction Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
12.4.2.3
Port Pin Data/Set Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
12.4.2.4
Port Clear Output Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
15
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
12.4.2.5
12.4.2.6
Port C/D Pin Assignment Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Port E Pin Assignment Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
12.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
12.5.1 Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
12.5.2 Port Digital I/O Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
12.6
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Section 13. Edge Port Module (EPORT)
13.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
13.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
13.3 Low-Power Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
13.3.1 Wait and Doze Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
13.3.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287
13.4
Interrupt/General-Purpose I/O Pin Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . 287
13.5 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
13.5.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
13.5.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
13.5.2.1
EPORT Pin Assignment Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
13.5.2.2
EPORT Data Direction Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
13.5.2.3
Edge Port Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
13.5.2.4
Edge Port Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
13.5.2.5
Edge Port Pin Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
13.5.2.6
Edge Port Flag Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
Section 14. Watchdog Timer Module
14.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
14.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
14.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
14.3.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
14.3.2 Doze Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
14.3.3 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
14.3.4 Debug Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
Advance Information
16
14.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
14.5
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
14.6
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
14.6.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
14.6.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
14.6.2.1
Watchdog Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
14.6.2.2
Watchdog Modulus Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
14.6.2.3
Watchdog Count Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .302
14.6.2.4
Watchdog Service Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Section 15. Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules
(PIT1 and PIT2)
15.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
15.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
15.3
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
15.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
15.4.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
15.4.2 Doze Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
15.4.3 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
15.4.4 Debug Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
15.5
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
15.6 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
15.6.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
15.6.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
15.6.2.1
PIT Control and Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .309
15.6.2.2
PIT Modulus Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
15.6.2.3
PIT Count Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
15.7 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
15.7.1 Set-and-Forget Timer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
15.7.2 Free-Running Timer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
15.7.3 Timeout Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
15.8
Interrupt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
Section 16. Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
16.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
16.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
16.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
17
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
16.5 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
16.5.1 Supervisor and User Modes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
16.5.2 Run Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
16.5.3 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
16.5.4 Wait, Doze, and Debug Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
16.5.5 Test Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
16.6 Signal Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
16.6.1 ICOC[2:0] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
16.6.2 ICOC3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
16.7 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
16.7.1 Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Select Register . . . 324
16.7.2 Timer Compare Force Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
16.7.3 Timer Output Compare 3 Mask Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
16.7.4 Timer Output Compare 3 Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
16.7.5 Timer Counter Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.7.6 Timer System Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329
16.7.7 Timer Toggle-On-Overflow Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330
16.7.8 Timer Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
16.7.9 Timer Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
16.7.10 Timer Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333
16.7.11 Timer System Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
16.7.12 Timer Flag Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
16.7.13 Timer Flag Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
16.7.14 Timer Channel Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
16.7.15 Pulse Accumulator Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
16.7.16 Pulse Accumulator Flag Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
16.7.17 Pulse Accumulator Counter Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
16.7.18 Timer Port Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343
16.7.19 Timer Port Data Direction Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
16.7.20 Timer Test Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
16.8 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
16.8.1 Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
16.8.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
16.8.3 Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
16.8.4 Pulse Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
16.8.4.1
Event Counter Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
16.8.4.2
Gated Time Accumulation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .348
Advance Information
18
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
16.8.5
16.9
General-Purpose I/O Ports. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
16.10 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
16.10.1 Timer Channel Interrupts (CxF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
16.10.2 Pulse Accumulator Overflow (PAOVF). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
16.10.3 Pulse Accumulator Input (PAIF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
16.10.4 Timer Overflow (TOF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Section 17. Serial Communications Interface Modules
(SCI1 and SCI2)
17.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
17.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354
17.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355
17.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
17.5 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
17.5.1 Doze Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
17.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
17.6 Signal Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
17.6.1 RXD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
17.6.2 TXD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
17.7 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
17.7.1 SCI Baud Rate Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
17.7.2 SCI Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361
17.7.3 SCI Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
17.7.4 SCI Status Register 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366
17.7.5 SCI Status Register 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369
17.7.6 SCI Data Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370
17.7.7 SCI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371
17.7.8 SCI Port Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
17.7.9 SCI Data Direction Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373
17.8
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374
17.9
Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374
17.10 Baud Rate Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375
17.11 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376
17.11.1 Frame Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
19
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
17.11.2 Transmitting a Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
17.11.3 Break Frames. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380
17.11.4 Idle Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
17.12 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
17.12.1 Frame Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
17.12.2 Receiving a Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
17.12.3 Data Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
17.12.4 Framing Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
17.12.5 Baud Rate Tolerance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
17.12.5.1 Slow Data Tolerance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388
17.12.5.2
Fast Data Tolerance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389
17.12.6 Receiver Wakeup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390
17.12.6.1 Idle Input Line Wakeup (WAKE = 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390
17.12.6.2 Address Mark Wakeup (WAKE = 1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
17.13 Single-Wire Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
17.14 Loop Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
17.15 I/O Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394
17.16 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
17.17 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
17.17.1 Transmit Data Register Empty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
17.17.2 Transmission Complete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
17.17.3 Receive Data Register Full. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
17.17.4 Idle Receiver Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
17.17.5 Overrun . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
Section 18. Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
18.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 397
18.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
18.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
18.4
Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .399
18.5
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
18.6 Signal Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
18.6.1 MISO (Master In/Slave Out) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
18.6.2 MOSI (Master Out/Slave In) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
18.6.3 SCK (Serial Clock) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
18.6.4 SS (Slave Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
Advance Information
20
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
18.7 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
18.7.1 SPI Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402
18.7.2 SPI Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405
18.7.3 SPI Baud Rate Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
18.7.4 SPI Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
18.7.5 SPI Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
18.7.6 SPI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
18.7.7 SPI Port Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .411
18.7.8 SPI Port Data Direction Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
18.8 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413
18.8.1 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
18.8.2 Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
18.8.3 Transmission Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
18.8.3.1
Transfer Format When CPHA = 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
18.8.3.2
Transfer Format When CPHA = 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417
18.8.4 SPI Baud Rate Generation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
18.8.5 Slave-Select Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
18.8.6 Bidirectional Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421
18.8.7 Error Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .422
18.8.7.1
Write Collision Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .422
18.8.7.2
Mode Fault Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422
18.8.8 Low-Power Mode Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423
18.8.8.1
Run Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423
18.8.8.2
Doze Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423
18.8.8.3
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
18.9
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
18.10 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
18.10.1 Mode Fault (MODF) Flag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
18.10.2 SPI Interrupt Flag (SPIF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
Section 19. Queued Analog-to-Digital
Converter (QADC)
19.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425
19.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427
19.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428
19.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
21
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
19.5 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .430
19.5.1 Debug Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 430
19.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.6 Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 431
19.6.1 Port QA Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 432
19.6.1.1
Port QA Analog Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .432
19.6.1.2
Port QA Digital Input/Output Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433
19.6.2 Port QB Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433
19.6.2.1
Port QB Analog Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .433
19.6.2.2
Port QB Digital Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .433
19.6.3 External Trigger Input Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
19.6.4 Multiplexed Address Output Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
19.6.5 Multiplexed Analog Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
19.6.6 Voltage Reference Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
19.6.7 Dedicated Analog Supply Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
19.6.8 Dedicated Digital I/O Port Supply Pin. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
19.7
Memory Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436
19.8 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 437
19.8.1 QADC Module Configuration Register (QADCMCR) . . . . .437
19.8.2 QADC Test Register (QADCTEST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .438
19.8.3 Port Data Registers (PORTQA and PORTQB) . . . . . . . . .438
19.8.4 Port QA and QB Data Direction Register
(DDRQA and DDRQB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440
19.8.5 Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .442
19.8.5.1
QADC Control Register 0 (QACR0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442
19.8.5.2
QADC Control Register 1 (QACR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445
19.8.5.3
QADC Control Register 2 (QACR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448
19.8.6 Status Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .453
19.8.6.1
QADC Status Register 0 (QASR0). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
19.8.6.2
QADC Status Register 1 (QASR1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 462
19.8.7 Conversion Command Word Table (CCW) . . . . . . . . . . . . 463
19.8.8 Result Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .468
19.8.8.1
Right-Justified Unsigned Result Register (RJURR) . . . . 468
19.8.8.2
Left-Justified Signed Result Register (LJSRR) . . . . . . . 469
19.8.8.3
Left-Justified Unsigned Result Register (LJURR) . . . . . 470
Advance Information
22
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.9 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470
19.9.1 Result Coherency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470
19.9.2 External Multiplexing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
19.9.2.1
External Multiplexing Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .471
19.9.2.2
Module Version Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473
19.9.3 Analog Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 474
19.9.3.1
Analog-to-Digital Converter Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . .474
19.9.3.2
Conversion Cycle Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475
19.9.3.3
Channel Decode and Multiplexer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476
19.9.3.4
Sample Buffer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .476
19.9.3.5
Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) Array . . . . . . . . . . . . 476
19.9.3.6
Comparator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
19.9.3.7
Bias . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
19.9.3.8
Successive Approximation Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
19.9.3.9
State Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .477
19.10 Digital Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .478
19.10.1 Queue Priority Timing Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 478
19.10.1.1 Queue Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .478
19.10.1.2 Queue Priority Schemes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481
19.10.2 Boundary Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492
19.10.3 Scan Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493
19.10.4 Disabled Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
19.10.5 Reserved Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
19.10.6 Single-Scan Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
19.10.6.1 Software-Initiated Single-Scan Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495
19.10.6.2 Externally Triggered Single-Scan Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . 496
19.10.6.3 Externally Gated Single-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
19.10.6.4 Interval Timer Single-Scan Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
19.10.7 Continuous-Scan Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499
19.10.7.1 Software-Initiated Continuous-Scan Mode. . . . . . . . . . . 500
19.10.7.2 Externally Triggered Continuous-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . 501
19.10.7.3 Externally Gated Continuous-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . 501
19.10.7.4 Periodic Timer Continuous-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502
19.10.8 QADC Clock (QCLK) Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503
19.10.9 Periodic/Interval Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .504
19.10.10 Conversion Command Word Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .505
19.10.11 Result Word Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 509
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
23
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.11 Pin Connection Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .509
19.11.1 Analog Reference Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .509
19.11.2 Analog Power Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510
19.11.3 Conversion Timing Schemes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .512
19.11.4 Analog Supply Filtering and Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 515
19.11.5 Accommodating Positive/Negative Stress Conditions . . . .517
19.11.6 Analog Input Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .519
19.11.7 Analog Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 521
19.11.7.1 Settling Time for the External Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 522
19.11.7.2 Error Resulting from Leakage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523
19.12 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524
19.12.1 Interrupt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524
19.12.2 Interrupt Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .525
Section 20. External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
20.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 527
20.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528
20.3 Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .529
20.3.1 Data Bus (D[31:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 530
20.3.2 Show Cycle Strobe (SHS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 530
20.3.3 Transfer Acknowledge (TA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 530
20.3.4 Transfer Error Acknowledge (TEA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .530
20.3.5 Emulation Mode Chip Selects (CSE[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 530
20.3.6 Transfer Code (TC[2:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.7 Read/Write (R/W) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.8 Address Bus (A[22:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.9 Enable Byte (EB[3:0]). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.10 Chip Selects (CS[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.11 Output Enable (OE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.12 Transfer Size (TSIZ[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532
20.3.13 Processor Status (PSTAT[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532
Advance Information
24
20.4
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532
20.5
Operand Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532
20.6
Enable Byte Pins (EB[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
20.7 Bus Master Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534
20.7.1 Read Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 535
20.7.1.1
State 1 (X1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536
20.7.1.2
Optional Wait States (X2W) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536
20.7.1.3
State 2 (X2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536
20.7.2 Write Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537
20.7.2.1
State 1 (X1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 538
20.7.2.2
Optional Wait States (X2W) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 538
20.7.2.3
State 2 (X2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 538
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
20.8 Bus Exception Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
20.8.1 Transfer Error Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
20.8.2 Transfer Abort Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
20.9 Emulation Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
20.9.1 Emulation Chip-Selects (CSE[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .540
20.9.2 Internal Data Transfer Display (Show Cycles) . . . . . . . . . . 541
20.9.3 Show Strobe (SHS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 542
20.9.4 Transfer Code (TC[2:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543
20.9.5 Processor Status (PSTAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543
20.10 Bus Monitor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
20.11 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
Section 21. Chip Select Module
21.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547
21.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547
21.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 548
21.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549
21.5
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
21.6 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
21.6.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
21.6.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 551
21.7
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 556
21.8
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 557
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
25
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
Section 22. JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 559
22.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.3 Top-Level Test Access Port (TAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 563
22.3.1 Test Clock (TCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.3.2 Test Mode Select (TMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.3.3 Test Data Input (TDI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.3.4 Test Data Output (TDO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.3.5 Test Reset (TRST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.3.6 Debug Event (DE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.4
Top-Level TAP Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .566
22.5 Instruction Shift Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567
22.5.1 EXTEST Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567
22.5.2 IDCODE Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 568
22.5.3 SAMPLE/PRELOAD Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 569
22.5.4 ENABLE_MCU_ONCE Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .569
22.5.5 HIGHZ Instruction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570
22.5.6 CLAMP Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570
22.5.7 BYPASS Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570
22.6
IDCODE Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 571
22.7
Bypass Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572
22.8
Boundary Scan Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572
22.9
Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572
22.10 Non-Scan Chain Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573
22.11 Boundary Scan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573
22.12 Low-Level TAP (OnCE) Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .579
22.13 Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .581
22.13.1 Debug Serial Input (TDI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 581
22.13.2 Debug Serial Clock (TCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 581
22.13.3 Debug Serial Output (TDO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 581
22.13.4 Debug Mode Select (TMS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 582
22.13.5 Test Reset (TRST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 582
22.13.6 Debug Event (DE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 582
Advance Information
26
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.14 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 582
22.14.1 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 583
22.14.2 OnCE Controller and Serial Interface. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 584
22.14.3 OnCE Interface Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 585
22.14.3.1 Internal Debug Request Input (IDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 585
22.14.3.2 CPU Debug Request (DBGRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .586
22.14.3.3 CPU Debug Acknowledge (DBGACK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .586
22.14.3.4 CPU Breakpoint Request (BRKRQ). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 586
22.14.3.5 CPU Address, Attributes (ADDR, ATTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . 587
22.14.3.6 CPU Status (PSTAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587
22.14.3.7 OnCE Debug Output (DEBUG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587
22.14.4 OnCE Controller Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587
22.14.4.1 OnCE Command Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .588
22.14.4.2 OnCE Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 590
22.14.4.3 OnCE Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 594
22.14.5 OnCE Decoder (ODEC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 596
22.14.6 Memory Breakpoint Logic. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 596
22.14.6.1 Memory Address Latch (MAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597
22.14.6.2 Breakpoint Address Base Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597
22.14.7 Breakpoint Address Mask Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597
22.14.7.1 Breakpoint Address Comparators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 598
22.14.7.2 Memory Breakpoint Counters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 598
22.14.8 OnCE Trace Logic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 598
22.14.8.1 OnCE Trace Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 599
22.14.8.2 Trace Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600
22.14.9 Methods of Entering Debug Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600
22.14.9.1 Debug Request During RESET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .600
22.14.9.2 Debug Request During Normal Activity . . . . . . . . . . . . . 601
22.14.9.3 Debug Request During Stop, Doze, or Wait Mode . . . .601
22.14.9.4 Software Request During Normal Activity . . . . . . . . . . . 601
22.14.10 Enabling OnCE Trace Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .601
22.14.11 Enabling OnCE Memory Breakpoints. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 602
22.14.12 Pipeline Information and Write-Back Bus Register . . . . . . 602
22.14.12.1 Program Counter Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .603
22.14.12.2 Instruction Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 603
22.14.12.3 Control State Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 603
22.14.12.4 Writeback Bus Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 605
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
27
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
22.14.12.5 Processor Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .605
22.14.13 Instruction Address FIFO Buffer (PC FIFO) . . . . . . . . . . . . 606
22.14.14 Reserved Test Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 607
22.14.15 Serial Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 607
22.14.16 OnCE Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 608
22.14.17 Target Site Debug System Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . 608
22.14.18 Interface Connector for JTAG/OnCE Serial Port . . . . . . . . 608
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Section 23. Preliminary Electrical Specifications
23.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 611
23.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 612
23.3
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 613
23.4
Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 614
23.5
Junction Temperature Determination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .614
23.6
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 615
23.7
DC Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 616
23.8
PLL Electrical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 618
23.9
QADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .620
23.10 FLASH Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .624
23.11 External Interface Timing Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 625
23.12 General Purpose I/O Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630
23.13 Reset and Configuration Override Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631
23.14 SPI Timing Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 632
23.15 OnCE, JTAG, and Boundary Scan Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 635
Section 24. Mechanical Specifications
Advance Information
28
24.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 639
24.3
Bond Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 640
24.4
Package Information for the 144-Pin LQFP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 641
24.5
Package Information for the 100-Pin LQFP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 641
24.6
Package Information for the 196-Ball MAPBGA . . . . . . . . . . . 642
24.7
144-Pin LQFP Mechanical Drawing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 643
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Table of Contents
24.8
100-Pin LQFP Mechanical Drawing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 644
24.9
196-Ball MAPBGA Mechanical Drawing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 645
Section 25. Ordering Information
25.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 647
25.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 647
25.3
MC Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .647
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Appendix A. Security
A.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 649
A.2
Security Philosophy/Strategy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 649
A.3
MCU Operation with Security Enabled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 650
A.4
FLASH Access Blocking Mechanisms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .650
A.4.1
Forced Operating Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 650
A.4.2
Disabled OnCE Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 651
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
29
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table of Contents
Advance Information
30
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Table of Contents
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
List of Figures
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure
Title
1-1
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
2-1
2-2
2-3
2-4
MMC2112 Address Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
MMC2113 Address Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
MMC2114 Address Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
3-1
3-2
3-3
196-Ball MAPBGA Assignments. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
144-Pin LQFP Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
100-Pin LQFP Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
4-1
4-2
4-3
4-4
4-5
Chip Configuration Module Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Chip Configuration Register (CCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Reset Configuration Register (RCON) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Chip Identification Register (CIR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
Chip Test Register (CTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
5-1
5-2
5-3
5-4
Reset Controller Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Reset Control Register (RCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Reset Status Register (RSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Reset Control Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
7-1
7-2
7-3
7-4
M•CORE Processor Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Programming Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
Data Organization in Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Data Organization in Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
8-1
8-2
Interrupt Controller Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Interrupt Control Register (ICR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Page
List of Figures
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
31
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Figures
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure
Advance Information
32
Title
Page
8-3
8-4
8-5
8-6
8-7
8-8
8-9
8-10
8-11
Interrupt Status Register (ISR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Interrupt Force Register High (IFRH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Interrupt Force Register Low (IFRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Interrupt Pending Register (IPR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Normal Interrupt Enable Register (NIER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Normal Interrupt Pending Register (NIPR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Fast Interrupt Enable Register (FIER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .189
Fast Interrupt Pending Register (FIPR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Priority Level Select Registers (PLSR0–PLSR39) . . . . . . . . .191
10-1
10-2
10-3
10-4
10-5
10-6
10-7
10-8
10-9
10-10
10-11
10-12
10-13
10-14
10-15
10-16
10-17
10-18
10-19
SGFM Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
SGFM Array Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
SGFM Module Configuration Register (SGFMCR). . . . . . . . .213
SGFM Clock Divider Register (SGFMCLKD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
SGFM Test Register (SGFMTST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
SGFM Security Register (SGFMSEC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
SGFM Monitor Data Register (SGFMMNTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
SGFM Protection Register (SGFMPROT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
SGFMPROT Protection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
SGFM Supervisor Access Register (SGFMASACC) . . . . . . . 222
SGFM Data Access Register (SGFMDACC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
SGFM Test Status Register (SGFMTSTAT). . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
SGFM User Status Register (SGFMUSTAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
SGFM Command Register (SGFMCMD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
SGFM Control Register (SGFMCTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
SGFM Address Register (SGFMADR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
SGFM Data Register (SGFMDATA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Example Program Algorithm. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
SGFM Interrupt Implementation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
11-1
11-2
11-3
11-4
11-5
11-6
Clock Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Synthesizer Control Register (SYNCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Synthesizer Status Register (SYNSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
Synthesizer Test Register (SYNTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Synthesizer Test Register 2 (SYNTR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Lock Detect Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
List of Figures
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Figures
Figure
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
11-7
11-8
12-1
12-2
12-3
12-4
12-5
12-6
Title
12-7
12-8
12-9
PLL Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Crystal Oscillator Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
Ports Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
Port Output Data Registers (PORTx) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Port Data Direction Registers (DDRx) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276
Port Pin Data/Set Data Registers (PORTxP/SETx) . . . . . . . . 277
Port Clear Output Data Registers (CLRx). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Port C, D, I7, and I6 Pin Assignment
Register (PCDPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Port E Pin Assignment Register (PEPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
Digital Input Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Digital Output Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
13-1
13-2
13-3
13-4
13-5
13-6
13-7
EPORT Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
EPORT Pin Assignment Register (EPPAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288
EPORT Data Direction Register (EPDDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
EPORT Port Interrupt Enable Register (EPIER). . . . . . . . . . . 291
EPORT Port Data Register (EPDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
EPORT Port Pin Data Register (EPPDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
EPORT Port Flag Register (EPFR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
14-1
14-2
14-3
14-4
14-5
Watchdog Timer Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
Watchdog Control Register (WCR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
Watchdog Modulus Register (WMR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
Watchdog Count Register (WCNTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
Watchdog Service Register (WSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
15-1
15-2
15-3
15-4
15-5
15-6
16-1
16-2
PIT Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
PIT Control and Status Register (PCSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
PIT Modulus Register (PMR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
PIT Count Register (PCNTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Counter Reloading from the Modulus Latch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
Counter in Free-Running Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
Timer Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
Timer Input Capture/Output Compare
Select Register (TIMIOS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 324
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Page
List of Figures
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
33
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Figures
Figure
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
16-3
16-4
16-5
16-6
16-7
16-8
16-9
16-10
16-11
16-12
16-13
16-14
16-15
16-16
16-17
16-18
16-19
16-20
16-21
34
Page
16-23
16-24
16-25
16-26
Timer Compare Force Register (TIMCFORC) . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
Timer Output Compare 3 Mask Register (TIMOC3M) . . . . . . 326
Timer Output Compare 3 Data Register (TIMOC3D) . . . . . . . 327
Timer Counter Register High (TIMCNTH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
Timer Counter Register Low (TIMCNTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
Timer System Control Register (TIMSCR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
Fast Clear Flag Logic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330
Timer Toggle-On-Overflow Register (TIMTOV) . . . . . . . . . . . 330
Timer Control Register 1 (TIMCTL1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
Timer Control Register 2 (TIMCTL2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIMIE). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333
Timer System Control Register 2 (TIMSCR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
Timer Flag Register 1 (TIMFLG1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
Timer Flag Register 2 (TIMFLG2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
Timer Channel [0:3] Register High (TIMCxH). . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
Timer Channel [0:3] Register Low (TIMCxL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
Pulse Accumulator Control Register (TIMPACTL) . . . . . . . . .339
Pulse Accumulator Flag Register (TIMPAFLG) . . . . . . . . . . . 341
Pulse Accumulator Counter Register High
(TIMPACNTH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
Pulse Accumulator Counter Register Low
(TIMPACNTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
Timer Port Data Register (TIMPORT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .343
Timer Port Data Direction Register (TIMDDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
Timer Test Register (TIMTST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
Channel 3 Output Compare/Pulse Accumulator Logic . . . . . . 348
17-1
17-2
17-3
17-4
17-5
17-6
17-7
17-8
17-9
SCI Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .356
SCI Baud Rate Register High (SCIBDH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
SCI Baud Rate Register Low (SCIBDL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
SCI Control Register 1 (SCICR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361
SCI Control Register 2 (SCICR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
SCI Status Register 1 (SCISR1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .366
SCI Status Register 2 (SCISR2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .369
SCI Data Register High (SCIDRH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370
SCI Data Register Low (SCIDRL). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370
16-22
Advance Information
Title
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
List of Figures
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Figures
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure
Title
17-10
17-11
17-12
17-13
17-14
17-15
17-16
17-17
17-18
17-19
17-20
17-21
17-22
17-23
17-24
17-25
17-26
SCI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register (SCIPURD) . . . . . . . 371
SCI Port Data Register (SCIPORT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372
SCI Data Direction Register (SCIDDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373
SCI Data Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374
Transmitter Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376
SCI Receiver Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
Receiver Data Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
Start Bit Search Example 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384
Start Bit Search Example 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385
Start Bit Search Example 3. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385
Start Bit Search Example 4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386
Start Bit Search Example 5. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386
Start Bit Search Example 6. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
Slow Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388
Fast Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389
Single-Wire Operation (LOOPS = 1, RSRC = 1) . . . . . . . . . . 392
Loop Operation (LOOPS = 1, RSRC = 0). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
18-1
18-2
18-3
18-4
18-5
18-6
18-7
18-8
18-9
18-10
18-11
18-12
18-13
SPI Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
SPI Control Register 1 (SPICR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402
SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405
SPI Baud Rate Register (SPIBR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
SPI Status Register (SPISR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
SPI Data Register (SPIDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
SPI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register (SPIPURD) . . . . . . . 410
SPI Port Data Register (SPIPORT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
SPI Port Data Direction Register (SPIDDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .412
Full-Duplex Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413
SPI Clock Format 1 (CPHA = 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .417
SPI Clock Format 0 (CPHA = 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .418
Transmission Error Due to Master/Slave Clock Skew . . . . . . 419
19-1
19-2
19-3
19-4
QADC Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
QADC Input and Output Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .432
QADC Module Configuration Register (QADCMCR) . . . . . . . 437
QADC Test Register (QADCTEST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Page
List of Figures
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
35
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Figures
Figure
Title
Page
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19-5 QADC Port QA Data Register (PORTQA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439
19-6 QADC Port QB Data Register (PORTQB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439
19-7 QADC Port QA Data Direction Register (DDRQA)
and Port QB Data Direction Register (DDRQB) . . . . . . . . 441
19-8 QADC Control Register 0 (QACR0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442
19-9 QADC Control Register 1 (QACR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445
19-10 QADC Control Register 2 (QACR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448
19-11 QADC Status Register 0 (QASR0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
19-12 Queue Status Transition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 461
19-13 QADC Status Register 1 (QASR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 462
19-14 Conversion Command Word Table (CCW) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 464
19-15 Right-Justified Unsigned Result Register (RJURR) . . . . . . . . 468
19-16 Left-Justified Signed Result Register (LJSRR). . . . . . . . . . . . 469
19-17 Left-Justified Unsigned Result Register (LJURR). . . . . . . . . . 470
19-18 External Multiplexing Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 472
19-19 QADC Analog Subsystem Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 474
19-20 Conversion Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475
19-21 Bypass Mode Conversion Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476
19-22 QADC Queue Operation with Pause . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 480
19-23 CCW Priority Situation 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483
19-24 CCW Priority Situation 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 483
19-25 CCW Priority Situation 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484
19-26 CCW Priority Situation 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 484
19-27 CCW Priority Situation 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 485
19-28 CCW Priority Situation 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 486
19-29 CCW Priority Situation 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 486
19-30 CCW Priority Situation 8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 487
19-31 CCW Priority Situation 9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 487
19-32 CCW Priority Situation 10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
19-33 CCW Priority Situation 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .488
19-34 CCW Freeze Situation 12 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .489
19-35 CCW Freeze Situation 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .489
19-36 CCW Freeze Situation 14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .490
19-37 CCW Freeze Situation 15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .490
19-38 CCW Freeze Situation 16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .490
19-39 CCW Freeze Situation 17 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .491
Advance Information
36
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
List of Figures
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Figures
Figure
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19-40
19-41
19-42
19-43
19-44
19-45
19-46
19-47
19-48
19-49
19-50
19-51
19-52
19-53
Title
Page
CCW Freeze Situation 18 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .491
CCW Freeze Situation 19 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .491
QADC Clock Subsystem Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503
QADC Conversion Queue Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 506
Equivalent Analog Input Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510
Errors Resulting from Clipping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 511
External Positive Edge Trigger Mode Timing with Pause. . . . 512
Gated Mode, Single Scan Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514
Gated Mode, Continuous Scan Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 514
Star-Ground at the Point of Power Supply Origin . . . . . . . . . . 516
Input Pin Subjected to Negative Stress . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 518
Input Pin Subjected to Positive Stress . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .518
External Multiplexing of Analog Signal Sources . . . . . . . . . . . 520
Electrical Model of an A/D Input Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 521
20-1 Read Cycle Flowchart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 535
20-2 Write Cycle Flowchart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537
20-3 Master Mode — 1-Clock Read and Write Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . 539
20-4 Master Mode — 2-Clock Read and Write Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . 539
20-5 Internal (Show) Cycle Followed by External 1-Clock Read . . 542
20-6 Internal (Show) Cycle Followed by External 1-Clock Write . . 543
21-1 Chip Select Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549
21-2
21-3
21-4
21-5
Chip Select Control Register 0 (CSCR0)
Chip Select Control Register 1 (CSCR1)
Chip Select Control Register 2 (CSCR2)
Chip Select Control Register 3 (CSCR3)
22-1
Top-Level Tap Module and Low-Level (OnCE)
TAP Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 562
Top-Level TAP Controller State Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 566
IDCODE Register Bit Specification. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 571
OnCE Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 579
Low-Level (OnCE) Tap Module Data Registers (DRs) . . . . . . 580
OnCE Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 583
OnCE Controller and Serial Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .585
22-2
22-3
22-4
22-5
22-6
22-7
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
List of Figures
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 551
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 552
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 553
Advance Information
37
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Figures
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure
Advance Information
38
Title
Page
22-8
22-9
22-10
22-11
22-12
22-13
22-14
22-15
22-16
22-17
OnCE Interface Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 586
OnCE Command Register (OCMR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 588
OnCE Control Register (OCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 590
OnCE Status Register (OSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 594
OnCE Memory Breakpoint Logic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 596
OnCE Trace Logic Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 599
CPU Scan Chain Register (CPUSCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .602
Control State Register (CTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 604
OnCE PC FIFO. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 606
Recommended Connector Interface to JTAG/OnCE Port . . . 609
23-1
23-2
23-3
23-4
23-5
23-6
23-7
23-8
23-9
23-10
23-11
23-12
CLKOUT Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 626
Clock Read/Write Cycle Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .627
Read/Write Cycle Timing with Wait States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 628
Show Cycle Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .629
GPIO Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630
RESET and Configuration Override Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631
SPI Timing Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .633
Test Clock Input Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 635
Boundary Scan (JTAG) Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636
Test Access Port Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636
TRST Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 636
Debug Event Pin Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 637
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
List of Figures
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
List of Tables
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table
Title
1-1
Package Option Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
2-1
Register Address Location Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .56
3-1
3-2
Package Pinouts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
4-1
4-2
4-3
4-4
4-5
4-6
4-7
4-8
4-9
4-10
4-11
4-12
Signal Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Write-Once Bits Read/Write Accessibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Chip Configuration Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Chip Configuration Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
Bus Monitor Timeout Values. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
Reset Configuration Pin States During Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Configuration During Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Chip Configuration Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Chip Select CS0 Configuration Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Boot Device Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
Output Pad Driver Strength Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Clock Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
5-1
5-2
5-3
Reset Controller Signal Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Reset Controller Address Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Reset Source Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
6-1
CPU and Peripherals in Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
7-1
M•CORE Instruction Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Page
List of Tables
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
39
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Tables
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table
Title
Page
8-1
8-2
8-3
8-4
8-5
8-6
Interrupt Controller Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
MASK Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Priority Select Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Fast Interrupt Vector Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Vector Table Mapping. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Interrupt Source Assignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
10-1
10-2
10-3
10-4
10-5
10-6
10-7
SGFM Configuration Field . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
SGFM Register Address Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
Register Bank Select Decoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
Security States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
SGFMCMD User Mode Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
FLASH User Mode Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
SGFM Interrupt Sources. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
11-1
11-2
11-3
Signal Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Clock Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
System Frequency Multiplier of the Reference
Frequency in Normal PLL Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
STPMD[1:0] Operation in Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
System Clock Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Clock-Out and Clock-In Relationships . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .258
Loss of Clock Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Stop Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
Charge Pump Current and MFD
in Normal Mode Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
11-4
11-5
11-6
11-7
11-8
11-9
12-1 I/O Port Module Memory Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
12-2 PEPAR Reset Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
12-3 Ports A–I Supported Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Advance Information
40
13-1
13-2
Edge Port Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287
EPPAx Field Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
14-1
Watchdog Timer Module Memory Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
List of Tables
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Tables
Table
Title
Page
15-1 Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules Memory Map . . . . . . 308
15-2 Prescaler Select Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
15-3 PIT Interrupt Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
16-1
16-2
16-3
16-4
16-5
16-6
16-7
16-8
Signal Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
Timer Modules Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
Output Compare Action Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
Input Capture Edge Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
Prescaler Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
Timer Settings and Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
Timer Interrupt Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
17-1
17-2
17-3
Signal Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
Serial Communications Interface Module Memory Map . . . . .359
SCI Normal, Loop, and Single-Wire Mode
Pin Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
17-4 Example Baud Rates (System Clock = 33 MHz) . . . . . . . . . . 375
17-5 Example 10-Bit and 11-Bit Frames. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377
17-6 Start Bit Verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
17-7 Data Bit Recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
17-8 Stop Bit Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384
17-9 SCI Port Control Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394
17-10 SCI Interrupt Request Sources. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
18-1
18-2
18-3
18-4
18-5
18-6
18-7
18-8
Signal Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
SPI Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402
SS Pin I/O Configurations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .404
Bidirectional Pin Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .405
SPI Baud Rate Selection (33-MHz Module Clock) . . . . . . . . .407
SPI Port Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
Normal Mode and Bidirectional Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .421
SPI Interrupt Request Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
19-1
19-2
Multiplexed Analog Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
QADC Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
List of Tables
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
41
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Tables
Table
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19-3
19-4
19-5
19-6
19-7
19-8
19-9
19-10
19-11
19-12
19-13
19-14
19-15
19-16
Title
Page
Prescaler fSYS Divide-by Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .444
Queue 1 Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446
Queue 2 Operating Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 449
CCW Pause Bit Response . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 455
Queue Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .458
Input Sample Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .465
Non-Multiplexed Channel Assignments
and Pin Designations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 466
Multiplexed Channel Assignments
and Pin Designations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 467
Analog Input Channels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473
Trigger Events . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481
Status Bits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 482
External Circuit Settling Time to 1/2 LSB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523
Error Resulting from Input Leakage (IOff) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524
QADC Status Flags and Interrupt Sources. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524
20-1 Signal Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 529
20-2 Data Transfer Cases. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 533
20-3 EB[3:0] Assertion Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534
20-4 Emulation Mode Chip-Select Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 541
20-5 Transfer Code Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .544
20-6 Processor Status Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 544
Advance Information
42
21-1
21-2
21-3
21-4
Signal Properties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
Chip Select Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .550
Chip Select Wait States Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 555
Chip Select Address Range Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .557
22-1
22-2
22-3
22-4
22-5
22-6
22-7
JTAG Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 568
List of Pins Not Scanned in JTAG Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 574
Boundary Scan Register Definition. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 575
OnCE Register Addressing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 589
Sequential Control Field Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 591
Memory Breakpoint Control Field Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 593
Processor Mode Field Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 595
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
List of Tables
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
List of Tables
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table
Title
23-1
23-2
23-3
23-4
23-5
23-6
23-7
23-8
23-9
23-10
23-11
23-12
23-13
23-14
23-15
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 613
Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 614
ESD Protection Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .615
DC Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 616
PLL Electrical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 618
QADC Absolute Maximum Ratings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 620
QADC Electrical Specifications (Operating) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .621
QADC Conversion Specifications (Operating) . . . . . . . . . . . . 622
SGFM FLASH Program and Erase Characteristics . . . . . . . . 624
SGFM FLASH Module Life Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 624
External Interface Timing Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 625
GPIO Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630
Reset and Configuration Override Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631
SPI Timing Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 632
OnCE, JTAG, and Boundary Scan Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 635
25-1
MC Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .647
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Page
List of Tables
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
43
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
List of Tables
Advance Information
44
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
List of Tables
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 1. General Description
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
1.1 Contents
1.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
1.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
1.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
1.2 Introduction
The MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112 are members of a family of
general-purpose microcontrollers (MCU) based on the M•CORE M210
central processor unit (CPU).
These are low-voltage devices that operate between 2.7 volts and
3.6 volts. They are well suited for use in battery-powered applications.
The maximum operating frequency is 33 MHz over a temperature range
of –40°C to 85°C.
Available packages are:
•
100-pin low-profile quad flat pack (LQFP) for single-chip mode
operation
•
144-pin LQFP for applications requiring an external memory
interface or a large number of general-purpose inputs/outputs
(GPIO)
•
196-ball plastic mold array process ball grid array (MAPBGA)
providing the same functionality as the 144-pin LQFP in a smaller
form factor
Table 1-1 summarizes the memory sizes, package options, and
operating modes of the MMC2112, MMC2113, and MMC2114.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
General Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
45
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
General Description
Table 1-1. Package Option Summary
Device
On-Chip SRAM
(Kbytes)
On-Chip FLASH
(Kbytes)
Packages
Operating
Modes(1)
MMC2112
32
—
144 LQFP
196 MAPBGA
Master only
MMC2113
8
128
MMC2114
32
256
100 LQFP
144 LQFP
196 MAPBGA
Single chip
Master
Emulation
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
1. See 4.4 Modes of Operation for descriptions of the different MCU operating modes.
NOTE:
The MMC2113 may contain more than 8K of internal SRAM, but only the
8K range from 0x0080_0000 to 0x0080_1fff is tested and guaranteed to
be operational. It is recommended that internal SRAM outside this range
not be used. Accesses to SRAM outside this range terminate without a
transfer error exception.
1.3 Features
Features include:
•
M•CORE M210 integer processor:
– 32-bit reduced instruction set computer (RISC) architecture
– Low power and high performance
•
OnCE debug support
•
128 Kbytes (MMC2113) or 256 Kbytes (MMC2114) FLASH
memory(1):
– Single cycle byte, half-word (16-bit) and word (32-bit) reads
– Fast automated program and erase cycles
– Ability to program one FLASH bank while executing from
another (MMC2114 only)
– Interrupt on program/erase command completion
– Flexible protection scheme for accidental program/erase
– Access restriction controls for both supervisor/user and
data/program spaces
1. The MMC2112 has no integrated FLASH memory and is intended for use with external
non-volatile memory devices.
Advance Information
46
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
General Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
General Description
Features
– Enhanced security feature prevents unauthorized access to
contents of FLASH (protects company IP)
– Single supply operation (no need for separate, high voltage
program/erase supply)
•
8 Kbytes (MMC2113) or 32 Kbytes (MMC2112 and MMC2114) of
static random-access memory (SRAM):
– Single cycle byte, half-word (16-bit), and word (32-bit) reads
and writes
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
– Standby power supply support
•
Serial peripheral interface (SPI):
– Master mode and slave mode
– Wired-OR mode
– Slave select output
– Mode fault error flag with CPU interrupt capability
– Double-buffered receiver
– Serial clock with programmable polarity and phase
– Control of SPI operation during wait mode
– Reduced drive control
– General-purpose input/output (I/O) capability
•
Two serial communications interfaces (SCI):
– Full-duplex operation
– Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format
– 13-bit baud rate prescaler
– Programmable 8-bit or 9-bit data format
– Separately enabled transmitter and receiver
– Separate receiver and transmitter CPU interrupt requests
– Two receiver wakeup methods (idle line and address mark)
– Receiver framing error detection
– Hardware parity checking
– 1/16 bit-time noise detection
– Reduced drive control
– General-purpose I/O capability
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
General Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
47
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
General Description
•
Two timers:
– Four 16-bit input capture/output compare channels
– 16-bit architecture
– 16-bit pulse accumulator
– Pulse widths variable from microseconds to seconds
– Eight selectable prescalers
– Toggle-on-overflow feature for pulse-width modulation
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
•
Queued analog-to-digital converter (QADC):
– Eight analog input channels
– 10-bit resolution ±2 counts accuracy
– Minimum 7 µs conversion time
– Internal sample and hold
– Programmable input sample time for various source
impedances
– Two conversion command queues with a total of 64 entries
– Subqueues possible using pause mechanism
– Queue complete and pause interrupts available on both
queues
– Queue pointers indicate current location for each queue
– Automated queue modes initiated by:
External edge trigger and gated trigger
Periodic/interval timer, within queued analog-to-digital
converter (QADC) module {queue1 and queue2}
Software command
– Single-scan or continuous-scan of queues
– Output data readable in three formats:
Right-justified unsigned
Left-justified signed
Left-justified unsigned
– Unused analog channels can be used as digital I/O
– Minimum pin set configuration implemented
Advance Information
48
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
General Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
General Description
Features
•
Interrupt controller:
– Up to 40 interrupt sources
– 32 unique programmable priority levels for each interrupt
source
– Independent enable/disable of pending interrupts based on
priority level
– Normal or fast interrupt request for each priority level
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
– Fast interrupt requests always have priority over normal
interrupts
– Ability to mask interrupts at and below a defined priority level
– Ability to select between autovectored or vectored interrupt
requests
– Vectored interrupts generated based on priority level
– Ability to generate a separate vector number for normal and
fast interrupts
– Ability for software to self-schedule interrupts
– Software visibility of pending interrupts and interrupt signals to
core
– Asynchronous operation to support wakeup from low-power
modes
•
External interrupts supported:
– Rising/falling edge select
– Low-level sensitive
– Ability for software generation of external interrupt event
– Interrupt pins configurable as general-purpose I/O
•
Two periodic interval timers:
– 16-bit counter with modulus "initial count" register
– Selectable as free running or count down
– 16 selectable prescalers — 20 to 215
•
Watchdog timer:
– 16-bit counter with modulus "initial count" register
– Pause option for low-power modes
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
General Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
49
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
General Description
•
Phase-lock loop (PLL):
– Reference crystal from 2 to 10 MHz
– Low-power modes supported
– Separate clock-out signal
•
Integrated low-voltage detector (LVD):
– Can be enabled and disabled under software control
– Sets flag when VDD drops below internal bandgap reference
threshold
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
– Reset and interrupt request enable bits
– Optional automatic disabling in low-power stop mode
•
Reset:
– Separate reset in and reset out signals
– Seven sources of reset:
Power-on reset (POR)
External
Software
Watchdog timer
Loss of clock
Loss of PLL lock
Low-voltage detect
– Status flag indicates source of last reset
•
Chip configurations:
– Support for single-chip, master, emulation, and test modes
– System configuration during reset
– Bus monitor
– Configurable output pad drive strength control
•
General-purpose input/output (GPIO):
– Up to 72 bits of GPIO
– Coherent 32-bit control
– Bit manipulation supported via set/clear functions
– Unused peripheral pins may be used as extra GPIO.
Advance Information
50
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
General Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
General Description
Block Diagram
•
External bus interface:
– Provides for direct support of asynchronous random-access
memory (RAM), read-only memory (ROM), FLASH, and
memory mapped peripherals
– Bidirectional data bus with wide (32-bit) and narrow (16-bit)
modes
– 23-bit address bus with four chip selects provide access to
32 Mbytes of external memory
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
– Byte/write enables
– Boot from on-chip FLASH or external memories
– Internal bus activity is visible via show-cycle mode
– Special chip selects support replacement of GPIO with
external port replacement logic
•
Joint Test Action Group (JTAG) support for system-level board
testing
1.4 Block Diagram
The basic structure of these devices is shown in Figure 1-1.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
General Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
51
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG
TAP
SRAM
8 KBYTES (MMC2113)
32 KBYTES (MMC2112/4)
VSSF
VDDF
TRST
TCLK
TMS
TDI
TDO
DE
VSTBY
General Description
FLASH
128 KBYTES (MMC2113)
256 KBYTES (MMC2114)
0 KBYTE (MMC2112)
CS
CPU BUS
CPU
TEST
PSTAT[3:0]
IPBUS
INTERFACE
PROGRAMMABLE
INTERVAL
TIMER 1
INTERRUPT
CONTROLLER
PROGRAMMABLE
INTERVAL
TIMER 2
EDGE
PORT
WATCHDOG
TIMER
INT[7:0]
A[22:0]
PORTS
OnCE
EXTERNAL MEMORY INTERFACE
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
D[31:0]
R/W
EB[3:0]
CS[3:0]
TC[2:0]
SHS
CSE[1:0]
TA
TEA
OE
TEST
EXTAL
XTAL
CLKOUT
PLLEN
OSC/PLL
POR
RESET
RSTOUT
VSS x 8
VDD x 8
RESET
LVD
IPBUS
VRL, VRH
TIM1
TIM2
SCI1
SPI
SCI2
ADC
VDDA, VSSA
PQA[4:3]
PQA[1:0]
PQB[3:0]
MISO
MOSI
SCK
SS
TXD2
RXD2
RXD1
TXD1
ICOC2[3:0]
ICOC1[3:0]
VDDH
Figure 1-1. Block Diagram
Advance Information
52
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
General Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 2. System Memory Map
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
2.1 Contents
2.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
2.3
Address Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
2.4
Register Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .57
2.2 Introduction
The address maps, shown in Figure 2-1, Figure 2-2, and Figure 2-3,
include:
•
Internal FLASH:
– 256 Kbytes (MMC2114)
– 128 Kbytes (MMC2113)
– 0 Kbytes (MMC2112)
•
Internal static random-access memory (SRAM):
– 32 Kbytes (MMC2112 and MMC2114)
– 8 Kbytes (MMC2113)
•
Internal memory mapped registers
•
External address space
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
53
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
2.3 Address Map
0xffff_ffff
EXTERNAL MEMORY
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x8000_0000
0x00d0_002f
REGISTERS
SEE TABLE 2-1
0x00c0_0000
0x0080_7fff
INTERNAL SRAM
32 KBYTES
0x0080_0000
0x0000_0000
Figure 2-1. MMC2112 Address Map
0xffff_ffff
EXTERNAL MEMORY
0x8000_0000
0x00d0_002f
REGISTERS
SEE TABLE 2-1
0x00c0_0000
0x0080_1fff
0x0080_0000
INTERNAL SRAM
8 KBYTES
0x0001_ffff
0x0000_0000
INTERNAL FLASH
128 KBYTES
Figure 2-2. MMC2113 Address Map
Advance Information
54
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address Map
NOTE:
The MMC2113 may contain more than 8K of internal SRAM, but only the
8K range from 0x0080_0000 to 0x0080_1fff is tested and guaranteed to
be operational. It is recommended that internal SRAM outside this range
not be used. Accesses to SRAM outside this range terminate without a
transfer error exception.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0xffff_ffff
EXTERNAL MEMORY
0x8000_0000
0x00d0_002f
REGISTERS
SEE TABLE 2-1
0x00c0_0000
0x0080_7fff
0x0080_0000
0x0003_ffff
0x0000_0000
INTERNAL SRAM
32 KBYTES
INTERNAL FLASH
256 KBYTES
Figure 2-3. MMC2114 Address Map
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
55
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 2-1. Register Address Location Map(1)
Base Address
(Hex)
Maximum
Size
0x00c0_0000
64 Kbyte
Ports(2) (PORTS)
0x00c1_0000
64 Kbyte
Chip configuration (CCM)
0x00c2_0000
64 Kbyte
Chip selects (CS)
0x00c3_0000
64 Kbyte
Clocks (CLOCK)
0x00c4_0000
64 Kbyte
Reset (RESET)
0x00c5_0000
64 Kbyte
Interrupt controller (INTC)
0x00c6_0000
64 Kbyte
Edge port (EPORT)
0x00c7_0000
64 Kbyte
Watchdog timer (WDT)
0x00c8_0000
64 Kbyte
Programmable interrupt timer 1 (PIT1)
0x00c9_0000
64 Kbyte
Programmable interrupt timer 2 (PIT2)
0x00ca_0000
64 Kbyte
Queued analog-to-digital converter (QADC)
0x00cb_0000
64 Kbyte
Serial peripheral interface (SPI)
0x00cc_0000
64 Kbyte
Serial communications interface 1 (SCI1)
0x00cd_0000
64 Kbyte
Serial communications interface 2 (SCI2)
0x00ce_0000
64 Kbyte
Timer 1 (TIM1)
0x00cf_0000
64 Kbyte
Timer 2 (TIM2)
0x00d0_0000
64 Kbyte
FLASH registers (SGFM)
0x8000_0000
2 Gbyte
External Memory
Usage
1. See module sections for details of how much of each block is being decoded. Accesses to
addresses outside the module memory maps (and also the reserved area
0x00d1_0000–0x7fff_ffff) will not be responded to and will result in a bus monitor transfer
error exception.
2. The port register space is mirrored/repeated in the 64-Kbyte block. This allows the full 64Kbyte block to be decoded and used to execute an external access to a port replacement
unit in emulation mode.
Advance Information
56
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
2.4 Register Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Ports (PORTS)
Bit 7
0x00c0_0000
Port A Output Data Read:
PORTA7
Register (PORTA)
Write:
See page 275.
Reset:
1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Bit 7
0x00c0_0001
Port B Output Data Read:
PORTB7
Register (PORTB)
Write:
See page 275.
Reset:
1
Bit 7
0x00c0_0002
Port C Output Data Read:
PORTC7
Register (PORTC)
Write:
See page 275.
Reset:
1
Bit 7
0x00c0_0003
Port D Output Data Read:
PORTD7
Register (PORTD)
Write:
See page 275.
Reset:
1
Bit 7
0x00c0_0004
Port E Output Data Read:
PORTE7
Register (PORTE)
Write:
See page 275.
Reset :
1
Bit 7
0x00c0_0005
Port F Output Data Read:
PORTF7
Register (PORTF)
Write:
See page 275.
Reset:
1
Bit 7
0x00c0_0006
P = Current pin state
Port G Output Data Read:
PORTG7
Register (PORTG)
Write:
See page 275.
Reset:
1
U = Unaffected
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTA6
PORTA5
PORTA4
PORTA3
PORTA2
PORTA1
PORTA0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTB6
PORTB5
PORTB4
PORTB3
PORTB2
PORTB1
PORTB0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTC6
PORTC5
PORTC4
PORTC3
PORTC2
PORTC1
PORTC0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTD6
PORTD5
PORTD4
PORTD3
PORTD2
PORTD1
PORTD0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTE6
PORTE5
PORTE4
PORTE3
PORTE2
PORTE1
PORTE0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTF6
PORTF5
PORTF4
PORTF3
PORTF2
PORTF1
PORTF0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTG6
PORTG5
PORTG4
PORTG3
PORTG2
PORTG1
PORTG0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
57
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 7
0x00c0_0007
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00c0_0008
0x00c0_000d
0x00c0_000e
0x00c0_000f
0x00c0_0010
P = Current pin state
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTH6
PORTH5
PORTH4
PORTH3
PORTH2
PORTH1
PORTH0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTI7
PORTI6
PORTI5
PORTI4
PORTI3
PORTI2
PORTI1
PORTI0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Port H Output Data Read:
PORTH7
Register (PORTH)
Write:
See page 275.
Reset:
1
Port I Output Data Read:
Register (PORTI)
Write:
See page 275.
Reset:
Reserved
0x00c0_0009
↓
0x00c0_000b
0x00c0_000c
6
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Port A Data Direction Read:
Register (DDRA)
Write:
See page 276.
Reset:
Port B Data Direction Read:
Register (DDRB)
Write:
See page 276.
Reset:
Port C Data Direction Read:
Register (DDRC)
Write:
See page 276.
Reset:
Port D Data Direction Read:
Register (DDRD)
Write:
See page 276.
Reset:
Port E Data Direction Read:
Register (DDRE)
Write:
See page 276.
Reset:
U = Unaffected
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRA7
DDRA6
DDRA5
DDRA4
DDRA3
DDRA2
DDRA1
DDRA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRB7
DDRB6
DDRB5
DDRB4
DDRB3
DDRB2
DDRB1
DDRB0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRC7
DDRC6
DDRC5
DDRC4
DDRC3
DDRC2
DDRC1
DDRC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRD7
DDRD6
DDRD5
DDRD4
DDRD3
DDRD2
DDRD1
DDRD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRE7
DDRE6
DDRE5
DDRE4
DDRE3
DDRE2
DDRE1
DDRE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 37)
Advance Information
58
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
0x00c0_0011
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00c0_0012
0x00c0_0013
0x00c0_0014
0x00c0_0015
↓
0x00c0_0017
Register Name
Bit Number
Port F Data Direction Read:
Register (DDRF)
Write:
See page 276.
Reset:
Port G Data Direction Read:
Register (DDRG)
Write:
See page 276.
Reset:
Port H Data Direction Read:
Register (DDRH)
Write:
See page 276.
Reset:
Port I Data Direction Read:
Register (DDRI)
Write:
See page 276.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRF7
DDRF6
DDRF5
DDRF4
DDRF3
DDRF2
DDRF1
DDRF0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRG7
DDRG6
DDRG5
DDRG4
DDRG3
DDRG2
DDRG1
DDRG0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRH7
DDRH6
DDRH5
DDRH4
DDRH3
DDRH2
DDRH1
DDRH0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRI7
DDRI6
DDRI5
DDRI4
DDRI3
DDRI2
DDRI1
DDRI0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Reserved
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Bit 7
0x00c0_0018
P = Current pin state
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Port B Pin Data/Set Read: PORTBP7 PORTBP6 PORTBP5 PORTBP4 PORTBP3 PORTBP2 PORTBP1 PORTBP0
Data Register
Write: SETB7
SETB6
SETB5
SETB4
SETB3
SETB2
SETB1
SETB0
(PORTBP/SETB)
See page 277. Reset:
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Bit 7
0x00c0_001a
5
Port A Pin Data/Set Read: PORTAP7 PORTAP6 PORTAP5 PORTAP4 PORTAP3 PORTAP2 PORTAP1 PORTAP0
Data Register
Write: SETA7
SETA6
SETA5
SETA4
SETA3
SETA2
SETA1
SETA0
(PORTAP/SETA)
See page 277. Reset:
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Bit 7
0x00c0_0019
6
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Port C Pin Data/Set Read: PORTCP7 PORTCP6 PORTCP5 PORTCP4 PORTCP3 PORTCP2 PORTCP1 PORTCP0
Data Register
Write: SETC7
SETC6
SETC5
SETC4
SETC3
SETC2
SETC1
SETC0
(PORTCP/SETC)
See page 277. Reset:
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
59
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 7
0x00c0_001b
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Port I Pin Data/Set Read: PORTIP7
Data Register
Write: SETI7
(PORTIP/SETI)
See page 277. Reset:
P
Bit 7
Reserved
0x00c0_0021
↓
0x00c0_0023
0x00c0_0024
P = Current pin state
1
Bit 0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Port H Pin Data/Set Read: PORTHP7 PORTHP6 PORTHP5 PORTHP4 PORTHP3 PORTHP2 PORTHP1 PORTHP0
Data Register
Write: SETH7
SETH6
SETH5
SETH4
SETH3
SETH2
SETH1
SETH0
(PORTHP/SETH)
See page 277. Reset:
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Bit 7
0x00c0_0020
2
Port G Pin Data/Set Read: PORTGP7 PORTGP6 PORTGP5 PORTGP4 PORTGP3 PORTGP2 PORTGP1 PORTGP0
Data Register
Write: SETG7
SETG6
SETG5
SETG4
SETG3
SETG2
SETG1
SETG0
(PORTGP/SETG)
See page 277. Reset:
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Bit 7
0x00c0_001f
3
Port F Pin Data/Set Read: PORTFP7 PORTFP6 PORTFP5 PORTFP4 PORTFP3 PORTFP2 PORTFP1 PORTFP0
Data Register
Write: SETF7
SETF6
SETF5
SETF4
SETF3
SETF2
SETF1
SETF0
(PORTFP/SETF)
See page 277. Reset:
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Bit 7
0x00c0_001e
4
Port E Pin Data/Set Read: PORTEP7 PORTEP6 PORTEP5 PORTEP4 PORTEP3 PORTEP2 PORTEP1 PORTEP0
Data Register
Write: SETE7
SETE6
SETE5
SETE4
SETE3
SETE2
SETE1
SETE0
(PORTEP/SETE)
See page 277. Reset:
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Bit 7
0x00c0_001d
5
Port D Pin Data/Set Read: PORTDP7 PORTDP6 PORTDP5 PORTDP4 PORTDP3 PORTDP2 PORTDP1 PORTDP0
Data Register
Write: SETD7
SETD6
SETD5
SETD4
SETD3
SETD2
SETD1
SETD0
(PORTDP/SETD)
See page 277. Reset:
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Bit 7
0x00c0_001c
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTIP6
PORTIP5
PORTIP4
PORTIP3
PORTIP2
PORTIP1
PORTIP0
SETI6
SETI5
SETI4
SETI3
SETI2
SETI1
SETI0
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Port A Clear Output Read:
Data Register (CLRA)
Write:
See page 278.
Reset:
U = Unaffected
6
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CLRA7
CLRA6
CLRA5
CLRA4
CLRA3
CLRA2
CLRA1
CLRA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 4 of 37)
Advance Information
60
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
0x00c0_0025
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00c0_0026
0x00c0_0027
0x00c0_0028
0x00c0_0029
0x00c0_002a
0x00c0_002b
P = Current pin state
Register Name
Bit Number
Port B Clear Output Read:
Data Register (CLRB)
Write:
See page 278.
Reset:
Port C Clear Output Read:
Data Register (CLRC)
Write:
See page 278.
Reset:
Port D Clear Output Read:
Data Register (CLRD)
Write:
See page 278.
Reset:
Port E Clear Output Read:
Data Register (CLRE)
Write:
See page 278.
Reset:
Port F Clear Output Read:
Data Register (CLRF)
Write:
See page 278.
Reset:
Port G Clear Output Read:
Data Register (CLRG)
Write:
See page 278.
Reset:
Port H Clear Output Read:
Data Register (CLRH)
Write:
See page 278.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CLRB7
CLRB6
CLRB5
CLRB4
CLRB3
CLRB2
CLRB1
CLRB0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CLRC7
CLRC6
CLRC5
CLRC4
CLRC3
CLRC2
CLRC1
CLRC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CLRD7
CLRD6
CLRD5
CLRD4
CLRD3
CLRD2
CLRD1
CLRD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CLRE7
CLRE6
CLRE5
CLRE4
CLRE3
CLRE2
CLRE1
CLRE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CLRF7
CLRF6
CLRF5
CLRF4
CLRF3
CLRF2
CLRF1
CLRF0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CLRG7
CLRG6
CLRG5
CLRG4
CLRG3
CLRG2
CLRG1
CLRG0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CLRH7
CLRH6
CLRH5
CLRH4
CLRH3
CLRH2
CLRH1
CLRH0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 5 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
61
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
0x00c0_002c
Register Name
Port I Clear Output Read:
Data Register (CLRI)
Write:
See page 278.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
CLRI7
CLRI6
CLRI5
CLRI4
CLRI3
CLRI2
CLRI1
CLRI0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Reserved
0x00c0_002d
↓
0x00c0_002f
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Bit Number
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Bit 7
0x00c0_0030
Port C/D Pin Read:
PCDPA
Assignment Register
Write:
(PCDPAR)
See page 279. Reset: See note
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Note: Reset state determined during reset configuration. PCDPA = 1 except in single-chip
mode or when an external boot device is selected with a 16-bit port size in master mode.
Bit 7
0x00c0_0031
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Port E Pin Read:
PEPA7
PEPA6
PEPA5
PEPA4
PEPA3
PEPA2
PEPA1
PEPA0
Assignment Register
Write:
(PEPAR)
See page 280. Reset: Reset state determined during reset configuration as shown in Table 12-2. PEPAR Reset Values.
Bit 7
Reserved
0x00c0_0032
↓
0x00c0_003f
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Reserved
0x00c0_0040
↓
0x00c0_ffff
P = Current pin state
6
Ports register space (block of 0x00c0_0000 through 0x00c0_003f) is mirrored/repeated.
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 6 of 37)
Advance Information
62
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Bit 15
0x00c1_0000
0x00c1_0001
Chip Configuration Read:
Register
Write:
(CCR)
See page 126. Reset:
Read:
14
13
12
SHEN
EMINT
0
LOAD
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
MODE2
MODE1
MODE0
Note 1
0
Note 2
Note 2
0
Note 1
Note 1
Note 1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SZEN
PSTEN
SHINT
BME
BMD
BMT1
BMT0
Note 3
Note 2
0
1
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
0
Notes:
1. Determined during reset configuration
2. 0 for all configurations except emulation mode, 1 for emulation mode
3. 0 for all configurations except emulation and master modes, 1 for emulation and master modes
Bit 7
0x00c1_0002
Reserved
0x00c1_0004
0x00c1_0005
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Bit 7
0x00c1_0003
6
Reserved
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Reset Configuration Read:
Register (RCON)
Write:
See page 129.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
RLOAD
0
0
0
MODE
0
0
0
0
1
1
RPLLSEL RPLLREF
1
0
BOOTPS BOOTSEL
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
1
U = Unaffected
1
1
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 7 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
63
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
0x00c1_0006
0x00c1_0007
Register Name
Bit Number
Chip Identification
Read:
Register (CIR)
See page 131.
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
PIN7
0
PIN6
0
PIN5
1
PIN4
0
PIN3
1
PIN2
1
PIN1
1
PIN0
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
PRN7
0
PRN6
0
PRN5
0
PRN4
0
PRN3
0
PRN2
0
PRN1
0
PRN0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Write:
Reset:
0x00c1_0008
0x00c1_0009
Chip Test Register Read:
(CTR)
Write:
See page 132.
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0x00c1_000a
0x00c1_000b
Reserved
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Bit 7
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
0x00c1_000c
↓
0x00c1_000f
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
0x00c1_0010
↓
0x00c1_ffff
P = Current pin state
6
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 8 of 37)
Advance Information
64
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Chip Selects (CS)
0x00c2_0000
0x00c2_0001
Chip Select Control Read:
Register 0 (CSCR0)
Write:
See page 551.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SO
RO
PS
WWS
WE
WS2
WS1
WS0
0
0
See note
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TAEN
CSEN
0
1
See note
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
Note: Reset state determined during reset configuration.
0x00c2_0002
0x00c2_0003
Chip Select Control Read:
Register 1 (CSCR1)
Write:
See page 552.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SO
RO
PS
WWS
WE
WS2
WS1
WS0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TAEN
CSEN
0
1
See note
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
Note: Reset state determined during reset configuration
0x00c2_0004
0x00c2_0005
Chip Select Control Read:
Register 2 (CSCR2)
Write:
See page 552.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SO
RO
PS
WWS
WE
WS2
WS1
WS0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TAEN
CSEN
1
0
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
0
U = Unaffected
0
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 9 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
65
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
0x00c2_0006
0x00c2_0007
Register Name
Bit Number
Chip Select Control Read:
Register 3 (CSCR3)
Write:
See page 553.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SO
RO
PS
WWS
WE
WS2
WS1
WS0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TAEN
CSEN
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
0x00c2_0008
↓
0x00c2_ffff
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
Clocks (CLOCK)
0x00c3_0000
0x00c3_0001
Synthesizer Control Read:
Register (SYNCR)
Write:
See page 250.
Reset:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
LOLRE
MFD2
MFD1
MFD0
LOCRE
RFD2
RFD1
RFD0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
LOCEN
DISCLK
FWKUP
RSVD4
STMPD1
STMPD0
RSVD1
RSVD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PLLSEL
PLLREF
LOCKS
LOCK
LOCS
0
0
Note 1
Note 1
Note 2
Note 2
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0x00c3_0002
Synthesizer Status Read: PLLMODE
Register (SYNSR)
Write:
See page 253.
Reset: Note 1
Notes:
1. Reset state determined during reset configuration
2. See the LOCKS and LOCK bit descriptions.
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 10 of 37)
Advance Information
66
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
0x00c3_0003
Register Name
Synthesizer Test Register Read:
(SYNTR)
Write:
See page 256.
Reset:
0x00c3_0004
0x00c3_0005
0x00c3_0006
0x00c3_0007
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Bit Number
Synthesizer Test Read:
Register 2 (SYNTR2)
Write:
See page 257.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
RSVD9
RSVD8
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
RSVD2
RSVD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0x00c3_0008
↓
0x00c3_ffff
Unimplemented
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
Reset (RESET)
Bit 7
0x00c4_0000
6
Reset Control Register Read:
FRCSOFTRST
(RCR)
RSTOUT
Write:
See page 143.
Reset:
0
0
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
LVDF
LVDIE
LVDRE
LVDSE
LVDE
See note
0
0
0
0
0
0
Note: Reset dependent
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 11 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
67
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
Register Name
Reset Status Register Read:
(RSR)
Write:
See page 143.
Reset:
0x00c4_0001
0x00c4_0002
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Bit Number
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
LVD
SOFT
WDR
POR
EXT
LOC
LOL
0
Reset dependent
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Reset Test Register Read:
(RTR)
Write:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0x00c4_0003
Reserved
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
0x00c4_0004
↓
0x00c4_ffff
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
Interrupt Controller (INTC)
0x00c5_0000
0x00c5_0001
Interrupt Control Register Read:
(ICR)
Write:
See page 181.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
AE
FVE
ME
MFI
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
MASK4
MASK3
MASK2
MASK1
MASK0
Write:
Reset:
0x00c5_0002
0x00c5_0003
Interrupt Status Register Read:
(ISR)
Write:
See page 183.
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
INT
FINT
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
VEC6
VEC5
VEC4
VEC3
VEC2
VEC1
VEC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 12 of 37)
Advance Information
68
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
0x00c5_0004
0x00c5_0005
0x00c5_0006
0x00c5_0007
Register Name
Bit Number
Interrupt Force Register Read:
High (IFRH)
Write:
See page 184.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
IF39
IF38
IF37
IF36
IF35
IF34
IF33
IF32
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
IF31
IF30
IF29
IF28
IF27
IF26
IF25
IF24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
IF23
IF22
IF21
IF20
IF19
IF18
IF17
IF16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
IF15
IF14
IF13
IF12
IF11
IF10
IF9
IF8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
IF7
IF6
IF5
IF4
IF3
IF2
IF1
IF0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0x00c5_0008
0x00c5_0009
0x00c5_000a
0x00c5_000b
Interrupt Force Register Read:
Low (IFRL)
Write:
See page 185.
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 13 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
69
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
0x00c5_000c
0x00c5_000d
0x00c5_000e
0x00c5_000f
Register Name
Bit Number
Interrupt Pending Register Read:
(IPR)
Write:
See page 186.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
IP31
IP30
IP29
IP28
IP27
IP26
IP25
IP24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
IP23
IP22
IP21
IP20
IP19
IP18
IP17
IP16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
IP15
IP14
IP13
IP12
IP11
IP10
IP9
IP8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
IP7
IP6
IP5
IP4
IP3
IP2
IP1
IP0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
NIE31
NIE30
NIE29
NIE28
NIE27
NIE26
NIE25
NIE24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
NIE23
NIE22
NIE21
NIE20
NIE19
NIE18
NIE17
NIE16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
NIE15
NIE14
NIE13
NIE12
NIE11
NIE10
NIE9
NIE8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
NIE7
NIE6
NIE5
NIE4
NIE3
NIE2
NIE1
NIE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0x00c5_0010
0x00c5_0011
0x00c5_0012
0x00c5_0013
Normal Interrupt Enable Read:
Register (NIER)
Write:
See page 187.
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 14 of 37)
Advance Information
70
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
0x00c5_0014
0x00c5_0015
0x00c5_0016
0x00c5_0017
Register Name
Bit Number
Normal Interrupt Pending Read:
Register (NIPR)
Write:
See page 188.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
NIP31
NIP30
NIP29
NIP28
NIP27
NIP26
NIP25
NIP24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
NIP23
NIP22
NIP21
NIP20
NIP19
NIP18
NIP17
NIP16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
NIP15
NIP14
NIP13
NIP12
NIP11
NIP10
NIP9
NIP8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
NIP7
NIP6
NIP5
NIP4
NIP3
NIP2
NIP1
NIP0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
FIE31
FIE30
FIE29
FIE28
FIE27
FIE26
FIE25
FIE24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
FIE23
FIE22
FIE21
FIE20
FIE19
FIE18
FIE17
FIE16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
FIE15
FIE14
FIE13
FIE12
FIE11
FIE10
FIE9
FIE8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
FIE7
FIE6
FIE5
FIE4
FIE3
FIE2
FIE1
FIE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0x00c5_0018
0x00c5_0019
0x00c5_001a
0x00c5_001b
Fast Interrupt Enable Read:
Register (FIER)
Write:
See page 189.
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 15 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
71
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
0x00c5_001c
0x00c5_001d
0x00c5_001e
0x00c5_001f
Register Name
Bit Number
Fast Interrupt Pending Read:
Register (FIPR)
Write:
See page 190.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
FIP31
FIP30
FIP29
FIP28
FIP27
FIP26
FIP25
FIP24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
FIP23
FIP22
FIP21
FIP20
FIP19
FIP18
FIP17
FIP16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
FIP15
FIP14
FIP13
FIP12
FIP11
FIP10
FIP9
FIP8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
FIP7
FIP6
FIP5
FIP4
FIP3
FIP2
FIP1
FIP0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
PLS4
PLS3
PLS2
PLS1
PLS0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0x00c5_0040
↓
0x00c5_0067
Priority Level Select Read:
Registers
Write:
(PLSR39–PLSR0)
See page 191. Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
0x00c5_0068
↓
0x00c5_007f
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error.
Bit 7
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
0x00c5_0080
↓
0x00c5_ffff
P = Current pin state
6
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 16 of 37)
Advance Information
72
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Edge Port (EPORT)
Bit 15
0x00c6_0000
0x00c6_0001
EPORT Pin Assignment Read:
Register (EPPAR)
Write:
See page 288.
Reset:
14
13
EPPA7
12
11
EPPA6
10
9
EPPA5
Bit 8
EPPA4
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
EPPA3
EPPA2
EPPA1
EPPA0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
EPORT Data Direction Read:
Register (EPDDR)
Write:
See page 290.
Reset:
0x00c6_0002
0x00c6_0003
EPORT Port Interrupt Read:
Enable Register (EPIER)
Write:
See page 291.
Reset:
EPORT Port Data Read:
Register (EPDR)
Write:
See page 292.
Reset:
0x00c6_0004
EPORT Port Pin Data Read:
Register (EPPDR)
Write:
See page 292.
Reset:
0x00c6_0005
0x00c6_0006
EPORT Port Flag Regiser Read:
(EPFR)
Write:
See page 293.
Reset:
0x00c6_0007
P = Current pin state
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EPDD7
EPDD6
EPDD5
EPDD4
EPDD3
EPDD2
EPDD1
EPDD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EPIE7
EPIE6
EPIE5
EPIE4
EPIE3
EPIE2
EPIE1
EPIE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EPD7
EPD6
EPD5
EPD4
EPD3
EPD2
EPD1
EPD0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EPPD7
EPPD6
EPPD5
EPPD4
EPPD3
EPPD2
EPPD1
EPPD0
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EPF7
EPF6
EPF5
EPF4
EPF3
EPF2
EPF1
EPF0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Reserved
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 17 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
73
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
0x00c6_0008
↓
0x00c6_ffff
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Watchdog Control Read:
Register (WCR)
Write:
See page 299.
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00c7_0000
0x00c7_0001
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
WAIT
DOZE
DBG
EN
Write:
Reset:
Watchdog Modulus Read:
Register (WMR)
Write:
See page 301.
Reset:
0x00c7_0002
0x00c7_0003
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
WM15
WM14
WM13
WM12
WM11
WM10
WM9
WM8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
WM7
WM6
WM5
WM4
WM3
WM2
WM1
WM0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
WC15
WC14
WC13
WC12
WC11
WC10
WC9
WC8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
WC7
WC6
WC5
WC4
WC3
WC2
WC1
WC0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0x00c7_0004
0x00c7_0005
Watchdog Count Register Read:
(WCNTR)
Write:
See page 302.
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 18 of 37)
Advance Information
74
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
0x00c7_0006
0x00c7_0007
Register Name
Bit Number
Watchdog Service Read:
Register (WSR)
Write:
See page 303.
Reset:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
WS15
WS14
WS13
WS12
WS11
WS10
WS9
WS8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
WS7
WS6
WS5
WS4
WS3
WS2
WS1
WS0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
0x00c7_0008
↓
0x00c7_ffff
Unimplemented
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
Programmable Interrupt Timer 1 (PIT1) and Programming Interrupt Timer 2 (PIT2)
Note: Addresses for PIT1 are at 0x00c8_#### and addresses for PIT2 are at 0x00c9_####.
0x00c8_0000
0x00c8_0001
0x00c9_0000
0x00c9_0001
PIT Control and Status Read:
Register (PCSR)
Write:
See page 309.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
0
0
0
0
11
10
9
Bit 8
PRE3
PRE2
PRE1
PRE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PDOZE
PDBG
OVW
PIE
PIF
RLD
EN
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
PM15
PM14
PM13
PM12
PM11
PM10
PM9
PM8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PM7
PM6
PM5
PM4
PM3
PM2
PM1
PM0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
Write:
Reset:
0x00c8_0002
0x00c8_0003
0x00c9_0002
0x00c9_0003
PIT Modulus Register Read:
(PMR)
Write:
See page 312.
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 19 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
75
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
0x00c8_0004
0x00c8_0005
0x00c9_0004
0x00c9_0005
Register Name
Bit Number
PIT Count Register Read:
(PCNTR)
Write:
See page 313.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
PC15
PC14
PC13
PC12
PC11
PC10
PC9
PC8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PC7
PC6
PC5
PC4
PC3
PC2
PC1
PC0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Unimplemented
0x00c8_0006
↓
0x00c8_0007
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
0x00ca_0008
↓
0x00ca_ffff
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
0x00ca_0000
0x00ca_0001
QADC Module Read:
Configuration Register
Write:
(QADCMCR)
See page 437. Reset:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
QSTOP
QDBG
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Read:
SUPV
Write:
Reset:
0x00ca_0002
0x00ca_0003
QADC Test Register
(QADCTEST)
See page 438.
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error if not in test mode.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error if not in test mode.
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 20 of 37)
Advance Information
76
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
Register Name
0x00ca_0004
0x00ca_0005
Bit Number
Reserved
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
QADC Port A Data Read:
Register (PORTQA)
Write:
See page 439.
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00ca_0006
QADC Port B Data Read:
Register (PORTQB)
Write:
See page 439.
Reset:
0x00ca_0007
QADC Port A Data Read:
Direction Register
Write:
(DDRQA)
See page 441. Reset:
0x00ca_0008
QADC Port B Data
Direction Register Read:
(DDRQB) Write:
See page 441.
Reset:
0x00ca_0009
0x00ca_000a
0x00ca_000b
QADC Control Register 0 Read:
(QACR0)
Write:
See page 442.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
0
0
0
4
3
PQA4
PQA3
2
1
Bit 0
PQA1
PQA0
0
0
0
0
P
P
0
P
P
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
PQB3
PQB2
PQB1
PQB0
0
0
0
0
P
P
P
P
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
DDQA4
DDQA3
DDQA1
DDQA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
DDQB3
DDQB2
DDQB1
DDQB0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
MUX
TRG
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
QPR6
QPR5
QPR4
QPR3
QPR2
QPR1
QPR0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
0
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 21 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
77
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
0x00ca_000c
0x00ca_000d
Register Name
Bit Number
QADC Control Register 1 Read:
(QACR1)
Write:
See page 445.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
CIE1
PIE1
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
MQ112
MQ111
MQ110
MQ19
MQ18
0
SSE1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
CIE2
PIE2
MQ212
MQ211
MQ210
MQ29
MQ28
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
0x00ca_000e
0x00ca_000f
QADC Control Register 2 Read:
(QACR2)
Write:
See page 448.
Reset:
0
SSE2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RESUME
BQ26
BQ25
BQ24
BQ23
BQ22
BQ21
BQ20
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
QS9
QS8
CF1
PF1
CF2
PF2
TOR1
TOR2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
QS7
QS6
CWP5
CWP4
CWP3
CWP2
CWP1
CWP0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0x00ca_0010
0x00ca_0011
QADC Status Register 0 Read:
(QASR0)
Write:
See page 453.
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 22 of 37)
Advance Information
78
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
0x00ca_0012
0x00ca_0013
Register Name
Bit Number
QADC Status Register 1 Read:
(QASR1)
Write:
See page 462.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
CWPQ15
CWPQ14
CWPQ13
CWPQ12
CWPQ11
CWPQ10
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
CWPQ25
CWPQ24
CWPQ23
CWPQ22
CWPQ21
CWPQ20
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Reserved
0x00ca_0014
↓
0x00ca_01ff
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Conversion Command Read:
Word Register
Write:
(CCW0–CCW63)
See page 464. Reset:
0x00ca_0200
0x00ca_027e
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
0
0
0
0
0
0
9
Bit 8
P
BYP
0
0
0
0
0
0
U
U
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
IST1
IST0
CHAN5
CHAN4
CHAN3
CHAN2
CHAN1
CHAN0
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0x00ca_0280
0x00ca_02fe
Right-Justified Unsigned Read:
Result Register
Write:
(RJURR0–RJURR63)
See page 468. Reset:
RESULT
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
RESULT
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 23 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
79
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 15
0x00ca_0300
0x00ca_037e
Left-Justified Signed Read:
Result Register
Write:
(LJSRR0–LJSRR63)
See page 469. Reset:
14
13
12
11
S
10
9
Bit 8
RESULT
Bit 7
6
Read:
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
RESULT
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Bit 15
0x00ca_0380
0x00ca_03fe
14
Left-Justified Unsigned Read:
Result Register
Write:
(LJURR0–LJURR63)
See page 470. Reset:
RESULT
Bit 7
6
Read:
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RESULT
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
6
Unimplemented
0x00ca_0400
↓
0x00ca_ffff
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
0x00cb_0000
0x00cb_0001
P = Current pin state
SPI Control Register 1 Read:
(SPICR1)
Write:
See page 402.
Reset:
SPI Control Register 2 Read:
(SPICR2)
Write:
See page 405.
Reset:
U = Unaffected
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SPIE
SPE
SWOM
MSTR
CPOL
CPHA
SSOE
LSBFE
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SPISDOZ
SPC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 24 of 37)
Advance Information
80
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 7
0x00cb_0002
SPI Baud Rate Register Read:
(SPIBR)
Write:
See page 406.
Reset:
SPI Status Register Read:
(SPISR)
Write:
See page 408.
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00cb_0003
0x00cb_0004
5
4
SPPR6
SPPR5
SPPR4
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
SPIF
WCOL
0
Bit 7
SPI Pullup and Reduced Read:
Drive Register
Write:
(SPIPURD)
See page 410. Reset:
0x00cb_0008
0x00cb_0009
↓
0x00cb_000f
P = Current pin state
3
1
Bit 0
SPR2
SPR1
SPR0
0
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
MODF
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
SPI Data Register Read:
(SPIDR)
Write:
See page 409.
Reset:
0x00cb_0007
2
0
Reserved
0x00cb_0005
0x00cb_0006
6
SPI Port Data Register Read:
(SPIPORT)
Write:
See page 411.
Reset:
SPI Port Data Direction Read:
Register (SPIDDR)
Write:
See page 412.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
RSVD5
RDPSP
RSVD1
PUPSP
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
DDRSP3
DDRSP2
DDRSP1
DDRSP0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Reserved
PORTSP3 PORTSP2 PORTSP1 PORTSP0
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 25 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
81
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
0x00cb_0010
↓
0x00cb_ffff
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
Serial Communications Interface 1 (SCI1) and Serial Communications Interface 2 (SCI2)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Note: Addresses for SCI1 are at 0x00cc_#### and addresses for SCI2 are at 0x00cd_####.
0x00cc_0000
0x00cd_0000
0x00cc_0001
0x00cd_0001
SCI Baud Rate Read:
Register High (SCIBDH)
Write:
See page 360.
Reset:
SCI Baud Rate Read:
Register Low (SCIBDL)
Write:
See page 360.
Reset:
0x00cc_0002
0x00cd_0002
0x00cc_0003
0x00cd_0003
0x00cc_0004
0x00cd_0004
0x00cc_0005
0x00cd_0005
P = Current pin state
SCI Control Register 1 Read:
(SCICR1)
Write:
See page 361.
Reset:
SCI Control Register 2 Read:
(SCICR2)
Write:
See page 364.
Reset:
SCI Status Register 1 Read:
(SCISR1)
Write:
See page 366.
Reset:
SCI Status Register 2 Read:
(SCISR2)
Write:
See page 369.
Reset:
U = Unaffected
Bit 7
6
5
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SBR12
SBR11
SBR10
SBR9
SBR8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SBR7
SBR6
SBR5
SBR4
SBR3
SBR2
SBR1
SBR0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
LOOPS
WOMS
RSRC
M
WAKE
ILT
PE
PT
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
TIE
TCIE
RIE
ILIE
TE
RE
RWU
SBK
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
TDRE
TC
RDRF
IDLE
OR
NF
FE
PF
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RAF
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 26 of 37)
Advance Information
82
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 7
0x00cc_0006
0x00cd_0006
SCI Data Register High Read:
(SCIDRH)
Write:
See page 370.
Reset:
SCI Data Register Low Read:
(SCIDRL)
Write:
See page 370.
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00cc_0007
0x00cd_0007
0x00cc_0008
0x00cd_0008
R8
0x00cc_000a
0x00cd_000a
0x00cc_000b
↓
0x00cc_000f
0x00cd_000b
↓
0x00cd_000f
SCI Port Data Register Read:
(SCIPORT)
Write:
See page 372.
Reset:
SCI Data Direction Read:
Register (SCIDDR)
Write:
See page 373.
Reset:
P = Current pin state
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R7
R6
R5
R4
R3
R2
R1
R0
T7
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
T0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
RSVD5
RDPSCI
RSVD1
PUPSCI
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
DDRSC1
DDRSC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
PORTSC1 PORTSC0
Reserved
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Bit 7
0x00cc_0010
↓
0x00cc_ffff
0x00cd_0010
↓
0x00cd_ffff
5
T8
SCI Pullup and Reduced Read:
SCISDOZ
Drive Register
Write:
(SCIPURD)
See page 371. Reset:
0
0x00cc_0009
0x00cd_0009
6
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 27 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
83
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Timer 1 (TIM1) and Timer 2 (TIM2)
Note: Addresses for TIM1 are at 0x00ce_#### and addresses for TIM2 are at 0x00cf_####.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00ce_0000
0x00cf_0000
Timer Input Capture/ Read:
Output Compare Select
Write:
Register (TIMIOS)
See page 324. Reset:
Timer Compare Force Read:
Register (TIMCFORC)
Write:
See page 325.
Reset:
0x00ce_0001
0x00cf_0001
0x00ce_0002
0x00cf_0002
0x00ce_0003
0x00cf_0003
0x00ce_0004
0x00cf_0004
0x00ce_0005
0x00cf_0005
Timer Output Compare 3 Read:
Mask Register
Write:
(TIMOC3M)
See page 326. Reset:
Timer Output Compare 3 Read:
Data Register (TIMOC3D)
Write:
See page 327.
Reset:
Timer Counter Register Read:
High (TIMCNTH)
Write:
See page 328.
Reset:
Timer Counter Register Read:
Low (TIMCNTL)
Write:
See page 328.
Reset:
0x00ce_0006
0x00cf_0006
P = Current pin state
Timer System Control Read:
Register 1 (TIMSCR1)
Write:
See page 329.
Reset:
U = Unaffected
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
IOS3
IOS2
IOS1
IOS0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
FOC3
FOC2
FOC1
FOC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
OC3M3
OC3M2
OC3M1
OC3M0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
OC3D3
OC3D2
OC3D1
OC3D0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TIMEN
0
TFFCA
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 28 of 37)
Advance Information
84
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 7
0x00ce_0007
0x00cf_0007
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00ce_0008
0x00cf_0008
Reserved
0x00ce_000a
0x00cf_000a
0x00ce_000b
0x00cf_000b
0x00ce_000c
0x00cf_000c
0x00ce_000d
0x00cf_000d
0x00ce_000e
0x00cf_000e
P = Current pin state
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Timer Toggle on Overflow Read:
Register (TIMTOV)
Write:
See page 330.
Reset:
0x00ce_0009
0x00cf_0009
6
Timer Control Read:
Register 1 (TIMCTL1)
Write:
See page 331.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
TOV3
TOV2
TOV1
TOV0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
OM3
OL3
OM2
OL2
OM1
OL1
OM0
OL0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Reserved
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Timer Control Read:
Register 2 (TIMCTL2)
Write:
See page 332.
Reset:
Timer Interrupt Enable Read:
Register (TIMIE)
Write:
See page 333.
Reset:
Timer System Control Read:
Register 2 (TIMSCR2)
Write:
See page 334.
Reset:
Timer Flag Register 1 Read:
(TIMFLG1)
Write:
See page 336.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EDG3B
EDG3A
EDG2B
EDG2A
EDG1B
EDG1A
EDG0B
EDG10
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
C3I
C2I
C1I
C0I
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PUPT
RDPT
TCRE
PR2
PR1
PR0
0
TOI
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
C3F
C2F
C1F
C0F
0
0
0
0
0
U = Unaffected
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 29 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
85
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 7
Timer Flag Register 2 Read:
(TIMFLG2)
Write:
See page 337.
Reset:
0x00ce_000f
0x00cf_000f
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00ce_0010
0x00cf_0010
0x00ce_0011
0x00cf_0011
0x00ce_0012
0x00cf_0012
0x00ce_0013
0x00cf_0013
0x00ce_0014
0x00cf_0014
0x00ce_0015
0x00cf_0015
0x00ce_0016
0x00cf_0016
Timer Channel 0 Register Read:
High (TIMC0H)
Write:
See page 338.
Reset:
Timer Channel 0 Register Read:
Low (TIMC0L)
Write:
See page 338.
Reset:
Timer Channel 1 Register Read:
High (TIMC1H)
Write:
See page 338.
Reset:
Timer Channel 1 Register Read:
Low (TIMC1L)
Write:
See page 338.
Reset:
Timer Channel 2 Register Read:
High (TIMC2H)
Write:
See page 338.
Reset:
Timer Channel 2 Register Read:
Low (TIMC2L)
Write:
See page 338.
Reset:
Timer Channel 3 Register Read:
High (TIMC3H)
Write:
See page 338.
Reset:
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TOF
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 30 of 37)
Advance Information
86
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
0x00ce_0017
0x00cf_0017
Register Name
Timer Channel 3 Register Read:
Low (TIMC3L)
Write:
See page 338.
Reset:
Pulse Accumulator Read:
Control Register
Write:
(TIMPACTL)
See page 339. Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00ce_0018
0x00cf_0018
0x00ce_0019
0x00cf_0019
Pulse Accumulator Flag Read:
Register (TIMPAFLG)
Write:
See page 341.
Reset:
Pulse Accumulator Read:
Counter Register High
Write:
(TIMPACNTH)
See page 342. Reset:
0x00ce_001a
0x00cf_001a
Pulse Accumulator Read:
Counter Register Low
Write:
(TIMPACNTL)
See page 342. Reset:
0x00ce_001b
0x00cf_001b
0x00ce_001c
0x00cf_001c
0x00ce_001d
0x00cf_001d
0x00ce_001e
0x00cf_001e
Bit Number
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PAE
PAMOD
PEDGE
CLK1
CLK0
PAOVI
PAI
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PAOVF
PAIF
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Reserved
Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates
without a transfer error exception.
Timer Port Data Register Read:
(TIMPORT)
Write:
See page 343.
Reset:
Timer Port Data Direction Read:
Register (TIMDDR)
Write:
See page 344.
Reset:
P = Current pin state
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTT3
PORTT2
PORTT1
PORTT0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
DDRT3
DDRT2
DDRT1
DDRT0
0
0
0
0
0
U = Unaffected
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 31 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
87
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00ce_001f
0x00cf_001f
Register Name
Bit Number
Timer Test Register Read:
(TIMTST)
Write:
See page 345.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
0x00ce_0020
↓
0x00ce_ffff
0x00cf_0030
↓
0x00cf_ffff
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Bit 15
0x00d0_0000
0x00d0_0001
SGFM Module Read:
Configuration Register
Write:
(SGFMMCR)
See page 213. Reset:
14
0
13
12
0
FRZ
11
10
0
EME
9
Bit 8
0
0
LOCK
0
0
0
Note 1
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
CBEIE
CCIE
KEYACC
0
0
0
Read:
BKSEL
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
Note:
1. Reset state determined by chip reset configuration.
Bit 7
0x00d0_0002
SGFM Clock Divider Read:
Register (SGFMCLKD)
Write:
See page 215.
Reset:
0x00d0_0003
P = Current pin state
Unimplemented
U = Unaffected
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PRDIV
DIV5
DIV4
DIV3
DIV2
DIV1
DIV0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DIVLD
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error.
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 32 of 37)
Advance Information
88
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
Register Name
SGFM Test Register Read:
(SGFMTST)
Write:
See page 216.
Reset:
0x00d0_0004
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00d0_0005
↓
0x00d0_0007
0x00d0_0008
0x00d0_0009
0x00d0_000a
0x00d0_000b
Bit Number
Bit 7
6
5
4
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
Unimplemented
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
RSVD1
RSVD0
0
0
0
2
1
Bit 0
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error.
SGFM Security Register Read:
(SGFMSEC)
Write:
See page 217.
Reset:
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
KEYEN
SECSTAT
0
0
0
0
0
0
F(1)
Note 2
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SEC15
SEC14
SEC13
SEC12
SEC11
SEC10
SEC9
SEC8
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SEC7
SEC6
SEC5
SEC4
SEC3
SEC2
SEC1
SEC0
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Notes:
1. Reset state loaded from FLASH array during reset.
2. Reset state determined by security state of module.
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 33 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
89
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 31
0x00d0_000c
0x00d0_000d
0x00d0_000e
0x00d0_000f
SGFM Monitor Data Read: RSVD31
Register (SGFMMNTR)
Write:
See page 219.
Reset:
Bit 23
Read: RSVD23
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
RSVD30
RSVD29
RSVD28
RSVD27
RSVD26
RSVD25
RSVD24
Note 1
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
RSVD22
RSVD21
RSVD20
RSVD19
RSVD18
RSVD17
RSVD16
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Note 1
Bit 15
Read: RSVD15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
RSVD14
RSVD13
RSVD12
RSVD11
RSVD10
RSVD9
RSVD8
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Note 1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
RSVD1
RSVD0
Write:
Reset:
Note 1
Note 1. SGFMMNTR does not have a default reset state.
Bit 15
0x00d0_0010
0x00d0_0011
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
PROT14
PROT13
PROT12
PROT11
PROT10
PROT9
PROT8
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PROT7
PROT6
PROT5
PROT4
PROT3
PROT2
PROT1
PROT0
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
1
Bit 0
SGFM Protection Register Read:
PROT15
(SGFMPROT)
Write:
See page 220.
Reset:
F(1)
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Note 1. Reset state loaded from FLASH configuration field during reset.
Bit 7
5
4
3
2
Unimplemented
0x00d0_0012
↓
0x00d0_0013
P = Current pin state
6
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error.
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 34 of 37)
Advance Information
90
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 15
0x00d0_0014
0x00d0_0015
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SUPV14
SUPV13
SUPV12
SUPV11
SUPV10
SUPV9
SUPV8
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SUPV7
SUPV6
SUPV5
SUPV4
SUPV3
SUPV2
SUPV1
SUPV0
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
SGFM Supervisor Access Read:
SUPV15
Register (SGFMASACC)
Write:
See page 221.
Reset:
F(1)
Read:
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Note 1. Reset state loaded from FLASH array during reset.
Bit 15
0x00d0_0016
0x00d0_0017
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
DATA14
DATA13
DATA12
DATA11
DATA10
DATA9
DATA8
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DATA7
DATA6
DATA5
DATA4
DATA3
DATA2
DATA1
DATA0
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
1
Bit 0
RSVD1
RSVD0
SGFM Data Access Read:
DATA15
Register (SGFMDACC)
Write:
See page 223.
Reset:
F(1)
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Note 1. Reset state loaded from FLASH configuration field during reset.
0x00d0_0018
SGFM Test Status Read:
Register (SGFMTSTAT)
Write:
See page 224.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
2
0
RSVD3
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Unimplemented
0x00d0_0019
↓
0x00d0_001b
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error.
Bit 7
0x00d0_001c
3
SGFM User Status Read:
Register (SGFMUSTAT)
Write:
See page 224.
Reset:
P = Current pin state
6
5
4
PVIOL
ACCERR
0
0
CCIF
CBEIF
1
U = Unaffected
1
3
2
0
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
BLANK
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 35 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
91
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 7
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
Bit 7
SGFM Command Read:
Buffer and Register
Write:
(SGFMCMD)
See page 226. Reset:
0x00d0_0020
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
5
Unimplemented
0x00d0_001d
↓
0x00d0_001f
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
CMD6
CMD5
CMD4
CMD3
CMD2
CMD1
CMD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
Unimplemented
0x00d0_0021
↓
0x00d0_0023
Access results in a bus monitor timeout generating an access termination transfer error.
Bit 15
0x00d0_0024
0x00d0_0025
6
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
RSVD1
RSVD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
RSVD14
RSVD13
RSVD12
RSVD11
RSVD10
RSVD9
RSVD8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
RSVD1
RSVD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SGFM Control Register Read:
RSVD15
(SGFMCTL)
Write:
See page 227.
0
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0x00d0_0026
0x00d0_0027
SGFM Address Register Read:
(SGFMADR)
Write:
See page 228.
Reset:
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
U = Unaffected
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 36 of 37)
Advance Information
92
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
System Memory Map
Register Map
Address
Register Name
Bit Number
Bit 31
0x00d0_0028
0x00d0_0029
0x00d0_002a
0x00d0_002b
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
RSVD30
RSVD29
RSVD28
RSVD27
RSVD26
RSVD25
RSVD24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
RSVD22
RSVD21
RSVD20
RSVD19
RSVD18
RSVD17
RSVD16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
RSVD14
RSVD13
RSVD12
RSVD11
RSVD10
RSVD9
RSVD8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
RSVD1
RSVD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SGFM Data Register Read: RSVD31
(SGFMDATA)
Write:
See page 229.
Reset:
0
Bit 23
Read: RSVD23
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Read: RSVD15
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
P = Current pin state
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
U = Unaffected
Figure 2-4. Register Summary (Sheet 37 of 37)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
93
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
System Memory Map
Advance Information
94
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
System Memory Map
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 3. Signal Description
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
3.1 Contents
3.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
3.3
Package Pinout Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
3.4
Chip Specific Implementation Signal Issues. . . . . . . . . . . . . .109
3.4.1
RSTOUT Signal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
3.4.2
INT Signal Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
3.4.3
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Pin Functions . . . . . . . . .110
3.4.4
Serial Communications Interface (SCI1 and SCI2)
Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
3.4.5
Timer 1 and Timer 2 Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
3.4.6
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
3.5
Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
3.5.1
Reset Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.5.1.1
Reset In (RESET) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.5.1.2
Reset Out (RSTOUT). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.5.2
Phase-Lock Loop (PLL) and Clock Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
3.5.2.1
External Clock In (EXTAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
3.5.2.2
Crystal (XTAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
3.5.2.3
Clock Out (CLKOUT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
3.5.2.4
PLL Enable (PLLEN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
3.5.3
External Memory Interface Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
3.5.3.1
Data Bus (D[31:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
3.5.3.2
Show Cycle Strobe (SHS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .114
3.5.3.3
Transfer Acknowledge (TA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
3.5.3.4
Transfer Error Acknowledge (TEA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
3.5.3.5
Emulation Mode Chip Selects (CSE[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . 115
3.5.3.6
Transfer Code (TC[2:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
3.5.3.7
Read/Write (R/W). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
95
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
3.5.3.8
3.5.3.9
3.5.3.10
3.5.3.11
3.5.4
3.5.4.1
3.5.4.2
3.5.4.3
3.5.5
3.5.5.1
3.5.5.2
3.5.5.3
3.5.5.4
3.5.6
3.5.6.1
3.5.6.2
3.5.7
3.5.8
3.5.8.1
3.5.8.2
3.5.8.3
3.5.8.4
3.5.9
3.5.9.1
3.5.9.2
3.5.9.3
3.5.9.4
3.5.9.5
3.5.9.6
3.5.10
3.5.11
3.5.11.1
3.5.11.2
3.5.11.3
Advance Information
96
Address Bus (A[22:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Enable Byte (EB[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Chip Select (CS[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Output Enable (OE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116
Edge Port Signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
External Interrupts (INT[7:6]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
External Interrupts (INT[5:2]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
External Interrupts (INT[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
Serial Peripheral Interface Module Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Master Out/Slave In (MOSI). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Master In/Slave Out (MISO). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Serial Clock (SCK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Slave Select (SS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Serial Communications Interface Module Signals . . . . . . . 117
Receive Data (RXD1 and RXD2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Transmit Data (TXD1 and TXD2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Timer Signals (ICOC1[3:0] and ICOC2[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Analog-to-Digital Converter Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Analog Inputs (PQA[4:3], PQA[1:0], and PQB[3:0]) . . . . 118
Analog Reference (VRH and VRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Analog Supply (VDDA and VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118
Positive Supply (VDDH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Debug and Emulation Support Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Reset (TRST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Clock (TCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Mode Select (TMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Data Input (TDI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Data Output (TDO). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Debug Event (DE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Test Signal (TEST). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Power and Ground Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Standby Power (VSTBY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Positive Supply (VDD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Ground (VSS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Introduction
3.2 Introduction
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112 are available in three
packages:
•
100-pin Joint-Electron Device Engineering Council (JEDEC) lowprofile quad flat pack (LQFP) — The 100-pin device is a minimum
pin set for single-chip mode implementation.
•
144-pin JEDEC LQFP — The 144-pin implementation includes 44
optional pins as a bond-out option to:
– Accommodate an expanded set of features
– Allow expansion of the number of general-purpose
input/output (I/O)
– Utilize off-chip memory
– Provide enhanced support for development purposes
•
196-pin molded array process (MAP) ball grid array (BGA) — The
196-pin implementation includes:
– Single-chip operation with extra general-purpose input/output
– Expanded master mode for interfacing to external memories
– Emulation mode for development and debug
The optional group of pins includes:
NOTE:
•
23 address output lines
•
Four chip selects
•
Two emulation chip selects
•
Four byte/write enables
•
Read/write (R/W) signal
•
Output enable signal
•
Three transfer code signals
•
Six power/ground pins
The optional pins are either all present or none of them are present.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
97
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
3.3 Package Pinout Summary
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Refer to:
•
Table 3-1 for a summary of the pinouts for the 144-pin and 100pin LQFP packages.
•
Figure 3-1, Figure 3-2, and Figure 3-3 for a graphic view of the
pinouts
•
Table 3-2 for a brief description of each signal
Table 3-1. Package Pinouts (Sheet 1 of 5)
Pin Number
Pin Name
144-Pin Package
100-Pin Package
196-Ball MAPBGA
1
1
B1
D30 / PA6
2
2
C2
D29 / PA5
3
3
C1
D28 / PA4
4
4
D3
D27 / PA3
5
5
D2
D26 / PA2
6
—
D1
A11
7
6
E3
D25 / PA1
8
—
—
VSS
9
—
—
VDD
10
7
E2
D24 / PA0
11
—
E1
A10
12
8
F3
D23 / PB7
13
—
F2
A9
14
—
F1
A8
15
9
G3
D22 / PB6
16
10
G2
D21 / PB5
17
11
G1
D20 / PB4
18
12
—
VSS
19
13
—
VDD
20
14
H3
D19 / PB3
21
15
H2
D18 / PB2
22
16
H1
D17 / PB1
23
—
J3
A7
Advance Information
98
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Package Pinout Summary
Table 3-1. Package Pinouts (Sheet 2 of 5)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Pin Number
Pin Name
144-Pin Package
100-Pin Package
196-Ball MAPBGA
24
—
J2
A6
25
17
J1
D16 / PB0
26
—
K3
A5
27
18
K2
D15 / PC7
28
—
K1
A4
29
—
L3
A3
30
19
L2
D14 / PC6
31
20
L1
D13 / PC5
32
21
—
VSS
33
22
—
VDD
34
23
M2
D12 / PC4
35
24
M1
D11 / PC3
36
25
N1
D10 / PC2
37
26
P2
D9 / PC1
38
27
M3
D8 / PC0
39
28
N3
D7 / PD7
40
29
P3
D6 / PD6
41
30
M4
D5 / PD5
42
31
N4
D4 / PD4
43
32
P4
D3 / PD3
44
—
—
VSS
45
—
—
VDD
46
33
M5
D2 / PD2
47
—
N5
A2
48
34
P5
D1 / PD1
49
—
M6
A1
50
—
N6
A0
51
35
P6
D0 / PD0
52
36
M7
ICOC23
53
37
N7
ICOC22
54
38
P7
ICOC21
55
39
M8
ICOC20
56
40
N8
ICOC13
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
99
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Table 3-1. Package Pinouts (Sheet 3 of 5)
Pin Number
Pin Name
100-Pin Package
196-Ball MAPBGA
57
41
P8
ICOC12
58
42
M9
ICOC11
59
—
N9
R/W
60
—
P9
CSE1
61
43
M10
ICOC10
62
—
N10
CSE0
63
44
P10
TEST
64
—
—
VSS
65
—
—
VDD
66
45
M11
TXD2
67
—
N11
TC2
68
46
P11
RXD2
69
47
N12
TXD1
70
48
P12
RXD1
71
49
N13
INT0
72
50
P13
INT1
73
51
P14
VSSF
74
52
M12
VDDF
75
53
N14
INT2
76
54
—
VSS
77
55
—
VDD
78
—
M13
TC1
79
56
M14
INT3
80
—
L12
TC0
81
—
L13
CS3
82
57
L14
INT4
83
—
K12
CS2
84
58
K13
INT5
85
—
K14
CS1
86
—
J12
CS0
87
59
J13
No connect
88
60
J14
INT6
89
61
H12
INT7
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
144-Pin Package
Advance Information
100
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Package Pinout Summary
Table 3-1. Package Pinouts (Sheet 4 of 5)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Pin Number
Pin Name
144-Pin Package
100-Pin Package
196-Ball MAPBGA
90
62
H13
MOSI
91
63
H14
MISO
92
64
G12
VSTBY
93
65
G13
SCK
94
66
G14
SS
95
—
F12
OE
96
—
F13
EB3
97
67
F14
SHS / PE7
98
—
E12
EB2
99
68
E13
TA / PE6
100
—
E14
EB1
101
—
D12
EB0
102
69
D13
TEA / PE5
103
70
E11
VDDH
104
71
D14
PQB3
105
72
C12
PQB2
106
73
C13
PQB1
107
74
C14
PQB0
108
75
B14
PQA4
109
76
A13
PQA3
110
77
B12
PQA1
111
78
A12
PQA0
112
79
C11
VRL
113
80
B11
VRH
114
81
E10
VSSA
115
82
E9
VDDA
116
—
A11
A22
117
—
C10
A21
118
83
B10
RESET
119
—
A10
A20
120
84
C9
RSTOUT
121
—
B9
A19
122
—
A9
A18
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
101
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Table 3-1. Package Pinouts (Sheet 5 of 5)
Pin Number
Pin Name
100-Pin Package
196-Ball MAPBGA
123
85
D8
PLLEN
124
86
A8
XTAL
125
87
A7
EXTAL
126
88
—
VSS
127
89
—
VSS
128
90
E8
CLKOUT
129
91
—
VDD
130
92
B7
TCLK
131
—
A6
A17
132
—
B6
A16
133
93
A5
TDI
134
—
C6
A15
135
94
B5
TDO
136
—
A4
A14
137
—
C5
A13
138
95
B4
TMS
139
—
A3
A12
140
96
—
VSS
141
97
—
VDD
142
98
B3
TRST
143
99
A2
DE
144
100
C3
D31 / PA7
—
—
A1, B2, C4, C7, C8, D4–D7, E4–E7,
F4–F6, G4, G5, H4, H5, J4, K4,–K11,
L4–L11, N2, P1
VDD
—
—
A14, B8, B13, D9–D11, F7–F11,
G6–G11, H6–H11, J5–J11
VSS
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
144-Pin Package
Advance Information
102
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
A8
D20
D17
D16
A4
D13
D11
D10
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
VDD
D12
D14
D15
A6
D18
D21
A9
D24
2
A10
E
D26
1
A11
D
D29
D9
D28
C
VDD
DE
2
VDD
D30
B
P
VDD
A
1
3
D6
D7
D8
A3
A5
A7
D19
D22
D23
D25
D27
D31
TRST
A12
3
4
D3
D4
D5
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
TMS
A14
4
6
D0
A0
A1
VDD
VDD
VSS
VSS
VSS
VDD
VDD
VDD
A15
A16
A17
6
VDD
VDD
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
CLKOUT
PLLEN
VDD
VSS
XTAL
8
VDD
VDD
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VDDA
VSS
RSTOUT
A19
A18
9
VDD
VDD
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSSA
VSS
A21
RESET
A20
10
7
8
ICOC21 ICOC12
ICOC22 ICOC13
9
CSE1
R/W
10
TEST
CSE0
ICOC23 ICOC20 ICOC11 ICOC10
VDD
VDD
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VDD
VDD
VDD
TCLK
EXTAL
7
Figure 3-1. 196-Ball MAPBGA Assignments
5
D1
A2
D2
VDD
VDD
VSS
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
VDD
A13
TDO
TDI
5
11
RXD2
TC2
TXD2
VDD
VDD
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VDDH
VSS
VRL
VRH
A22
11
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
12
RXD1
TXD1
VDDF
TC0
CS2
CS0
INT7
VSTBY
OE
EB2
EB0
PQB2
PQA1
PQA0
12
13
INT1
INT0
TC1
CS3
INT5
N/C
MOSI
SCK
EB3
TA
TEA
PQB1
VSS
PQA3
13
14
VSS
INT2
INT3
INT4
CS1
INT6
MISO
SS
SHS
EB1
PQB3
PAB0
PQA4
VSS
14
P
N
M
L
K
J
H
G
F
E
D
C
B
A
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Package Pinout Summary
Advance Information
103
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
108
107
106
105
104
103
102
101
100
99
98
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
PQA4
PQB0
PQB1
PQB2
PQB3
VDDH
TEA
EB0
EB1
TA
EB2
SHS
EB3
OE
SS
SCK
VSTBY
MISO
MOSI
INT7
INT6
NO CONNECT
CS0
CS1
INT5
CS2
INT4
CS3
TC0
INT3
TC1
VDD
VSS
INT2
VDDF
VSSF
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70
71
72
D30
D29
D28
D27
D26
A11
D25
VSS
VDD
D24
A10
D23
A9
A8
D22
D21
D20
VSS
VDD
D19
D18
D17
A7
A6
D16
A5
D15
A4
A3
D14
D13
VSS
VDD
D12
D11
D10
D9
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
VSS
VDD
D2
A2
D1
A1
A0
D0
ICOC23
ICOC22
ICOC21
ICOC20
ICOC13
ICOC12
ICOC11
R/W
CSE1
ICOC10
CSE0
TEST
VSS
VDD
TXD2
TC2
RXD2
TXD1
RXD1
INT0
INT1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
144
143
142
141
140
139
138
137
136
135
134
133
132
131
130
129
128
127
126
125
124
123
122
121
120
119
118
117
116
115
114
113
112
111
110
109
D31
DE
TRST
VDD
VSS
A12
TMS
A13
A14
TDO
A15
TDI
A16
A17
TCLK
VDD
CLKOUT
VSS
VSS
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLEN
A18
A19
RSTOUT
A20
RESET
A21
A22
VDDA
VSSA
VRH
VRL
PQA0
PQA1
PQA3
Signal Description
Figure 3-2. 144-Pin LQFP Assignments
Advance Information
104
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
PQA1
PQA3
78
77
76
VRH
VRL
PQA0
80
79
VDDA
VSSA
82
81
RSTOUT
RESET
85
84
83
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLEN
87
86
VSS
VSS
90
89
88
TCLK
VDD
CLKOUT
92
91
TDO
TDI
94
93
VSS
TMS
97
96
95
DE
TRST
VDD
1
2
3
75
PQA4
PA5
PA4
74
73
PA3
PA2
PA1
4
5
72
71
PQB0
PQB1
PQB2
6
7
70
11
12
54
47
48
TXD1
RXD1
INT0
51
MISO
MOSI
INT7
INT6
NO CONNECT
INT5
INT4
INT3
VDD
VSS
INT2
VDDF
VSSF
INT1
45
46
TXD2
RXD2
49
50
43
44
41
42
ICOC11
ICOC10
TEST
39
40
53
52
ICOC13
ICOC12
23
24
25
ICOC21
ICOC20
PC4
PC3
PC2
VSTBY
56
55
37
38
21
22
35
36
VSS
VDD
64
63
58
57
PD0
ICOC23
ICOC22
18
19
20
SS
SCK
59
33
34
PC7
PC6
PC5
66
65
61
60
PD2
PD1
16
17
31
32
PB1
PB0
67
62
PD4
PD3
13
14
15
PC1
PC0
PB3
PB2
29
30
PB4
VSS
VDD
8
9
10
27
28
PB6
PB5
PQB3
VDDH
PE5
PE6
PE7
69
68
PD7
PD6
PD5
PA0
PB7
26
PA6
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
99
98
100
PA7
Signal Description
Package Pinout Summary
Figure 3-3. 100-Pin LQFP Assignments
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
105
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Table 3-2. Signal Descriptions (Sheet 1 of 3)
Name
(1)
Alternate
Qty.
Dir.
Input
Input
Hyst. Sync.(2)
Drive
Strength
Pullup
(4)
Control(3)
Output
Driver
(ST/OD/SP)(5)
Reset
RESET
—
1
I/O(6)
Y
Y
—
Pullup
—
RSTOUT
SHOWINT
1
I/O(6)
—
—
LOAD
—
ST
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Clock
EXTAL
—
1
I
N
N
—
—
SP
XTAL
—
1
O
—
—
—
—
SP
CLKOUT
—
1
I/O(6)
—
—
LOAD
—
ST
PLLEN
—
1
I
—
—
—
Pullup
—
External Memory Interface and Ports
D[31:0]
PA[7:0], PB[7:0]
PC[7:0], PD[7:0]
32
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
—
ST
SHS
RCON / PE7
1
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
Pullup
ST
TA
PE6
1
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
Pullup
ST
TEA
PE5
1
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
Pullup
ST
CSE[1:0]
PE[4:3]
2
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
Pullup
ST
TC[2:0]
PE[2:0]
3
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
Pullup
ST
R/W
PF7
1
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
Pullup
ST
A[22:0]
PF[6:0], PG[7:0]
PH[7:0]
23
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
Pullup
ST
EB[3:0]
PI[7:4]
4
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
Pullup
ST
CS[3:0]
PI[3:0]
4
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
Pullup
ST
OE
—
1
I/O(6)
—
—
LOAD
—
ST
Edge Port
INT[7:6]
TSIZ[1:0] / GPIO
2
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
—
—
INT[5:2]
PSTAT[3:0] / GPIO
4
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
—
—
INT[1:0]
GPIO
2
I/O
Y
Y
LOAD
—
—
Advance Information
106
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Package Pinout Summary
Table 3-2. Signal Descriptions (Sheet 2 of 3)
Name(1)
Alternate
Qty.
Dir.
Input
Input
Hyst. Sync.(2)
Drive
Strength
Control(3)
Pullup(4)
Output
Driver
(ST/OD/SP)(5)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
MOSI
GPIO
1
I/O
Y
Y
RDPSP0
Pullup(4)
ST / OD (7)
MISO
GPIO
1
I/O
Y
Y
RDPSP0
Pullup(4)
ST / OD (7)
SCK
GPIO
1
I/O
Y
Y
RDPSP0
Pullup(4)
ST / OD (7)
SS
GPIO
1
I/O
Y
Y
RDPSP0
Pullup(4)
ST / OD (7)
Serial Communication Interface (SCI1 and SCI2)
TXD1
GPIO
1
I/O
Y
Y
RDPSCI0
Pullup(4)
ST / OD (7)
RXD1
GPIO
1
I/O
Y
Y
RDPSCI0
Pullup(4)
ST / OD (7)
TXD2
GPIO
1
I/O
Y
Y
RDPSCI0
Pullup(4)
ST / OD (7)
RXD2
GPIO
1
I/O
Y
Y
RDPSCI0
Pullup(4)
ST / OD (7)
Timer 1 and Timer 2
ICOC13
IC / OC / PAI / GPIO
1
I/O
Y
Y
RDPT
Pullup(4)
ST
ICOC1[2:0]
IC / OC / GPIO
3
I/O
Y
Y
RDPT
Pullup(4)
ST
ICOC23
IC / OC / PAI / GPIO
1
I/O
Y
Y
RDPT
Pullup(4)
ST
ICOC2[2:0]
IC / OC / GPIO
3
I/O
Y
Y
RDPT
Pullup(4)
ST
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
PQA4–PQA3,
PQA1–PQA0
GPIO
4
I/O
Y
Y
—
—
ST
PQB[3:0]
GPI
4
I/O
Y
Y
—
—
ST
VRH
—
1
I
—
—
—
—
—
VRL
—
1
I
—
—
—
—
—
VDDA
—
1
I
—
—
—
—
—
VSSA
—
1
I
—
—
—
—
—
VDDH
—
1
I
—
—
—
—
—
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
107
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Table 3-2. Signal Descriptions (Sheet 3 of 3)
Name(1)
Alternate
Qty.
Dir.
Input
Input
Hyst. Sync.(2)
Drive
Strength
Control(3)
Pullup(4)
Output
Driver
(ST/OD/SP)(5)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Debug and JTAG Test Port Control
TRST
—
1
I
Y
N
—
Pullup
—
TCLK
—
1
I
Y
N
—
Pullup
—
TMS
—
1
I
Y
N
—
Pullup
—
TDI
—
1
I
Y
N
—
Pullup
—
TDO
—
1
O(8)
—
—
LOAD
—
ST
DE
—
1
I/O
Y
N
LOAD
Pullup
OD
N
—
—
—
Test
TEST
—
1
I
Y
Power Supplies
VDDF
—
1
I
—
—
—
—
—
VSSF
—
1
I
—
—
—
—
—
VSTBY
—
1
I
—
—
—
—
—
VDD
—
5
I
—
—
—
—
—
VSS
—
6
I
—
—
—
—
—
VDD
—
3
I
—
—
—
—
—
VSS
—
3
I
—
—
—
—
—
Total
100
Total with optional pins
144
1. Shaded signals are for optional bond-out for 144-pin package.
2. Synchronized input used only if signal configured as a digital I/O. RESET signal is always synchronized, except in lowpower stop mode.
3. LOAD (Chip Configuration Register bit), RDPSP0 (PURD register bit in SPI), RDPSCI0 (SCIPURD register bit in both
SCIs), RDPT (TIMSCR2 register bit in both timers)
4. All pullups are disconnected when the signal is programmed as an output.
5. Output driver type: ST = standard, OD = standard driver with open-drain pulldown option selected, SP = special
6. Digital input function for RSTOUT, CLKOUT, OE, and digital output function for RESET used only for JTAG boundary scan
7. Open-drain and pullup function selectable via programmer’s model in module configuration registers
8. Three-state output with no input function
Advance Information
108
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Chip Specific Implementation Signal Issues
3.4 Chip Specific Implementation Signal Issues
Most modules are designed to allow expanded capabilities if all the
module signals to the pads are implemented. This subsection discusses
how these modules are implemented on the MMC2114, MMC2113, and
MMC2112.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
3.4.1 RSTOUT Signal Functions
The RSTOUT signal has these multiple functions:
CAUTION:
•
Whenever the internal system reset is asserted, the RSTOUT
signal will always be asserted to indicate the reset condition to the
system.
•
If the internal reset is not asserted, then setting the FRCRSTOUT
bit in the Reset Control Register (RCR) will assert the RSTOUT
signal for as long as the FRCRSTOUT bit is set. See 5.6.1 Reset
Control Register.
•
If the internal reset is not asserted and the FRCRSTOUT bit is not
set, then setting the SHOWINT bit in the Chip Configuration
Register will reflect internal interrupt requests out to the RSTOUT
signal.
•
If the internal reset is not asserted and the FRCRSTOUT bit is not
set and the SHOWINT bit is not set, then the RSTOUT signal will
be negated to indicate to the system that there is no reset
condition.
External logic used to drive reset configuration data during reset needs
to be considered when using the RSTOUT signal for a function other
than an indication of reset.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
109
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
3.4.2 INT Signal Functions
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The INT signals have these multiple functions:
NOTE:
•
If the SZEN bit in the Chip Configuration Register is set, then
INT[7:6] will be used to reflect the state of the TSIZ[1:0] signals
from the CPU. See 4.7.3.1 Chip Configuration Register.
•
If the PSTEN bit in the Chip Configuration Register (CCR) is set,
then INT[5:2] will be used to reflect the state of the PSTAT[3:0]
signals from the CPU. See 4.7.3.1 Chip Configuration Register.
If the SZEN or PSTEN bits are set during emulation mode, then the
corresponding edge port INT functions are lost and will not be emulated
externally.
The default reset value for the PUPSC1 bit in SCIPURD is 0. Thus, the
pullup function is disabled by default.
3.4.3 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) Pin Functions
The SPI module can support up to eight external pins, but only the four
pins required for the SPI interface are implemented.
Full SPI interface capabilities and GPIO functions using the MISO,
MOSI, SCK, and SS pins are supported.
Advance Information
110
•
SWOM register bit controls whether output buffers behave as
open-drain outputs. Default is not open-drain outputs.
•
PUPSP0 register bit enables internal weak pad pullup devices.
Default is pullups disabled.
•
RDPSP0 register bit controls reduced drive function of output
buffers. Default is full drive.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Chip Specific Implementation Signal Issues
GPIO [7:4] of SPI module not implemented.
•
Writes to bits [7:4] of the SPIPORT and SPIDDR registers have no
effect except to change the register bit values.
•
Reads of bits [7:4] of the SPIPORT when the corresponding
SPIDDR bits are set for inputs always return 0.
•
PUPSP and RDPSP register bits have no effect.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The default reset values for the PUPSP bit in SPIPURD is 0. Thus, the
pullup function is disabled by default.
3.4.4 Serial Communications Interface (SCI1 and SCI2) Pin Functions
Full SCI interface capabilities and GPIO functions using the TXD1/2 and
RXD1/2 pins are supported.
•
WOMS register bit controls whether output buffers behave as
open-drain outputs. Default is not open-drain outputs.
•
PUPSCI register bit enables internal weak pad pullup devices.
Default is pullups disabled.
•
RDPSCI register bit controls reduced drive function of output
buffers. Default is full drive.
GPIO [7:2] of SCI modules not implemented.
•
Writes to bits [7:2] of the SCIPORT and SCIDDR registers have
no effect except to change the register bit values.
•
Reads of bits [7:2] of the SCIPORT when the corresponding
SCIDDR bits are set for inputs always return 0.
•
PUPSCI and RDPSCI register bits have no effect.
The default reset value for PUPSCI is 0. Thus, the pullup function is
disabled by default.
NOTE:
Only the pins associated with each SCI are controlled by the register bits
for the corresponding SCI. Thus, the WOMS register bit from SCI1 only
affects TXD1 and RXD1 and has no effect on TXD2 and RXD2.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
111
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
3.4.5 Timer 1 and Timer 2 Pin Functions
The timer modules can support up to four external pins each.
NOTE:
Only the pins associated with each timer are controlled by the register
bits for the corresponding timer.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Full timer port pin functions are supported.
•
PUPT register bit enables internal weak pad pullup devices.
Default disables pullups.
•
RDPT register bit controls reduced drive function of output buffers.
Default is full drive.
The default reset value for PUPT is 0. Thus, the pullup function is
disabled by default.
The sync input is tied off and this function is not supported.
3.4.6 Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC) Pin Functions
This implementation is a limited pin out version of the original QADC.
Limiting the number of pins lowers the over all pin count of the complete
package. The lower pin count is achieved by utilizing 8 of 16 pins of the
original full pin set. The available pins are, PQA4–PQA3, PQA1–PQA0,
and PQB3–PQB0. All of the original functionality of the module is
implemented with exception of limiting the total number of multiplexed
channels. By using four external multiplexer chips, the maximum
number of channels is 18. In nonmultiplexed mode, the maximum
number of channels is eight.
Advance Information
112
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Signal Descriptions
3.5 Signal Descriptions
This subsection provides a brief description of the signals. For more
detailed information, reference the specific module section.
3.5.1 Reset Signals
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
These signals are used to either reset the chip or as a reset indication.
3.5.1.1 Reset In (RESET)
This active-low input signal is used as the external reset request. Reset
places the CPU in supervisor mode with default settings for all register
bits.
3.5.1.2 Reset Out (RSTOUT)
This active-low output signal is an indication that the internal reset
controller has reset the chip. When RSTOUT is active, the user may
drive override configuration options on the data bus. See Table 4-7.
Configuration During Reset. RSTOUT is three-stated in phase-lock
loop (PLL) test mode.
RSTOUT may also be used to reflect an indication of an internal interrupt
request.
3.5.2 Phase-Lock Loop (PLL) and Clock Signals
These signals are used to support the on-chip clock generation circuitry.
3.5.2.1 External Clock In (EXTAL)
This input signal is always driven by an external clock input except when
used as a connection to an external crystal when the internal oscillator
circuit is used. The clock source is configured during reset.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
113
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
3.5.2.2 Crystal (XTAL)
This output signal is used as a connection to drive an external crystal
when the internal oscillator circuit is used. XTAL should be grounded
when using an external clock input on EXTAL.
3.5.2.3 Clock Out (CLKOUT)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This output signal reflects the internal system clock.
3.5.2.4 PLL Enable (PLLEN)
This is an active high signal only required during reset if chip
configuration is performed. If this signal is pulled high during reset, then
the PLL will be used to clock the device. Pulling this signal low during
reset selects external clock mode. See Table 4-7. Configuration
During Reset.
3.5.3 External Memory Interface Signals
In addition to the functions stated here, these signals can also be
configured for discrete I/O.
3.5.3.1 Data Bus (D[31:0])
These three-state bidirectional signals provide the general-purpose data
path between the microcontroller unit (MCU) and all other devices.
Some of these pins are used during reset for chip configuration.
3.5.3.2 Show Cycle Strobe (SHS)
This output signal is used in emulation mode as a strobe for capturing
addresses, controls, and data during show cycles. This signal is also
used as RCON.
NOTE:
Advance Information
114
The RCON signal, used only during reset, indicates whether the states
on the external signals affect the chip configuration.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Signal Descriptions
3.5.3.3 Transfer Acknowledge (TA)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This input signal indicates that the external data transfer is complete.
During a read cycle, when the processor recognizes TA, it latches the
data and then terminates the bus cycle. During a write cycle, when the
processor recognizes TA, the bus cycle is terminated. This signal is an
input in master and emulation modes. This function is not used in singlechip mode and its pin defaults to digital I/O.
3.5.3.4 Transfer Error Acknowledge (TEA)
This signal indicates an error condition exists for the bus transfer. The
bus cycle is terminated and the central processor unit (CPU) begins
execution of the access error exception. This signal is an input in master
and emulation modes. This function is not used in single-chip mode and
its pin defaults to digital I/O.
3.5.3.5 Emulation Mode Chip Selects (CSE[1:0])
These output signals provide chip select support in emulation mode.
3.5.3.6 Transfer Code (TC[2:0])
These output signals indicate the data transfer code for the current bus
cycle. These signals are enabled by default only in emulation mode. See
Table 12-2. PEPAR Reset Values.
3.5.3.7 Read/Write (R/W)
This output signal indicates the direction of the data transfer on the bus.
A logic 1 indicates a read from a slave device and a logic 0 indicates a
write to a slave device.
3.5.3.8 Address Bus (A[22:0])
These output signals provide the address for the current bus transfer.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
115
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
3.5.3.9 Enable Byte (EB[3:0])
These output signals indicate which byte of data is valid during external
cycles.
3.5.3.10 Chip Select (CS[3:0])
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
These output signals select external devices for external bus
transactions.
3.5.3.11 Output Enable (OE)
This output signal indicates when an external device can drive data
during external read cycles.
3.5.4 Edge Port Signals
These signals are used by the edge port module.
3.5.4.1 External Interrupts (INT[7:6])
These bidirectional signals function as either external interrupt sources
or GPIO. Also, these signals may be used to reflect the internal TSIZ[1:0]
signals and externally to provide an indication of the CPU transfer size.
See 4.7.3.1 Chip Configuration Register and Section 20. External
Bus Interface Module (EBI).
3.5.4.2 External Interrupts (INT[5:2])
These bidirectional signals function as either external interrupt sources
or GPIO. Also, these signals may be used to reflect the internal
PSTAT[3:0] signals and externally to provide an indication of the CPU
processor status.See 4.7.3.1 Chip Configuration Register and
Section 20. External Bus Interface Module (EBI).
3.5.4.3 External Interrupts (INT[1:0])
These bidirectional signals function as either external interrupt sources
or GPIO.
Advance Information
116
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Signal Descriptions
3.5.5 Serial Peripheral Interface Module Signals
These signals are used by the SPI module and may also be configured
to be discrete I/O signals.
3.5.5.1 Master Out/Slave In (MOSI)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This signal is the serial data output from the SPI in master mode and the
serial data input in slave mode.
3.5.5.2 Master In/Slave Out (MISO)
This signal is the serial data input to the SPI in master mode and the
serial data output in slave mode.
3.5.5.3 Serial Clock (SCK)
The serial clock synchronizes data transmissions between master and
slave devices. SCK is an output if the SPI is configured as a master. SCK
is an input if the SPI is configured as a slave.
3.5.5.4 Slave Select (SS)
This I/O signal is the peripheral chip select signal in master mode and is
an active-low slave select in slave mode.
3.5.6 Serial Communications Interface Module Signals
These signals are used by the two SCI modules.
3.5.6.1 Receive Data (RXD1 and RXD2)
These signals are used for the SCI receiver data input and are also
available for GPIO when not configured for receiver operation.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
117
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
3.5.6.2 Transmit Data (TXD1 and TXD2)
These signals are used for the SCI transmitter data output and are also
available for GPIO when not configured for transmitter operation.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
3.5.7 Timer Signals (ICOC1[3:0] and ICOC2[3:0])
These signals provide the external interface to the timer functions. They
may be configured as general-purpose I/O if the timer output function is
not needed. The default state at reset is general-purpose input.
3.5.8 Analog-to-Digital Converter Signals
These signals are used by the analog-to-digital converter (QADC)
module.
3.5.8.1 Analog Inputs (PQA[4:3], PQA[1:0], and PQB[3:0])
These signals provide the analog inputs to the QADC. The PQA and
PQB signals may also be used as general-purpose digital I/O.
3.5.8.2 Analog Reference (VRH and VRL)
These signals serve as the high (VRH) and low (VRL) reference potentials
for the analog converter.
3.5.8.3 Analog Supply (VDDA and VSSA)
These dedicated power supply signals isolate the sensitive analog
circuitry from the normal levels of noise present on the digital power
supply.
3.5.8.4 Positive Supply (VDDH)
This signal supplies positive power to the ESD structures in the QADC
pads.
Advance Information
118
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
Signal Descriptions
3.5.9 Debug and Emulation Support Signals
These signals are used as the interface to the on-chip JTAG (Joint Test
Action Group) controller and also to interface to the OnCE logic.
3.5.9.1 Test Reset (TRST)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This active-low input signal is used to initialize the JTAG and OnCE logic
asynchronously.
3.5.9.2 Test Clock (TCLK)
This input signal is the test clock used to synchronize the JTAG and
OnCE logic.
3.5.9.3 Test Mode Select (TMS)
This input signal is used to sequence the JTAG state machine. TMS is
sampled on the rising edge of TCLK.
3.5.9.4 Test Data Input (TDI)
This input signal is the serial input for test instructions and data. TDI is
sampled on the rising edge of TCLK.
3.5.9.5 Test Data Output (TDO)
This output signal is the serial output for test instructions and data. TDO
is three-stateable and is actively driven in the shift-IR and shift-DR
controller states. TDO changes on the falling edge of TCLK.
3.5.9.6 Debug Event (DE)
This is a bidirectional, active-low signal. As an output, this signal will be
asserted for three system clocks, synchronous to the rising CLKOUT
edge, to acknowledge that the CPU has entered debug mode as a result
of a debug request or a breakpoint condition. As an input, this signal
provides multiple functions.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
119
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Signal Description
3.5.10 Test Signal (TEST)
This input signal (TEST) is reserved for factory testing only and should
be connected to VSS to prevent unintentional activation of test functions.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
3.5.11 Power and Ground Signals
These signals provide system power and ground to the chip. Multiple
signals are provided for adequate current capability. All power supply
signals must have adequate bypass capacitance for high-frequency
noise suppression.
3.5.11.1 Standby Power (VSTBY)
This signal is used to provide standby voltage to the RAM array if VDD is
lost. Typically, if used, this signal would be connected to a battery.
3.5.11.2 Positive Supply (VDD)
This signal supplies positive power to the core logic and I/O pads.
3.5.11.3 Ground (VSS)
This signal is the negative supply (ground) to the chip.
Advance Information
120
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Signal Description
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 4. Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
4.1 Contents
4.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
4.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
4.4
Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122
4.4.1
Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
4.4.2
Single-Chip Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
4.4.3
Emulation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
4.4.4
Factory Access Slave Test (FAST) Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
4.5
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
4.6
Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
4.7
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
4.7.1
Programming Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
4.7.2
Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
4.7.3
Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
4.7.3.1
Chip Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
4.7.3.2
Reset Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
4.7.3.3
Chip Identification Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131
4.7.3.4
Chip Test Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
4.8
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
4.8.1
Reset Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
4.8.2
Chip Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
4.8.3
Boot Device Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
4.8.4
Output Pad Strength Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
4.8.5
Clock Mode Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
4.8.6
Internal FLASH Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
4.9
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
4.10
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
121
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
4.2 Introduction
The chip configuration module (CCM) controls the chip configuration and
mode of operation.
4.3 Features
The CCM performs these operations.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
•
Selects the chip operating mode:
– Master mode
– Single-chip mode
– Emulation mode
– Factory access slave test (FAST) mode for factory test only
•
Selects external clock or phase-lock loop (PLL) mode with internal
or external reference
•
Selects output pad strength
•
Selects boot device
•
Selects module configuration
•
Selects bus monitor configuration
4.4 Modes of Operation
The CCM configures the chip for four modes of operation:
•
Master mode
•
Single-chip mode
•
Emulation mode
•
FAST mode for factory test only
The operating mode is determined at reset and cannot be changed
thereafter.
Advance Information
122
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Modes of Operation
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
4.4.1 Master Mode
In master mode, the internal central processor unit (CPU) can access
external memories and peripherals. Full master mode functionality
requires the bonding out of the optional pins. The external bus consists
of a 32-bit data bus and 23 address lines. Available bus control signals
include R/W, TC[2:0], TSIZ[1:0], TA, TEA, OE, and EB[3:0]. Up to four
chip selects can be programmed to select and control external devices
and to provide bus cycle termination. When interfacing to 16-bit ports,
the ports C and D pins and EB[3:2] can be configured as
general-purpose input/output (I/O).
4.4.2 Single-Chip Mode
In single-chip mode, all memory is internal to the chip. External bus pins
are configured as digital I/O.
4.4.3 Emulation Mode
Emulation mode supports external port replacement logic. All ports are
emulated and all primary pin functions are enabled. Since the full
external bus must be visible to support the external port replacement
logic, the emulation mode pin configuration resembles master mode.
Full emulation mode functionality requires bonding out the optional pins.
Emulation mode chip selects are provided to give additional information
about the bus cycle. Also, the signal SHS is provided as a strobe for
capturing addresses and data during show cycles.
4.4.4 Factory Access Slave Test (FAST) Mode
FAST mode is for factory test only.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
123
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
4.5 Block Diagram
RESET
CONFIGURATION
OUTPUT PAD
STRENGTH SELECTION
CHIP MODE
SELECTION
CLOCK MODE
SELECTION
BOOT DEVICE
SELECTION
MODULE
CONFIGURATION
CHIP CONFIGURATION REGISTER
RESET CONFIGURATION REGISTER
CHIP IDENTIFICATION REGISTER
CHIP TEST REGISTER
Figure 4-1. Chip Configuration Module Block Diagram
4.6 Signal Descriptions
Table 4-1 provides an overview of the CCM signals. For more detailed
information, refer to Section 3. Signal Description.
Table 4-1. Signal Properties
Name
Advance Information
124
Function
Reset State
Internal weak
pullup device
RCON
Reset configuration select
PLLEN
Clock mode select
—
D[26, 23, 22, 21, 19, 18, 17, 16]
Reset configuration overrides
—
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Memory Map and Registers
4.7 Memory Map and Registers
This subsection provides a description of the memory map and registers.
4.7.1 Programming Model
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The CCM programming model consists of these registers:
•
The Chip Configuration Register (CCR) controls the main chip
configuration. See 4.7.3.1 Chip Configuration Register.
•
The Reset Configuration Register (RCON) indicates the default
chip configuration. See 4.7.3.2 Reset Configuration Register.
•
The Chip Identification Register (CIR) contains a unique part
number. See 4.7.3.3 Chip Identification Register.
•
The Chip Test Register (CTR) contains chip-specific test
functions. See 4.7.3.4 Chip Test Register.
Some control register bits are implemented as write-once bits. These
bits are always readable, but once the bit has been written, additional
writes have no effect, except during debug and test operations.
Some write-once bits and test bits can be read and written while in debug
mode or test mode. When debug or test mode is exited, the chip
configuration module resumes operation based on the current register
values. If a write to a write-once register bit occurs while in debug or test
mode, the register bit remains writable on exit from debug or test mode.
Table 4-2 shows the accessibility of write-once bits.
Table 4-2. Write-Once Bits Read/Write Accessibility
Configuration
Read/Write Access
All configurations
Read-always
Debug operation (all modes)
Write-always
Test operation (all modes)
Write-always
Master mode
Write-once
Single-chip mode
Write-once
FAST mode
Write-once
Emulation mode
Write-once
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
125
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
4.7.2 Memory Map
Table 4-3. Chip Configuration Module Memory Map
Address
Bits 31–16
Bits 15–0
Access(1)
0x00c1_0000
Chip Configuration Register (CCR)
Reserved (2)
S
0x00c1_0004
Reset Configuration Register (RCON)
Chip Identification Register (CIR)
S
0x00c1_0008
Chip Test Register (CTR)
Reserved (2)
S
Unimplemented(3)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00c1_000c
—
1. S = CPU supervisor mode access only. User mode accesses to supervisor only addresses have no effect and result in a
cycle termination transfer error.
2. Writing to reserved addresses has no effect; reading returns 0s.
3. Accessing an unimplemented address has no effect and causes a cycle termination transfer error.
4.7.3 Register Descriptions
The following subsection describes the CCM registers.
4.7.3.1 Chip Configuration Register
Address: 0x00c1_0000 and 0x00c1_0001
Bit 15
Read:
14
13
12
SHEN
EMINT
0
LOAD
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
MODE2
MODE1
MODE0
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Note 1
0
Note 2
Note 2
0
Note 1
Note 1
Note 1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SZEN
PSTEN
SHINT
BME
BMD
BMT1
BMT0
Note 3
Note 2
0
1
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Notes:
1. Determined during reset configuration
2. 0 for all configurations except emulation mode, 1 for emulation mode
3. 0 for all configurations except emulation and master modes, 1 for emulation and master
modes
Figure 4-2. Chip Configuration Register (CCR)
Advance Information
126
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Memory Map and Registers
LOAD — Pad Driver Load Bit
The LOAD bit selects full or default drive strength for selected pad
output drivers. For maximum capacitive load, set the LOAD bit to
select full drive strength. For reduced power consumption, clear the
LOAD bit to select default drive strength.
1 = Full drive strength
0 = Default drive strength
Table 4-2 shows the read/write accessibility of this write-once bit.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SHEN — Show Cycle Enable Bit
The SHEN bit enables the external memory interface to drive the
external bus during internal transfer operations.
1 = Show cycles enabled
0 = Show cycles disabled
In emulation mode, the SHEN bit is read-only. In all other modes, it is
a read/write bit.
EMINT — Emulate Internal Address Space Bit
The EMINT bit enables chip select 1 (CS1) to decode the internal
memory address space.
1 = CS1 decodes internal memory address space.
0 = CS1 decodes external memory address space.
The EMINT bit is read-always but can be written only in emulation
mode.
MODE[2:0] — Chip Configuration Mode Field
This read-only field reflects the chip configuration mode, as shown in
Table 4-4.
Table 4-4. Chip Configuration Mode Selection
MODE[2:0]
Chip Configuration Mode
111
Master mode
110
Single-chip mode
10X
FAST mode
0XX
Emulation mode
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
127
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
SZEN — TSIZ[1:0] Enable Bits
This read/write bit enables the TSIZ[1:0] function of the external pins.
1 = TSIZ[1:0] function enabled
0 = TSIZ[1:0] function disabled
PSTEN — PSTAT[3:0] Signal Enable Bits
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This read/write bit enables the PSTAT[3:0] function of the external
pins.
1 = PSTAT[3:0] function enabled
0 = PSTAT[3:0] function disabled
SHINT — Show Interrupt Bit
The SHINT bit allows visibility to any active interrupt request to the
processor. If the SHINT bit is set, the RSTOUT pin is the OR of the
fast and normal interrupt signals.
1 = Internal requests reflected on RSTOUT pin
0 = Normal RSTOUT pin function
The SHINT bit is read/write always.
NOTE:
The FRCRSTOUT function in the reset controller has a higher priority
than the SHINT function.
BME — Bus Monitor External Enable Bit
The BME bit enables the bus monitor to operate during external bus
cycles.
1 = Bus monitor enabled for external bus cycles
0 = Bus monitor disabled for external bus cycles
Table 4-2 shows the read/write accessibility of this write-once bit.
BMD — Bus Monitor Debug Mode Bit
The BMD bit controls how the bus monitor responds during debug
mode.
1 = Bus monitor enabled in debug mode
0 = Bus monitor disabled in debug mode
This bit is read/write always.
Advance Information
128
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Memory Map and Registers
BMT[1:0] — Bus Monitor Timing Field
The BMT field selects the timeout time for the bus monitor as shown
in Table 4-5.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 4-5. Bus Monitor Timeout Values
BMT[1:0]
Timeout Period
(in System Clocks)
00
64
01
32
10
16
11
8
Table 4-2 shows the read/write accessibility of these write-once bits.
4.7.3.2 Reset Configuration Register
The Reset Configuration Register (RCON) is a read-only register; writing
to RCON has no effect. At reset, RCON determines the default operation
of certain chip functions. All default functions defined by the RCON
values may be overridden during reset configuration (see 4.8.1 Reset
Configuration) only if the external RCON pin is asserted.
Address: 0x00c1_0004 and 0x00c1_0005
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
RLOAD
0
0
0
MODE
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
Read:
1
1
RPLLSEL RPLLREF
1
0
BOOTPS BOOTSEL
Write:
Reset:
1
1
1
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 4-3. Reset Configuration Register (RCON)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
129
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
RPLLSEL — PLL Mode Select Bit
When the PLL is enabled, the read-only RPLLSEL bit reflects the
default PLL mode.
1 = Normal PLL mode
0 = 1:1 PLL mode
The default PLL mode can be overridden during reset configuration.
If the default mode is overridden, the PLLSEL bit in the clock module
SYNSR reflects the PLL mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
RPLLREF — PLL Reference Bit
When the PLL is enabled in normal PLL mode, the read-only
RPLLREF bit reflects the default PLL reference.
1 = Crystal oscillator is PLL reference.
0 = External clock is PLL reference.
The default PLL reference can be overridden during reset
configuration. If the default mode is overridden, the PLLREF bit in the
clock module SYNSR reflects the PLL reference.
RLOAD — Pad Driver Load Bit
The read-only RLOAD bit reflects the pad driver strength
configuration.
1 = Full drive strength
0 = Default drive strength
The default function of the pad driver strength can be overridden
during reset configuration. If the default mode is overridden, the
LOAD bit in CCR reflects the pad driver strength configuration.
BOOTPS — Boot Port Size Bit
If the boot device is configured to be external, the read-only BOOTPS
bit reflects the default selection for the boot port size.
1 = Boot device uses 32-bit port.
0 = Boot device uses 16-bit port.
The default function of the boot port size can be overridden during
reset configuration. If the default mode is overridden, the PS bit in
CSCR0 reflects the boot device port size configuration.
Advance Information
130
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Memory Map and Registers
BOOTSEL — Boot Select Bit
This read-only bit reflects the default selection for the boot device.
1 = Boot from external boot device
0 = Boot from internal boot device
The default function of the boot select can be overridden during reset
configuration. If the default mode is overridden, the CSEN bit in
CSCR0 bit reflects the boot device configuration.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
MODE — Chip Configuration Mode Bit
The read-only MODE bit reflects the chip configuration mode.
1 = Master mode
0 = Single-chip mode
The default mode can be overridden during reset configuration. If the
default mode is overridden, the MODE bits in CCR reflect the mode
configuration.
4.7.3.3 Chip Identification Register
The Chip Identification Register (CIR) is a read-only register; writing to
CIR has no effect.
Address: 0x00c1_0006 and 0x00c1_0007
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
PIN7
0
PIN6
0
PIN5
1
PIN4
1
PIN3
1
PIN2
1
PIN1
0
PIN0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
PRN7
0
PRN6
0
PRN5
0
PRN4
0
PRN3
0
PRN2
0
PRN1
0
PRN0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 4-4. Chip Identification Register (CIR)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
131
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
PIN[7:0] — Part Identification Number Field
This read-only field contains a unique identification number for the
part.
PRN[7:0] — Part Revision Number Field
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This read-only field contains the full-layer mask revision number. This
number is increased by one for each new full-layer mask set of this
part. The revision numbers are assigned in chronological order.
4.7.3.4 Chip Test Register
The Chip Test Register (CTR) is reserved for factory testing.
NOTE:
To safeguard against unintentionally activating test logic, write $0000 to
the lock out test features. Setting any bit in CTR may lead to
unpredictable results.
Address: 0x00c1_0008 and 0x00c1_0009
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 4-5. Chip Test Register (CTR)
Advance Information
132
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Functional Description
4.8 Functional Description
Six functions are defined within the chip configuration module:
1. Reset configuration
2. Chip mode selection
3. Boot device selection
4. Output pad strength configuration
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
5. Clock mode selection
6. Module configuration
These functions are described here.
4.8.1 Reset Configuration
During reset, the pins for the reset override functions are immediately
configured to known states. Table 4-6 shows the states of the external
pins while in reset.
Table 4-6. Reset Configuration Pin States During Reset
Pin
Pin
Function(1)
I/O
Output
State
Input
State
D[26, 23:21, 19:16],
PA[4, 2], PB[7:5, 3:0]
Digital I/O or primary
Input
function
—
Must be driven
by external logic
RCON
RCON function for all
Input
modes(2)
—
Internal weak
pullup device
PLLEN
Not affected
—
Must be driven by
external logic
Input
1. If the external RCON pin is not asserted during reset, pin functions are determined by the
default operation mode defined in the RCON register. If the external RCON pin is asserted,
pin functions are determined by the chip operation mode defined by the override values
driven on the external data bus pins.
2. During reset, the external RCON pin assumes its RCON pin function, but this pin changes
to the function defined by the chip operation mode immediately after reset. See Table 4-7.
If the RCON pin is not asserted during reset, the chip configuration and
the reset configuration pin functions after reset are determined by RCON
or fixed defaults, regardless of the states of the external data pins. The
internal configuration signals are driven to levels specified by the RCON
register’s reset state for default module configuration.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
133
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
If the external RCON pin is asserted during reset, then various chip
functions, including the reset configuration pin functions after reset, are
configured according to the levels driven onto the external data pins.
(See Table 4-7.) The internal configuration signals are driven to reflect
the levels on the external configuration pins to allow for module
configuration.
Table 4-7. Configuration During Reset(1)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Pin(s) Affected
D[31:0], SHS, TA, TEA,
CSE[1:0], TC[2:0], OE,
A[22:0], EB[3:0], CS[3:0]
Default
Configuration
RCON0 = 0
Override Pins
in Reset(2),(3)
Function
D[26,17:16]
Chip Mode Selected
111
Master mode
110
Single-chip mode(4)
10X
FAST mode
0XX
Emulation mode
D[19:18]
CS[1:0]
Boot Device
X0
Internal with 32-bit port(4)
01
External with 16-bit port
11
External with 32-bit port
RCON[3:2] = 10
D21
All output pins
RCON5 = 0
Output Pad Drive Strength
0
Default strength(4)
1
Full strength
PLLEN, D[23:22]
Clock mode
Clock Mode
0XX
External clock mode (PLL disabled)
10X
1:1 PLL mode
110
Normal PLL mode with external
clock reference
111
Normal PLL mode w/crystal
oscillator reference(4)
RCON[7:6] = 11
1. Modifying the default configurations is possible only if the external RCON pin is asserted.
2. The D[31:29, 28, 27, 25:24, 20, 15:0] pins do not affect reset configuration.
3. The external reset override circuitry drives the data bus pins with the override values while RSTOUT is asserted. It must
stop driving the data bus pins within one CLKOUT cycle after RSTOUT is negated. To prevent contention with the external
reset override circuitry, the reset override pins are forced to inputs during reset and do not become outputs until at least
one CLKOUT cycle after RSTOUT is negated.
4. Default configuration
Advance Information
134
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Functional Description
4.8.2 Chip Mode Selection
The chip mode is selected during reset and reflected in the MODE field
of the Chip Configuration Register (CCR). (See 4.7.3.1 Chip
Configuration Register.) Once reset is exited, the operating mode
cannot be changed. Table 4-8 shows the mode selection during reset
configuration.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 4-8. Chip Configuration Mode Selection(1)
Chip Configuration
Mode
CCR Register MODE Field
MODE2
MODE1
MODE0
Master mode
D26 driven high
D17 driven high
D16 driven high
Single-chip mode
D26 driven high
D17 driven high
D16 driven low
FAST mode
D26 driven high
D17 driven low
D16 don’t care
Emulation mode
D26 driven low
D17 don’t care
D16 don’t care
1. Modifying the default configurations is possible only if the external RCON pin is asserted.
During reset, certain module configurations depend on whether
emulation mode is active as determined by the state of the internal
emulation signal.
4.8.3 Boot Device Selection
During reset configuration, the CS0 chip select pin is optionally
configured to select an external boot device. In this case, the CSEN bit
in CSCR0 is set, enabling CS0 after reset. CS0 will be asserted for the
initial boot fetch accessed from address 0x0. It is assumed that the reset
vector loaded from address 0x0 causes the CPU to start executing from
external memory space decoded by CS0. Also, the PS bit is configured
for either a 16-bit or 32-bit port size depending on the external boot
device. See Table 4-9.
In emulation mode, the CS1 chip select pin is optionally configured for
emulating an internal memory. In emulation mode and booting from
internal memory, the CSEN bit in CSCR1 is set, enabling CS1 after
reset.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
135
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Table 4-9. Chip Select CS0 Configuration Encoding
CSCR0
Register
Chip Select CS0 Control
CSCR1
Register
CSEN Bit
PS Bit
CSEN Bit
Chip select disabled (32-bit port size)
0
1
1(1)
Chip select enabled with 16-bit port size
1
0
0
Chip select enabled with 32-bit port size
1
1
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
1. CSCR1 CSEN is initially set only in emulation mode when booting from internal memory
and is cleared otherwise.
Once reset is exited, the states of the CSEN and PS bits in CSCR0 and
the CSEN bit in CSCR1 remain, but can be modified by software.
The boot device selection during reset configuration is summarized in
Table 4-10.
Table 4-10. Boot Device Selection(1)
CSCR0
Register
Boot Device Selection
CSEN Bit
CSCR1
Register
PS Bit
CSEN Bit
Internal boot device;
default 32-bit port
D18 driven low
D19 don’t care
D18 driven low
External boot device
with 16-bit port
D18 driven high
D19 driven low
D18 driven high
External boot device
with 32-bit port
D18 driven high
D19 driven high
D18 driven high
1. Modifying the default configurations is possible only if the external RCON pin is asserted.
Advance Information
136
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
Functional Description
4.8.4 Output Pad Strength Configuration
Output pad strength is determined during reset configuration as shown
in Table 4-11. See 23.7 DC Electrical Specifications for drive
capability for each setting. Once reset is exited, the output pad strength
configuration can be changed by programming the LOAD bit of the Chip
Configuration Register.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 4-11. Output Pad Driver Strength Selection(1)
Optional Pin Function Selection
CCR Register LOAD Bit
Output pads configured for default strength
D21 driven low
Output pads configured for full strength
D21 driven high
1. Modifying the default configurations is possible only if the external RCON pin is asserted
low.
4.8.5 Clock Mode Selection
The clock mode is selected during reset and reflected in the PLLMODE,
PLLSEL, and PLLREF bits of SYNSR. Once reset is exited, the clock
mode cannot be changed.
Table 4-12 summarizes clock mode selection during reset configuration.
Table 4-12. Clock Mode Selection(1)
Synthesizer Status Register (SYNSR)
Clock Mode
MODE Bit
PLLSEL Bit
PLLREF Bit
External clock mode; PLL disabled
PLLEN driven low
D23 don’t care
D22 don’t care
1:1 PLL mode
PLLEN driven high
D23 driven low
D22 don’t care
Normal PLL mode; external clock reference
PLLEN driven high
D23 driven high
D22 driven low
Normal PLL mode; crystal oscillator reference
PLLEN driven high
D23 driven high
D22 driven high
1. Modifying the default configurations is possible only if the external RCON pin is asserted low.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
137
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
4.8.6 Internal FLASH Configuration
The internal FLASH in the MMC2113 and MMC2114 is always enabled.
4.9 Reset
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset initializes CCM registers to a known startup state as described in
4.7 Memory Map and Registers. The CCM controls chip configuration
at reset as described in 4.8 Functional Description.
4.10 Interrupts
The CCM does not generate interrupt requests.
Advance Information
138
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Configuration Module (CCM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 5. Reset Controller Module
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
5.1 Contents
5.2
Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
5.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140
5.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
5.5
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
5.5.1
RESET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
5.5.2
RSTOUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
5.6
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
5.6.1
Reset Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
5.6.2
Reset Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
5.7
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
5.7.1
Reset Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
5.7.1.1
Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
5.7.1.2
External Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
5.7.1.3
Watchdog Timer Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
5.7.1.4
Loss of Clock Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148
5.7.1.5
Loss of Lock Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
5.7.1.6
Software Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
5.7.1.7
LVD Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
5.7.2
Reset Control Flow. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
5.7.2.1
Synchronous Reset Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
5.7.2.2
Internal Reset Request . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
5.7.2.3
Power-On Reset/Low-Voltage Detect Reset . . . . . . . . .151
5.7.3
Concurrent Resets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
5.7.3.1
Reset Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
5.7.3.2
Reset Status Flags. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
139
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
5.2 Overview
The reset controller is provided to determine the cause of reset, assert
the appropriate reset signals to the system, and then to keep a history of
what caused the reset. The power management CPU (PMM) control
registers that generate low-voltage detect (LVD) bits are implemented in
the reset module.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
5.3 Features
Module features include:
•
Six sources of reset:
– External
– Power-on reset (POR)
– Watchdog timer
– Phase locked-loop (PLL) loss of lock
– PLL loss of clock
– Software
– LVD reset
Advance Information
140
•
Software-assertable RSTOUT pin independent of chip reset state
•
Software-readable status flags indicating the cause of the last
reset
•
LVD control and status bits for setup and use of LVD reset or
interrupt
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
Block Diagram
5.4 Block Diagram
Figure 5-1 illustrates the reset controller and PMM controller and is
explained in the following sections.
RESET
PIN
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
POWER-ON
RESET
RSOUT
PIN
WATCHDOG
TIMER TIMEOUT
RESET
CONTROLLER
AND
PMM
CONTROLLER
PLL
LOSS OF CLOCK
TO INTERNAL RESETS
PLL
LOSS OF LOCK
TO PMM HARD BLOCK
SOFTWARE
RESET
LVD
DETECT
Figure 5-1. Reset Controller Block Diagram
5.5 Signals
Table 5-1 provides a summary of the reset controller signal properties.
The signals are described in the following paragraphs.
Table 5-1. Reset Controller Signal Properties
Direction
Input
Hysteresis
Input
Synchronization
RESET pin
I
Y
Y(1)
RSTOUT pin
O
—
—
Name
1. RESET is always synchronized except when in low-power stop mode.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
141
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
5.5.1 RESET
Asserting the external RESET pin for at least four rising CLKOUT edges
causes the external reset request to be recognized and latched.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
5.5.2 RSTOUT
This active-low output signal is driven low when the internal reset
controller module resets the chip. When RSTOUT is active, the user can
drive override options on the data bus.
5.6 Memory Map and Registers
The reset controller programming model consists of these registers:
•
Reset Control Register (RCR) — selects reset controller functions
•
Reset Status Register (RSR) — reflects the state of the last reset
source
See Table 5-2 for the address map and the following paragraphs for a
description of the registers.
Table 5-2. Reset Controller Address Map
Address
Bits 7:0
Access(1)
0x00c4_0000
RCR — Reset Control Register
S/U
0x00c4_0001
RSR — Reset Status Register
S/U
0x00c4_0002
Reserved(2)
—
0x00c4_0003
Reserved(2)
—
1. S/U = supervisor or user mode access.
2. Writes to reserved address locations have no effect and reads return 0s.
Advance Information
142
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
Memory Map and Registers
5.6.1 Reset Control Register
The Reset Control Register (RCR) allows software control for requesting
a reset, for independently asserting the external RSTOUT pin, and for
controlling low-voltage detect (LVD) functions.
Address: 0x00c4_0000
Bit 7
6
5
FRCRSTOUT
0
SOFTRST
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Read:
Write:
Reset:
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
LVDF
LVDIE
LVDRE
LVDSE
LVDE
See note
0
1
1
1
Note: Reset dependent
= Writes have no effect and terminate without transfer error exception.
Figure 5-2. Reset Control Register (RCR)
SOFTRST — Software Reset Request
The SOFTRST bit allows software to request a reset. The reset
caused by setting this bit clears this bit.
1 = Software reset request
0 = No software reset request
FRCRSTOUT — Force RSTOUT Pin
The FRCRSTOUT bit allows software to assert or negate the external
RSTOUT pin.
1 = Assert RSTOUT pin
0 = Negate RSTOUT pin
CAUTION:
External logic driving reset configuration data during reset needs to be
considered when asserting the RSTOUT pin when setting
FRCRSTOUT.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
143
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
LVDF — LVD Flag
The LVDF bit indicates the low-voltage detect status if LVDE is set.
Write a 1 to clear the LVDF bit.
1 = Low voltage has been detected
0 = Low voltage has not been detected
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
NOTE:
The setting of this flag causes an LVD interrupt if LVDE and LVDIE bits
are set and LVDRE is cleared when the supply voltage VDD drops below
VDD (minimum). The vector for this interrupt is shared with INT0 of the
EPORT module. Interrupt arbitration in the interrupt service routine is
necessary if both of these interrupts are enabled.
LVDIE — LVD Interrupt Enable
The LVDIE bit controls the LVD interrupt if LVDE is set. This bit has
no effect if the LVDE bit is a logic 0.
1 = LVD interrupt enabled
0 = LVD interrupt disabled
LVDRE — LVD Reset Enable
The LVDRE bit controls the LVD reset if LVDE is set. This bit has no
effect if the LVDE bit is a logic 0. LVD reset has priority over LVD
interrupt, if both are enabled.
1 = LVD reset enabled
0 = LVD reset disabled
LVDSE — LVD Stop Enable
The LVDSE bit controls the behavior of the LVD when the MCU stop
mode is entered if LVDE is set. This bit has no effect if the LVDE bit
is a logic 0.
1 = LVD enabled in MCU stop mode
0 = LVD disabled in MCU stop mode
LVDE — LVD Enable
The LVDE bit controls whether the LVD is enabled.
1 = LVD is enabled
0 = LVD is disabled
Advance Information
144
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
Memory Map and Registers
5.6.2 Reset Status Register
The Reset Status Register (RSR) contains a status bit for every reset
source. When reset is entered, the cause of the reset condition is latched
along with a value of 0 for the other reset sources that were not pending
at the time of the reset condition. These values are then reflected in
RSR. One or more status bits may be set at the same time. The cause
of any subsequent reset is also recorded in the register, overwriting
status from the previous reset condition.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
RSR can be read at any time. Writing to RSR has no effect.
Address: 0x00c4_0001
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
LVD
SOFT
WDR
POR
EXT
LOC
LOL
Write:
Reset:
0
Reset dependent
= Writes have no effect and terminate without transfer error exception.
Figure 5-3. Reset Status Register (RSR)
LVD — Low-Voltage Detect
This bit indicates that the last reset state was caused by an LVD reset.
1 = Last reset state was caused by an LVD reset
0 = Last reset state was not caused by an LVD reset
SOFT — Software Reset Flag
SOFT indicates that the last reset was caused by software.
1 = Last reset caused by software
0 = Last reset not caused by software
WDR — Watchdog Timer Reset Flag
WDR indicates that the last reset was caused by a watchdog timer
timeout.
1 = Last reset caused by watchdog timer timeout
0 = Last reset not caused by watchdog timer timeout
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
145
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
POR — Power-On Reset Flag
POR indicates that the last reset was caused by a power-on reset.
1 = Last reset caused by power-on reset
0 = Last reset not caused by power-on reset
EXT — External Reset Flag
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
EXT indicates that the last reset was caused by an external device
asserting the external RESET pin.
1 = Last reset state caused by external reset
0 = Last reset not caused by external reset
LOC — Loss of Clock Reset Flag
LOC indicates that the last reset state was caused by a PLL los of
clock.
1 = Last reset caused by loss of clock
0 = Last reset not caused by loss of clock
LOL — Loss of Lock Reset Flag
LOL indicates that the last reset state was caused by a PLL loss of
lock.
1 = Last reset caused by a loss of lock
0 = Last reset not caused by loss of lock
Advance Information
146
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
Functional Description
5.7 Functional Description
5.7.1 Reset Sources
Table 5-3 defines the sources of reset and the signals driven by the reset
controller.
Table 5-3. Reset Source Summary
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Source
Type
Power on
Asynchronous
External RESET pin (not stop mode)
Synchronous
External RESET pin (during stop mode)
Asynchronous
Watchdog timer
Synchronous
Loss of clock
Asynchronous
Loss of lock
Asynchronous
Software
Synchronous
LVD reset
Asynchronous
To protect data integrity, a synchronous reset source is not acted upon
by the reset control logic until the end of the current bus cycle. Reset is
then asserted on the next rising edge of the system clock after the cycle
is terminated. Whenever the reset control logic must synchronize reset
to the end of the bus cycle, the internal bus monitor is automatically
enabled regardless of the BME bit state in the chip configuration module
CCR register. Then, if the current bus cycle is not terminated normally
the bus monitor terminates the cycle based on the length of time
programmed in the BMT field of the CCR register.
Internal single-byte, half-word, or word writes are guaranteed to
complete without data corruption when a synchronous reset occurs.
External writes, including word writes to 16-bit ports, are also
guaranteed to complete.
Asynchronous reset sources usually indicate a catastrophic failure.
Therefore, the reset control logic does not wait for the current bus cycle
to complete. Reset is asserted immediately to the system.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
147
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
5.7.1.1 Power-On Reset
At power up, the reset controller asserts RSTOUT. RSTOUT continues
to be asserted until VDD has reached a minimum acceptable level and,
if PLL clock mode is selected, until the PLL achieves phase lock. Then
after approximately another 512 cycles, RSTOUT is negated and the
part begins operation.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
5.7.1.2 External Reset
Asserting the external RESET pin for at least four rising CLKOUT edges
causes the external reset request to be recognized and latched. The bus
monitor is enabled and the current bus cycle is completed. The reset
controller asserts RSTOUT for approximately 512 cycles after the
RESET pin is negated and the PLL has acquired lock. The part then exits
reset and begins operation.
In low-power stop mode, the system clocks are stopped. Asserting the
external RESET pin in stop mode causes an external reset to be
recognized.
5.7.1.3 Watchdog Timer Reset
A watchdog timer timeout causes timer reset request to be recognized
and latched. The bus monitor is enabled and the current bus cycle is
completed. If the RESET pin is negated and the PLL has acquired lock,
the reset controller asserts RSTOUT for approximately 512 cycles. Then
the part exits reset and begins operation.
5.7.1.4 Loss of Clock Reset
This reset condition occurs in PLL clock mode when the LOCRE bit in
the SYNCR register is set and either the PLL reference or the PLL fails.
The reset controller asserts RSTOUT for approximately 512 cycles after
the PLL has acquired lock. The part then exits reset and begins
operation.
Advance Information
148
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
Functional Description
5.7.1.5 Loss of Lock Reset
This reset condition occurs in PLL clock mode when the LOLRE bit in the
SYNCR register is set and the PLL loses lock. The reset controller
asserts RSTOUT for approximately 512 cycles after the PLL has
acquired lock. The part then exits reset and resumes operation.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
5.7.1.6 Software Reset
A software reset occurs the SOFTRST bit is set. If the RESET pin is
negated and the PLL has acquired lock, the reset controller asserts
RSTOUT for approximately 512 cycles. Then the part exits reset and
resumes operation.
5.7.1.7 LVD Reset
The LVD reset will occur when the supply input voltage drops below VDD
(minimum).
5.7.2 Reset Control Flow
The reset logic control flow is shown in Figure 5-4. In this figure, the
control state boxes have been numbered, and these numbers are
referred to (within parentheses) in the flow description that follows. All
cycle counts given are approximate.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
149
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
0
1
POR OR LVD
Y
LOSS OF CLOCK?
N
2
Y
LOSS OF LOCK?
5
ENABLE BUS MONITOR
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
N
3
RESET
PIN OR WD TIMEOUT
OR SW RESET?
Y
6
N
BUS CYCLE
COMPLETE?
N
4
ASSERT RSTOUT AND
LATCH RESET STATUS
Y
7
ASSERT RSTOUT AND
LATCH RESET STATUS
8
N
RESET NEGATED?
Y
9
Y
PLL MODE?
9A
N
PLL LOCKED?
Y
N
10
12
NEGATE RSTOUT
WAIT 512 CLKOUT CYCLES
11A
11
Y
RCON ASSERTED?
LATCH CONFIGURATION
N
Figure 5-4. Reset Control Flow
Advance Information
150
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
Functional Description
5.7.2.1 Synchronous Reset Requests
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
In this discussion, the reference in parentheses refer to the state
numbers in Figure 5-4. All cycle counts given are approximate.
If either the external RESET pin is asserted by an external device for at
least four rising CLKOUT edges (3), or the watchdog timer times out, or
software requests a reset, the reset control logic latches the reset
request internally and enables the bus monitor (5). When the current bus
cycle is completed (6), RSTOUT is asserted (7). The reset control logic
waits until the RESET pin is negated (8) and for the PLL to attain lock
(9, 9A) before waiting 512 CLKOUT cycles (1).The reset control logic
may latch the configuration according to the RCON pin level (11, 11A)
before negating RSTOUT (12).
If the external RESET pin is asserted by an external device for at least
four rising CLKOUT edges during the 512 count (10) or during the wait
for PLL lock (9A), the reset flow switches to (8) and waits for the RESET
pin to be negated before continuing.
5.7.2.2 Internal Reset Request
If reset is asserted by an asynchronous internal reset source, such as
loss of clock (1) or loss of lock (2), the reset control logic asserts
RSTOUT (4). The reset control logic waits for the PLL to attain lock
(9, 9A) before waiting 512 CLKOUT cycles (1). Then the reset control
logic may latch the configuration according to the RCON pin level (11,
11A) before negating RSTOUT (12).
If loss of lock occurs during the 512 count (10), the reset flow switches
to (9A) and waits for the PLL to lock before continuing.
5.7.2.3 Power-On Reset/Low-Voltage Detect Reset
When the reset sequence is initiated by power-on reset (0), the same
reset sequence is followed as for the other asynchronous reset sources.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
151
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
5.7.3 Concurrent Resets
This section describes the concurrent resets. As in the previous
discussion references in parentheses refer to the state numbers in
Figure 5-4.
5.7.3.1 Reset Flow
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
If a power-on reset or low-voltage detect condition is detected during any
reset sequence, the reset sequence starts immediately (0).
If the external RESET pin is asserted for at least four rising CLKOUT
edges while waiting for PLL lock or the 512 cycles, the external reset is
recognized. Reset processing switches to wait for the external RESET
pin to negate (8).
If a loss of clock or loss of lock condition is detected while waiting for the
current bus cycle to complete (5, 6) for an external reset request, the
cycle is terminated. The reset status bits are latched (7) and reset
processing waits for the external RESET pin to negate (8).
If a loss of clock or loss of lock condition is detected during the 512 cycle
wait, the reset sequence continues after a PLL lock (9, 9A).
5.7.3.2 Reset Status Flags
For a POR reset, the POR and LVD bits in the RSR register are set, and
the SOFT, WDR, EXT, LOC, and LOL bits are cleared even if another
type of reset condition is detected during the reset sequence for the
POR.
If a loss of clock or loss of lock condition is detected while waiting for the
current bus cycle to complete (5, 6) for an external reset request, the
EXT, SOFT, and/or WDR bits along with the LOC and/or LOL bits are
set.
If the RSR bits are latched (7) during the EXT, SOFT, and/or WDR reset
sequence with no other reset conditions detected, only the EXT, SOFT,
and/or WDR bits are set.
Advance Information
152
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Reset Controller Module
Functional Description
If the RSR bits are latched (4) during the internal reset sequence with the
RESET pin not asserted and no SOFT or WDR event, then the LOC
and/or LOL bits are the only bits set.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
For a LVD reset, the LVD bit in the Reset Status Register (RSR) is set,
and the SOFT, WDR, EXT, LOC, and LOL bits are cleared to 0 even if
another type of reset condition is detected during the reset sequence for
LVD.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
153
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset Controller Module
Advance Information
154
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Reset Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 6. Power Management
6.1 Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
6.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
6.3
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
6.3.1
Run Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
6.3.2
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
6.3.3
Doze Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
6.3.4
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
6.3.5
Peripheral Shut Down . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
6.4
Peripheral Behavior in Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
6.4.1
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
6.4.2
Clocks. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
6.4.3
OnCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
6.4.4
JTAG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
6.4.5
Interrupt Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
6.4.6
Edge Port . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
6.4.7
Random-Access Memory (RAM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
6.4.8
FLASH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
6.4.9
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC) . . . . . . . . . . 161
6.4.10 Watchdog Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
6.4.11 Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT1 and PIT2). . . . . . . . 162
6.4.12 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
6.4.13 Serial Communication Interfaces (SCI1 and SCI2) . . . . . . 162
6.4.14 Timers (TIM1 and TIM2). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
6.5
Summary of Peripheral State During Low-Power Modes . . . . 163
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Power Management
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
155
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Power Management
6.2 Introduction
The following features support low power operation.
•
Four modes of operation:
– Run
– Wait
– Doze
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
– Stop
•
Ability to shut down most peripherals independently
•
Ability to shut down the external CLKOUT pin
6.3 Low-Power Modes
The system enters a low-power mode by execution of a STOP, WAIT, or
DOZE instruction.This idles the CPU with no cycles active. An internal
signal indicates to the system and clock controller to power down and
stop the clocks appropriately. During stop mode, the system clock is
stopped low.
A wakeup event is required to exit a low-power mode and return to run
mode. Wakeup events consist of any of these conditions:
•
Any type of reset
•
Assertion of the DE pin to request entry into debug mode
•
Debug request bit set in the OnCE Control Register to request
entry into debug mode
•
Any valid interrupt request
6.3.1 Run Mode
Run mode is the normal system operating mode. Current consumption
in this mode is related directly to the system clock frequency.
Advance Information
156
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Power Management
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Power Management
Low-Power Modes
6.3.2 Wait Mode
Wait mode is intended to be used to stop only the CPU and memory
clocks until a wakeup event is detected. In this mode, peripherals may
be programmed to continue operating and can generate interrupts,
which cause the CPU to exit from wait mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
6.3.3 Doze Mode
Doze mode affects the CPU in the same manner as wait mode, except
that each peripheral defines individual operational characteristics in
doze mode. Peripherals which continue to run and have the capability of
producing interrupts may cause the CPU to exit the doze mode and
return to run mode. Peripherals which are stopped will restart operation
on exit from doze mode as defined for each peripheral.
6.3.4 Stop Mode
Stop mode affects the CPU in the same manner as the wait and doze
modes, except that all clocks to the system are stopped and the
peripherals cease operation.
Stop mode must be entered in a controlled manner to ensure that any
current operation is properly terminated. When exiting stop mode, most
peripherals retain their pre-stop status and resume operation.
The following subsections specify the operation of each module while in
and when exiting low-power modes.
6.3.5 Peripheral Shut Down
Most peripherals may be disabled by software in order to cease internal
clock generation and remain in a static state. Each peripheral has its own
specific disabling sequence (refer to each peripheral description for
further details). A peripheral may be disabled at any time and will remain
disabled during any low-power mode of operation.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Power Management
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
157
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Power Management
6.4 Peripheral Behavior in Low-Power Modes
6.4.1 Reset
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
A power-on reset (POR) will always cause a chip reset and exit from any
low-power mode.
In wait and doze modes, asserting the external RESET pin for at least
four clocks will cause an external reset that will reset the chip and exit
any low-power modes.
In stop mode, the RESET pin synchronization is disabled and asserting
the external RESET pin will asynchronously generate an internal reset
and exit any low-power modes. Registers will loose current values and
must be reconfigured from reset state if needed.
If the phase lock loop (PLL) is active, then any loss of clock or loss of
lock will reset the chip and exit any low-power modes.
If the watchdog timer is still enabled during wait or doze modes, then a
watchdog timer timeout may generate a reset to exit these low-power
modes.
When the CPU is inactive, a software reset can not be generated to exit
any low-power mode.
6.4.2 Clocks
During the low power wait and doze modes, the clocks to the CPU,
FLASH, and random-access memory (RAM) will be stopped and the
system clocks to the peripherals are enabled. Each module may disable
the module clocks locally at the module level. During the low-power stop
mode, all clocks to the system will be stopped.
During stop mode, there are several options for enabling/disabling the
PLL and/or crystal oscillator (OSC) compromising between wakeup
recovery time and stop mode power. The PLL may be disabled during
stop. A wakeup time of up to 200 µs is required for the PLL to re-lock.
The OSC may also be disabled during STOP. A wakeup time required
Advance Information
158
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Power Management
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Power Management
Peripheral Behavior in Low-Power Modes
for the OSC to restart is dependent upon the startup time of the crystal
used. Power consumption can be reduced in stop mode by disabling
either or both of these functions via the STMPD bits of the Synthesizer
Control Register (SYNCR). See 11.7.2.1 Synthesizer Control
Register.
The external CLKOUT signal may be enabled during low-power stop (if
the PLL is still enabled) to support systems using this signal as the clock
source.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The system clocks may be enabled during wakeup from stop mode
without waiting for the PLL to lock. This eliminates the wakeup recovery
time, but at the risk of sending a potentially unstable clock to the system.
It is recommended, if this option is used, that the PLL frequency divider
is set so that the targeted system frequency is no more than half the
maximum allowed. This will allow for any frequency overshoot of the PLL
while still keeping the system clock within specification.
In external clock mode, there are no wait times for the OSC startup or
PLL lock.
During wakeup from stop mode, the FLASH clock will always clock
through 16 cycles before the system clocks are enabled. This allows the
FLASH module time to recover from the low-power mode. Thus,
software may immediately continue to fetch instructions from the FLASH
memory.
The external CLKOUT output pin may be disabled in the low state to
lower power consumption via the disable CLKOUT (DISCLK) bit in the
SYNCR. The external CLKOUT pin function is enabled by default at
reset.
6.4.3 OnCE
The OnCE logic is clocked using the TCLK input and is not affected by
the system clock. Entering debug mode via the OnCE port (or asserting
the external DE pin) will cause the CPU to exit any low-power mode.
Toggling TCLK during any low-power mode will increase the system
current consumption.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Power Management
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
159
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Power Management
6.4.4 JTAG
The JTAG (Joint Test Action Group) controller logic is clocked using the
TCLK input and is not affected by the system clock. The JTAG cannot
generate an event to cause the CPU to exit any low-power mode.
Toggling TCLK during any low-power mode will increase the system
current consumption.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
6.4.5 Interrupt Controller
The interrupt controller is not affected by any of the low-power modes.
All logic between the input sources and generating the interrupt to the
M•CORE processor will be combinational to allow the ability to wakeup
the CPU processor during low-power stop mode when all system clocks
are stopped.
A fast interrupt request will cause the CPU to exit a low-power mode only
if the FE bit in the CPU’s PSR register is set. A normal interrupt request
will cause the CPU to exit a low-power mode only if the IE and EE bits in
the CPU’s PSR register are set.
6.4.6 Edge Port
In wait and doze modes, the edge port continues to operate normally and
may be configured to generate interrupts (either an edge transition or
low level on an external pin) to exit the low-power modes.
In stop mode, there are no clocks available to perform the edge detect
function. Thus, only the level detect logic is active (if configured) to allow
any low level on the external interrupt pin to generate an interrupt (if
enabled) to exit the stop mode.
6.4.7 Random-Access Memory (RAM)
The random-access memory (RAM) is disabled during any low-power
mode. No recovery time is required when exiting any low-power mode.
Advance Information
160
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Power Management
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Power Management
Peripheral Behavior in Low-Power Modes
6.4.8 FLASH
The FLASH is in a low-power state if not being accessed. No recovery
time is required after exit from any low-power mode.
6.4.9 Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Setting the queued analog-to-digital converter (QADC) STOP bit
(QSTOP) will disable the QADC.
The QADC is unaffected by either wait or doze mode and may generate
an interrupt to exit these modes.
Low-power stop mode (or setting the QSTOP bit), immediately freezes
operation, register values, state machines, and external pins. This stops
the clock signals to the digital electronics of the module and eliminates
the quiescent current draw of the analog electronics. Any conversion
sequences in progress are stopped. Exit from low-power stop mode (or
clearing the QSTOP bit), returns the QADC to operation from the state
prior to stop mode entry, but any conversions in progress are undefined
and the QADC requires recovery time (tSR in 23.9 QADC Electrical
Characteristics) to stabilize the analog circuits before new conversions
can be performed.
6.4.10 Watchdog Timer
In stop mode (or in wait/doze mode, if so programmed), the watchdog
ceases operation and freezes at the current value.When exiting these
modes, the watchdog resumes operation from the stopped value. It is
the responsibility of software to avoid erroneous operation.
When not stopped, the watchdog may generate a reset to exit the
low-power modes.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Power Management
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
161
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Power Management
6.4.11 Programmable Interrupt Timers (PIT1 and PIT2)
In stop mode (or in doze mode, if so programmed), the programmable
interrupt timer (PIT) ceases operation, and freezes at the current value.
When exiting these modes, the PIT resumes operation from the stopped
value. It is the responsibility of software to avoid erroneous operation.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When not stopped, the PIT may generate an interrupt to exit the
low-power modes.
6.4.12 Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI)
When not stopped, the serial peripheral interface (SPI) may generate an
interrupt to exit the low-power modes.
•
Clearing the SPI enable bit (SPE) disables the SPI function.
•
The SPI is unaffected by wait mode and may generate an interrupt
to exit this mode.
SPI operation in doze mode is programmable. Depending on the state of
internal bits, the SPI can operate normally when the CPU is in doze
mode or the SPI clock generation can be turned off and the SPI module
enters a power conservation state during doze mode. During doze
mode, any master transmission in progress stops. Reception and
transmission of a byte as slave continues so that the slave is
synchronized to the master.
The SPI is inactive in stop mode for reduced power consumption.
6.4.13 Serial Communication Interfaces (SCI1 and SCI2)
When not stopped, the serial communications interface (SCI) may
generate an interrupt to exit the low-power modes.
Advance Information
162
•
Clearing the transmit enable bit (TE) or the receiver enable bit
(RE) disables SCI functions.
•
The SCIs are unaffected by wait mode and may generate an
interrupt to exit this mode.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Power Management
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Power Management
Summary of Peripheral State During Low-Power Modes
In stop mode (or doze mode, if so programmed), the SCIs stop
immediately and freeze their operation, register values, state machines,
and external pins. During these modes, the SCI clocks are shut down.
Coming out of the doze or stop modes, returns the SCIs to operation
from the state prior to the low-power mode entry.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
6.4.14 Timers (TIM1 and TIM2)
When not stopped, the timers may generate an interrupt to exit the
low-power modes.
Clearing the timer enable bit (TE) in the Timer System Control Register 1
(TIMSCR1) or the pulse accumulator enable bit (PAE) in the Pulse
Accumulator Control Register (TIMPACTL) disables timer functions.
Timer and pulse accumulator registers are still accessible by the CPU
and OnCE interface, but the remaining functions of the timer are
disabled. See 16.7.6 Timer System Control Register 1 and 16.7.15
Pulse Accumulator Control Register.
The timer is unaffected by either the wait or doze modes and may
generate an interrupt to exit these modes.
In stop mode, the timers stop immediately and freeze their operation,
register values, state machines, and external pins. Upon exiting stop
mode, the timer will resume operation unless stop mode was exited by
reset.
6.5 Summary of Peripheral State During Low-Power Modes
The functionality of each of the peripherals and CPU during the various
low-power modes is summarized in Table 6-1. The status of each
peripheral during a given mode refers to the condition the peripheral
automatically assumes when the particular instruction (WAIT, DOZE, or
STOP) is executed. Individual peripherals may be disabled by
programming its dedicated control bits. The wakeup capability field
refers to the ability of an interrupt or reset by that peripheral to force the
CPU into run mode.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Power Management
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
163
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Power Management
Table 6-1. CPU and Peripherals in Low-Power Modes
Peripheral Status(1) / Wakeup Capability
Module
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Run Mode
Wait Mode
Doze Mode
Stop Mode
CPU
Enabled
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
Reset
Enabled
Enabled
Yes(2)
Enabled
Yes(2)
Enabled
Yes(2)
Clock
Enabled
Enabled
Yes(2)
Enabled
Yes(2)
Program
Yes(2)
OnCE
Enabled
Enabled
Yes(3)
Enabled
Yes(3)
Enabled
Yes(3)
JTAG
Enabled
Enabled
No
Enabled
No
Enabled
No
Interrupt controller
Enabled
Enabled
Yes(4)
Enabled
Yes(4)
Enabled
Yes(4)
Edge port
Enabled
Enabled
Yes(4)
Enabled
Yes(4)
Stopped
Yes(4)
RAM
Enabled
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
FLASH
Enabled
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
Stopped
No
QADC
Enabled
Enabled
Yes(4)
Enabled
Yes(4)
Stopped
No
Watchdog timer
Enabled
Program
Yes(2)
Program
Yes(2)
Stopped
No
PIT1 and PIT2
Enabled
Enabled
Yes(4)
Program
Yes(4)
Stopped
No
SPI
Enabled
Enabled
Yes(4)
Program
Yes(4)
Stopped
No
SCI1 and SCI2
Enabled
Enabled
Yes(4)
Program
Yes(4)
Stopped
No
TIM1 and TIM2
Enabled
Enabled
Yes(4)
Enabled
Yes(4)
Stopped
No
1. “Program” Indicates that the peripheral function during the low-power mode is dependent on programmable bits in the
peripheral register map.
2. These modules can generate a reset which will exit any low-power mode.
3. The OnCE logic is clocked by a separate TCLK clock. Entering debug mode via the OnCE port (or assertion of the external
DE pin) exits any low-power mode. Upon exit from debug mode, the previous low-power mode will be re-entered and the
changes made during debug mode will remain in effect.
4. These modules can generate a interrupt which will exit any low-power mode. The CPU will begin to service the interrupt
exception after wakeup.
Advance Information
164
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Power Management
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 7. M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
7.1 Contents
7.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
7.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
7.4
Microarchitecture Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
7.5
Programming Model . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
7.6
Data Format Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
7.7
Operand Addressing Capabilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
7.8
Instruction Set Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
7.2 Introduction
The M•CORE M210 central processor unit (CPU) architecture is one of
the most compact, full 32-bit core implementations available. The
pipelined reduced instruction set computer (RISC) execution unit uses
16-bit instructions to achieve maximum speed and code efficiency, while
conserving on-chip memory resources. The instruction set is designed
to support high-level language implementation. A non-intrusive resident
debugging system supports product development and in-situ testing.
Total system power consumption is determined by all the system
components, rather than the CPU alone. In particular, memory power
consumption (both on-chip and external) is a dominant factor in total
power consumption of the CPU plus memory subsystem. With this in
mind, the CPU instruction set architecture trades absolute performance
capability for reduced total energy consumption. This is accomplished
while maintaining a high level of performance at a given clock frequency.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
165
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
A strictly defined load/store architecture minimizes control complexity.
Use of a fixed, 16-bit instruction encoding significantly lowers the
memory bandwidth needed to sustain a high rate of instruction
execution, and careful selection of the instruction set allows the code
density and overall memory efficiency of the CPU architecture to
surpass those of complex instruction set computer (CISC) architectures.
These factors reduce system energy consumption significantly, and the
fully static CPU design uses other techniques to reduce power
consumption even more. The CPU uses dynamic clock management to
automatically power-down internal functions that are not in use on a
clock-by-clock basis. It also incorporates three power-conservation
operating modes, which are invoked via dedicated instructions as
detailed in Section 6. Power Management.
7.3 Features
The main features of the CPU are:
Advance Information
166
•
32-bit load/store RISC architecture
•
Fixed 16-bit instruction length
•
13 entry, 32-bit control register file
•
16 entry, 32-bit general-purpose register file
•
Efficient 4-stage execution pipeline
•
Single-cycle execution for most instructions, 2-cycle branches and
memory accesses
•
Support for byte/half-word/word memory access
•
Fast interrupt support
•
Availability of alternate general purpose register file
•
Vectored and autovectored interrupt support
•
On-chip emulation support (OnCE)
•
Full static design for minimal power consumption
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Microarchitecture Summary
7.4 Microarchitecture Summary
Figure 7-1 is a block diagram of the M•CORE processor.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The processor utilizes a 4-stage pipeline for instruction execution. The
instruction fetch, instruction decode/register file read, execute, and
register file writeback stages operate in an overlapped fashion, allowing
single clock instruction execution for most instructions.
The execution unit consists of a 32-bit arithmetic/logic unit (ALU), a
32-bit barrel shifter, a find-first-one unit, result feed-forward hardware,
support hardware for multiplication and division, and multiple-register
load and store instructions.
DATA CALCULATION
GENERAL-PURPOSE
REGISTER FILE
32 BITS X 16
ADDRESS GENERATION
ALTERNATE
REGISTER FILE
32 BITS X 16
CONTROL
REGISTER FILE
32 BITS X 13
Y PORT
X PORT
ADDRESS MUX
IMMEDIATE
MUX
PC
INCREMENT
SCALE
BRANCH
ADDER
BARREL SHIFTER
MULTIPLIER
DIVIDER
SIGN EXT.
MUX
ADDRESS
BUS
MUX
INSTRUCTION PIPELINE
ADDER/LOGICAL PRIORITY ENCODER/
ZERO DETECT RESULT MUX
INSTRUCTION DECODE
WRITEBACK BUS
H/W ACCELERATOR INTERFACE BUS
DATA
BUS
Figure 7-1. M•CORE Processor Block Diagram
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
167
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Arithmetic and logical operations are executed in a single cycle.
Multiplication is implemented with a 2-bit per clock, overlapped-scan,
modified Booth algorithm with early-out capability, to reduce execution
time for operations with small multipliers. Divide is implemented with a
1-bit per clock early-in algorithm. The find-first-one unit operates in one
clock cycle.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The program counter unit incorporates a dedicated branch address
adder to minimize delays during change of flow operations. Branch
target addresses are calculated in parallel with branch instruction
decode. Taken branches and jumps require only two clocks; branches
which are not taken execute in one clock cycle.
Memory load and store operations are provided for 8-bit (byte), 16-bit
(halfword), and 32-bit (word) data, with automatic zero extension for byte
and half-word load operations. These instructions can execute in as few
as two clock cycles. Load and store multiple register instructions allow
low overhead context save and restore operations. These instructions
can execute in (N+1) clock cycles, where N is the number of registers to
transfer.
A condition code/carry (C) bit is provided for condition testing or for use
in implementing arithmetic and logical operations with operands/results
greater than 32 bits. The C bit is typically set by explicit test/comparison
operations, not as a side-effect of normal instruction operation.
Exceptions to this rule occur for specialized operations where it is
desirable to combine condition setting with actual computation.
The processor uses autovectors for both normal and fast interrupt
requests. Fast interrupts take precedence over normal interrupts. Both
types have dedicated exception shadow registers. For service requests
of either kind, an automatic vector is generated when the request is
made.
Advance Information
168
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Programming Model
7.5 Programming Model
Figure 7-2 shows the M•CORE processor programming model. The
model is defined differently for supervisor and user privilege modes. By
convention, in both modes R15 serves as the link register for subroutine
calls. R0 is typically used as the stack pointer.
R0
R1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
ALTERNATE FILE
R0’
R0
R2
R3
R4
R5
R6
R7
R8
R9
R10
R11
R12
R13
R14
R1
PSR
CR0
R2
VBR
CR1
R3
EPSR
CR2
R4
FPSR
CR3
R5
EPC
CR4
R6
FPC
CR5
R7
SS0
CR6
R8
SS1
CR7
R9
SS2
CR8
R10
SS3
CR9
R11
SS4
CR10
R12
GCR
CR11
R13
GSR
CR12
R14
R15
R15
PC
PC
C
*
USER PROGRAMMER’S
MODEL
C
*
SUPERVISOR PROGRAMMER’S
MODEL
* BIT 0 OF PSR
Figure 7-2. Programming Model
The user programming model consists of 16 general-purpose 32-bit
registers (R0–R15), the 32-bit PC, and the C bit. The C bit is
implemented as bit 0 of the Processor Status Register (PSR) and is the
only portion of the PSR accessible in the user model.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
169
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
The supervisor programming model consists of the user model plus 16
additional 32-bit general-purpose registers (R0–R15), called the
alternate file and a set of status/control registers (CR0–CR12) which
includes the entire PSR. Setting the S bit in the PSR enables supervisor
mode operation.
The alternate file allows very low overhead context switching for
real-time event handling. While the alternate file is enabled,
general-purpose registers are accessed from it.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The Vector Base Register (VBR) determines the base address of the
exception vector table. Exception shadow registers EPC and EPSR are
used to save the states of the program counter and PSR, respectively,
when an exception occurs. Shadow registers FPC and FPSR save the
states of the program counter and PSR, respectively, when a fast
interrupt exception occurs.
Five scratch registers (SS0–SS4) are used to handle exception events.
The global control (GCR) and status (GSR) registers can be used for a
variety of system monitoring tasks at the discretion of the compiler used.
They serve no specific function by or for the CPU.
Advance Information
170
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Data Format Summary
7.6 Data Format Summary
The operand data formats supported by the integer unit are standard
two’s-complement data formats. The operand size for each instruction is
either explicitly encoded in the instruction (load/store instructions) or
implicitly defined by the instruction operation (index operations, byte
extraction). Typically, instructions operate on all 32 bits of the source
operand(s) and generate a 32-bit result.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Memory is viewed from a big-endian byte ordering perspective. The
most significant byte (byte 0) of word 0 is located at address 0. Bits are
numbered within a word starting with bit 31 as the most significant bit.
0
31
BYTE 0
BYTE 1
BYTE 2
BYTE 3
WORD AT 0x0000 000 0
BYTE 4
BYTE 5
BYTE 6
BYTE 7
WORD AT 0x0000 000 4
BYTE 8
BYTE 9
BYTE A
BYTE B
WORD AT 0x0000 000 8
BYTE C
BYTE D
BYTE E
BYTE F
WORD AT 0x0000 000 C
Figure 7-3. Data Organization in Memory
31
87
S
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S SSSS
31
0
BYTE
87
0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
31
BYTE
16 15
S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S
31
SIGNED BYTE
UNSIGNED BYTE
0
S
SIGNED
HALF-WORD
HALF-WORD
16 15
0
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
UNSIGNED
HALF-WORD
HALF-WORD
31
0
BYTE 0
BYTE 1
BYTE 2
BYTE 3
WORD
Figure 7-4. Data Organization in Registers
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
171
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
7.7 Operand Addressing Capabilities
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The M•CORE processor accesses all memory operands through load
and store instructions, transferring data between the general-purpose
registers and memory. Register-plus-four-bit scaled displacement
addressing mode is used for load and store instructions addressing byte,
half-word, and word data.
Load and store multiple instructions allow a subset of the 16
general-purpose registers to be transferred to or from a base address
pointed to by register R0 (the default stack pointer by convention).
Load and store register quadrant instructions use register indirect
addressing to transfer a register quadrant to or from memory.
7.8 Instruction Set Overview
The instruction set is tailored to support high-level languages and is
optimized for those instructions most commonly executed. A standard
set of arithmetic and logical instructions is provided, as well as
instruction support for bit operations, byte extraction, data movement,
control flow modification, and a small set of conditionally executed
instructions which can be useful in eliminating short conditional
branches.
Table 7-1 is an alphabetized listing of the M•CORE instruction set. Refer
to the M•CORE Reference Manual (Motorola document order number
MCORERM/AD) for more details on instruction operation.
Advance Information
172
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Instruction Set Overview
Table 7-1. M•CORE Instruction Set (Sheet 1 of 3)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Mnemonic
Description
Execution Time
(Cycles)
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
ABS
ADDC
ADDI
ADDU
AND
ANDI
ANDN
ASR
ASRC
Absolute Value
Add with C Bit
Add Immediate
Add Unsigned
Logical AND
Logical AND Immediate
AND NOT
Arithmetic Shift Right
Arithmetic Shift Right, Update C Bit
BCLRI
BF
BGENI
BGENR
BKPT
BMASKI
BR
BREV
BSETI
BSR
BT
BTSTI
Bit Clear Immediate
Branch on Condition False
Bit Generate Immediate
Bit Generate Register
Breakpoint
Bit Mask Immediate
Branch
Bit Reverse
Bit Set Immediate
Branch to Subroutine
Branch on Condition True
Bit Test Immediate
CLRF
CLRT
CMPHS
CMPLT
CMPLTI
CMPNE
CMPNEI
Clear Register on Condition False
Clear Register on Condition True
Compare Higher or Same
Compare Less Than
Compare Less Than Immediate
Compare Not Equal
Compare Not Equal Immediate
DECF
DECGT
DECLT
DECNE
DECT
DIVS
DIVU
DOZE
Decrement on Condition False
Decrement Register and Set Condition if Result Greater Than Zero
Decrement Register and Set Condition if Result Less Than Zero
Decrement Register and Set Condition if Result Not Equal to Zero
Decrement on Condition True
Divide Signed Integer
Divide Unsigned Integer
Doze
FF1
Find First One
1
INCF
INCT
IXH
IXW
Increment on Condition False
Increment on Condition True
Index Half-Word
Index Word
1
1
1
1
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
1
1/2(1)
1
1
Indet(2)
1/2(1)
1
1
1/2(1)
1/2(1)
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
3–37(3)
3–37(3)
Indet(2)
Advance Information
173
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Table 7-1. M•CORE Instruction Set (Sheet 2 of 3)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Mnemonic
Execution Time
(Cycles)
Description
JMP
JMPI
JSR
JSRI
Jump
Jump Indirect
Jump to Subroutine
Jump to Subroutine Indirect
LD.[BHW]
LDM
LDQ
LOOPT
LRW
LSL, LSR
LSLC, LSRC
LSLI, LSRI
Load
Load Multiple Registers
Load Register Quadrant
Decrement with C-Bit Update and Branch if Condition True
Load Relative Word
Logical Shift Left and Right
Logical Shift Left and Right, Update C Bit
Logical Shift Left and Right by Immediate
n+1(4)
5
1/2(1)
2
1
1
1
MFCR
MOV
MOVI
MOVF
MOVT
MTCR
MULT
MVC
MVCV
Move from Control Register
Move
Move Immediate
Move on Condition False
Move on Condition True
Move to Control Register
Multiply
Move C Bit to Register
Move Inverted C Bit to Register
2
1
1
1
1
2
3–18(3)
1
1
NOT
Logical Complement
1
OR
Logical Inclusive-OR
1
ROTLI
RSUB
RSUBI
RTE
RFI
Rotate Left by Immediate
Reverse Subtract
Reverse Subtract Immediate
Return from Exception
Return from Interrupt
1
1
1
3
3
SEXTB
SEXTH
ST.[BHW]
STM
STQ
STOP
SUBC
SUBU
SUBI
SYNC
Sign-Extend Byte
Sign-Extend Half-Word
Store
Store Multiple Registers
Store Register Quadrant
Stop
Subtract with C Bit
Subtract
Subtract Immediate
Synchronize
TRAP
TST
TSTNBZ
Trap
Test Operands
Test for No Byte Equal Zero
WAIT
Wait
Advance Information
174
2
3
2
3
2
1
1
2
n+1(4)
5
Indet(2)
1
1
1
1
5
1
1
Indet(2)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Instruction Set Overview
Table 7-1. M•CORE Instruction Set (Sheet 3 of 3)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Mnemonic
Description
Execution Time
(Cycles)
XOR
XSR
XTRB0
XTRB1
XTRB2
XTRB3
Exclusive OR
Extended Shift Right
Extract Byte 0
Extract Byte 1
Extract Byte 2
Extract Byte 3
1
1
1
1
1
1
ZEXTB
ZEXTH
Zero-Extend Byte
Zero-Extend Half-Word
1
1
1. 1 cycle if branch not taken, 2 cycles if branch taken
2. Execution time of BKPT, DOZE, WAIT, and STOP is 1 cycle but execution does not take place until allcurrent bus transactions have completed.
3. Cycle time is dependent upon magnitude of result.
4. Number of cycles is equal to number of registers loaded/stored plus 1.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
175
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Advance Information
176
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
M•CORE M210 Central Processor Unit (CPU)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 8. Interrupt Controller Module
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
8.1 Contents
8.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
8.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
8.4
Low-Power Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
8.5
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
8.6
External Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
8.7
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
8.7.1
Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
8.7.2
Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
8.7.2.1
Interrupt Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
8.7.2.2
Interrupt Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
8.7.2.3
Interrupt Force Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
8.7.2.4
Interrupt Pending Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .186
8.7.2.5
Normal Interrupt Enable Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
8.7.2.6
Normal Interrupt Pending Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
8.7.2.7
Fast Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 189
8.7.2.8
Fast Interrupt Pending Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
8.7.2.9
Priority Level Select Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
8.8
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
8.8.1
Interrupt Sources and Prioritization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
8.8.2
Fast and Normal Interrupt Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
8.8.3
Autovectored and Vectored Interrupt Requests . . . . . . . . .193
8.8.4
Interrupt Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
8.8.4.1
CPU Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
8.8.4.2
Interrupt Controller Configuration. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
8.8.4.3
Interrupt Source Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
8.8.5
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
177
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
8.2 Introduction
The interrupt controller collects requests from multiple interrupt sources
and provides an interface to the CPU interrupt logic.
8.3 Features
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Features of the interrupt controller module include:
•
Up to 40 interrupt sources
•
32 unique programmable priority levels for each interrupt source
•
Independent enable/disable of pending interrupts based on
priority level
•
Select normal or fast interrupt request for each priority level
•
Fast interrupt requests always have priority over normal interrupts
•
Ability to mask interrupts at and below a defined priority level
•
Ability to select between autovectored or vectored interrupt
requests
•
Vectored interrupts generated based on priority level
•
Ability to generate a separate vector number for normal and fast
interrupts
•
Ability for software to self-schedule interrupts
•
Software visibility of pending interrupts and interrupt signals to
core
•
Asynchronous operation to support wakeup from low-power
modes
8.4 Low-Power Mode Operation
The interrupt controller is not affected by any low-power modes. All logic
between the input sources and generating the raw interrupt to the CPU
is combinational. This allows the CPU to wake up during low-power stop
mode when all system clocks are stopped.
Advance Information
178
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Block Diagram
8.5 Block Diagram
F
I
E
R
I
F
R
F
I
P
R
M
32-to-5
U
PRIORITY
C 32 ENCODER
5
&
FVE
INTERRUPT
SOURCES
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
OR
40
&
32
40
PRIORITY
LEVEL
SELECT
I
P
R
FMASK
&
32 NMASK
&
OR
32
&
S
Y
N
C
32
N
I
E
R
MASK
ICR
N
I
P
R
5
NORMAL
AND FAST
INTERRUPTS
ISR
AE
32
DECODE
VECTOR
NUMBER
OR
32
40 x 5 BITS
PLSR
PLSR
PLSR
PLSR
S
Y
N
C
32
AUTOVECTOR
SELECT
NMASK
&
ME
32
MFI
&
FMASK
Figure 8-1. Interrupt Controller Block Diagram
8.6 External Signals
No interrupt controller signals connect off-chip.
8.7 Memory Map and Registers
This subsection describes the memory map (see Table 8-1) and
registers.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
179
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
8.7.1 Memory Map
Table 8-1. Interrupt Controller Module Memory Map
Address
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00c5_0000
Bits 31–24
Bits 23–16
Interrupt Control Register (ICR)
Bits 15–8
Bits 7–0
Interrupt Status Register (ISR)
Access(1)
S/U
0x00c5_0004
Interrupt Force Register High (IFRH)
S/U
0x00c5_0008
Interrupt Force Register Low (IFRL)
S/U
0x00c5_000c
Interrupt Pending Register (IPR)
S/U
0x00c5_0010
Normal Interrupt Enable Register (NIER)
S/U
0x00c5_0014
Normal Interrupt Pending Register (NIPR)
S/U
0x00c5_0018
Fast Interrupt Enable Register (FIER)
S/U
0x00c5_001c
Fast Interrupt Pending Register (FIPR)
S/U
0x00c5_0020
through
0x00c5_003c
Unimplemented(2)
—
Priority Level Select Registers (PLSR0–PLSR39)
0x00c5_0040
PLSR0
PLSR1
PLSR2
PLSR3
S
0x00c5_0044
PLSR4
PLSR5
PLSR6
PLSR7
S
0x00c5_0048
PLSR8
PLSR9
PLSR10
PLSR11
S
0x00c5_004c
PLSR12
PLSR13
PLSR14
PLSR15
S
0x00c5_0050
PLSR16
PLSR17
PLSR18
PLSR19
S
0x00c5_0054
PLSR20
PLSR21
PLSR22
PLSR23
S
0x00c5_0058
PLSR24
PLSR25
PLSR26
PLSR27
S
0x00c5_005c
PLSR28
PLSR29
PLSR30
PLSR31
S
0x00c5_0060
PLSR32
PLSR33
PLSR34
PLSR35
S
0x00c5_0064
PLSR36
PLSR37
PLSR38
PLSR39
S
0x00c5_0068
through
0x00c5_007c
Unimplemented(2)
—
1. S = CPU supervisor mode access only. S/U = CPU supervisor or user mode access. User mode accesses to supervisor
only addresses have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
2. Accesses to unimplemented address locations have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
Advance Information
180
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Memory Map and Registers
8.7.2 Registers
This subsection contains a description of the interrupt controller module
register set.
8.7.2.1 Interrupt Control Register
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The 16-bit Interrupt Control Register (ICR) selects whether interrupt
requests are autovectored or vectored, and if vectored, whether fast
interrupts generate a different vector number than normal interrupts.
This register also controls the masking functions.
Address: 0x00c5_0000 and 0x00c5_0001
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
AE
FVE
ME
MFI
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
MASK4
MASK3
MASK2
MASK1
MASK0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 8-2. Interrupt Control Register (ICR)
AE — Autovector Enable Bit
The read/write AE bit enables fast and normal autovectored interrupt
requests. Reset sets AE.
1 = Autovectored interrupt requests
0 = Vectored interrupt requests
FVE — Fast Vector Enable Bit
The read/write FVE bit enables fast vectored interrupt requests to
have vector numbers separate from normal vectored interrupt
requests. Reset clears FVE.
1 = Unique vector numbers for fast vectored interrupt requests
0 = Same vector number for fast and normal vectored interrupt
requests
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
181
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
ME — Mask Enable Bit
The read/write ME bit enables interrupt masking. Reset clears ME.
1 = Interrupt masking enabled
0 = Interrupt masking disabled
MFI — Mask Fast Interrupts Bit
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The read/write MFI bit enables masking of fast interrupt requests.
Reset clears MFI.
1 = Fast interrupt requests masked by MASK value. All normal
interrupt requests are masked.
0 = Fast interrupt requests are not masked regardless of the MASK
value. The MASK only applies to normal interrupts. Reset
clears MFI.
MASK[4:0] — Interrupt Mask Field
The read/write MASK[4:0] field determines which interrupt priority
levels are masked. When the ME bit is set, all pending interrupt
requests at priority levels at and below the current MASK value are
masked. To mask all normal interrupts without masking any fast
interrupts, set the MASK value to 31 with the MFI bit cleared. See
Table 8-2. Reset clears MASK[4:0].
Table 8-2. MASK Encoding
MASK[4:0]
Advance Information
182
Decimal
Binary
Masked Priority
Levels
0
00000
0
1
00001
1–0
2
00010
2–0
3
00011
3–0
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
31
11111
31–0
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Memory Map and Registers
8.7.2.2 Interrupt Status Register
The 16-bit, read-only Interrupt Status Register (ISR) reflects the state of
the interrupt controller outputs to the CPU. Writes to this register have
no effect and are terminated normally.
Address: 0x00c5_0002 and 0x00c5_0003
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
INT
FINT
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
VEC6
VEC5
VEC4
VEC3
VEC2
VEC1
VEC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 8-3. Interrupt Status Register (ISR)
INT — Normal Interrupt Request Flag
The read-only INT flag indicates whether the normal interrupt request
signal to the CPU is asserted or negated. Reset clears INT.
1 = Normal interrupt request asserted
0 = Normal interrupt request negated
FINT — Fast Interrupt Request Flag
The read-only FINT flag indicates whether the fast interrupt request
signal to the CPU is asserted or negated. Reset clears FINT.
1 = Fast interrupt request asserted
0 = Fast interrupt request negated
VEC[6:0] — Interrupt Vector Number Field
The read-only VEC[6:0] field contains the 7-bit interrupt vector
number (see Table 8-5). Reset clears VEC[6:0].
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
183
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
8.7.2.3 Interrupt Force Registers
The two 32-bit read/write Interrupt Force Registers (IFRH and IFRL)
individually force interrupt source requests.
Address: 0x00c5_0004 through 0x00c5_0007
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
IF39
IF38
IF37
IF36
IF35
IF34
IF33
IF32
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 8-4. Interrupt Force Register High (IFRH)
Advance Information
184
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Memory Map and Registers
Address: 0x00c5_0008 through 0x00c5_000b
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
IF31
IF30
IF29
IF28
IF27
IF26
IF25
IF24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
IF23
IF22
IF21
IF20
IF19
IF18
IF17
IF16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
IF15
IF14
IF13
IF12
IF11
IF10
IF9
IF8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
IF7
IF6
IF5
IF4
IF3
IF2
IF1
IF0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 8-5. Interrupt Force Register Low (IFRL)
IF[39:0] — Interrupt Force Field
This read/write field forces interrupt requests at the corresponding
source numbers. Reference Table 8-6 for interrupt source numbers
to determine which bit(s) to set in this register. IFRH and IFRL allow
software generation of interrupt requests for functional or debug
purposes. Writing 0 to an IF bit negates the interrupt request. Reset
clears the IF[39:0] field.
1 = Force interrupt request
0 = Interrupt source not forced
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
185
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
8.7.2.4 Interrupt Pending Register
The 32-bit, read-only Interrupt Pending Register (IPR) reflects any
currently pending interrupts which are assigned to each priority level.
Writes to this register have no effect and are terminated normally.
Address: 0x00c5_000c through 0x00c5_000f
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
IP31
IP30
IP29
IP28
IP27
IP26
IP25
IP24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
IP23
IP22
IP21
IP20
IP19
IP18
IP17
IP16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
IP15
IP14
IP13
IP12
IP11
IP10
IP9
IP8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
IP7
IP6
IP5
IP4
IP3
IP2
IP1
IP0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 8-6. Interrupt Pending Register (IPR)
IP[31:0] — Interrupt Pending Field
A read-only IPx bit is set when at least one interrupt request is
asserted at priority level x. Reset clears IP[31:0].
1 = At least one interrupt request asserted at priority level x
0 = All interrupt requests at level x negated
Advance Information
186
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Memory Map and Registers
8.7.2.5 Normal Interrupt Enable Register
The read/write, 32-bit Normal Interrupt Enable Register (NIER)
individually enables any current pending interrupts which are assigned
to each priority level as a normal interrupt source. Enabling an interrupt
source which has an asserted request causes that request to become
pending, and a request to the CPU is asserted if not already outstanding.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: 0x00c5_0010 through 0x00c5_0013
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
NIE31
NIE30
NIE29
NIE28
NIE27
NIE26
NIE25
NIE24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
NIE23
NIE22
NIE21
NIE20
NIE19
NIE18
NIE17
NIE16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
NIE15
NIE14
NIE13
NIE12
NIE11
NIE10
NIE9
NIE8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
NIE7
NIE6
NIE5
NIE4
NIE3
NIE2
NIE1
NIE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 8-7. Normal Interrupt Enable Register (NIER)
NIE[31:0] — Normal Interrupt Enable Field
The read/write NIE[31:0] field enables interrupt requests from sources
at the corresponding priority level as normal interrupt requests. Reset
clears NIE[31:0].
1 = Normal interrupt request enabled
0 = Normal interrupt request disabled
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
187
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
8.7.2.6 Normal Interrupt Pending Register
The read-only, 32-bit Normal Interrupt Pending Register (NIPR) reflects
any currently pending normal interrupts which are assigned to each
priority level. Writes to this register have no effect and are terminated
normally.
Address: 0x00c5_0014 through 0x00c5_0017
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
NIP31
NIP30
NIP29
NIP28
NIP27
NIP26
NIP25
NIP24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
NIP23
NIP22
NIP21
NIP20
NIP19
NIP18
NIP17
NIP16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
NIP15
NIP14
NIP13
NIP12
NIP11
NIP10
NIP9
NIP8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
NIP7
NIP6
NIP5
NIP4
NIP3
NIP2
NIP1
NIP0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 8-8. Normal Interrupt Pending Register (NIPR)
NIP[31:0] — Normal Interrupt Pending Field
A read-only NIPx bit is set when at least one normal interrupt request
is asserted at priority level x. Reset clears NIP[31:0].
1 = At least one normal interrupt request asserted at priority level x
0 = All normal interrupt requests at priority level x negated
Advance Information
188
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Memory Map and Registers
8.7.2.7 Fast Interrupt Enable Register
The read/write, 32-bit Fast Interrupt Enable Register (FIER) enables any
current pending interrupts which are assigned at each priority level as a
fast interrupt source. Enabling an interrupt source which has an asserted
request causes that interrupt to become pending, and a request to the
CPU is asserted if not already outstanding.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: 0x00c5_0018 through 0x00c5_001b
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
FIE31
FIE30
FIE29
FIE28
FIE27
FIE26
FIE25
FIE24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
FIE23
FIE22
FIE21
FIE20
FIE19
FIE18
FIE17
FIE16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
FIE15
FIE14
FIE13
FIE12
FIE11
FIE10
FIE9
FIE8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
FIE7
FIE6
FIE5
FIE4
FIE3
FIE2
FIE1
FIE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 8-9. Fast Interrupt Enable Register (FIER)
FIE[31:0] — Fast Interrupt Enable Field
The read/write FIE[31:0] field enables interrupt requests from sources
at the corresponding priority level as fast interrupts. Reset clears
FIE[31:0].
1 = Fast interrupt enabled
0 = Fast interrupt disabled
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
189
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
8.7.2.8 Fast Interrupt Pending Register
The read-only, 32-bit Fast Interrupt Pending Register (FIPR) reflects any
currently pending fast interrupts which are assigned to each priority
level. Writes to this register have no effect and are terminated normally.
Address: 0x00c5_001c through 0x00c5_001f
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
FIP31
FIP30
FIP29
FIP28
FIP27
FIP26
FIP25
FIP24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
FIP23
FIP22
FIP21
FIP20
FIP19
FIP18
FIP17
FIP16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
FIP15
FIP14
FIP13
FIP12
FIP11
FIP10
FIP9
FIP8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
FIP7
FIP6
FIP5
FIP4
FIP3
FIP2
FIP1
FIP0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 8-10. Fast Interrupt Pending Register (FIPR)
FIP[31:0] — Fast Interrupt Pending Field
A read-only FIP[x] bit is set when at least one interrupt request at
priority level x is pending and enabled as a fast interrupt. Reset clears
FIP[31:0].
1 = At least one fast interrupt request asserted at priority level x
0 = Any fast interrupt requests at priority level x negated
Advance Information
190
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Functional Description
8.7.2.9 Priority Level Select Registers
The read/write 8-bit Priority Level Select Registers (PLSRx) are 40
read/write, 8-bit priority level select registers PLSR0–PLSR39, one for
each of the interrupt source. The PLSRx register assigns a priority level
to interrupt source x.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: 0x00c5_0040 through 0x00c5_0067
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PLS4
PLS3
PLS2
PLS1
PLS0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 8-11. Priority Level Select Registers (PLSR0–PLSR39)
PLS[4:0] — Priority Level Select Field
The PLS[4:0] field assigns a priority level from 0 to 31 to the
corresponding interrupt source. Reset clears PLS[4:0].
Table 8-3. Priority Select Encoding
PLS[4:0]
Priority Level
Vector Number
00000
0 (lowest)
00000
00001–11110
1–30
00001–11110
11111
31 (highest)
11111
8.8 Functional Description
The interrupt controller collects interrupt requests from multiple interrupt
sources and provides an interface to the CPU interrupt logic. Interrupt
controller functions include:
•
Interrupt source prioritization
•
Fast and normal interrupt requests
•
Autovectored and vectored interrupt requests
•
Interrupt configuration
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
191
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
8.8.1 Interrupt Sources and Prioritization
Each interrupt source in the system sends a unique signal to the interrupt
controller. Up to 40 interrupt sources are supported. Each interrupt
source can be programmed to one of 32 priority levels by programing the
PLS bits of the PLSR in the interrupt controller. The highest priority level
is 31 and lowest priority level is 0. By default, each interrupt source is
assigned to the priority level 0. Each interrupt source is associated with
a 5-bit priority level select value that selects one of 32 priority levels. The
interrupt controller uses the priority levels as the basis for the generation
of all interrupt signals to the CPU.
Interrupt requests may be forced by software by writing to IFRH and
IFRL. Each bit of IFRH and IFRL is logically ORed with the
corresponding interrupt source signal before the priority level select
logic. To negate the forced interrupt request, the interrupt handler can
clear the appropriate IFR bit. IPR reflects the state of each priority level.
8.8.2 Fast and Normal Interrupt Requests
FIER allows individual enabling or masking of pending fast interrupt
requests. FIER is logically ANDed with IPR, and the result is stored in
FIPR. FIPR bits are bit-wise ORed together and inverted to form the fast
interrupt signal routed to the CPU (see Figure 8-1). The FIPR allows
software to quickly determine the highest priority pending fast interrupt.
The output of FIPR also feeds into a 32-to-5 priority encoder to generate
the vector number to present to the CPU if vectored interrupts are
required.
NIER allows individual enabling or masking of pending normal interrupt
requests. NIER is logically ANDed with IPR, and the result is stored in
NIPR. NIPR bits are bit-wise ORed together and inverted to form the
normal interrupt signal routed to the CPU. The normal interrupt signal is
only asserted if the fast interrupt signal is negated. The NIPR allows
software to quickly determine the highest priority pending normal
interrupt. The output of NIPR also feeds into a 32-to-5 priority encoder to
generate the vector number to present to the CPU if vectored interrupts
are required. If the fast interrupt signal is asserted, then the vector
number is determined by the highest priority fast interrupt.
Advance Information
192
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Functional Description
If an interrupt is pending at a given priority level and both the
corresponding FIER and NIER bits are set, then both the corresponding
FIPR and NIPR bits are set, assuming these bits are not masked.
Fast interrupt requests always have priority over normal interrupt
requests, even if the normal interrupt request is at a higher priority level
than the highest fast interrupt request.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
If the fast interrupt signal is asserted when the normal interrupt signal is
already asserted, then the normal interrupt signal is negated.
IPR, NIPR, and FIPR are read-only. To clear a pending interrupt, the
interrupt must be cleared at the source using a special clearing
sequence defined by each source. All interrupt sources to the interrupt
controller are to be held until recognized and cleared by the interrupt
service routine. The interrupt controller does not have any edge-detect
logic. Edge-triggered interrupt sources are handled at the source
module.
In ICR, the MASK[4:0] bits can mask interrupt sources at and below a
selected priority level. The MFI bit determines whether the mask applies
only to normal interrupts or to fast interrupts with all normal interrupts
being masked. The ME bit enables interrupt masking.
ISR reflects the current vector number and the states of the signals to
the CPU.
The vector number and fast/normal interrupt sources are synchronized
before being sent to the CPU. Thus, the interrupt controller adds one
clock of latency to the interrupt sequence. The fast and normal interrupt
raw sources are not synchronized and are used to wake up the CPU
during stop mode.
8.8.3 Autovectored and Vectored Interrupt Requests
The AE bit in ICR enables autovectored interrupt requests to the CPU.
AE is set by default, and all interrupt requests are autovectored. An
interrupt handler may read FIPR or NIPR to determine the priority of the
interrupt source. If multiple interrupt sources share the same priority
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
193
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
level, then it is up to the interrupt service routine to determine the correct
source of the interrupt.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
If the AE bit is 0, then each interrupt request is presented with a vector
number. The low five bits of the vector number (4–0) are determined
based on the highest pending priority, with active fast interrupts having
priority over active normal interrupts. The remaining two bits (vector bits
5 and 6) are determined based on whether the interrupt request is a fast
interrupt and the setting of the FVE bit. If FVE is set, then a fast interrupt
request has a vector number different from that of a normal interrupt
request as shown in Table 8-4.
Table 8-4. Fast Interrupt Vector Number
Fast Interrupt
FVE
Interrupt Vector
Bits 6:5
No
X
01
X
0
01
Yes
1
10
If FVE is 0, both normal and fast interrupts have the same vector and
requests assigned to priority levels 0–31 are mapped to vector numbers
32–63 in the vector table.
If FVE is 1, normal interrupt requests assigned to priority levels 0–31 are
mapped to vector numbers 32–63 and fast interrupt requests assigned
to priority levels 0–31 are mapped to vector numbers 64–95 in the vector
table. See Table 8-5.
Table 8-5. Vector Table Mapping
Vector
Number
Usage
0–31
Fixed exceptions (including autovectors)
00
32–63
Normal only (FVE = 1) or normal/fast (FVE = 0)
vectored interrupts
32 = lowest priority
63 = highest priority
01
64–95
Fast vectored interrupts (FVE = 1)
64 = lowest priority
95 = highest priority
10
96–127 Vectored interrupts (not used)
Advance Information
194
Interrupt Vector
Bits 6:5
11
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Functional Description
8.8.4 Interrupt Configuration
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
After reset, all interrupts are disabled by default. To properly configure
the system to handle interrupt requests, configuration must be
performed at three levels:
•
CPU
•
Interrupt controller
•
Local interrupt sources
Configure the CPU first, the interrupt controller second, and the local
interrupt sources last.
8.8.4.1 CPU Configuration
For fast interrupts, set the FIE[x] bit in FIER in the CPU. For normal
interrupts, set the NIE[x] bit. Both FIE and NIE are cleared at reset.
NOTE:
To allow long latency, multicycle instructions to be interrupted before
completion, set the IC bit in the PSR.
VBR in the CPU defines the base address of the exception vector table.
If autovectors are to be used, then initialize the INT and FINT
autovectors (vector numbers 10 and 11, respectively). If vectored
interrupts are to be used, then initialize the vectored interrupts (vector
numbers 32–63 and/or 64–95). Whether 32 or 64 vectors are required
depends on whether the fast interrupts share vectors with the normal
interrupt sources based on the FVE bit in the interrupt controller ICR.
For each vector number, create an interrupt service routine to service
the interrupt, clear the local interrupt flag, and return from the interrupt
routine.
8.8.4.2 Interrupt Controller Configuration
By default, each interrupt source to the interrupt controller is assigned a
priority level of 0 and disabled. Each interrupt source can be
programmed to one of 32 priority levels and enabled as either a fast or
normal interrupt source. Also, the FVE and AE bits in ICR can be
programmed to select autovectored/vectored interrupts and also
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
195
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
determine if the fast interrupt vector number is to be separate from the
normal interrupt vector.
8.8.4.3 Interrupt Source Configuration
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Each module that is capable of generating an interrupt request has an
interrupt request enable/disable bit. To allow the interrupt source to be
asserted, set the local interrupt enable bit.
Once an interrupt request is asserted, the module keeps the source
asserted until the interrupt service routine performs a special sequence
to clear the interrupt flag. Clearing the flag negates the interrupt request.
8.8.5 Interrupts
The interrupt controller assigns a number to each interrupt source, as
Table 8-6 shows.
Advance Information
196
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Functional Description
Table 8-6. Interrupt Source Assignment
Source
Module
0
Flag
Source Description
Flag Clearing Mechanism
PF1
Queue 1 conversion pause
CF1
Queue 1 conversion complete Write CF1 = 0 after reading CF1 = 1
2
PF2
Queue 2 conversion pause
3
CF2
Queue 2 conversion complete Write CF2 = 0 after reading CF2 = 1
1
Write PF1 = 0 after reading PF1 = 1
ADC
4
MODF Mode fault
Write PF2 = 0 after reading PF2 = 1
Write to SPICR1 after reading MODF = 1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SPI
5
SPIF
Transfer complete
6
TDRE
Transmit Data Register empty Write SCIDRL after reading TDRE = 1
7
TC
8
SCI1
Transmit complete
RDRF Receive Data Register full
Access SPIDR after reading SPIF = 1
Write SCIDRL after reading TC = 1
Read SCIDRL after reading RDRF = 1
9
OR
Receiver overrun
Read SCIDRL after reading OR = 1
10
IDLE
Receiver line idle
Read SCIDRL after reading IDLE = 1
11
TDRE
Transmit Data Register empty Write SCIDRL after reading TDRE = 1
12
TC
13
SCI2
Transmit complete
RDRF Receive Data Register full
Write SCIDRL after reading TC = 1
Read SCIDRL after reading RDRF = 1
14
OR
Receiver overrun
Read SCIDRL after reading OR = 1
15
IDLE
Receiver line idle
Read SCIDRL after reading IDLE = 1
16
C0F
Timer channel 0
Write C0F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
17
C1F
Timer channel 1
Write 1 to C1F or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
18
C2F
Timer channel 2
Write 1 to C2F or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
C3F
Timer channel 3
Write 1 to C3F or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
20
TOF
Timer overflow
Write TOF = 1 or access TIMCNTH/L if TFFCA = 1
21
PAIF
Pulse accumulator input
Write PAIF = 1 or access PAC if TFFCA = 1
19
TIM1
22
PAOVF Pulse accumulator overflow
Write PAOVF = 1 or access PAC if TFFCA = 1
Continued on next page
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
197
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Interrupt Controller Module
Table 8-6. Interrupt Source Assignment (Continued)
Source
Flag
Source Description
Flag Clearing Mechanism
23
C0F
Timer channel 0
Write C0F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
24
C1F
Timer channel 1
Write C1F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
25
C2F
Timer channel 2
Write C2F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
C3F
Timer channel 3
Write C3F = 1 or access IC/OC if TFFCA = 1
27
TOF
Timer overflow
Write TOF = 1 or access TIMCNTH/L if TFFCA = 1
28
PAIF
Pulse accumulator input
Write PAIF = 1 or access PAC if TFFCA = 1
26
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Module
TIM2
29
PAOVF Pulse accumulator overflow
Write PAOVF = 1 or access PAC if TFFCA = 1
30
PIT1
PIF
PIT interrupt flag
Write PIF = 1 or write PMR
31
PIT2
PIF
PIT interrupt flag
Write PIF = 1 or write PMR
32
EPORT/
PMM(1)
EPF0/
LVDF
Edge port flag 0/LVD
Write EPF0 = 1/write LVDF = 1
33
EPORT/ EPF1 Edge port flag 1/SGFM buffer
CBEIF/
empty/SGFM command
SGFM(2) CCIF
complete
Write EPF1 = 1/write CBEIF = 1; CCIF cleared
automatically
34
EPF2
Edge port flag 2
Write EPF2 = 1
35
EPF3
Edge port flag 3
Write EPF3 = 1
EPF4
Edge port flag 4
Write EPF4 = 1
37
EPF5
Edge port flag 5
Write EPF5 = 1
38
EPF6
Edge port flag 6
Write EPF6 = 1
39
EPF7
Edge port flag 7
Write EPF7 = 1
36
EPORT
1. Interrupt source 32 is shared by INT0 of the EPORT and low voltage detect (LVD) of the power management module (PMM),
a sub-module of the reset mode (see Section 5. Reset Controller Module).
2. Interrupt source 33 is shared by INT1 of the EPORT and two interrupts from the second generation FLASH for M•CORE
(SGFM) module. See 10.7.2.5 SGFM User Status Register for a description of the flags set when these two interrupts
occur.
Advance Information
198
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Interrupt Controller Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 9. Static Random Access Memory (SRAM)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
9.1 Contents
9.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
9.3
Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
9.4
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
9.5
Standby Power Supply Pin (VSTBY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
9.6
Standby Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
9.7
Reset Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
9.8
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
9.2 Introduction
Features of the static random access memory (SRAM) include:
•
On-chip 8-Kbyte SRAM (MMC2113) or on-chip 32-Kbyte SRAM
(MC2112 and MMC2114)
•
Fixed address space
•
Byte, half-word (16-bit), or word (32-bit) read/write accesses
•
One clock per access (including bytes, half-words, and words)
•
Supervisor or user mode access
•
Standby power supply switch to support an external power supply
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Static Random Access Memory (SRAM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
199
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Static Random Access Memory (SRAM)
9.3 Modes of Operation
Access to the SRAM is not restricted in any way. The array can be
accessed in supervisor and user modes.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
NOTE:
The MMC2113 may contain more than 8K of internal SRAM, but only the
8K range from 0x0080_0000 to 0x0080_1fff is tested and guaranteed to
be operational. It is recommended that internal SRAM outside this range
not be used. Accesses to SRAM outside this range terminate without a
transfer error exception.
9.4 Low-Power Modes
In wait, doze, and stop modes, clocks to the SRAM are disabled. No
recovery time is required when exiting these modes.
9.5 Standby Power Supply Pin (VSTBY)
The standby power supply pin (VSTBY) provides standby voltage to the
SRAM array if VDD is lost. VSTBY is isolated from all other VDD nodes.
9.6 Standby Operation
When the chip is powered down, the contents of the SRAM array are
maintained by the standby power supply, VSTBY. If the standby voltage
falls below the minimum required voltage, the SRAM contents may be
corrupted. The SRAM automatically switches to standby operation with
no loss of data when the voltage on VDD is below the voltage on VSTBY.
In standby mode, the SRAM does not respond to any bus cycles.
Unexpected operation may occur if the central processor unit (CPU)
requests data from the SRAM in standby mode. If standby operation is
not needed, then the VSTBY pin should be connected to VDD.
The current on VSTBY may exceed its specified maximum value at some
time during the transition time during which VDD is at or below the
voltage switch threshold to a threshold above VSS. If the standby power
supply cannot provide enough current to maintain VSTBY above the
Advance Information
200
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Static Random Access Memory (SRAM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Static Random Access Memory (SRAM)
Reset Operation
required minimum value, then a capacitor must be provided from VSTBY
to VSS. The value of the capacitor, C, can be calculated as:
t
C = I × ---V
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
where:
I is the difference between the transition current requirement and the
maximum power supply current,
t is the duration of the VDD transition near the voltage switch
threshold, and
V is the difference between the minimum available supply voltage and
the required minimum VSTBY voltage.
9.7 Reset Operation
The SRAM contents are undefined immediately following a power-on
reset. SRAM contents are unaffected by system reset.
If a synchronous reset occurs during a read or write access, then the
access completes normally and any pipelined access in progress is
stopped without corruption of the SRAM contents.
9.8 Interrupts
The SRAM module does not generate interrupt requests.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Static Random Access Memory (SRAM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
201
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Static Random Access Memory (SRAM)
Advance Information
202
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Static Random Access Memory (SRAM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 10. Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE
(SGFM)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
10.1 Contents
10.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
10.3
Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
10.4
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
10.5
Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
10.6
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
10.7 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
10.7.1 Unbanked Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
10.7.1.1
SGFM Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
10.7.1.2
SGFM Clock Divider Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
10.7.1.3
SGFM Test Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
10.7.1.4
SGFM Security Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
10.7.1.5
SGFM Monitor Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
10.7.2 Banked Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
10.7.2.1
SGFM Protection Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .220
10.7.2.2
SGFM Supervisor Access Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
10.7.2.3
SGFM Data Access Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
10.7.2.4
SGFM Test Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
10.7.2.5
SGFM User Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
10.7.2.6
SGFM Command Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226
10.7.2.7
SGFM Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
10.7.2.8
SGFM Address Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
10.7.2.9
SGFM Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
10.8 SGFM User Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
10.8.1 Read Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
10.8.2 Write Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
203
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
10.8.3
10.8.3.1
10.8.3.2
10.8.3.3
10.8.3.4
10.8.4
10.8.5
10.8.6
10.8.7
Program and Erase Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Setting the SGFMCLKD Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Program, Erase, and Verify Sequences. . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
FLASH User Mode Valid Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
FLASH User Mode Illegal Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .237
Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Emulation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
Debug Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
10.9 FLASH Security Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
10.9.1 Back Door Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
10.9.2 Erase Verify Check. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
10.10 Resets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
10.11 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
10.2 Introduction
The second generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM) is constructed with
building blocks of 32,768 by 16 bits that can be used to generate 128-,
256-, 384- and 512-Kbyte electrically erasable and programmable
read-only memory arrays using two, four, six, and eight blocks
respectively. The SGFM is ideal for program and data storage for
single-chip applications and allows for field reprogramming without
external high-voltage sources.
The voltages required to program and erase the FLASH is generated
internally by on-chip charge pumps. Program and erase operations are
performed under CPU control through a command driven interface to an
internal state machine. All FLASH physical blocks can be programmed
or erased at the same time; however, it is not possible to read from a
FLASH physical block while the same block is being programmed or
erased. For 256-Kbyte and larger arrays, it is possible to program or
erase one pair of FLASH physical blocks under the control of software
routines executing out of another pair.
Advance Information
204
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Glossary
10.3 Glossary
SGFM — Second generation FLASH for M•CORE. Acronym used
throughout this document to reference this module.
SGFM Module — Includes the bus interface, command controller,
built-in self test (BIST) controller, and the FLASH physical blocks.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
FLASH Physical Block — A 64-Kbyte FLASH hard block organized as
32,768 halfwords (32K x 16 bits) that includes high voltage generation
and parametric test features.
FLASH Logical Sector — An 8-Kbyte sector of contiguous FLASH
memory that can be protected from program and erase operations. A
logical sector can have supervisor/user and program/data space access
restrictions.
FLASH Erase Page — Eight rows of 64 bytes (512 bytes) in one FLASH
physical block. Two pages, one from each interleaving physical block,
are erased at one time.
Banked Register — A register that operates on two interleaved FLASH
physical blocks. Banked registers share the same control register
addresses as the equivalent registers for the other FLASH physical
blocks. The active register bank is selected by a bank select field in the
unbanked register space. The SGFM module contains one to four sets
of banked registers depending on the size of the array.
Unbanked Register — A register which operates upon all FLASH
physical blocks.
Command Sequence — A three step sequence to program, erase, or
verify the FLASH.
FLASH User Mode — The mode in which the FLASH module operates
when executing user code and software controlled program and erase
operations.
SATO — Acronym used for sense amplifier timeout analog hard-macro
block. The SATO saves power at low system clock frequencies by
limiting the time during which sense amps are enabled.
Erased State — Bit state that reads as a 1.
Programmed State — Bit state that reads as a 0.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
205
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
10.4 Features
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Features of the SGFM include:
•
128- (MMC2113), 256- (MMC2114), 384-, or 512-Kbytes of
FLASH memory
•
33 MHz single cycle reads of bytes, aligned halfwords (16 bits),
and aligned words (32 bits)
•
Automated program and erase operation
•
Concurrent verify, program, and erase of all array blocks
•
Read-while-write capability for 256-Kbyte and larger arrays
•
Optional interrupt on command completion
•
Flexible scheme for protection against accidental program or
erase operations
•
Access restriction controls for both supervisor/user and
data/program space operations
•
Security for single-chip applications
•
Single power supply (system VDD) used for all module operations
•
Auto sense amplifier timeout for low-power, low-frequency read
operations
10.5 Modes of Operation
The SGFM has two operating modes:
1. FLASH User Mode — In this mode, the SGFM is used for
non-volatile program and data storage. FLASH program and
erase operations are controlled by user software.
2. FLASH Test Mode — This is used at the factory only to test the
SGFM.
Refer to 10.8 SGFM User Mode for a description of FLASH user mode
operations.
Advance Information
206
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Block Diagram
10.6 Block Diagram
The SGFM module shown in Figure 10-1 contains the FLASH physical
blocks, the M•CORE local bus (MLB) and IP bus interfaces, FLASH
interface, register blocks, and the BIST engine.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Each 64-Kbyte FLASH physical block is arranged as 32,768 halfwords
(16 bits) and may be read as either bytes or aligned halfwords. Aligned
word access is provided by concatenating the outputs of two FLASH
physical blocks. Reads of bytes, aligned halfwords, and aligned words
require one clock cycle. Misaligned read accesses are not supported
and will result in a cycle termination transfer error.
All FLASH program, erase, and verify commands operate on adjacent
FLASH physical blocks and are initiated with a single aligned 32-bit write
to the appropriate array location. Any other write operation will cause a
cycle termination transfer error. For erase purposes, a FLASH physical
block is organized as 1024 rows of 64 bytes with a single erase page
consisting of 8 rows (512 bytes). Page erase operates simultaneously on
two interleaving erase pages in adjacent FLASH physical blocks, making
the minimum effective erase size 1 Kbyte. Mass erase operates
simultaneously on two adjacent FLASH physical blocks in their entirety
and erases a total of 128 Kbytes of array space.
Each pair of FLASH physical blocks requires a banked set of registers to
control program and erase operations. Figure 10-1 shows a 512-Kbyte
module configured with four sets of banked registers. A 128 K-byte
module would only require one set, a 256-Kbyte module would require
two sets and a 384-Kbyte module would require three sets of banked
registers.
An erased FLASH bit reads 1 and a programmed FLASH bit reads 0.
The SGFM features a sense amplifier timeout block that automatically
reduces current consumption during reads at low clock frequencies.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
207
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
M•CORE LOCAL BUS (MLB)
D[31:16]
D[15:0]
D[31:16]
BLOCK 0H
32 K x 16
BLOCK 0L
32 K x 16
BLOCK 3H
32 K x 16
SATO
•
•
•
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
MLB INTERFACE
SATO
D[15:0]
SATO
BLOCK 3L
32 K x 16
SATO
FLASH INTERFACE
CONTROL
REGISTER
BANK 3
•
•
CONTROL
REGISTER
BANK 0
•
BIST
ENGINE
COMMON
REGISTERS
VDDF
VSSF
IP BUS INTERFACE
IP BUS
Figure 10-1. SGFM Module Block Diagram
Advance Information
208
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Module Memory Map
10.7 Module Memory Map
The SGFM memory array is mapped starting at address 0x0000_0000.
Figure 10-2 shows how multiple 32,768 by 16-bit FLASH physical
blocks interleave to form a contiguous non-volatile memory space. Each
pair of blocks (upper and lower) interleave every 2 bytes to form
128 Kbytes of memory.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x0007_ffff
•
•
•
BLOCK 3L (2BYTES)
BLOCK 3H (2BYTES)
BLOCK 3L (2BYTES)
BLOCK 3H (2BYTES)
0x0006_0000
•
•
•
BLOCK 2L (2BYTES)
BLOCK 2H (2BYTES)
BLOCK 2L (2BYTES)
BLOCK 2H (2BYTES)
0x0004_0000
•
•
•
BLOCK 1L (2BYTES)
BLOCK 1H (2BYTES)
BLOCK 1L (2BYTES)
BLOCK 1H (2BYTES)
0x0002_0000
•
•
CONFIGURATION FIELD (0x0000_0200–0x0000_022B)
•
128 KBYTES
0x0000_0000
BLOCK 0L (2BYTES)
BLOCK 0H (2BYTES)
BLOCK 0L (2BYTES)
BLOCK 0H (2BYTES)
Figure 10-2. SGFM Array Memory Map
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
209
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
The SGFM module has hardware interlocks to protect data from
accidental corruption. The SGFM memory array is logically divided into
8-Kbyte sectors for the purpose of data protection and access control. A
flexible scheme allows the protection of any combination of logical
sectors (see 10.7.2.1 SGFM Protection Register). A similar
mechanism is available to control supervisor/user and program/data
space access to these sectors.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The SGFM configuration field comprises 44 bytes of reserved array
memory space that determines the module protection and access
restrictions out of reset. Data to secure the FLASH from unauthorized
access is also stored in the SGFM configuration field. Table 10-1
describes each byte used in this field.
The SGFM module also contains a set of control and status registers.
The memory map for these registers and their accessibility in supervisor
and user modes is shown in Table 10-2.
The SGFM module contains one to four sets of banked registers
depending on the size of the array. The active register bank is selected
via the BKSEL field in the unbanked Module Configuration Register
(SGFMCR). Each set of banked registers controls the operation of two
interleaving FLASH physical blocks such that Block 0L and Block 0H are
controlled with one register bank. Other blocks are controlled in a similar
fashion as shown in Figure 10-2.
Advance Information
210
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Module Memory Map
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 10-1. SGFM Configuration Field
Address
Size
in Bytes
0x0000_0200–0x0000_0207
8
Back door comparison key
0x0000_0208–0x0000_0209
2
FLASH program/erase sector protection
Blocks 0H/0L (see 10.7.2.1 SGFM Protection Register)
0x0000_020a–0x0000_020b
2
Reserved
0x0000_020c–0x0000_020d
2
FLASH supervisor/user space restrictions
Blocks 0H/0L (see 10.7.2.2 SGFM Supervisor Access Register)
0x0000_020e–0x0000_020f
2
FLASH program/data space restrictions
Blocks 0H/0L (see 10.7.2.3 SGFM Data Access Register)
0x0000_0210–0x0000_0211
2
FLASH program/erase sector protection(1)
Blocks 1H/1L (see 10.7.2.1 SGFM Protection Register)
0x0000_0212–0x0000_0213
2
Reserved
0x0000_0214–0x0000_0215
2
FLASH supervisor/user space restrictions(1)
Blocks 1H/1L (see 10.7.2.2 SGFM Supervisor Access Register)
0x0000_0216–0x0000_0217
2
FLASH program/data space restrictions(1)
Blocks 1H/1L (see 10.7.2.3 SGFM Data Access Register)
0x0000_0218–0x0000_0219
2
FLASH program/erase sector protection(2)
Blocks 2H/2L (see 10.7.2.1 SGFM Protection Register)
0x0000_021a–0x0000_021b
2
Reserved
0x0000_021c–0x0000_021d
2
FLASH supervisor/user space restrictions(2)
Blocks 2H/2L (see 10.7.2.2 SGFM Supervisor Access Register)
0x0000_021e–0x0000_021f
2
FLASH program/data space restrictions(2)
Blocks 2H/2L (see 10.7.2.3 SGFM Data Access Register)
0x0000_021e–0x0000_0221
2
FLASH program/erase sector protection(3)
Blocks 3H/3L (see 10.7.2.1 SGFM Protection Register)
0x0000_0222–0x0000_0223
2
Reserved
0x0000_0224–0x0000_0225
2
FLASH supervisor/user space restrictions(3)
Blocks 3H/3L (see 10.7.2.2 SGFM Supervisor Access Register)
0x0000_0226–0x0000_0227
2
FLASH program/data space restrictions(3)
Blocks 3H/3L (see 10.7.2.3 SGFM Data Access Register)
0x0000_0228–0x0000_022b
4
FLASH security word (see 10.7.1.4 SGFM Security Register)
Description
1. These configuration bytes are only required for 256-Kbyte arrays and larger.
2. These configuration bytes are only required for 384-Kbyte arrays and larger.
3. These configuration bytes are only required for 512-Kbyte arrays.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
211
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Table 10-2. SGFM Register Address Map
Address
0x00d0_0000
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0x00d0_0004
Bits 31–24
Bits 23–16
SGFMCR
SGFMTST
Bits 15–8
Bits 7–0
Access(1)
Banked
Register
SGFMCLKD
Reserved (2)
S
No
S
No
Reserved(2)
0x00d0_0008
SGFMSEC
S
No
0x00d0_000c
SGFMMNTR
S
No
0x00d0_0010
SGFMPROT
Reserved (2)
S
Yes
0x00d0_0014
SGFMSACC
SGFMDACC
S
Yes
0x00d0_0018
SGFMTSTAT
Reserved(2)
S
Yes
0x00d0_001c
SGFMUSTAT
Reserved(2)
S
Yes
0x00d0_0020
SGFMCMD
Reserved(2)
S
Yes
S
Yes
0x00d0_0024
SGFMCTL
SGFMADR
0x00d0_0028
SGFMDATA
S
Yes
0x00d0_002c–
0x00d0_003c
Unimplemented(3)
—
Yes
1. S = Supervisor access only. User mode accesses to supervisor only addresses have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
2. Writes to reserved address locations have no effect and reads return 0s.
3. Accesses to unimplemented addresses have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
Advance Information
212
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Module Memory Map
10.7.1 Unbanked Register Descriptions
The unbanked registers are described in this subsection.
10.7.1.1 SGFM Configuration Register
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The SGFM Configuration Register (SGFMCR) is unbanked and is used
to configure and control the operation of the SGFM array and bus
interface unit (BIU).
Address: 0x00d0_0000 and 0x00d0_0001
Bit 15
Read:
14
13
0
12
0
FRZ
11
10
0
EME
9
Bit 8
0
0
LOCK
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
Note 1
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
CBEIE
CCIE
KEYACC
BKSEL1
BKSEL0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
= Reserved
Note 1. Reset state determined by chip reset configuration.
Figure 10-3. SGFM Module Configuration Register (SGFMCR)
FRZ — Freeze Enable Bit
The FRZ bit is readable and writable in all modes. In debug mode the
SGFM behaves exactly as it does in user mode except that the LOCK
bit in SGFMCR and SGFMCLKD[6:0] bits are writable.
1 = Enter debug mode if debug signal on MLB is asserted
0 = Ignore debug mode if debug signal on MLB is asserted
EME — Emulation Enable Bit
The EME bit is always readable and only writable when LOCK = 0.
EME places the SGFM in emulation mode, during which the SGFM
BIU will not assert TA or TEA to terminate read bus cycles of the
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
213
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
SGFM array. Instead, external memory that emulates the FLASH
must drive the data bus, and the EBI emulation chip select
mechanism terminates the bus cycle instead of the SGFM.
NOTE:
In emulation mode, writes to the SGFM array will generate an SGFM
access error and set the ACCERR bit (see 10.8.3.4 FLASH User Mode
Illegal Operations).
1 = Emulation mode
0 = User mode
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
LOCK — Write Lock Control Bit
The LOCK bit is always readable but can only be set once in user
mode. In debug or test mode, the LOCK bit is always writable.
1 = The EME bit, SGFMPROT, SGFMSACC, and SGFMDACC
registers are write-locked
0 = The EME bit, SGFMPROT, SGFMSACC, and SGFMDACC
registers are writable
CBEIE — Command Buffer Empty Interrupt Enable Bit
The CBEIE bit is readable and writable in all modes. CBEIE enables
an interrupt request when the command buffer for the FLASH
physical blocks selected by BKSEL[1:0] is empty.
1 = Request an interrupt whenever the CBEIF flag is set.
0 = Command buffer empty interrupts disabled
CCIE — Command Complete Interrupt Enable Bit
The CCIE bit is readable and writable in all modes. CCIE enables an
interrupt when the command executing for the FLASH physical blocks
selected by BKSEL[1:0] is complete.
1 = Request an interrupt whenever the CCIF flag is set.
0 = Command complete interrupts disabled
KEYACC — Enable Security Key Writing Bit
The KEYACC bit is readable in all modes and only writable if the
KEYEN bit in the SGFMSEC register is set.
1 = Writes to the FLASH array are interpreted as keys to open the
back door.
0 = Writes to the FLASH array are interpreted as the start of a
program, erase, or verify sequence.
Advance Information
214
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Module Memory Map
BKSEL[1:0] — Register Bank Select Field
The BKSEL bits are readable and writable in all modes and select
which set of bank registers is accessible.
Table 10-3 shows which set of banked registers is selected by the
BKSEL field depending on the size of the FLASH memory array.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 10-3. Register Bank Select Decoding
BKSEL[1:0]
128 Kbytes
256 Kbytes
384 Kbytes
512 Kbytes
00
Bank 0
Bank 0
Bank 0
Bank 0
01
Bank 0
Bank 1
Bank 1
Bank 1
10
Bank 0
Bank 0
Bank 2
Bank 2
11
Bank 0
Bank 1
Bank 2
Bank 3
10.7.1.2 SGFM Clock Divider Register
The SGFM Clock Divider Register (SGFMCLKD) is unbanked and is
used to set the frequency of the clock used for timed events in program
and erase algorithms.
Address: 0x00d0_0002
Bit 7
Read:
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PRDIV
DIV5
DIV4
DIV3
DIV2
DIV1
DIV0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DIVLD
Write:
Reset:
0
= Reserved
Figure 10-4. SGFM Clock Divider Register (SGFMCLKD)
In user mode, all bits in SGFMCLKD are readable while bits 6–0 can only
be written once. In test and debug modes, all bits in SGFMCLKD are
readable and writable at anytime, except bit 7 which is a status-only bit
and is not writable in any mode.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
215
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
DIVLD — Clock Divider Loaded Bit
1 = SGFMCLKD has been written since the last reset.
0 = SGFMCLKD has not been written.
PRDIV8 — Enable Prescaler Divide by 8 Bit
1 = Enables a prescaler that divides the SGFM clock by 8 before it
enters the SGFMCLKD divider.
0 = The SGFM clock is fed directly into the SGFMCLKD divider.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
DIV[5:0] — Clock Divider Field
The combination of PRDIV8 and DIV[5:0] effectively divides the
SGFM input clock down to a frequency between 150 kHz and
200 kHz. The frequency range of the SGFM clock is 150 kHz to
102.4 MHz.
NOTE:
SGFMCLKD must be written with an appropriate value before
programming or erasing the FLASH array. Refer to 10.8.3.1 Setting the
SGFMCLKD Register.
10.7.1.3 SGFM Test Register
The SGFM Test Register (SGFMTST) is unbanked and is used only for
factory testing.
Address: 0x00d0_0004
Bit 7
6
5
4
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
0
0
0
0
Read:
3
2
0
0
1
Bit 0
RSVD1
RSVD0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 10-5. SGFM Test Register (SGFMTST)
Accesses to SGFMTST when not in test mode will result in a cycle
termination transfer error.
Advance Information
216
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Module Memory Map
10.7.1.4 SGFM Security Register
The SGFM Security Register (SGFMSEC) is unbanked and controls the
FLASH security features.
Address: 0x00d0_0008 through 0x00d0_000b
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
KEYEN
SECSTAT
0
0
0
0
0
0
F(1)
Note 2
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SEC15
SEC14
SEC13
SEC12
SEC11
SEC10
SEC9
SEC8
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SEC7
SEC6
SEC5
SEC4
SEC3
SEC2
SEC1
SEC0
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Reserved
Notes:
1. Reset state loaded from FLASH configuration field during reset.
2. Reset state determined by security state of module.
Figure 10-6. SGFM Security Register (SGFMSEC)
SGFMSEC is readable in all modes but is not writable in any mode.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
217
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
SGFMSEC register bits with a reset state denoted by F in Figure 10-6
are loaded from the FLASH configuration at address 0x0000_0228
during the reset sequence.
KEYEN — Enable Back Door Key to Security Bit
1 = Back door to FLASH is enabled.
0 = Back door to FLASH is disabled.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SECSTAT — FLASH Security Status Bit
1 = FLASH security is enabled
0 = FLASH security is disabled
SEC[15:0] — Security Field
The SEC bits define the security state of the device. Table 10-4 lists
the single code that enables security.
Table 10-4. Security States
SEC[15:0]
Description
$000B
FLASH secured(1)
All other combinations
FLASH unsecured
1. The $000B value was chosen because it represents the M•CORE TRAP #3 opcode,
making it unlikely that compiled code accidentally programmed at the security word
in the FLASH configuration field location would unintentionally secure the device.
The security features of the SGFM are described in 10.9 FLASH
Security Operation.
Advance Information
218
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Module Memory Map
10.7.1.5 SGFM Monitor Data Register
The SGFM Monitor Data Register (SGFMMNTR) is unbanked and is
used only for factory testing.
Address: 0x00d0_000c through 0x00d0_000f
Bit 31
Read: RSVD31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
RSVD30
RSVD29
RSVD28
RSVD27
RSVD26
RSVD25
RSVD24
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Note 1
Bit 23
Read: RSVD23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
RSVD22
RSVD21
RSVD20
RSVD19
RSVD18
RSVD17
RSVD16
Write:
Reset:
Note 1
Bit 15
Read: RSVD15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
RSVD14
RSVD13
RSVD12
RSVD11
RSVD10
RSVD9
RSVD8
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Note 1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
RSVD1
RSVD0
Write:
Reset:
Note 1
= Reserved
Note 1. SGFMMNTR does not have a default reset state.
Figure 10-7. SGFM Monitor Data Register (SGFMMNTR)
Accesses to SGFMMNTR when not in test mode will result in a cycle
termination transfer error.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
219
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
10.7.2 Banked Register Descriptions
The banked registers are described in this subsection.
10.7.2.1 SGFM Protection Register
The SGFM Protection Register (SGFMPROT) is banked and specifies
which FLASH logical sectors are protected from program and erase
operations.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: 0x00d0_0010 and 0x00d0_0011
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
PROT15
PROT14
PROT13
PROT12
PROT11
PROT10
PROT9
PROT8
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PROT7
PROT6
PROT5
PROT4
PROT3
PROT2
PROT1
PROT0
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Note 1. Reset state loaded from FLASH configuration field during reset.
Figure 10-8. SGFM Protection Register (SGFMPROT)
The SGFMPROT register is always readable and only writable when
LOCK = 0. To change which logical sectors are protected on a
temporary basis, write SGFMPROT with a new value after the LOCK bit
in SGFMCR has been cleared. To change the value of SGFMPROT that
will be loaded on reset, the protection byte in the FLASH configuration
field must be reprogrammed for the interleaved FLASH physical blocks
currently selected by BKSEL[1:0]. If necessary, the logical sector
containing the FLASH configuration field must be temporarily
unprotected using the method just described before reprogramming the
protection bytes.
PROT[15:0] — Sector Protection Bits
Each FLASH logical sector can be protected from program and erase
operations by setting its corresponding PROT bit.
1 = Logical sector is protected.
0 = Logical sector is not protected.
Advance Information
220
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Module Memory Map
Each banked SGFMPROT register controls the protection of sixteen
8-Kbyte FLASH logical sectors in a 128-Kbyte bank of memory (two
interleaved FLASH physical blocks). Figure 10-9 shows the association
between each bit in the SGFMPROT register and its corresponding
logical sector.
0x0007_ffff
0x0007_e000
SECTOR 15
SECTOR 14
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SECTOR 13
0x0005_ffff
0x0005_e000
SECTOR 12
SECTOR 15
SECTOR 14
SECTOR 13
0x0003_ffff
0x0003_e000
SECTOR 12
SECTOR 15
SECTOR 14
SECTOR 13
0x0001_ffff
0x0001_e000
SECTOR 12
SECTOR 15
SECTOR 14
PROT13
SECTOR 13
PROT12
SECTOR 12
SECTOR 11
8-KBYTE LOGICAL SECTOR
{
SECTOR 10
SECTOR 9
SECTOR 8
SECTOR 7
SECTOR 6
SECTOR 5
SECTOR 4
8-KBYTE LOGICAL SECTOR
{
SECTOR 11
SECTOR 10
SECTOR 9
SECTOR 8
SECTOR 7
SECTOR 6
SECTOR 5
SECTOR 4
PROT0
SECTOR 0
SECTOR 9
SECTOR 8
SECTOR 7
SECTOR 6
SECTOR 5
SECTOR 4
SECTOR 10
SECTOR 9
SECTOR 8
SECTOR 7
SECTOR 6
SECTOR 5
SECTOR 4
SECTOR 3
SECTOR 2
SECTOR 1
SECTOR 0
SECTOR 3
SECTOR 2
SECTOR 1
SECTOR 0
SECTOR 2
SECTOR 1
SECTOR 0
SECTOR 2
SECTOR 1
SECTOR 10
SECTOR 3
SECTOR 3
PROT1
SECTOR 11
SECTOR 11
0x0006_2000
0x0006_0000
BKSEL[1:0]
= %11
0x0004_2000
0x0004_0000
BKSEL[1:0]
= %10
0x0002_2000
0x0002_0000
BKSEL[1:0]
= %01
0x0000_2000
0x0000_0000
BKSEL[1:0]
= %00
Figure 10-9. SGFMPROT Protection Diagram
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
221
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
10.7.2.2 SGFM Supervisor Access Register
The SGFM Supervisor Access Register (SGFMSACC) is banked and
specifies the supervisor/user access permissions of FLASH logical
sectors.
Address: 0x00d0_0014 and 0x00d0_0015
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SUPV15
SUPV14
SUPV13
SUPV12
SUPV11
SUPV10
SUPV9
SUPV8
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SUPV7
SUPV6
SUPV5
SUPV4
SUPV3
SUPV2
SUPV1
SUPV0
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Note 1. Reset state loaded from FLASH configuration field during reset.
Figure 10-10. SGFM Supervisor Access Register (SGFMASACC)
SUPV[15:0] — Supervisor Address Space Assignment Bits
The SUPV[15:0] bits are always readable and only writable when
LOCK = 0. Each FLASH logical sector can be mapped into supervisor
or unrestricted address space. SGFMSACC uses the same
correspondence between logical sectors and register bits as does
SGFMPROT. See Figure 10-9 for details.
When a logical sector is mapped into supervisor address space, only
CPU supervisor accesses will be allowed. A CPU user access to a
location in supervisor address space will result in a cycle termination
transfer error. When a logical sector is mapped into unrestricted
address space both supervisor and user accesses are allowed.
1 = Logical sector is mapped in supervisor address space.
0 = Logical sector is mapped in unrestricted address space.
Advance Information
222
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Module Memory Map
10.7.2.3 SGFM Data Access Register
The SGFM Data Access Register (SGFMDACC) is banked and specifies
the data/program access permissions of FLASH logical sectors.
Address: 0x00d0_0016 and 0x00d0_0017
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
DATA15
DATA14
DATA13
DATA12
DATA11
DATA10
DATA9
DATA8
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DATA7
DATA6
DATA5
DATA4
DATA3
DATA2
DATA1
DATA0
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
F(1)
Read:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Note 1. Reset state loaded from FLASH configuration field during reset.
Figure 10-11. SGFM Data Access Register (SGFMDACC)
DATA[15:0] — Data Address Space Assignment Bits
The DATA[15:0] bits are always readable and only writable when
LOCK = 0. Each FLASH logical sector can be mapped into data or
both data and program address space. SGFMDACC uses the same
correspondence between logical sectors and register bits as does
SGFMPROT. See Figure 10-9 for details.
When a logical sector is mapped into data address space, only CPU
data accesses will be allowed. A CPU program access to a location
in data address space will result in a cycle termination transfer error.
When an array sector is mapped into both data and program address
space both data and program accesses are allowed.
1 = Logical sector is mapped in data address space.
0 = Logical sector is mapped in data and program address space.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
223
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
10.7.2.4 SGFM Test Status Register
The SGFM Test Status Register (SGFMTSTAT) is banked and is used
only for factory testing.
Address: 0x00d0_0018
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD1
RSVD0
0
0
0
RSVD3
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 10-12. SGFM Test Status Register (SGFMTSTAT)
Accesses to SGFMSTAT when not in test mode will result in a cycle
termination transfer error.
10.7.2.5 SGFM User Status Register
The SGFM User Status Register (SGFMUSTAT) is banked reports
FLASH state machine command status, array access errors, protection
violations, and blank check status.
Address: 0x00d0_001c
Bit 7
Read:
6
5
4
PVIOL
ACCERR
0
0
CCIF
CBEIF
3
2
0
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
BLANK
Write:
Reset:
1
1
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 10-13. SGFM User Status Register (SGFMUSTAT)
SGFMUSTAT bits 7, 5, 4, and 2 are readable and writable in all modes.
Bits 3, 1, and 0 always read 0 and writes have no effect. Bit 6 is a
read-only bit in all modes.
NOTE:
Advance Information
224
Only one SGFMTUSTAT bit should be cleared at a time.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Module Memory Map
CBEIF — Command Buffer Empty Interrupt Flag
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The CBEIF flag indicates that the command buffer for the interleaved
FLASH physical blocks selected by BKSEL[1:0] is empty and that a
new command sequence can be started. Clear CBEIF by writing it
to 1. Writing a 0 to CBEIF has no effect but can be used to abort a
command sequence. The CBEIF bit can trigger an interrupt request if
the CBEIE bit is set in SGFMMCR. While CBEIF is clear, the
SGFMCMD register is not writable.
1 = Command buffer is ready to accept a new command.
0 = Command buffer is full.
CCIF — Command Complete Interrupt Flag
The CCIF flag indicates that no commands are pending for the
FLASH physical blocks selected by BKSEL[1:0]. CCIF is set and
cleared automatically upon start and completion of a command.
Writing to CCIF has no effect. The CCIF bit can trigger an interrupt
request if the CCIE bit is set in SGFMCR.
1 = All commands are completed
0 = Command in progress
PVIOL — Protection Violation Flag
The PVIOL flag indicates an attempt was made to initiate a program
or erase operation in a FLASH logical sector denoted as protected by
SGFMPROT. Clear PVIOL by writing it to 1. Writing a 0 to PVIOL has
no effect. While PVIOL is set in any banked register, it is not possible
to launch another command.
1 = A protection violation has occurred
0 = No failure
ACCERR — Access Error Flag
The ACCERR flag indicates an illegal access to the SGFM array or
registers caused by a bad program or erase sequence. ACCERR is
cleared by writing it to 1. Writing a 0 to ACCERR has no effect. While
ACCERR is set in any banked register, it is not possible to launch
another command. See 10.8.3.4 FLASH User Mode Illegal
Operations for details on what sets the ACCERR flag.
1 = Access error has occurred
0 = No failure
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
225
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
BLANK — Erase Verified Flag
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The BLANK flag indicates that the erase verify command (RDARY1)
has checked the two interleaved FLASH physical blocks selected by
BKSL[1:0] and found them to be blank. Clear BLANK by writing it to 1.
Writing a 0 has no effect.
1 = FLASH physical blocks verify as erased.
0 = If an erase verify command has been requested, and the CCIF
flag is set, then the selected FLASH physical blocks are not
blank.
10.7.2.6 SGFM Command Register
The SGFM Command Register (SGFMCMD) is banked and is the
register to which FLASH program, erase, and verify commands are
written.
Address: 0x00d0_0020
Bit 7
Read:
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
CMD6
CMD5
CMD4
CMD3
CMD2
CMD1
CMD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
6
0
= Reserved
Figure 10-14. SGFM Command Register (SGFMCMD)
SGFMCMD is readable and writable in all modes. Writes to bit 7 have no
effect and reads return 0.
CMD[6:0] — Command Field
Valid FLASH user mode commands are shown in Table 10-5. Writing
a command in user mode other than those listed in Table 10-5 will set
the ACCERR flag in SGFMUSTAT.
Table 10-5. SGFMCMD User Mode Commands
Advance Information
226
Command
Name
Description
$05
RDARY1
Erase verify (all 1s)
$20
PGM
Word program
$40
PGERS
Page erase
$41
MASERS
Mass erase
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Module Memory Map
10.7.2.7 SGFM Control Register
The SGFM Control Register (SGFMCTL) is banked and is used only for
factory testing.
Address: 0x00d0_0024 and 0x00d0_0025
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
RSVD1
RSVD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
RSVD15
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Reserved
Figure 10-15. SGFM Control Register (SGFMCTL)
Accesses to SGFMCTL when not in test mode will result in a cycle
termination transfer error.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
227
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
10.7.2.8 SGFM Address Register
The SGFM Address Register (SGFMADR) is a banked register and is
used only for factory testing.
Address: 0x00d0_0026 and 0x00d0_0027
Bit 15
Read:
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
RSVD14
RSVD13
RSVD12
RSVD11
RSVD10
RSVD9
RSVD8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
RSVD1
RSVD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Reserved
Figure 10-16. SGFM Address Register (SGFMADR)
Access to SGFMADR when not in test mode will result in a cycle
termination transfer error.
Advance Information
228
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Module Memory Map
10.7.2.9 SGFM Data Register
The SGFM Data Register (SGFMDATA) is a banked register and is used
only for factory testing.
Address: 0x00d0_0028 through 0x00d0_002b
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
RSVD31
RSVD30
RSVD29
RSVD28
RSVD27
RSVD26
RSVD25
RSVD24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
RSVD23
RSVD22
RSVD21
RSVD20
RSVD19
RSVD18
RSVD17
RSVD16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
RSVD15
RSVD14
RSVD13
RSVD12
RSVD11
RSVD10
RSVD9
RSVD8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
RSVD1
RSVD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 10-17. SGFM Data Register (SGFMDATA)
Accesses to SGFMDATA when not in test mode will result in a cycle
termination transfer error.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
229
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
10.8 SGFM User Mode
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Normal operation of the SGFM occurs in user mode. The SGFM
registers, subject to the restrictions previously noted, can generally be
read and written. Reads of the SGFM array generally occur normally and
writes behave according to the setting of the KEYACC bit in SGFMCR.
Program, erase, and verify operations are initiated by the CPU. Special
cases of user mode apply when the CPU is in low power or debug modes
and when the MCU boots in master mode or emulation mode.
10.8.1 Read Operations
A valid read operation occurs whenever a transfer request is initiated by
the M•CORE, the MLB address is equal to an address within the valid
range of the SGFM memory space, and the read/write control indicates
a read cycle. Aligned read accesses (byte, halfword, or word) complete
in one system clock cycle. Misaligned accesses are not allowed and
result in a cycle termination transfer error.
In order to reduce power at low system clock frequencies, the sense
amplifier timeout (SATO) block minimizes the time during which the
sense amplifiers are enabled for read operations. The sense amplifier
enable signals to the FLASH timeout after approximately 50 ns.
10.8.2 Write Operations
A valid write operation occurs whenever a transfer request is initiated by
the M•CORE, the MLB address is equal to an address within the valid
range of the SGFM memory space, and the read/write control indicates
a write cycle.
The action taken on a valid SGFM array write depends on the
subsequent user command issued as part of a valid command
sequence. Only aligned 32-bit write operations are allowed to the SGFM
array. Byte and halfword write operations will result in a cycle termination
transfer error.
Advance Information
230
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
SGFM User Mode
10.8.3 Program and Erase Operations
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Read and write operations are both used for the program and erase
algorithms described in this subsection. These algorithms are controlled
by a state machine whose timebase is derived from the SGFM module
clock via a programmable counter.
The command register and associated address and data buffers operate
as a two stage FIFO so that a new command along with the necessary
address and data can be stored while the previous command is still in
progress. This pipelining speeds when programming more than one
word on a specific row, as the charge pumps can be kept on in between
two programming commands, thus saving the overhead needed to setup
the charge pumps. Buffer empty and command completion are indicated
by flags in the SGFM User Status Register. Interrupts will be requested
if enabled.
10.8.3.1 Setting the SGFMCLKD Register
Prior to issuing any program or erase commands, SGFMCLKD must be
written to set the FLASH state machine clock (FCLK). The SGFM
module runs at the system clock frequency, but FCLK must be divided
down from the system clock to a frequency between 150 kHz and
200 kHz. Use the following procedure to set the PRDIV8 and DIV[5:0]
bits in SGFMCLKD:
1. If fSYS is greater than 12.8 MHz, PRDIV8 = 1, otherwise
PRDIV8 = 0.
2. Determine DIV[5:0] by using the following equation. Keep only the
integer portion of the result and discard any fraction. Do not round
the result.
fSYS
DIV[5:0] =
1 + (PRDIV8 x 7)
200 kHz
3. Thus the FLASH state machine clock will be:
fSYS
FCLK =
1 + (PRDIV8 x 7)
DIV[5:0] + 1
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
231
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Consider the following example for fSYS = 33 MHz:
fSYS = 12.8 MHz, so PRDIV8 = 1
33 MHz
fSYS
DIV[5:0] =
1 + (PRDIV8 x 7)
200 kHz
fSYS
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
FCLK =
1 + (PRDIV8 x 7)
DIV[5:0] + 1
=
1 + (1 x 7)
200 kHz
= 20
33 MHz
=
1 + (1 x 7)
20 + 1
= 196.43 kHz
So, for fSYS = 33 MHz, writing $54 to SGFMCLKD will set FCLK to
196.43 kHz which is a valid frequency for the timing of program and
erase operations.
WARNING:
NOTE:
For proper program and erase operations, it is critical to set FCLK
between 150 kHz and 200 kHz. Array damage due to overstress can
occur when FCLK is less than 150 kHz. Incomplete programming
and erasure can occur when FCLK is greater than 200 kHz.
Command execution time increases proportionally with the period of
FCLK.
When SGFMCLKD is written, the DIVLD bit is set automatically. If DIVLD
is 0, SGFMCLKD has not been written since the last reset. Program and
erase commands will not execute if this register has not been written
(see 10.8.3.4 FLASH User Mode Illegal Operations).
10.8.3.2 Program, Erase, and Verify Sequences
A command state machine is used to supervise the write sequencing of
program, erase, and verify commands. Before any command write
sequence is started, it is necessary to write the BKSEL field SGFMMCR
to select the banked set of registers associated with the FLASH physical
blocks to be programmed or erased (see Figure 10-2 for more details).
To prepare for a command, the CBEIF flag should be tested to ensure
that the address, data, and command buffers are empty. If CBEIF is set,
the command write sequence can be started.
Advance Information
232
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
SGFM User Mode
This three-step command write sequence must be strictly followed. No
intermediate writes to the SGFM module are permitted between these
three steps. The command write sequence is:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
1. Write the 32-bit word to be programmed to its location in the
SGFM array. The address and data will be stored in internal
buffers. All address bits are valid for program commands. The
value of the data written for verify and erase commands is ignored.
For mass erase or verify, the address can be any location in the
SGFM array. For page erase, address bits [9:0] are ignored.
NOTE:
The page erase command operates simultaneously on adjacent erase
pages in two interleaved FLASH physical blocks. Thus, a single erase
page is effectively 1 Kbyte.
2. Write the program, erase, or verify command to SGFMCMD, the
command buffer. See 10.8.3.3 FLASH User Mode Valid
Commands.
3. Launch the command by writing a 1 to the CBEIF flag. This will
clear CBEIF. When command execution is complete, the FLASH
state machine will set the CCIF flag. The CBEIF flag will also be
set again, indicating that the address, data, and command buffers
are ready for a new command sequence to begin.
NOTE:
On devices with 256 Kbytes of FLASH or more, concurrent command
execution is possible. After a command is launched for the FLASH
physical blocks serviced by the current set of banked registers,
BKSEL[1:0] can be changed in order to launch a command for another
pair of FLASH physical blocks. A command launched for one pair of
FLASH physical blocks will not interfere with the execution of commands
launched for other FLASH physical blocks and will only set the CCIF flag
in the SGFMUSTAT register selected by BKSEL[1:0] at the time the
command was launched.
The FLASH state machine will flag errors in command write sequences
by means of the ACCERR and PVIOL flags in the SGFMUSTAT register.
An erroneous command write sequence will self-abort and set the
appropriate flag. The ACCERR or PVIOL flags must be cleared before
commencing another command write sequence.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
233
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
NOTE:
By writing a 0 to CBEIF, a command sequence can be aborted after the
word write to the SGFM array or the command write to the SGFMCMD
and before the command is launched. The ACCERR flag will be set on
aborted commands and must be cleared before a new command write
sequence.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
A summary of the programming algorithm is shown in Figure 10-18. The
flow is similar for the erase and verify algorithms with the exceptions
noted in step 1 above.
10.8.3.3 FLASH User Mode Valid Commands
Table 10-6 summarizes the valid FLASH user commands.
Table 10-6. FLASH User Mode Commands
Advance Information
234
SGFMCMD
Meaning
Description
$05
Erase
verify
$20
Program
$40
Page
erase
Erase 1 Kbyte of FLASH. Two 512 byte pages from
interleaving physical blocks are erased in this
operation.
$41
Mass
erase
Erase all 128 Kbytes of FLASH from two interleaving
physical blocks. A mass erase is only possible when no
PROTECT bits are set for that block.
Verify that all 128 Kbytes of FLASH from two
interleaving physical blocks are erased. If both blocks
are erased, the BLANK bit will set in the SGFMUSTAT
register upon command completion.
Program a 32-bit word.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
SGFM User Mode
START
READ SGFMCLKD
CLOCK REGISTER
WRITTEN CHECK
NO
DIVLD SET?
YES
WRITE SGFMCLKD
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
READ SGFMUSTAT
NO
CBEIF
SET?
YES
WRITE PROGRAM DATA
TO ARRAY ADDRESS
1.
2.
WRITE PROGRAM COMMAND $20
TO SGFMCMD
NOTE: COMMAND SEQUENCE
ABORTED BY WRITING $00
TO SGFMUSTAT
3.
WRITE $80 TO CLEAR SGFMUSTAT
CBEIF BIT
NOTE: COMMAND SEQUENCE
ABORTED BY WRITING $00
TO SGFMUSTAT
READ SGFMUSTAT
PVIOL
SET?
YES
WRITE $20 TO CLEAR
SGFMUSTAT PVIOL BIT
ACCERR
SET?
YES
WRITE $10 TO CLEAR
SGFMUSTAT ACCERR BIT
PROTECTION
VIOLATION CHECK
NO
ACCESS
ERROR CHECK
YES
NO
ADDRESS, DATA,
COMMAND BUFFER
EMPTY CHECK
CBEIF
SET?
YES
NEXT WRITE?
NO
NO
READ SGFMUSTAT
BIT POLLING
FOR COMMAND
COMPLETION CHECK
CCIF
SET?
NO
YES
EXIT
Figure 10-18. Example Program Algorithm
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
235
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
10.8.3.4 FLASH User Mode Illegal Operations
The ACCERR flag will be set during a command write sequence if any
of the illegal operations below are performed. Such operations will cause
the command sequence to immediately abort.
1. Writing to the SGFM array before initializing SGFMCLKD.
2. Writing to the SGFM array while in emulation mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
3. Writing a byte or a halfword to the SGFM array. Only 32-bit word
programming is allowed.
4. Writing to the SGFM array at a location that does not match
BKSEL[1:0]. Depending on the size of the FLASH array. MLB
address bits [18:17] must match BKSEL[1:0].
5. Writing to the SGFM array while CBEIF is not set.
6. Writing a second word to the SGFM array before executing a
command on the previously written word.
7. Writing an invalid user command to the SGFMCMD.
8. Writing to any SGFM other than SGFMCMD after writing a word to
the SGFM array.
9. Writing a second command to SGFMCMD before executing the
previously written command.
10. Writing to any SGFM register other than SGFMUSTAT (to clear
CBEIF) after writing to the command register.
11. Entering stop mode while a program or erase command is in
progress.
12. Aborting a command sequence by writing a 0 to CBEIF after the
word write to the SGFM array or after writing a command to
SGFMCMD and before launching it.
Advance Information
236
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
SGFM User Mode
The PVIOL flag will be set during a command write sequence after the
word write to the SGFM array if any of the illegal operations below are
performed. Such operations will cause the command sequence to
immediately abort.
1. Writing to an address in a protected area of the SGFM array.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
2. Writing a mass erase command to SGFMCMD while any logical
sector is protected (see 10.7.2.1 SGFM Protection Register).
If a FLASH physical block is read during a program or erase operation
on that block (SGFMUSTAT bit CCIF = 0), the read will return non-valid
data and the ACCERR flag will not be set.
10.8.4 Stop Mode
If a command is active (CCIF = 0) when the MCU enters stop mode, the
command sequence monitor will perform the following:
1. The command in progress will be aborted.
2. The FLASH high voltage circuitry will be switched off and any
pending command (CBEIF = 0) will not be executed when the
MCU exits stop mode.
3. The CCIF and ACCERR flags will be set if a command is active
when the MCU enters stop mode.
NOTE:
WARNING:
The state of any word(s) being programmed or any erase pages/physical
blocks being erased is not guaranteed if the MCU enters stop mode with
a command in progress.
Active commands are immediately aborted when the MCU enters
stop mode. Do not execute the STOP instruction during program
and erase operations.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
237
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
10.8.5 Master Mode
If the MCU is booted in master mode with an external memory selected
as the boot device, the SGFM will not respond to the first transfer request
out of reset, even if the MLB address is equal to an address within the
SGFM array. This will allow the external boot device to provide the reset
vector and terminate the bus cycle.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
10.8.6 Emulation Mode
In emulation mode, the SGFM module will not terminate the bus cycles
by asserting TA or TEA in response to array read requests. External
memory that emulates the FLASH will drive the data bus and the EBI
emulation chip mechanism will terminate the bus cycle instead of the
SGFM module.
NOTE:
In emulation mode, write accesses to the SGFM array will generate an
SGFM access error and set the ACCERR bit.
10.8.7 Debug Mode
In debug mode, the SGFM module behaves exactly as it does in user
mode, except that the LOCK bit in SGFMMCR and the SGFMCLKD[6:0]
register bits are always writable.
10.9 FLASH Security Operation
The SGFM array provides security information to the integration module
and the rest of the MCU. A word in the FLASH configuration field stores
this information. This word is read automatically after each reset and is
stored in the SGFMSEC register.
In user mode, security can be bypassed via a back door access scheme
using an 8-byte long key. Upon successful completion of the back door
access sequence, the module output signal and status bit indicating that
the chip is secure are cleared.
Advance Information
238
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
FLASH Security Operation
The SGFM may be unsecured via one of two methods:
1. Executing a back door access scheme.
2. Passing an erase verify check.
10.9.1 Back Door Access
If the KEYEN bit is set, security can be bypassed by:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
1. Setting the KEYACC bit in the SGFM Configuration Register
(SGFMMCR).
2. Writing the correct 8-byte back door comparison key to the SGFM
array at addresses 0x0000_0200 to 0x0000_0207. This operation
must consist of two 32-bit writes to address 0x0000_0200 and
0x0000_0204 in that order. The two back door write cycles can be
separated by any number of bus cycles.
3. Clearing the KEYACC bit.
4. If all 8 bytes written match the array contents at addresses
0x0000_0200 to 0x0000_0207, then security is bypassed until the
next reset.
NOTE:
The security of the FLASH as defined by the FLASH security word at
address 0x0000_0228 is not changed by the back door method of
unsecuring the device. After the next reset the device is again secured
and the same back door key remains in effect unless changed by
program or erase operations. The back door method of unsecuring the
device has no effect on the program and erase protections defined by
the SGFM Protection Register (SGFMPROT).
10.9.2 Erase Verify Check
Security can be disabled by verifying that the SGFM array is blank. If
required, the mass erase command can be executed for each pair of
FLASH physical blocks that comprise the array. The erase verify
command must then be executed for all FLASH physical blocks within
the array. The SGFM will be unsecured if the erase verify command
determines that the entire array is blank. After the next reset, the security
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
239
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
state of the SGFM will be determined by the FLASH security word,
which, after being erased, will read 0xffff_ffff, thus unsecuring the
module.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
10.10 Resets
The SGFM array is not accessible for any operations via the address and
data buses during reset. If a reset occurs while any command is in
progress that command will immediately abort. The state of any word
being programmed or any erase pages/physical blocks being erased is
not guaranteed.
10.11 Interrupts
The SGFM module can request an interrupt when all commands are
completed or when the address, data, and command buffers are empty.
Table 10-7SGFM Interrupt Sources
Interrupt
Source
Interrupt
Flag
Local
Enable
Global Mask
(PSR)
Command, data and address
buffers empty
CBEIF
(SGFMUSTAT)
CBEIE
(SGFMMCR)
IE/FE bit
All commands are completed
CCIF
(SGFMUSTAT)
CCIE
(SGFMMCR)
IE/FE bit
Figure 10-19 shows the SGFM interrupt mechanism. This system uses
the CBEIE and CCIE bits as well as the register bank select signals to
enable interrupt requests. By taking into account the selected register
bank, false interrupt requests are not generated when the command
buffer is empty in an unselected register bank.
Advance Information
240
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Interrupts
BANK 0 CBEIF
BANK 0 SELECT
BANK 1 CBEIF
•
•
•
CBEIE
•
•
•
BANK 1 SELECT
CCIE
SGFM INTERRUPT
REQUEST
BANK 0 CCIF
BANK 0 SELECT
BANK 1 CCIF
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
BANK 1 SELECT
Figure 10-19. SGFM Interrupt Implementation
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
241
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
Advance Information
242
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Second Generation FLASH for M•CORE (SGFM)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 11. Clock Module
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
11.1 Contents
11.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
11.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244
11.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .245
11.4.1 Normal PLL Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
11.4.2 1:1 PLL Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
11.4.3 External Clock Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
11.4.4 Low-Power Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
11.4.4.1
Wait and Doze Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
11.4.4.2
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
11.5
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
11.6 Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
11.6.1 EXTAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
11.6.2 XTAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
11.6.3 CLKOUT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
11.6.4 PLLEN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
11.6.5 RSTOUT. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
11.7 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
11.7.1 Module Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
11.7.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
11.7.2.1
Synthesizer Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
11.7.2.2
Synthesizer Status Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
11.7.2.3
Synthesizer Test Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
11.7.2.4
Synthesizer Test Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
11.8 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
11.8.1 System Clock Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
11.8.2 System Clocks Generation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
243
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Clock Module
11.8.3
11.8.3.1
11.8.3.2
11.8.4
11.8.4.1
11.8.4.2
11.8.5
11.8.6
11.8.6.1
11.8.6.2
11.8.6.3
11.8.6.4
11.9
PLL Lock Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
PLL Loss of Lock Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
PLL Loss of Lock Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Loss of Clock Detection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Alternate Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Loss-of-Clock Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
Clock Operation During Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
PLL Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Phase and Frequency Detector (PFD). . . . . . . . . . . . . .268
Charge Pump/Loop Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
Voltage Control Output (VCO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Multiplication Factor Divider (MFD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
11.10 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
11.2 Introduction
The clock module contains:
•
Crystal oscillator (OSC)
•
Phase-locked loop (PLL)
•
Reduced frequency divider (RFD)
•
Status and control registers
•
Control logic
11.3 Features
Features of the clock module include:
Advance Information
244
•
2- to 10-MHz reference crystal oscillator
•
Support for low-power modes
•
Separate clock out signal
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Modes of Operation
11.4 Modes of Operation
The clock module can be operated in normal PLL mode (default), 1:1
PLL mode, or external clock mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
11.4.1 Normal PLL Mode
In normal PLL mode, the PLL is fully programmable. It can synthesize
frequencies ranging from 2x to 9x the reference frequency and has a
post divider capable of reducing this synthesized frequency without
disturbing the PLL. The PLL reference can be either a crystal oscillator
or an external clock.
11.4.2 1:1 PLL Mode
In 1:1 PLL mode, the PLL synthesizes a frequency equal to the external
clock input reference frequency. The post divider is not active.
11.4.3 External Clock Mode
In external clock mode, the PLL is bypassed, and the external clock is
applied to EXTAL. The resulting operating frequency is one-half the
external clock frequency.
11.4.4 Low-Power Options
During wakeup from a low-power mode, the FLASH clock always clocks
through at least 16 cycles before the CPU clocks are enabled. This
allows the FLASH module time to recover from the low-power mode, and
software can immediately resume fetching instructions from the flash
memory.
11.4.4.1 Wait and Doze Modes
In wait and doze modes, the system clocks to the peripherals are
enabled, and the clocks to the CPU, FLASH, and SRAM are stopped.
Each module can disable the module clocks locally at the module level.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
245
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
11.4.4.2 Stop Mode
In stop mode, all system clocks are disabled. There are several options
for enabling/disabling the PLL and/or crystal oscillator in stop mode at
the price of increased wakeup recovery time. The PLL can be disabled
in stop mode, but then it requires a wakeup period before it can relock.
The OSC can also be disabled during stop mode, but then it requires a
wakeup period to restart.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When the PLL is enabled in stop mode (STPMD[1:0]), the external
CLKOUT signal can support systems using CLKOUT as the clock
source.
There is also a fast wakeup option for quickly enabling the system clocks
during stop recovery. This eliminates the wakeup recovery time but at a
risk of sending a potentially unstable clock to the system. To prevent a
non-locked PLL frequency overshoot when using the fast wakeup
option, change the RFD divisor to the current RFD value plus one before
entering stop mode.
In external clock mode, there are no wakeup periods for OSC startup or
PLL lock.
Advance Information
246
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Block Diagram
11.5 Block Diagram
PLLEN
EXTAL
RSTOUT
CLKOUT
LOCKS
XTAL
MFD
PLLMODE
LOCK
EXTERNAL CLOCK
REFERENCE
CLOCK
LOCS
PLL
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
OSC
RFD
TO RESET
MODULE
PLLREF
LOCEN
LOLRE
LOCRE
PLL CLOCK OUT
STPMD[1:0]
SCALED PLL CLOCK OUT
STOP MODE
INTERNAL CLOCK
PLLSEL
CLKOUT
DISCLK
INTERNAL
CLOCKS
CLKGEN
(÷ 2)
STOP MODE
PLLMODE
LOCK
FWKUP
Figure 11-1. Clock Module Block Diagram
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
247
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
11.6 Signal Descriptions
The clock module signals are summarized in Table 11-1 and a brief
description follows. For more detailed information, refer to Section 3.
Signal Description.
Table 11-1. Signal Properties
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Name
Function
EXTAL
Oscillator or clock input
XTAL
Oscillator output
CLKOUT
System clock output
PLLEN
PLL enable input
RSTOUT
Reset signal from reset controller
11.6.1 EXTAL
This input is driven by an external clock except when used as a
connection to the external crystal when using the internal oscillator.
11.6.2 XTAL
This output is an internal oscillator connection to the external crystal.
11.6.3 CLKOUT
This output reflects the internal system clock.
11.6.4 PLLEN
This input must be at VDD potential to enable the PLL.
Advance Information
248
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Memory Map and Registers
11.6.5 RSTOUT
The RSTOUT pin is asserted by:
•
Internal system reset signal, or
•
FRCRSTOUT bit in the Reset Control Status Register (RCR); see
5.6.1 Reset Control Register
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
11.7 Memory Map and Registers
The clock programming model consists of these registers:
•
Synthesizer Control Register (SYNCR) — Defines clock
operation, refer to 11.7.2.1 Synthesizer Control Register
•
Synthesizer Status Register (SYNSR) — Reflects clock status,
refer to 11.7.2.2 Synthesizer Status Register
•
Synthesizer Test Register (SYNTR) — Used for factory test, refer
to 11.7.2.3 Synthesizer Test Register
•
Synthesizer Test Register 2 (SYNTR2) — Used only for factory
test, refer to 11.7.2.4 Synthesizer Test Register 2
11.7.1 Module Memory Map
Table 11-2. Clock Module Memory Map
Address
Register Name
Access(1)
0x00c3_0000
Synthesizer Control Register (SYNCR)
S
0x00c3_0002
Synthesizer Status Register (SYNSR)
S
0x00c3_0003
Synthesizer Test Register (SYNTR)
S
0x00c3_0004
Synthesizer Test Register 2 (SYNTR2)
S
1. S = CPU supervisor mode access only.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
249
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
11.7.2 Register Descriptions
This subsection provides a description of the clock module registers.
11.7.2.1 Synthesizer Control Register
The Synthesizer Control Register (SYNCR) is read/write always.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: 0x00c3_0000 and 0x00c3_0001
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
LOLRE
MFD2
MFD1
MFD0
LOCRE
RFD2
RFD1
RFD0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
LOCEN
DISCLK
FWKUP
STMPD1
STMPD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
0
Write:
Reset:
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 11-2. Synthesizer Control Register (SYNCR)
LOLRE — Loss of Lock Reset Enable Bit
The LOLRE bit determines how the system handles a loss of lock
indication. When operating in normal mode or 1:1 PLL mode, the PLL
must be locked before setting the LOLRE bit. Otherwise reset is
immediately asserted. To prevent an immediate reset, the LOLRE bit
must be cleared before writing the MFD[2:0] bits or entering stop
mode with the PLL disabled.
1 = Reset on loss of lock
0 = No reset on loss of lock
NOTE:
Advance Information
250
In external clock mode, the LOLRE bit has no effect.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Memory Map and Registers
MFD[2:0] — Multiplication Factor Divider Field
MFD[2:0] contain the binary value of the divider in the PLL feedback
loop. See Table 11-3. The MFD[2:0] value is the multiplication factor
applied to the reference frequency. When MFD[2:0] are changed or
the PLL is disabled in stop mode, the PLL loses lock. In 1:1 PLL
mode, MFD[2:0] are ignored, and the multiplication factor is one.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
NOTE:
In external clock mode, the MFD[2:0] bits have no effect.
See Table 11-6.
Table 11-3. System Frequency Multiplier of the Reference
Frequency(1) in Normal PLL Mode
RFD[2:0]
MFD[2:0]
000(2)
(2x)
001
(3x)
010
(4x)(3)
011
(5x)
100
(6x)
101
(7x)
110
(8x)
111
(9x)
000 (÷ 1)
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
001 (÷ 2)(3)
1
3/2
2
5/2
3
7/2
4
9/2
010 (÷ 4)
1/2
3/4
1
5/4
3/2
7/4
2
9/4
011 (÷ 8)
1/4
3/8
1/2
5/8
3/4
7/8
1
9/8
100 (÷ 16)
1/8
3/16
1/4
5/16
3/8
7/16
1/2
9/16
101 (÷ 32)
1/16
3/32
1/8
5/32
3/16
7/32
1/4
9/32
110 (÷ 64)
1/32
3/64
1/16
5/64
3/32
7/64
1/8
9/64
111 (÷ 128)
1/64
3/128
1/32
5/128
3/64
7/128
1/16
9/128
1. fsys = fref x (MFD + 2)/2 exp RFD; fref x (MFD + 2) <= 80 MHz, fsys <= 33 MHz
2. MFD = 000 not valid for fref < 3 MHz
3. Default value out of reset
LOCRE — Loss of Clock Reset Enable Bit
The LOCRE bit determines how the system handles a loss of clock
condition. When the LOCEN bit is clear, LOCRE has no effect. If the
LOCS flag in SYNSR indicates a loss of clock condition, setting the
LOCRE bit causes an immediate reset. To prevent an immediate
reset, the LOCRE bit must be cleared before entering stop mode with
the PLL disabled.
1 = Reset on loss of clock
0 = No reset on loss of clock
NOTE:
In external clock mode, the LOCRE bit has no effect.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
251
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
RFD[2:0] — Reduced Frequency Divider Field
The binary value written to RFD[2:0] is the PLL frequency divisor. See
Table 11-3. Changing RFD[2:0] does not affect the PLL or cause a
relock delay. Changes in clock frequency are synchronized to the
next falling edge of the current system clock. To avoid surpassing the
allowable system operating frequency, write to RFD[2:0] only when
the LOCK bit is set.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
NOTE:
In external clock mode, the RFD[2:0] bits have no effect.
See Table 11-6.
LOCEN — Loss of Clock Enable Bit
The LOCEN bit enables the loss of clock function. LOCEN does not
affect the loss of lock function.
1 = Loss of clock function enabled
0 = Loss of clock function disabled
NOTE:
In external clock mode, the LOCEN bit has no effect.
DISCLK — Disable CLKOUT Bit
The DISCLK bit determines whether CLKOUT is driven. Setting the
DISCLK bit holds CLKOUT low.
1 = CLKOUT disabled
0 = CLKOUT enabled
FWKUP — Fast Wakeup Bit
The FWKUP bit determines when the system clocks are enabled
during wakeup from stop mode.
1 = System clocks enabled on wakeup regardless of PLL lock
status
0 = System clocks enabled only when PLL is locked or operating
normally
NOTE:
When FWKUP = 0, if the PLL or OSC is enabled and unintentionally lost
in stop mode, the PLL wakes up in self-clocked mode or reference clock
mode depending on the clock that was lost.
In external clock mode, the FWKUP bit has no effect on the wakeup
sequence.
Advance Information
252
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Memory Map and Registers
STPMD[1:0] — Stop Mode Bits
STPMD[1:0] control PLL and CLKOUT operation in stop mode as
shown in Table 11-4.
Table 11-4. STPMD[1:0] Operation in Stop Mode
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Operation During Stop Mode
STPMD[1:0]
System
Clocks
PLL
OSC
CLKOUT
00
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Enabled
01
Disabled
Enabled
Enabled
Disabled
10
Disabled
Disabled
Enabled
Disabled
11
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
Disabled
11.7.2.2 Synthesizer Status Register
The Synthesizer Status Register (SYNSR) is a read-only register that
can be read at any time. Writing to the SYNSR has no effect and
terminates the cycle normally.
Address: 0x00c3_0002
Bit 7
Read: PLLMODE
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PLLSEL
PLLREF
LOCKS
LOCK
LOCS
0
0
Note 1
Note 1
Note 2
Note 2
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
Note 1
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Notes:
1. Reset state determined during reset configuration.
2. See the LOCKS and LOCK bit descriptions.
Figure 11-3. Synthesizer Status Register (SYNSR)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
253
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
PLLMODE — Clock Mode Bit
The MODE bit is configured at reset and reflects the clock mode as
shown in Table 11-5.
1 = PLL clock mode
0 = External clock mode
PLLSEL — PLL Select Bit
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The PLLSEL bit is configured at reset and reflects the PLL mode as
shown in Table 11-5.
1 = Normal PLL mode
0 = 1:1 PLL mode
PLLREF — PLL Reference Bit
The PLLREF bit is configured at reset and reflects the PLL reference
source in normal PLL mode as shown in Table 11-5.
1 = Crystal clock reference
0 = External clock reference
Table 11-5. System Clock Modes
PLLMODE:PLLSEL:PLLREF
Clock Mode
000
External clock mode
100
1:1 PLL mode
110
Normal PLL mode with external clock reference
111
Normal PLL mode with crystal oscillator
reference
LOCKS — Sticky PLL Lock Bit
The LOCKS flag is a sticky indication of PLL lock status.
1 = No unintentional PLL loss of lock since last system reset or
MFD change
0 = PLL loss of lock since last system reset or MFD change or
currently not locked due to exit from STOP with FWKUP set
The lock detect function sets the LOCKS bit when the PLL achieves
lock after:
– A system reset, or
– A write to SYNCR that changes the MFD[2:0] bits
Advance Information
254
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Memory Map and Registers
When the PLL loses lock, LOCKS is cleared. When the PLL relocks,
LOCKS remains cleared until one of the two listed events occurs.
In stop mode, if the PLL is intentionally disabled, then the LOCKS bit
reflects the value prior to entering stop mode. However, if FWKUP is
set, then LOCKS is cleared until the PLL regains lock. Once lock is
regained, the LOCKS bit reflects the value prior to entering stop
mode. Furthermore, reading the LOCKS bit at the same time that the
PLL loses lock does not return the current loss of lock condition.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
In external clock mode, LOCKS remains cleared after reset. In normal
PLL mode and 1:1 PLL mode, LOCKS is set after reset.
LOCK — PLL Lock Flag
1 = PLL locked
0 = PLL not locked
The LOCK flag is set when the PLL is locked. PLL lock occurs when
the synthesized frequency is within approximately 0.75 percent of the
programmed frequency. The PLL loses lock when a frequency
deviation of greater than approximately 1.5 percent occurs. Reading
the LOCK flag at the same time that the PLL loses lock or acquires
lock does not return the current condition of the PLL. The power-on
reset circuit uses the LOCK bit as a condition for releasing reset.
If operating in external clock mode, LOCK remains cleared after reset.
LOCS — Sticky Loss Of Clock Flag
1 = Loss of clock detected since exiting reset or oscillator not yet
recovered from exit from stop mode with FWKUP = 1
0 = Loss of clock not detected since exiting reset
The LOCS flag is a sticky indication of whether a loss of clock
condition has occurred at any time since exiting reset in normal PLL
and 1:1 PLL modes. LOCS = 0 when the system clocks are operating
normally. LOCS = 1 when system clocks have failed due to a
reference failure or PLL failure.
After entering stop mode with FWKUP set and the PLL and oscillator
intentionally disabled (STPMD[1:0] = 11), the PLL exits stop mode in
SCM while the oscillator starts up. During this time, LOCS is
temporarily set regardless of LOCEN. It is cleared once the oscillator
comes up and the PLL is attempting to lock.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
255
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
If a read of the LOCS flag and a loss of clock condition occur
simultaneously, the flag does not reflect the current loss of clock
condition.
A loss of clock condition can be detected only if LOCEN = 1 or the
oscillator has not yet returned from exit from stop mode with
FWKUP = 1.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
NOTE:
The LOCS flag is always 0 in external clock mode.
11.7.2.3 Synthesizer Test Register
The Synthesizer Test Register (SYNTR) is only for factory testing. When
not in test mode, SYNTR is read-only.
Address: 0x00c3_0003
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 11-4. Synthesizer Test Register (SYNTR)
Advance Information
256
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Memory Map and Registers
11.7.2.4 Synthesizer Test Register 2
The Synthesizer Test Register 2 (SYNTR2) is only for factory testing.
Address: 0x00c3_0004 through 0x00c3_0007
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
RSVD9
RSVD8
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
RSVD1
RSVD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 11-5. Synthesizer Test Register 2 (SYNTR2)
Bits 31–10
Bits 31–10 are read-only. Writing to bits 31–10 has no effect.
RSVD9–RSVD0 — Reserved
The RSVD bits can be read at any time. Writes to these bits update
the register values but have no effect on functionality.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
257
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
11.8 Functional Description
This subsection provides a functional description of the clock module.
11.8.1 System Clock Modes
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The system clock source is determined during reset (see Table 4-7.
Configuration During Reset). The value of PLLEN is latched during
reset and is of no importance after reset is negated. If PLLEN is changed
during a reset other than power-on reset, the internal clocks may glitch
as the clock source is changed between external clock mode and PLL
clock mode. Whenever PLLEN is changed in reset, an immediate loss of
lock condition occurs.
Table 11-6 shows the clock-out frequency to clock-in frequency
relationships for the possible clock modes.
Table 11-6. Clock-Out and Clock-In Relationships
PLL Options(1)
Clock Mode
Normal PLL clock mode
fsys = fref × (MFD + 2)/2RFD
1:1 PLL clock mode
fsys = fref
External clock mode
fsys = fref/2
1. fref = input reference frequency
fsys = CLKOUT frequency
MFD ranges from 0 to 7.
RFD ranges from 0 to 7.
CAUTION:
XTAL must be tied low in external clock mode when reset is asserted. If
it is not, clocks could be suspended indefinitely.
The external clock is divided by two internally to produce the system
clocks.
Advance Information
258
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Functional Description
11.8.2 System Clocks Generation
In normal PLL clock mode, the default system frequency is two times the
reference frequency after reset. The RFD[2:0] and MFD[2:0] bits in
SYNCR select the frequency multiplier.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When programming the PLL, do not exceed the maximum system clock
frequency listed in the electrical specifications. Use this procedure to
accommodate the frequency overshoot that occurs when the MFD bits
are changed:
1. Determine the appropriate value for the MFD and RFD fields in
SYNCR. The amount of jitter in the system clocks can be
minimized by selecting the maximum MFD factor that can be
paired with an RFD factor to provide the required frequency.
2. Write a value of RFD (from step 1) + 1 to the RFD field of SYNCR.
3. Write the MFD value from step 1 to SYNCR.
4. Monitor the LOCK flag in SYNSR. When the PLL achieves lock,
write the RFD value from step 1 to the RFD field of SYNCR. This
changes the system clocks frequency to the required frequency.
NOTE:
Keep the maximum system clock frequency below the limit given in
Section 23. Preliminary Electrical Specifications.
11.8.3 PLL Lock Detection
The lock detect logic monitors the reference frequency and the PLL
feedback frequency to determine when frequency lock is achieved.
Phase lock is inferred by the frequency relationship, but is not
guaranteed. The LOCK flag in SYNSR reflects the PLL lock status. A
sticky lock flag, LOCKS, is also provided.
The lock detect function uses two counters. One is clocked by the
reference and the other is clocked by the PLL feedback. When the
reference counter has counted N cycles, its count is compared to that of
the feedback counter. If the feedback counter has also counted N cycles,
the process is repeated for N + K counts. Then, if the two counters still
match, the lock criteria is relaxed by 1/2 and the system is notified that
the PLL has achieved frequency lock.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
259
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
After lock is detected, the lock circuit continues to monitor the reference
and feedback frequencies using the alternate count and compare
process. If the counters do not match at any comparison time, then the
LOCK flag is cleared to indicate that the PLL has lost lock. At this point,
the lock criteria is tightened and the lock detect process is repeated.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The alternate count sequences prevent false lock detects due to
frequency aliasing while the PLL tries to lock. Alternating between tight
and relaxed lock criteria prevents the lock detect function from randomly
toggling between locked and non-locked status due to phase
sensitivities. Figure 11-6 shows the sequence for detecting locked and
non-locked conditions.
In external clock mode, the PLL is disabled and cannot lock.
START
WITH TIGHT LOCK
CRITERIA
LOSS OF LOCK DETECTED
SET TIGHT LOCK CRITERIA
AND NOTIFY SYSTEM OF LOSS
OF LOCK CONDITION
REFERENCE COUNT
REFERENCE COUNT
≠ FEEDBACK COUNT
≠ FEEDBACK COUNT
COUNT N
REFERENCE CYCLES
AND COMPARE
NUMBER OF FEEDBACK
CYCLES ELAPSED
REFERENCE COUNT =
FEEDBACK COUNT = N
IN SAME COUNT/COMPARE SEQUENCE
LOCK DETECTED.
SET RELAXED LOCK
CONDITION AND NOTIFY
SYSTEM OF LOCK
CONDITION
COUNT N + K
REFERENCE CYCLES
AND COMPARE NUMBER
OF FEEDBACK CYCLES
ELAPSED
REFERENCE COUNT =
FEEDBACK COUNT = N + K
IN SAME COUNT/COMPARE SEQUENCE
Figure 11-6. Lock Detect Sequence
Advance Information
260
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Functional Description
11.8.3.1 PLL Loss of Lock Conditions
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Once the PLL acquires lock after reset, the LOCK and LOCKS flags are
set. If the MFD is changed, or if an unexpected loss of lock condition
occurs, the LOCK and LOCKS flags are negated. While the PLL is in the
non-locked condition, the system clocks continue to be sourced from the
PLL as the PLL attempts to relock. Consequently, during the relocking
process, the system clocks frequency is not well defined and may
exceed the maximum system frequency, violating the system clock
timing specifications.
However, once the PLL has relocked, the LOCK flag is set. The LOCKS
flag remains cleared if the loss of lock is unexpected. The LOCKS flag is
set when the loss of lock is caused by changing MFD. If the PLL is
intentionally disabled during stop mode, then after exit from stop mode,
the LOCKS flag reflects the value prior to entering stop mode once lock
is regained.
11.8.3.2 PLL Loss of Lock Reset
If the LOLRE bit in SYNCR is set, a loss of lock condition asserts reset.
Reset reinitializes the LOCK and LOCKS flags. Therefore, software
must read the LOL bit in Reset Status Register (RSR) to determine if a
loss of lock caused the reset. See 5.6.2 Reset Status Register.
To exit reset in PLL mode, the reference must be present, and the PLL
must achieve lock.
In external clock mode, the PLL cannot lock. Therefore, a loss of lock
condition cannot occur, and the LOLRE bit has no effect.
11.8.4 Loss of Clock Detection
The LOCEN bit in SYNCR enables the loss of clock detection circuit to
monitor the input clocks to the phase and frequency detector (PFD).
When either the reference or feedback clock frequency falls below the
minimum frequency, the loss of clock circuit sets the sticky LOCS flag in
SYNSR.
NOTE:
In external clock mode, the loss of clock circuit is disabled.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
261
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
11.8.4.1 Alternate Clock Selection
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Depending on which clock source fails, the loss-of-clock circuit switches
the system clocks source to the remaining operational clock. The
alternate clock source generates the system clocks until reset is
asserted. As Table 11-7 shows, if the reference fails, the PLL goes out
of lock and into self-clocked mode (SCM). The PLL remains in SCM until
the next reset. When the PLL is operating in SCM, the system frequency
depends on the value in the RFD field. The SCM system frequency
stated in electrical specifications assumes that the RFD has been
programmed to binary 000. If the loss-of-clock condition is due to PLL
failure, the PLL reference becomes the system clocks source until the
next reset, even if the PLL regains and relocks.
Table 11-7. Loss of Clock Summary
Clock
Mode
System Clock
Source
Before Failure
Reference Failure
Alternate Clock
Selected by LOC
Circuit(1) Until Reset
PLL Failure
Alternate Clock
Selected by
LOC Circuit
Until Reset
PLL
PLL
PLL self-clocked mode
PLL reference
External
External clock
None
NA
1. The LOC circuit monitors the reference and feedback inputs to the PFD. See Figure 11-8.
A special loss-of-clock condition occurs when both the reference and the
PLL fail. The failures may be simultaneous, or the PLL may fail first. In
either case, the reference clock failure takes priority and the PLL
attempts to operate in SCM. If successful, the PLL remains in SCM until
the next reset. If the PLL cannot operate in SCM, the system remains
static until the next reset. Both the reference and the PLL must be
functioning properly to exit reset.
Advance Information
262
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Functional Description
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
X X X
X
X
—
NRM
0 0
X
LOCS
FWKUP
EXT
LOCK
OSC
Expected PLL
Action at Stop
LOCKS
MODE
In
LOCEN
LOCRE
LOLRE
PLL
Table 11-8. Stop Mode Operation (Sheet 1 of 3)
—
EXT
0
0
0
Lose reference clock
Stuck
—
—
—
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Stuck
—
—
—
PLL Action
During Stop
Regain
Lose lock,
0 Off Off 0 f.b. clock,
reference clock No regain
Regain clocks, but
don’t regain lock
NRM
NRM
X 0
0 0
Lose lock,
0 Off Off 1 f.b. clock,
reference clock
0 Off On 0 Lose lock
0 0
0 Off On 1 Lose lock
SCM–>
unstable NRM
0 On On 0
—
0–>
1–>
No f.b. clock regain
Stuck
—
—
—
Regain
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose reference clock
or no lock regain
Stuck
—
—
—
Lose reference clock,
NRM
regain
‘LK
1
‘LC
Block LOCKS from being
cleared
‘LC
Block LOCKS until lock
regained
Unstable NRM
Lose reference clock
Stuck
or no f.b. clock regain
0 0
0 On On 1
—
0–>‘LK 0–>1
—
—
0–>‘LK 0–>1
MOTOROLA
‘LC
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose lock or clock
Stuck
—
—
—
Lose lock, regain
NRM
0
1
‘LC
Lose clock and lock,
regain
NRM
0
1
‘LC
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose lock
Unstable NRM
0
0–>1
‘LC
Lose lock, regain
NRM
0
1
‘LC
Lose clock
Stuck
—
—
—
Lose clock, regain
without lock
Unstable NRM
0
0–>1
‘LC
Lose clock, regain
with lock
NRM
0
1
‘LC
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Block LOCKS from being
cleared
—
NRM
—
NRM
Block LOCS and LOCKS until
clock and lock respectively
regain; enter SCM regardless
of LOCEN bit
0–>
—
0 0
Block LOCS and LOCKS until
clock and lock respectively
0–>‘LK 0–>1 1–>‘LC regain; enter SCM regardless
of LOCEN bit until reference
regained
SCM–>
Lose reference clock,
Unstable NRM
regain
NRM
Comments
No reference clock
regain
No lock regain
NRM
MODE
Out
LOCS not set because
LOCEN = 0
LOCS not set because
LOCEN = 0
Advance Information
263
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
X
Lose lock,
X f.b. clock,
RESET
reference clock
NRM
0 0
1 On On X
1 0
Lose lock,
Regain
0 Off Off 0 f.b. clock,
reference clock
No regain
NRM
NRM
NRM
NRM
NRM
1 0
1 0
1 0
1 0
0 Off On 0
0 Off On 1
0 On On 0
0 On On 1
NRM
1 0
1 On On X
NRM
1 1 X Off
X
—
Lose lock,
f.b. clock
Lose lock,
f.b. clock
—
—
—
LOCS
FWKUP
X X 1 Off
LOCK
OSC
NRM
Expected PLL
Action at Stop
LOCKS
MODE
In
LOCEN
LOCRE
LOLRE
PLL
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 11-8. Stop Mode Operation (Sheet 2 of 3)
RESET
—
—
—
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
RESET
—
—
—
Reset immediately
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
REF not entered during stop;
SCM entered during stop only
during OSC startup
Stuck
—
—
—
Regain
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
No f.b. clock or lock
regain
Stuck
—
—
—
Lose reference clock
SCM
0
0
1
Regain f.b. clock
Unstable NRM
No f.b. clock regain
Stuck
—
—
—
Lose reference clock
SCM
0
0
1
—
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose reference clock
SCM
0
0
1
Wakeup without lock
Lose f.b. clock
REF
0
X
1
Wakeup without lock
Lose lock
Stuck
—
—
—
Lose lock, regain
NRM
0
1
‘LC
—
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose reference clock
SCM
0
0
1
Wakeup without lock
Lose f.b. clock
REF
0
X
1
Wakeup without lock
Lose lock
Unstable NRM
0
0–>1
‘LC
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
RESET
—
—
—
Reset immediately
RESET
—
—
—
Reset immediately
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose clock
RESET
—
—
—
Lose lock
Stuck
—
—
—
Lose lock, regain
NRM
0
1
‘LC
PLL Action
During Stop
—
Lose lock or clock
—
Lose lock or clock
Lose lock,
X f.b. clock,
RESET
reference clock
—
NRM
1 1
0 On On 0
Advance Information
264
—
MODE
Out
0–>‘LK 0–>1
‘LC
Comments
Reset immediately
REF mode not entered during
stop
Wakeup without lock
REF mode not entered during
stop
Wakeup without lock
Reset immediately
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Functional Description
LOCK
LOCS
Expected PLL
Action at Stop
LOCKS
FWKUP
OSC
MODE
In
LOCEN
LOCRE
LOLRE
PLL
Table 11-8. Stop Mode Operation (Sheet 3 of 3)
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
Lose clock
RESET
—
—
—
Lose lock
Unstable NRM
0
0–>1
‘LC
Lose lock, regain
NRM
0
1
‘LC
NRM
‘LK
1
‘LC
RESET
—
—
—
—
REF
0
X
1
Lose reference clock
Stuck
—
—
—
PLL Action
During Stop
—
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
NRM
1 1
0 On On 1
—
—
MODE
Out
NRM
1 1
1 On On X
—
REF
1 0
0
X
X
X
—
SCM
1 0
0 Off
X
0 PLL disabled
Regain SCM
SCM
0
0
1
SCM
1 0
0 Off
X
1 PLL disabled
Regain SCM
SCM
0
0
1
SCM
1 0
0 On On 0
—
—
SCM
Lose reference clock
SCM
0
0
1
SCM
1 0
0 On On 1
—
—
SCM
Lose reference clock
SCM
0
0
1
Lose clock or lock
Comments
Reset immediately
Reset immediately
Wakeup without lock
Wakeup without lock
PLL = PLL enabled during STOP mode. PLL = On when STPMD[1:0] = 00 or 01
OSC = OSC enabled during STOP mode. OSC = On when STPMD[1:0] = 00, 01, or 10
MODES
NRM = normal PLL crystal clock reference or normal PLL external reference or PLL 1:1 mode. During PLL 1:1 or normal external reference
mode, the oscillator is never enabled. Therefore, during these modes, refer to the OSC = On case regardless of STPMD values.
EXT = external clock mode
REF = PLL reference mode due to losing PLL clock or lock from NRM mode
SCM = PLL self-clocked mode due to losing reference clock from NRM mode
RESET = immediate reset
LOCKS
‘LK
= expecting previous value of LOCKS before entering stop
0–>‘LK = current value is 0 until lock is regained which then will be the previous value before entering stop
0–>
= current value is 0 until lock is regained but lock is never expected to regain
LOCS
‘LC
= expecting previous value of LOCS before entering stop
1–>‘LC = current value is 1 until clock is regained which then will be the previous value before entering stop
1–>
= current value is 1 until clock is regained but CLK is never expected to regain
11.8.4.2 Loss-of-Clock Reset
When a loss-of-clock condition is recognized, reset is asserted if the
LOCRE bit in SYNCR is set. The LOCS bit in SYNSR is cleared after
reset. Therefore, the LOC bit must be read in RSR to determine that a
loss of clock condition occurred. LOCRE has no effect in external clock
mode.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
265
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
To exit reset in PLL mode, the reference must be present, and the PLL
must acquire lock.
11.8.5 Clock Operation During Reset
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
In external clock mode, the system is static and does not recognize reset
until a clock is applied to EXTAL.
In PLL mode, the PLL operates in self-clocked mode (SCM) during reset
until the input reference clock to the PLL begins operating within the
limits given in the electrical specifications.
If a PLL failure causes a reset, the system enters reset using the
reference clock. Then the clock source changes to the PLL operating in
SCM. If SCM is not functional, the system becomes static. Alternately, if
the LOCEN bit in SYNCR is clear when the PLL fails, the system
becomes static. If external reset is asserted, the system cannot enter
reset unless the PLL is capable of operating in SCM.
11.8.6 PLL Operation
In PLL mode, the PLL synthesizes the system clocks. The PLL can
multiply the reference clock frequency by 2x to 9x, provided that the
system clock (CLKOUT) frequency remains within the range listed in
electrical specifications. For example, if the reference frequency is
2 MHz, the PLL can synthesize frequencies of 4 MHz to 18 MHz. In
addition, the RFD can reduce the system frequency by dividing the
output of the PLL. The RFD is not in the feedback loop of the PLL, so
changing the RFD divisor does not affect PLL operation.
Figure 11-8 shows the external support circuitry for the crystal oscillator
with example component values. Actual component values depend on
crystal specifications.
Advance Information
266
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Functional Description
PLLEN
RSTOUT
STPMD
LOCKS
LOCK
DETECT
LOCK
LOLRE
TO RESET
MODULE
PLLMODE
LOCEN
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
LOCRE
LOSS OF
CLOCK
DETECT
REFERENCE
CLOCK
LOCS
PHASE AND
FREQUENCY
DETECT
CHARGE
PUMP
FILTER
VCO
RFD[2:0]
SCALED PLL
CLOCK OUT
PLLSEL
DISCLK
MDF[2:0]
CLKOUT
÷ MFD
(2–9)
PLL CLOCK
OUT
Figure 11-7. PLL Block Diagram
C1
C2
V66
EXTAL
XTAL
ON-CHIP
8-MHz CRYSTAL CONFIGURATION
C1 = C2 = 16 pF
RF = 1 MΩ
RS = 470 Ω
V666<1
RS
RF
Figure 11-8. Crystal Oscillator Example
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
267
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
11.8.6.1 Phase and Frequency Detector (PFD)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The PFD is a dual-latch phase-frequency detector. It compares both the
phase and frequency of the reference and feedback clocks. The
reference clock comes from either the crystal oscillator or an external
clock source. The feedback clock comes from:
•
CLKOUT in 1:1 PLL mode, or
•
VCO output divided by two if CLKOUT is disabled in 1:1 PLL
mode, or
•
VCO output divided by the MFD in normal PLL mode
When the frequency of the feedback clock equals the frequency of the
reference clock, the PLL is frequency-locked. If the falling edge of the
feedback clock lags the falling edge of the reference clock, the PFD
pulses the UP signal. If the falling edge of the feedback clock leads the
falling edge of the reference clock, the PFD pulses the DOWN signal.
The width of these pulses relative to the reference clock depends on how
much the two clocks lead or lag each other. Once phase lock is
achieved, the PFD continues to pulse the UP and DOWN signals for very
short durations during each reference clock cycle. These short pulses
continually update the PLL and prevent the frequency drift phenomenon
known as dead-banding.
11.8.6.2 Charge Pump/Loop Filter
In 1:1 PLL mode, the charge pump uses a fixed current. In normal mode
the current magnitude of the charge pump varies with the MFD as shown
in Table 11-9.
Table 11-9. Charge Pump Current and MFD
in Normal Mode Operation
Advance Information
268
Charge Pump Current
MFD
1X
0 ≤ MFD < 2
2X
2 ≤ MFD < 6
4X
6 ≤ MFD
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Clock Module
Reset
The UP and DOWN signals from the PFD control whether the charge
pump applies or removes charge, respectively, from the loop filter. The
filter is integrated on the chip.
11.8.6.3 Voltage Control Output (VCO)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The voltage across the loop filter controls the frequency of the VCO
output. The frequency-to-voltage relationship (VCO gain) is positive, and
the output frequency is four times the target system frequency.
11.8.6.4 Multiplication Factor Divider (MFD)
When the PLL is not in 1:1 PLL mode, the MFD divides the output of the
VCO and feeds it back to the PFD. The PFD controls the VCO frequency
via the charge pump and loop filter such that the reference and feedback
clocks have the same frequency and phase. Thus, the frequency of the
input to the MFD, which is also the output of the VCO, is the reference
frequency multiplied by the same amount that the MFD divides by. For
example, if the MFD divides the VCO frequency by six, the PLL is
frequency locked when the VCO frequency is six times the reference
frequency. The presence of the MFD in the loop allows the PLL to
perform frequency multiplication, or synthesis.
In 1:1 PLL mode, the MFD is bypassed, and the effective multiplication
factor is one.
11.9 Reset
The clock module can assert a reset when a loss of clock or loss of lock
occurs as described in 11.8 Functional Description.
Reset initializes the clock module registers to a known startup state as
described in 11.7 Memory Map and Registers.
11.10 Interrupts
The clock module does not generate interrupt requests.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
269
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Clock Module
Advance Information
270
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Clock Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 12. Ports Module
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
12.1 Contents
12.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
12.3
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
12.4 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
12.4.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
12.4.2 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
12.4.2.1
Port Output Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
12.4.2.2
Port Data Direction Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
12.4.2.3
Port Pin Data/Set Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
12.4.2.4
Port Clear Output Data Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
12.4.2.5
Port C/D Pin Assignment Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
12.4.2.6
Port E Pin Assignment Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .280
12.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
12.5.1 Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
12.5.2 Port Digital I/O Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
12.6
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
271
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
12.2 Introduction
Many of the pins associated with the external interface may be used for
several different functions. Their primary function is to provide an
external interface to access off-chip resources. When not used for their
primary functions, many of the pins may be used as general purpose
digital input/output (I/O) pins. In some cases, the pin function is set by
the operating mode, and the alternate pin functions are not supported.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
To facilitate the general purpose digital I/O function, these pins are
grouped into 8-bit ports. Each port has registers that configure the pins
for the desired function, monitor the pins, and control the pins within the
ports.
R/W / PF7(1)
PORT A
D[31:24] / PA[7:0]
PORT F
PORT B
D[23:16] / PB[7:0]
PORT G
A[15:8] / PG[7:0](1)
PORT C
D[15:8] / PC[7:0]
PORT H
A[7:0] / PH[7:0](1)
PORT D
D[7:0] / PD[7:0]
PORT I
PORT E
SHS / RCON / PE7
TA / PE6
TEA / PE5
CSE[1:0] / PE[4:3](1)
TC[2:0] / PE[2:0](1)
A[22:16] / PF[6:0](1)
EB[3:0] / PI[7:4](1)
CS[3:0]/ PI[3:0](1)
Note 1. These pins are found only on the 144-pin package.
Figure 12-1. Ports Module Block Diagram
Advance Information
272
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
Signals
12.3 Signals
See Table 12-3 in 12.5 Functional Description for signal location and
naming convention.
12.4 Memory Map and Registers
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The ports programming model consists of these registers:
•
The port output data registers (PORTx) store the data to be driven
on the corresponding port pins when the pins are configured for
digital output.
•
The port data direction registers (DDRx) control the direction of
the port pin drivers when the pins are configured for digital I/O.
•
Port pin data/set data registers (PORTxP/SETx):
– Reflect the current state of the port pins
– Allow for setting individual bits in PORTx
•
The port clear output data registers (CLRx) allow for clearing
individual bits in PORTx.
•
The port pin assignment registers (PCDPAR and PEPAR) control
the function of each pin of the C, D, E, I7, and I6 ports.
In emulation mode, accesses to the port registers are ignored and the
port access goes external so that emulation hardware can satisfy the
port access request. The cycle termination is always provided by the port
logic, even in emulation mode.
All port registers are word-, half-word, and byte-accessible and are
grouped to allow coherent access to port data register groups. Writing to
reserved bits in the port registers has no effect and reading returns 0s.
The I/O ports have a base address of 0x00c0_0000.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
273
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
12.4.1 Memory Map
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 12-1. I/O Port Module Memory Map
Address
Bits 31–24
Bits 23–16
Bits 15–8
Bits 7–0
Access(1)
0x00c0_0000
PORTA
PORTB
PORTC
PORTD
S/U
0x00c0_0004
PORTE
PORTF
PORTG
PORTH
S/U
0x00c0_0008
PORTI
0x00c0_000c
DDRA
DDRB
DDRC
DDRD
S/U
0x00c0_0010
DDRE
DDRF
DDRG
DDRH
S/U
0x00c0_0014
DDRI
0x00c0_0018
PORTAP/SETA
PORTBP/SETB
PORTCP/SETC
PORTDP/SETD
S/U
0x00c0_001c
PORTEP/SETE
PORTFP/SETF
PORTGP/SETG
PORTHP/SETH
S/U
0x00c0_0020
PORTIP/SETI
0x00c0_0024
CLRA
CLRB
CLRC
CLRD
S/U
0x00c0_0028
CLRE
CLRF
CLRG
CLRH
S/U
0x00c0_002c
CLRI
0x00c0_0030
PCDPAR
0x00c0_0034–
0x00c0_003c
Reserved(2)
S/U
Reserved(2)
S/U
Reserved(2)
Reserved(2)
Reserved (2)
PEPAR
Reserved(2)
S/U
S/U
S/U
S/U
1. S/U = CPU supervisor or user mode access. User mode accesses to supervisor only addresses have no effect and result
in a cycle termination transfer error.
2. Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Advance Information
274
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
Memory Map and Registers
12.4.2 Register Descriptions
This subsection provides a description of the I/O port registers.
12.4.2.1 Port Output Data Registers
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The port output data registers (PORTx) store the data to be driven on the
corresponding port x pins when the pins are configured for digital output.
Reading PORTx returns the current value in the register, not the port x
pin values.
The SETx and CLRx registers also affect the PORTx register bits. To set
bits in PORTx, write 1s to the corresponding bits in PORTxP/SETx. To
clear bits in PORTx, write 0s to the corresponding bits in CLRx.
PORTx are read/write registers when not in emulation mode. Reset sets
PORTx.
Address: 0x00c0_0000 — PORTA
0x00c0_0001 — PORTB
0x00c0_0002 — PORTC
0x00c0_0003 — PORTD
0x00c0_0004 — PORTE
0x00c0_0005 — PORTF
0x00c0_0006 — PORTG
0x00c0_0007 — PORTH
0x00c0_0008 — PORTI
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTx7
PORTx6
PORTx5
PORTx4
PORTx3
PORTx2
PORTx1
PORTx0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 12-2. Port Output Data Registers (PORTx)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
275
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
12.4.2.2 Port Data Direction Registers
A port data direction registers (DDRx) control the direction of the port x
pin drivers when the pins are configured for digital I/O. Setting any bit in
DDRx configures the corresponding port x pin as an output. Clearing any
bit in DDRx configures the corresponding pin as an input. When a pin is
not configured for digital I/O, its corresponding data direction bit has no
effect.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
DDRx are read/write registers when not in emulation mode. Reset clears
DDRx.
Address: 0x00c0_000c — DDRA
0x00c0_000d — DDRB
0x00c0_000e — DDRC
0x00c0_000f — DDRD
0x00c0_0010 — DDRE
0x00c0_0011 — DDRF
0x00c0_0012 — DDRG
0x00c0_0013 — DDRH
0x00c0_0014 — DDRI
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRx7
DDRx6
DDRx5
DDRx4
DDRx3
DDRx2
DDRx1
DDRx0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 12-3. Port Data Direction Registers (DDRx)
DDRx[7:0] — Port x Data Direction Bits
1 = Pin configured as output
0 = Pin configured as input
Advance Information
276
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
Memory Map and Registers
12.4.2.3 Port Pin Data/Set Data Registers
Reading a Port Pin Data/Set Data Register (PORTxP/SETx) returns the
current state of the port x pins.
Writing 1s to PORTxP/SETx sets the corresponding bits in PORTx.
Writing 0s has no effect.
PORTxP/SETx are read/write registers when not in emulation mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: 0x00c0_0018 — PORTAP/SETA
0x00c0_0019 — PORTBP/SETB
0x00c0_001a — PORTCP/SETC
0x00c0_001b — PORTDP/SETD
0x00c0_001c — PORTEP/SETE
0x00c0_001d — PORTFP/SETF
0x00c0_001e — PORTGP/SETG
0x00c0_001f — PORTHP/SETH
0x00c0_0020 — PORTIP/SETI
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read: PORTxP7 PORTxP6 PORTxP5 PORTxP4 PORTxP3 PORTxP2 PORTxP1 PORTxP0
Write:
SETx7
SETx6
SETx5
SETx4
SETx3
SETx2
SETx1
SETx0
Reset:
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P = Current pin state
Figure 12-4. Port Pin Data/Set Data Registers (PORTxP/SETx)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
277
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
12.4.2.4 Port Clear Output Data Registers
Writing 0s to a Port Clear Output Data Register (CLRx) clears the
corresponding bits in PORTx. Writing 1s has no effect. Reading CLRx
returns 0s.
CLRx are read/write registers when not in emulation mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: 0x00c0_0024 — CLRA
0x00c0_0025 — CLRB
0x00c0_0026 — CLRC
0x00c0_0027 — CLRD
0x00c0_0028 — CLRE
0x00c0_0029 — CLRF
0x00c0_002a — CLRG
0x00c0_002b — CLRH
0x00c0_002c — CLRI
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
CLRx7
CLRx6
CLRx5
CLRx4
CLRx3
CLRx2
CLRx1
CLRx0
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 12-5. Port Clear Output Data Registers (CLRx)
Advance Information
278
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
Memory Map and Registers
12.4.2.5 Port C/D Pin Assignment Register
The Port C/D Pin Assignment Register (PCDPAR) controls the pin
function of ports C, D, I7, and I6.
PCDPAR is a read/write register when not in emulation mode.
Address: 0x00c0_0030
Bit 7
Read:
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
PCDPA
Write:
Reset: See note
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Note: Reset state determined during reset configuration. PCDPA = 1 except in single-chip
mode or when an external boot device is selected with a 16-bit port size in master mode.
Figure 12-6. Port C, D, I7, and I6 Pin Assignment
Register (PCDPAR)
PCDPA — Port C, D, I7, and I6 Pin Assignment Bit
1 = Port C, D, I7, and I6 pins configured for primary function
0 = Port C, D, I7, and I6 pins configured for digital I/O
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
279
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
12.4.2.6 Port E Pin Assignment Register
The Port E Pin Assignment Register (PEPAR) controls the pin function
of port E.
PEPAR is a read/write register when not in emulation mode.
Address: 0x00c0_0031
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PEPA7
PEPA6
PEPA5
PEPA4
PEPA3
PEPA2
PEPA1
PEPA0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Read:
Write:
Reset:
See note
Note: Reset state determined during reset configuration as shown in Table 12-2.
Figure 12-7. Port E Pin Assignment Register (PEPAR)
PEPA[7:0] — Port E Pin Assignment Bits
1 = Port E pins configured for primary function
0 = Port E pins configured for digital I/O
Table 12-2. PEPAR Reset Values
Advance Information
280
PEPAR
Pin
Master
Mode
Single-Chip
Mode
Emulation
Mode
PEPA7
SHS
1
0
1
PEPA6
TA
1
0
1
PEPA5
TEA
1
0
1
PEPA[4:3]
CSE[1:0]
0
0
1
PEPA[2:0]
TC[2:0]
0
0
1
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
Functional Description
12.5 Functional Description
The initial pin function is determined during reset configuration (see
Section 4. Chip Configuration Module (CCM)). The pin assignment
registers (PCDPAR and PEPAR) allow the user to select between digital
I/O or another pin function after reset.
In single-chip mode, all pins are configured as digital I/O by default.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Every digital I/O pin is individually configurable as an input or an output
via a data direction register (DDRx).
Every port has an output data register (PORTx) and a pin data register
(PORTxP/SETx) to monitor and control the state of its pins. Data written
to PORTx is stored and then driven to the corresponding PORTx pins
configured as outputs.
Reading PORTx returns the current state of the register regardless of
the state of the corresponding pins.
Reading PORTxP returns the current state of the corresponding pins,
regardless of whether the pins are input or output.
Every port has a set register (PORTxP/SETx) and a clear register
(CLRx) for setting or clearing individual bits in PORTx.
In master mode and emulation mode, ports A and B function as the
upper external data bus, D[31:16]. When the PCDPA bit is set, ports C
and D function as the lower external data bus, D[15:0]. Ports E–I are
configured to support external memory and emulation functions.
In master mode, the function of EB[3:2] is determined by the PCDPA bit.
The function of CS[3:0] is determined by the individual chip select enable
(CSENx) bits.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
281
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
12.5.1 Pin Functions
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Pin
Port
Table 12-3. Ports A–I Supported Pin Functions
Master Mode
Single-Chip Mode
Emulation Mode(1)
D[31:24]
A D[31:24] (I/O)
PA[7:0] (I/O)
D[31:24] (I/O)
D[23:16]
B D[23:16] (I/O)
PB[7:0](I/O)
D[23:16](I/O)
D[15:8]
D[15:8] (I/O) (PCDPA = 1)
C or
PC[7:0] (I/O) (PCDPA = 0)
PC[7:0] (I/O) (PCDPA = 0)(2)
D[15:8] (I/O) (PCDPA = 1)
D[7:0]
D[7:0] (I/O) (PCDPA = 1)
D or
PD[7:0] (I/O) (PCDPA = 0)
PD[7:0] (I/O) (PCDPA = 0)(2)
D[7:0] (I/O) (PCDPA = 1)
SHS (O) (PEPAR7 = 1)
or
PE7 (I/O) (PEPAR7 = 0)
PE7 (I/O) (PEPAR7 = 0)(4)
SHS (O) (PEPAR7 = 1)
TA (I) (PEPAR6 = 1)
or
PE6 (I/O) (PEPAR6 = 0)
PE6 (I/O) (PEPAR6 = 0)(4)
TA (I) (PEPAR6 = 1)
TEA (I) (PEPAR5 = 1)
or
E PE5 (I/O) (PEPAR5 = 0)
PE5 (I/O) (PEPAR5 = 0)(4)
TEA (I) (PEPAR5 = 1)
CSE[1:0]
CSE[1:0] (O)
(PEPAR[4:3] = 1)(5)
or
PE[4:3] (I/O) (PEPAR[4:3] = 0)
PE[4:3] (I/O) (PEPAR[4:3] = 0)(4)
CSE[1:0] (O) (PEPAR[4:3] = 1)
TC[2:0]
TC[2:0] (O) (PEPAR[2:0] = 1)
or
PE[2:0] (I/O) (PEPAR[2:0] = 0)
PE[2:0] (I/O) (PEPAR[2:0] = 0)(4)
TC[2:0] (O) (PEPAR[2:0] = 1)
R/W (O)
PF7 (I/O)
R/W (O)
A[22:16] (O)
PF[6:0] (I/O)
A[22:16] (O)
SHS
(3)
TA
TEA
R/W
A[22:16]
F
A[15:8]
G A[15:8] (O)
PG[7:0] (I/O)
A[15:8] (O)
A[7:0]
H A[7:0] (O)
PH[7:0] (I/O)
A[7:0] (O)
EB[3:2] (O) (PCDPA = 1)
or
PI[7:6] (I/O) (PCDPA = 0)
PI[7:6] (I/O) (PCDPA = 0)(2)
EB[3:2] (O) (PCDPA = 1)
EB[1:0] (O)
PI[5:4] (I/O)
EB[1:0] (O)
CS[3:0] (O) (CSENx = 1)
or
PI[3:0] (I/O) (CSENx = 0)
PI[3:0] (I/O)(6)
CS[3:0] (O)(6)
EB[3:2]
EB[1:0]
CS[3:0]
I
1. Digital I/O pin function provided by port replacement unit.
2. Writing PCDPA = 1 has an undefined pin operation for D[31:16] and EB[3:2] in single-chip mode.
3. This pin functions as the reset configuration override enable (RCON) during reset.
4. Writing PEPAx = 1 has an undefined pin operation for port E pins in single-chip mode.
5. Writing PEPAx = 1 has an undefined pin operation for these port E pins in single-chip and master modes.
6. CSENx has no effect on selecting CS[3:0] pin function in single-chip or emulation modes.
Advance Information
282
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Ports Module
Interrupts
12.5.2 Port Digital I/O Timing
Input data on all pins configured as digital I/O is synchronized to the
rising edge of CLKOUT. See Figure 12-8.
CLKOUT
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
INPUT
PIN
REGISTER
PIN DATA
Figure 12-8. Digital Input Timing
Data written to PORTx of any pin configured as a digital output is
immediately driven to its respective pin. See Figure 12-9.
CLKOUT
OUTPUT DATA
REGISTER
OUTPUT PIN
Figure 12-9. Digital Output Timing
12.6 Interrupts
The ports module does not generate interrupt requests.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
283
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Ports Module
Advance Information
284
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Ports Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 13. Edge Port Module (EPORT)
13.1 Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
13.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
13.3 Low-Power Mode Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
13.3.1 Wait and Doze Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
13.3.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287
13.4
Interrupt/General-Purpose I/O Pin Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . 287
13.5 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
13.5.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
13.5.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
13.5.2.1
EPORT Pin Assignment Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
13.5.2.2
EPORT Data Direction Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
13.5.2.3
Edge Port Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
13.5.2.4
Edge Port Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
13.5.2.5
Edge Port Pin Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
13.5.2.6
Edge Port Flag Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
13.2 Introduction
The edge port module (EPORT) has eight external interrupt pins. Each
pin can be configured individually as a low level-sensitive interrupt pin,
an edge-detecting interrupt pin (rising edge, falling edge, or both), or a
general-purpose input/output (I/O) pin. See Figure 13-1.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
285
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
STOP
MODE
EPPAR[2n, 2n + 1]
EDGE DETECT
LOGIC
D0
EPFR[n]
D0
Q
D1
Q
IPBUS
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
D1
TO INTERRUPT
CONTROLLER
EPPDR[n]
SYNCHRONIZER
RISING EDGE
OF CLOCK
EPIER[n]
INTx PIN
EPDR[n]
EPDDR[n]
Figure 13-1. EPORT Block Diagram
13.3 Low-Power Mode Operation
This subsection describes the operation of the EPORT module in
low-power modes.
13.3.1 Wait and Doze Modes
In wait and doze modes, the EPORT module continues to operate
normally and may be configured to exit the low-power modes by
generating an interrupt request on either a selected edge or a low level
on an external pin.
Advance Information
286
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
Interrupt/General-Purpose I/O Pin Descriptions
13.3.2 Stop Mode
In stop mode, there are no clocks available to perform the edge-detect
function. Only the level-detect logic is active (if configured) to allow any
low level on the external interrupt pin to generate an interrupt (if enabled)
to exit stop mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
NOTE:
The input pin synchronizer is bypassed for the level-detect logic since no
clocks are available.
13.4 Interrupt/General-Purpose I/O Pin Descriptions
All pins default to general-purpose input pins at reset. The pin value is
synchronized to the rising edge of CLKOUT when read from the EPORT
Pin Data Register (EPPDR). The values used in the edge/level detect
logic are also synchronized to the rising edge of CLKOUT. These pins
use Schmitt triggered input buffers which have built in hysteresis
designed to decrease the probability of generating false edge-triggered
interrupts for slow rising and falling input signals.
13.5 Memory Map and Registers
This subsection describes the memory map and register structure.
13.5.1 Memory Map
Refer to Table 13-1 for a description of the EPORT memory map. The
EPORT has a base address of 0x00c6_0000.
Table 13-1. Edge Port Module Memory Map
Address
0x00c6_0000
Bits 15–8
Access(1)
Bits 7–0
EPORT Pin Assignment Register (EPPAR)
S
0x00c6_0002
EPORT Data Direction Register (EPDDR)
EPORT Interrupt Enable Register (EPIER)
S
0x00c6_0004
EPORT Data Register (EPDR)
EPORT Pin Data Register (EPPDR)
S/U
0x00c6_0006
EPORT Flag Register (EPFR)
Reserved
(2)
S/U
1. S = CPU supervisor mode access only. S/U = CPU supervisor or user mode access. User mode accesses to supervisor
only addresses have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
2. Writing to reserved address locations has no effect, and reading returns 0s.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
287
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
13.5.2 Registers
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The EPORT programming model consists of these registers:
•
The EPORT Pin Assignment Register (EPPAR) controls the
function of each pin individually.
•
The EPORT Data Direction Register (EPDDR) controls the
direction of each one of the pins individually.
•
The EPORT Interrupt Enable Register (EPIER) enables interrupt
requests for each pin individually.
•
The EPORT Data Register (EPDR) holds the data to be driven to
the pins.
•
The EPORT Pin Data Register (EPPDR) reflects the current state
of the pins.
•
The EPORT Flag Register (EPFR) individually latches EPORT
edge events.
13.5.2.1 EPORT Pin Assignment Register
Address: 0x00c6_0000 and 0x00c6_0001
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Read:
EPPA7
EPPA6
EPPA5
EPPA4
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
EPPA3
EPPA2
EPPA1
EPPA0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 13-2. EPORT Pin Assignment Register (EPPAR)
Advance Information
288
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
Memory Map and Registers
EPPA[7:0] — EPORT Pin Assignment Select Fields
The read/write EPPAx fields configure EPORT pins for level detection
and rising and/or falling edge detection as Table 13-2 shows.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Pins configured as level-sensitive are inverted so that a logic 0 on the
external pin represents a valid interrupt request. Level-sensitive
interrupt inputs are not latched. To guarantee that a level-sensitive
interrupt request is acknowledged, the interrupt source must keep the
signal asserted until acknowledged by software. Level sensitivity
must be selected to bring the device out of stop mode with an INTx
interrupt.
Pins configured as edge-triggered are latched and need not remain
asserted for interrupt generation. A pin configured for edge detection
is monitored regardless of its configuration as input or output.
Table 13-2. EPPAx Field Settings
EPPAx
Pin Configuration
00
Pin INTx level-sensitive
01
Pin INTx rising edge triggered
10
Pin INTx falling edge triggered
11
Pin INTx both falling edge and rising edge triggered
Interrupt requests generated in the EPORT module can be masked
by the interrupt controller module. EPPAR functionality is
independent of the selected pin direction.
Reset clears the EPPAx fields.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
289
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
13.5.2.2 EPORT Data Direction Register
Address: 0x00c6_0002
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EPDD7
EPDD6
EPDD5
EPDD4
EPDD3
EPDD2
EPDD1
EPDD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 13-3. EPORT Data Direction Register (EPDDR)
EPDD[7:0] — Edge Port Data Direction Bits
Setting any bit in the EPDDR configures the corresponding pin as an
output. Clearing any bit in EPDDR configures the corresponding pin
as an input. Pin direction is independent of the level/edge detection
configuration. Reset clears EPDD[7:0].
To use an EPORT pin as an external interrupt request source, its
corresponding bit in EPDDR must be clear. Software can generate
interrupt requests by programming the EPORT Data Register when
the EPDDR selects output.
1 = Corresponding EPORT pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding EPORT pin configured as input
Advance Information
290
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
Memory Map and Registers
13.5.2.3 Edge Port Interrupt Enable Register
Address: 0x00c6_0003
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EPIE7
EPIE6
EPIE5
EPIE4
EPIE3
EPIE2
EPIE1
EPIE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 13-4. EPORT Port Interrupt Enable Register (EPIER)
EPIE[7:0] — Edge Port Interrupt Enable Bits
The read/write EPIE[7:0] bits enable EPORT interrupt requests. If a
bit in EPIER is set, EPORT generates an interrupt request when:
•
The corresponding bit in the EPORT Flag Register (EPFR) is
set or later becomes set, or
•
The corresponding pin level is low and the pin is configured for
level-sensitive operation
Clearing a bit in EPIER negates any interrupt request from the
corresponding EPORT pin. Reset clears EPIE[7:0].
1 = Interrupt requests from corresponding EPORT pin enabled
0 = Interrupt requests from corresponding EPORT pin disabled
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
291
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
13.5.2.4 Edge Port Data Register
Address: 0x00c6_0004
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EPD7
EPD6
EPD5
EPD4
EPD3
EPD2
EPD1
EPD0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Figure 13-5. EPORT Port Data Register (EPDR)
EPD[7:0] — Edge Port Data Bits
Data written to EPDR is stored in an internal register; if any pin of the
port is configured as an output, the bit stored for that pin is driven onto
the pin. Reading EDPR returns the data stored in the register. Reset
sets EPD[7:0].
13.5.2.5 Edge Port Pin Data Register
Address: 0x00c6_0005
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EPPD7
EPPD6
EPPD5
EPPD4
EPPD3
EPPD2
EPPD1
EPPD0
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
P
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
P = Current pin state
Figure 13-6. EPORT Port Pin Data Register (EPPDR)
EPPD[7:0] — Edge Port Pin Data Bits
The read-only EPPDR reflects the current state of the EPORT pins.
Writing to EPPDR has no effect, and the write cycle terminates
normally. Reset does not affect EPPDR.
Advance Information
292
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
Memory Map and Registers
13.5.2.6 Edge Port Flag Register
Address: 0x00c6_0006
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EPF7
EPF6
EPF5
EPF4
EPF3
EPF2
EPF1
EPF0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 13-7. EPORT Port Flag Register (EPFR)
EPF[7:0] — Edge Port Flag Bits
When an EPORT pin is configured for edge triggering, its
corresponding read/write bit in EPFR indicates that the selected edge
has been detected. Reset clears EPF[7:0].
1 = Selected edge for INTx pin has been detected.
0 = Selected edge for INTx pin has not been detected.
Bits in this register are set when the selected edge is detected on the
corresponding pin. A bit remains set until cleared by writing a 1 to it.
Writing 0 has no effect. If a pin is configured as level-sensitive
(EPPARx = 00), pin transitions do not affect this register.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
293
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
Advance Information
294
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Edge Port Module (EPORT)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 14. Watchdog Timer Module
14.1 Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
14.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
14.3 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
14.3.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
14.3.2 Doze Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
14.3.3 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
14.3.4 Debug Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
14.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
14.5
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
14.6 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
14.6.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
14.6.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
14.6.2.1
Watchdog Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
14.6.2.2
Watchdog Modulus Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
14.6.2.3
Watchdog Count Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .302
14.6.2.4
Watchdog Service Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
14.2 Introduction
The watchdog timer is a 16-bit timer used to help software recover from
runaway code. The watchdog timer has a free-running down-counter
(watchdog counter) that generates a reset on underflow. To prevent a
reset, software must periodically restart the countdown by servicing the
watchdog.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Watchdog Timer Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
295
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Watchdog Timer Module
14.3 Modes of Operation
This subsection describes the operation of the watchdog timer in
low-power modes and debug mode of operation.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
14.3.1 Wait Mode
In wait mode with the WAIT bit set in the Watchdog Control Register
(WCR), watchdog timer operation stops. In wait mode with the WAIT bit
clear, the watchdog timer continues to operate normally.
14.3.2 Doze Mode
In doze mode with the DOZE bit set in WCR, watchdog timer module
operation stops. In doze mode with the DOZE bit clear, the watchdog
timer continues to operate normally.
14.3.3 Stop Mode
The watchdog operation stops in stop mode. When stop mode is exited,
the watchdog operation continues operation from the state it was in prior
to entering stop mode.
14.3.4 Debug Mode
In debug mode with the DBG bit set in WCR, watchdog timer module
operation stops. In debug mode with the DBG bit clear, the watchdog
timer continues to operate normally. When debug mode is exited,
watchdog timer operation continues from the state it was in before
entering debug mode, but any updates made in debug mode remain.
Advance Information
296
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Watchdog Timer Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Watchdog Timer Module
Block Diagram
14.4 Block Diagram
IPBUS
16-BIT WCNTR
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SYSTEM
CLOCK
DIVIDE BY
4096
16-BIT WSR
16-BIT WATCHDOG COUNTER
EN
COUNT = 0
RESET
LOAD COUNTER
WAIT
DOZE
16-BIT WMR
DBG
IPBUS
Figure 14-1. Watchdog Timer Block Diagram
14.5 Signals
The watchdog timer module has no off-chip signals.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Watchdog Timer Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
297
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Watchdog Timer Module
14.6 Memory Map and Registers
This subsection describes the memory map and registers for the
watchdog timer. The watchdog timer has a base address of
0x00c7_0000.
14.6.1 Memory Map
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Refer to Table 14-1 for an overview of the watchdog memory map.
Table 14-1. Watchdog Timer Module Memory Map
Address
Bits 15–8
Bits 7–0
Access(1)
0x00c7_0000
Watchdog Control Register (WCR)
S
0x00c7_0002
Watchdog Modulus Register (WMR)
S
0x00c7_0004
Watchdog Count Register (WCNTR)
S/U
0x00c7_0006
Watchdog Service Register (WSR)
S/U
1. S = CPU supervisor mode access only. S/U = CPU supervisor or user mode access. User
mode accesses to supervisor only addresses have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
14.6.2 Registers
The watchdog timer programming model consists of these registers:
Advance Information
298
•
The Watchdog Control Register (WCR) configures watchdog timer
operation. See 14.6.2.1 Watchdog Control Register.
•
The Watchdog Modulus Register (WMR) determines the timer
modulus reload value. See 14.6.2.2 Watchdog Modulus
Register.
•
The Watchdog Count Register (WCNTR) provides visibility to the
watchdog counter value. See 14.6.2.3 Watchdog Count
Register.
•
The Watchdog Service Register (WSR) requires a service
sequence to prevent reset. See 14.6.2.4 Watchdog Service
Register.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Watchdog Timer Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Watchdog Timer Module
Memory Map and Registers
14.6.2.1 Watchdog Control Register
The 16-bit read/write Watchdog Control Register (WCR) configures
watchdog timer operation.
Address: 0x00c7_0000 and 0x00c7_0001
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
WAIT
DOZE
DBG
EN
1
1
1
1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 14-2. Watchdog Control Register (WCR)
WAIT — Wait Mode Bit
The read-always, write-once WAIT bit controls the function of the
watchdog timer in wait mode. Once written, the WAIT bit is not
affected by further writes except in debug mode. Reset sets WAIT.
1 = Watchdog timer stopped in wait mode
0 = Watchdog timer not affected in wait mode
DOZE — Doze Mode Bit
The read-always, write-once DOZE bit controls the function of the
watchdog timer in doze mode. Once written, the DOZE bit is not
affected by further writes except in debug mode. Reset sets DOZE.
1 = Watchdog timer stopped in doze mode
0 = Watchdog timer not affected in doze mode
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Watchdog Timer Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
299
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Watchdog Timer Module
DBG — Debug Mode Bit
The read-always, write-once DBG bit controls the function of the
watchdog timer in debug mode. Once written, the DBG bit is not
affected by further writes except in debug mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
During debug mode, watchdog timer registers can be written and read
normally. When debug mode is exited, timer operation continues from
the state it was in before entering debug mode, but any updates made
in debug mode remain. If a write-once register is written for the first
time in debug mode, the register is still writable when debug mode is
exited.
1 = Watchdog timer stopped in debug mode
0 = Watchdog timer not affected in debug mode
NOTE:
Changing the DBG bit from 1 to 0 during debug mode starts the
watchdog timer. Changing the DBG bit from 0 to 1 during debug mode
stops the watchdog timer.
EN — Watchdog Enable Bit
The read-always, write-once EN bit enables the watchdog timer.
Once written, the EN bit is not affected by further writes except in
debug mode. When the watchdog timer is disabled, the watchdog
counter and prescaler counter are held in a stopped state.
1 = Watchdog timer enabled
0 = Watchdog timer disabled
Advance Information
300
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Watchdog Timer Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Watchdog Timer Module
Memory Map and Registers
14.6.2.2 Watchdog Modulus Register
Address: 0x00c7_0002 and 0x00c7_0003
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
WM15
WM14
WM13
WM12
WM11
WM10
WM9
WM8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
WM7
WM6
WM5
WM4
WM3
WM2
WM1
WM0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 14-3. Watchdog Modulus Register (WMR)
WM[15:0] — Watchdog Modulus Field
The read-always, write-once WM[15:0] field contains the modulus
that is reloaded into the watchdog counter by a service sequence.
Once written, the WM[15:0] field is not affected by further writes
except in debug mode. Writing to WMR immediately loads the new
modulus value into the watchdog counter. The new value is also used
at the next and all subsequent reloads. Reading WMR returns the
value in the modulus register.
Reset initializes the WM[15:0] field to 0xFFFF.
NOTE:
The prescaler counter is reset anytime a new value is loaded into the
watchdog counter and also during reset.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Watchdog Timer Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
301
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Watchdog Timer Module
14.6.2.3 Watchdog Count Register
Address: 0x00c7_0004 and 0x00c7_0005
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
WC15
WC14
WC13
WC12
WC11
WC10
WC9
WC8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
WC7
WC6
WC5
WC4
WC3
WC2
WC1
WC0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 14-4. Watchdog Count Register (WCNTR)
WC[15:0] — Watchdog Count Field
The read-only WC[15:0] field reflects the current value in the
watchdog counter. Reading the 16-bit WCNTR with two 8-bit reads is
not guaranteed to return a coherent value. Writing to WCNTR has no
effect, and write cycles are terminated normally.
Advance Information
302
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Watchdog Timer Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Watchdog Timer Module
Memory Map and Registers
14.6.2.4 Watchdog Service Register
When the watchdog timer is enabled, writing 0x5555 and then 0xAAAA
to the Watchdog Service Register (WSR) before the watchdog counter
times out prevents a reset. If WSR is not serviced before the timeout, the
watchdog timer sends a signal to the reset controller module which sets
the WDR bit and asserts a system reset.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Both writes must occur in the order listed before the timeout, but any
number of instructions can be executed between the two writes.
However, writing any value other than 0x5555 or 0xAAAA to WSR resets
the servicing sequence, requiring both values to be written to keep the
watchdog timer from causing a reset.
Address: 0x00c7_0006 and 0x00c7_0007
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
WS15
WS14
WS13
WS12
WS11
WS10
WS9
WS8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
WS7
WS6
WS5
WS4
WS3
WS2
WS1
WS0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 14-5. Watchdog Service Register (WSR)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Watchdog Timer Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
303
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Watchdog Timer Module
Advance Information
304
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Watchdog Timer Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 15. Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules
(PIT1 and PIT2)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
15.1 Contents
15.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
15.3
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
15.4 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
15.4.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
15.4.2 Doze Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
15.4.3 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .307
15.4.4 Debug Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
15.5
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
15.6 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
15.6.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
15.6.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
15.6.2.1
PIT Control and Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .309
15.6.2.2
PIT Modulus Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
15.6.2.3
PIT Count Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
15.7 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
15.7.1 Set-and-Forget Timer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
15.7.2 Free-Running Timer Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
15.7.3 Timeout Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
15.8
Interrupt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
305
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
15.2 Introduction
The programmable interrupt timer (PIT) is a 16-bit timer that provides
precise interrupts at regular intervals with minimal processor
intervention. The timer can either count down from the value written in
the modulus latch, or it can be a free-running down-counter.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This device has two programmable interrupt timers. PIT1 has a base
address located at 0x00c8_0000. PIT2 base address is 0x00c9_0000.
15.3 Block Diagram
IPBUS
16-BIT PCNTR
SYSTEM
CLOCK
PRESCALER
COUNT = 0
16-BIT PIT COUNTER
PIF
LOAD
COUNTER
EN
PRE[3:0]
TO INTERRUPT
CONTROLLER
PIE
OVW
RLD
PDOZE
PDBG
16-BIT PMR
IPBUS
Figure 15-1. PIT Block Diagram
Advance Information
306
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
Modes of Operation
15.4 Modes of Operation
This subsection describes the three low-power modes and the debug
mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
15.4.1 Wait Mode
In wait mode, the PIT module continues to operate normally and can be
configured to exit the low-power mode by generating an interrupt
request.
15.4.2 Doze Mode
In doze mode with the PDOZE bit set in the PIT Control and Status
Register (PCSR), PIT module operation stops. In doze mode with the
PDOZE bit clear, doze mode does not affect PIT operation. When doze
mode is exited, PIT operation continues from the state it was in before
entering doze mode.
15.4.3 Stop Mode
In stop mode, the system clock is absent, and PIT module operation
stops.
15.4.4 Debug Mode
In debug mode with the PDBG bit set in PCSR, PIT module operation
stops. In debug mode with the PDBG bit clear, debug mode does not
affect PIT operation. When debug mode is exited, PIT operation
continues from the state it was in before entering debug mode, but any
updates made in debug mode remain.
15.5 Signals
The PIT module has no off-chip signals.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
307
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
15.6 Memory Map and Registers
This subsection describes the memory map and register structure for
PIT1 and PIT2.
15.6.1 Memory Map
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Refer to Table 15-1 for a description of the memory map.
This device has two programmable interrupt timers. PIT1 has a base
address located at 0x00c8_0000. PIT2 base address is 0x00c9_0000.
Table 15-1. Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules Memory Map
PIT1
Address
PIT2
Address
0x00c8_0000
0x00c9_0000
PIT Control and Status Register (PCSR)
S
0x00c8_0002
0x00c9_0002
PIT Modulus Register (PMR)
S
0x00c8_0004
0x00c9_0004
PIT Count Register (PCNTR)
S/U
0x00c8_0006
0x00c9_0006
Unimplemented(2)
—
Bits 15–8
Bits 7–0
Access(1)
1. S = CPU supervisor mode access only. S/U = CPU supervisor or user mode access. User mode accesses to supervisor
only addresses have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
2. Accesses to unimplemented address locations have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
15.6.2 Registers
The PIT programming model consists of these registers:
Advance Information
308
•
The PIT Control and Status Register (PCSR) configures the
timer’s operation. See 15.6.2.1 PIT Control and Status Register.
•
The PIT Modulus Register (PMR) determines the timer modulus
reload value. See 15.6.2.2 PIT Modulus Register.
•
The PIT Count Register (PCNTR) provides visibility to the counter
value. See 15.6.2.3 PIT Count Register.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
Memory Map and Registers
15.6.2.1 PIT Control and Status Register
Address: PIT1 — 0x00c8_0000 and 0x00c8_0001
PIT2 — 0x00c9_0000 and 0x00c9_0001
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
0
0
0
0
11
10
9
Bit 8
PRE3
PRE2
PRE1
PRE0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PDOZE
PDBG
OVW
PIE
PIF
RLD
EN
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 15-2. PIT Control and Status Register (PCSR)
PRE[3:0] — Prescaler Bits
The read/write PRE[3:0] bits select the system clock divisor to
generate the PIT clock as Table 15-2 shows.
To accurately predict the timing of the next count, change the
PRE[3:0] bits only when the enable bit (EN) is clear. Changing the
PRE[3:0] resets the prescaler counter. System reset and the loading
of a new value into the counter also reset the prescaler counter.
Setting the EN bit and writing to PRE[3:0] can be done in this same
write cycle. Clearing the EN bit stops the prescaler counter.
PDOZE — Doze Mode Bit
The read/write PDOZE bit controls the function of the PIT in doze
mode. Reset clears PDOZE.
1 = PIT function stopped in doze mode
0 = PIT function not affected in doze mode
When doze mode is exited, timer operation continues from the state
it was in before entering doze mode.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
309
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
Table 15-2. Prescaler Select Encoding
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
PRE[3:0]
System Clock Divisor
0000
1
0001
2
0010
4
0011
8
0100
16
0101
32
0110
64
0111
128
1000
256
1001
512
1010
1,024
1011
2,048
1100
4,096
1101
8,192
1110
16,384
1111
32,768
PDBG — Debug Mode Bit
The read/write PDBG bit controls the function of the PIT in debug
mode. Reset clears PDBG.
1 = PIT function stopped in debug mode
0 = PIT function not affected in debug mode
During debug mode, register read and write accesses function
normally. When debug mode is exited, timer operation continues from
the state it was in before entering debug mode, but any updates made
in debug mode remain.
NOTE:
Advance Information
310
Changing the PDBG bit from 1 to 0 during debug mode starts the PIT
timer. Likewise, changing the PDBG bit from 0 to 1 during debug mode
stops the PIT timer.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
Memory Map and Registers
OVW — Overwrite Bit
The read/write OVW bit enables writing to PMR to immediately
overwrite the value in the PIT counter.
1 = Writing PMR immediately replaces value in PIT counter.
0 = Value in PMR replaces value in PIT counter when count
reaches 0x0000.
PIE — PIT Interrupt Enable Bit
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The read/write PIE bit enables the PIF flag to generate interrupt
requests.
1 = PIF interrupt requests enabled
0 = PIF interrupt requests disabled
PIF — PIT Interrupt Flag
The read/write PIF flag is set when the PIT counter reaches 0x0000.
Clear PIF by writing a 1 to it or by writing to PMR. Writing 0 has no
effect. Reset clears PIF.
1 = PIT count has reached 0x0000.
0 = PIT count has not reached 0x0000.
RLD — Reload Bit
The read/write RLD bit enables loading the value of PMR into the PIT
counter when the count reaches 0x0000.
1 = Counter reloaded from PMR on count of 0x0000
0 = Counter rolls over to 0xFFFF on count of 0x0000
EN — PIT Enable Bit
The read/write EN bit enables PIT operation. When the PIT is
disabled, the counter and prescaler are held in a stopped state.
1 = PIT enabled
0 = PIT disabled
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
311
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
15.6.2.2 PIT Modulus Register
The 16-bit read/write PIT Modulus Register (PMR) contains the timer
modulus value for loading into the PIT counter when the count reaches
0x0000 and the RLD bit is set.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When the OVW bit is set, PMR is transparent, and the value written to
PMR is immediately loaded into the PIT counter. The prescaler counter
is reset anytime a new value is loaded into the PIT counter and also
during reset. Reading the PMR returns the value written in the modulus
latch. Reset initializes PMR to 0xFFFF.
Address: PIT1 — 0x00c8_0002 and 0x00c8_0003
PIT2 — 0x00c9_0002 and 0x00c9_0003
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
PM15
PM14
PM13
PM12
PM11
PM10
PM9
PM8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PM7
PM6
PM5
PM4
PM3
PM2
PM1
PM0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 15-3. PIT Modulus Register (PMR)
Advance Information
312
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
Memory Map and Registers
15.6.2.3 PIT Count Register
The 16-bit, read-only PIT Control Register (PCNTR) contains the
counter value. Reading the 16-bit counter with two 8-bit reads is not
guaranteed to be coherent. Writing to PCNTR has no effect, and write
cycles are terminated normally.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: PIT1 — 0x00c8_0004 and 0x00c8_0005
PIT2 — 0x00c9_0004 and 0x00c9_0005
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
PC15
PC14
PC13
PC12
PC11
PC10
PC9
PC8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PC7
PC6
PC5
PC4
PC3
PC2
PC1
PC0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 15-4. PIT Count Register (PCNTR)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
313
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
15.7 Functional Description
This subsection describes the PIT functional operation.
15.7.1 Set-and-Forget Timer Operation
This mode of operation is selected when the RLD bit in the PCSR
register is set.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When the PIT counter reaches a count of 0x0000, the PIF flag is set in
PCSR. The value in the modulus latch is loaded into the counter, and the
counter begins decrementing toward 0x0000. If the PIE bit is set in
PCSR, the PIF flag issues an interrupt request to the CPU.
When the OVW bit is set in PCSR, the counter can be directly initialized
by writing to PMR without having to wait for the count to reach 0x0000.
PIT CLOCK
COUNTER
MODULUS
0x0002
0x0001
0x0000
0x0005
0x0005
PIF
Figure 15-5. Counter Reloading from the Modulus Latch
Advance Information
314
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
Functional Description
15.7.2 Free-Running Timer Operation
This mode of operation is selected when the RLD bit in PCSR is clear.
In this mode, the counter rolls over from 0x0000 to 0xFFFF without
reloading from the modulus latch and continues to decrement.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When the counter reaches a count of 0x0000, the PIF flag is set in
PCSR. If the PIE bit is set in PCSR, the PIF flag issues an interrupt
request to the CPU.
When the OVW bit is set in PCSR, the counter can be directly initialized
by writing to PMR without having to wait for the count to reach 0x0000.
PIT CLOCK
COUNTER
0x0002
0x0001
MODULUS
0x0000
0xFFFF
0x0005
PIF
Figure 15-6. Counter in Free-Running Mode
15.7.3 Timeout Specifications
The 16-bit PIT counter and prescaler supports different timeout periods.
The prescaler divides the system clock as selected by the PRE[3:0] bits
in PCSR. The PM[15:0] bits in PMR select the timeout period.
timeout period = PRE[3:0] × (PM[15:0] + 1) clocks
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
315
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
15.8 Interrupt Operation
Table 15-3 lists the interrupt requests generated by the PIT.
Table 15-3. PIT Interrupt Requests
Interrupt Request
Flag
Enable Bit
Timeout
PIF
PIE
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The PIF flag is set when the PIT counter reaches 0x0000. The PIE bit
enables the PIF flag to generate interrupt requests. Clear PIF by writing
a 1 to it or by writing to the PMR.
Advance Information
316
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Programmable Interrupt Timer Modules (PIT1 and PIT2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 16. Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
16.1 Contents
16.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
16.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
16.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
16.5 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
16.5.1 Supervisor and User Modes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
16.5.2 Run Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
16.5.3 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
16.5.4 Wait, Doze, and Debug Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
16.5.5 Test Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
16.6 Signal Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
16.6.1 ICOC[2:0] . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
16.6.2 ICOC3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
16.7 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
16.7.1 Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Select Register . . . 324
16.7.2 Timer Compare Force Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
16.7.3 Timer Output Compare 3 Mask Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
16.7.4 Timer Output Compare 3 Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
16.7.5 Timer Counter Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.7.6 Timer System Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329
16.7.7 Timer Toggle-On-Overflow Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330
16.7.8 Timer Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
16.7.9 Timer Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
16.7.10 Timer Interrupt Enable Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333
16.7.11 Timer System Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
16.7.12 Timer Flag Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
16.7.13 Timer Flag Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
16.7.14 Timer Channel Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
317
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.7.15
16.7.16
16.7.17
16.7.18
16.7.19
16.7.20
Pulse Accumulator Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Pulse Accumulator Flag Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
Pulse Accumulator Counter Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
Timer Port Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343
Timer Port Data Direction Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .344
Timer Test Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
16.8 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
16.8.1 Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
16.8.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
16.8.3 Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
16.8.4 Pulse Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
16.8.4.1
Event Counter Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
16.8.4.2
Gated Time Accumulation Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .348
16.8.5 General-Purpose I/O Ports. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
16.9
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
16.10 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
16.10.1 Timer Channel Interrupts (CxF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
16.10.2 Pulse Accumulator Overflow (PAOVF). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
16.10.3 Pulse Accumulator Input (PAIF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
16.10.4 Timer Overflow (TOF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 352
Advance Information
318
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Introduction
16.2 Introduction
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The MMC2114, MMC2113 and MMC2112 have two 4-channel timer
modules (TIM1 and TIM2). Each consists of a 16-bit programmable
counter driven by a 7-stage programmable prescaler. Each of the four
timer channels can be configured for input capture or output compare.
Additionally, one of the channels, channel 3, can be configured as a
pulse accumulator.
A timer overflow function allows software to extend the timing capability
of the system beyond the 16-bit range of the counter. The input capture
and output compare functions allow simultaneous input waveform
measurements and output waveform generation. The input capture
function can capture the time of a selected transition edge. The output
compare function can generate output waveforms and timer software
delays. The 16-bit pulse accumulator can operate as a simple event
counter or a gated time accumulator. The pulse accumulator shares
timer channel 3 when in event mode.
16.3 Features
Features of the timer include:
•
Four 16-bit input capture/output compare channels
•
16-bit architecture
•
Programmable prescaler
•
Pulse widths variable from microseconds to seconds
•
Single 16-bit pulse accumulator
•
Toggle-on-overflow feature for pulse-width modulator (PWM)
generation
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
319
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.4 Block Diagram
CLK[1:0]
PR[2:0]
PACLK
PACLK/256
PACLK/65536
SYSTEM
CLOCK
CHANNEL 3 OUTPUT COMPARE
MUX
PRESCALER
TCRE
CxI
TIMCNTH:TIMCNTL
CxF
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
CLEAR COUNTER
16-BIT COUNTER
TOF
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
TOI
TE
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
CHANNEL 0
16-BIT COMPARATOR
EDGE
DETECT
C0F
IOS0
CH. 0 CAPTURE
TIMC0H:TIMC0L
16-BIT LATCH
EDG0A
OM:OL0
EDG0B
TOV0
PT0
LOGIC
CH. 0 COMPARE
ICOC0
PIN
CHANNEL 1
16-BIT COMPARATOR
EDGE
DETECT
C1F
IOS1
CH. 1 CAPTURE
TIMC1H:TIMC1L
16-BIT LATCH
EDG1A
OM:OL1
EDG1B
TOV1
PT1
LOGIC
CH. 1 COMPARE
ICOC1
PIN
CHANNEL 2
CHANNEL3
16-BIT COMPARATOR
EDGE
DETECT
C3F
IOS3
TIMC3H:TIMC3L
16-BIT LATCH
EDG3A
OM:OL3
EDG3B
TOV3
PEDGE
PAOVF
TIMPACNTH:TIMPACNTL
PAE
PACLK/256
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
CH. 3 COMPARE
ICOC3
PIN
PAIF
DIVIDE-BY-64
PACLK
CH.3 CAPTURE
PA INPUT
EDGE
DETECT
MUX
16-BIT COUNTER
PACLK/65536
PT3
LOGIC
MODULE CLOCK
PAMOD
PAOVI
PAI
PAOVF
PAIF
Figure 16-1. Timer Block Diagram
Advance Information
320
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Modes of Operation
16.5 Modes of Operation
This subsection describes the supervisor and user modes, the five
low-power options, and test mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
16.5.1 Supervisor and User Modes
The SO bit in the Chip-Select Control Register determines whether the
processor is operating in user mode or supervisor mode. Accessing
supervisor address locations while not in supervisor mode causes the
timer to assert a transfer error. See Figure 21-2. Chip Select Control
Register 0 (CSCR0).
16.5.2 Run Mode
Clearing the TIMEN bit in the Timer System Control Register 1
(TIMSCR1) or the PAE bit in the Pulse Accumulator Control Register
(TIMPACTL) reduces power consumption in run mode. Timer registers
are still accessible, but all timer functions are disabled. See Figure 16-8.
Timer System Control Register (TIMSCR1) and Figure 16-19. Pulse
Accumulator Control Register (TIMPACTL).
16.5.3 Stop Mode
If the central processor unit (CPU) enters stop mode, timer operation
stops. Upon exiting stop mode, the timer resumes operation unless stop
mode was exited by reset.
16.5.4 Wait, Doze, and Debug Modes
The timer is unaffected by these low-power modes.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
321
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.5.5 Test Mode
A high signal on the TEST pin puts the processor in test mode or special
mode. The timer behaves as in user mode, except that timer test
registers are accessible.
16.6 Signal Description
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 16-1 provides an overview of the signal properties.
Table 16-1. Signal Properties
Pin
TIMPORT
Name(1) Register Bit
Function
Reset State
Pullup
ICOCx0
PORTT0
Timer x channel 0 IC/OC pin
Pin state
Active
ICOCx1
PORTT1
Timer x channel 1 IC/OC pin
Pin state
Active
ICOCx2
PORTT2
Timer x channel 2 IC/OC pin
Pin state
Active
ICOCx3
PORTT3
Timer x channel 3 IC/OC or PA pin
Pin state
Active
1. x is timer designation 1 or 2
16.6.1 ICOC[2:0]
The ICOC[2:0] pins are for channel 2–0 input capture and output
compare functions. These pins are available for general-purpose
input/output (I/O) when not configured for timer functions.
16.6.2 ICOC3
The ICOC3 pin is for channel 3 input capture and output compare
functions or for the pulse accumulator input. This pin is available for
general-purpose I/O when not configured for timer functions.
Advance Information
322
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Memory Map and Registers
16.7 Memory Map and Registers
See Table 16-2 for a memory map of the two timer modules. Timer 1 has
a base address of 0x00ce_0000. Timer 2 has a base address of
0x00cf_0000.
NOTE:
Reading reserved or unimplemented locations returns 0s. Writing to
reserved or unimplemented locations has no effect.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 16-2. Timer Modules Memory Map
Address
Bits 7–0
Access(1)
0x00cf_0000
Timer IC/OC Select Register (TIMIOS)
S
0x00ce_0001
0x00cf_0001
Timer Compare Force Register (TIMCFORC)
S
0x00ce_0002
0x00cf_0002
Timer Output Compare 3 Mask Register (TIMOC3M)
S
0x00ce_0003
0x00cf_0003
Timer Output Compare 3 Data Register (TIMOC3D)
S
0x00ce_0004
0x00cf_0004
Timer Counter Register High (TIMCNTH)
S
0x00ce_0005
0x00cf_0005
Timer Counter Register Low (TIMCNTL)
S
0x00ce_0006
0x00cf_0006
Timer System Control Register 1 (TIMSCR1)
S
0x00ce_0007
0x00cf_0007
Reserved (2)
²
0x00ce_0008
0x00cf_0008
Timer Toggle-on-Overflow Register (TMTOV)
S
0x00ce_0009
0x00cf_0009
Timer Control Register 1 (TIMCTL1)
S
0x00ce_000a
0x00cf_000a
Reserved (2)
²
0x00ce_000b
0x00cf_000b
Timer Control Register 2 (TIMCTL2)
S
0x00ce_000c
0x00cf_000c
Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIMIE)
S
0x00ce_000d
0x00cf_000d
Timer System Control Register 2 (TIMSCR2)
S
0x00ce_000e
0x00cf_000e
Timer Flag Register 1 (TIMFLG1)
S
0x00ce_000f
0x00cf_000f
Timer Flag Register 2 (TIMFLG2)
S
0x00ce_0010
0x00cf_0010
Timer Channel 0 Register High (TIMC0H)
S
0x00ce_0011
0x00cf_0011
Timer Channel 0 Register Low (TIMC0L)
S
0x00ce_0012
0x00cf_0012
Timer Channel 1 Register High (TIMC1H)
S
0x00ce_0013
0x00cf_0013
Timer Channel 1 Register Low (TIMC1L)
S
0x00ce_0014
0x00cf_0014
Timer Channel 2 Register High (TIMC2H)
S
0x00ce_0015
0x00cf_0015
Timer Channel 2 Register Low (TIMC2L)
S
0x00ce_0016
0x00cf_0016
Timer Channel 3 Register High (TIMC3H)
S
TIM1
TIM2
0x00ce_0000
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
323
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Table 16-2. Timer Modules Memory Map (Continued)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address
Bits 7–0
Access(1)
0x00cf_0017
Timer Channel 3 Register Low (TIMC3L)
S
0x00ce_0018
0x00cf_0018
Pulse Accumulator Control Register (TIMPACTL)
S
0x00ce_0019
0x00cf_0019
Pulse Accumulator Flag Register (TIMPAFLG)
S
0x00ce_001a
0x00cf_001a
Pulse Accumulator Counter Register High (TIMPACNTH)
S
0x00ce_001b
0x00cf_001b
Pulse Accumulator Counter Register Low (TIMPACNTL)
S
0x00ce_001c
0x00cf_001c
Reserved (2)
²
0x00ce_001d
0x00cf_001d
Timer Port Data Register (TIMPORT)
S
0x00ce_001e
0x00cf_001e
Timer Port Data Direction Register (TIMDDR)
S
0x00ce_001f
0x00cf_001f
Timer Test Register (TIMTST)
S
TIM1
TIM2
0x00ce_0017
1. S = CPU supervisor mode access only.
2. Writes have no effect, reads return 0s, and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
16.7.1 Timer Input Capture/Output Compare Select Register
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_0000
TIM2 — 0x00cf_0000
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
IOS3
IOS2
IOS1
IOS0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-2. Timer Input Capture/Output Compare
Select Register (TIMIOS)
Read: Anytime; always read $00
Write: Anytime
IOS[3:0] — I/O Select Bits
The IOS[3:0] bits enable input capture or output compare operation
for the corresponding timer channels.
1 = Output compare enabled
0 = Input capture enabled
Advance Information
324
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Memory Map and Registers
16.7.2 Timer Compare Force Register
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_0001
TIM2 — 0x00cf_0001
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
FOC3
FOC2
FOC1
FOC0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-3. Timer Compare Force Register (TIMCFORC)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
FOC[3:0] — Force Output Compare Bits
Setting an FOC bit causes an immediate output compare on the
corresponding channel. Forcing an output compare does not set the
output compare flag.
1 = Force output compare
0 = No effect
NOTE:
A successful channel 3 output compare overrides any channel 2:0
compares. For each OC3M bit that is set, the output compare action
reflects the corresponding OC3D bit.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
325
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.7.3 Timer Output Compare 3 Mask Register
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_0002
TIM2 — 0x00cf_0002
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
OC3M3
OC3M2
OC3M1
OC3M0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-4. Timer Output Compare 3 Mask Register (TIMOC3M)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
OC3M[3:0] — Output Compare 3 Mask Bits
Setting an OC3M bit configures the corresponding TIMPORT pin to
be an output. OC3Mx makes the timer port pin an output regardless
of the data direction bit when the pin is configured for output compare
(IOSx = 1). The OC3Mx bits do not change the state of the TIMDDR
bits.
1 = Corresponding TIMPORT pin configured as output
0 = No effect
Advance Information
326
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Memory Map and Registers
16.7.4 Timer Output Compare 3 Data Register
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_0003
TIM2 — 0x00cf_0003
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
OC3D3
OC3D2
OC3D1
OC3D0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-5. Timer Output Compare 3 Data Register (TIMOC3D)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
OC3D[3:0] — Output Compare 3 Data Bits
When a successful channel 3 output compare occurs, these bits
transfer to the Timer Port Data Register if the corresponding OC3Mx
bits are set.
NOTE:
A successful channel 3 output compare overrides any channel 2:0
compares. For each OC3M bit that is set, the output compare action
reflects the corresponding OC3D bit.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
327
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.7.5 Timer Counter Registers
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_0004
TIM2 — 0x00cf_0004
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-6. Timer Counter Register High (TIMCNTH)
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_0005
TIM2 — 0x00cf_0005
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-7. Timer Counter Register Low (TIMCNTL)
Read: Anytime
Write: Only in test (special) mode; has no effect in normal modes
To ensure coherent reading of the timer counter, such that a timer
rollover does not occur between two back-to-back 8-bit reads, it is
recommended that only half-word (16-bit) accesses be used.
A write to TIMCNT may have an extra cycle on the first count because
the write is not synchronized with the prescaler clock. The write occurs
at least one cycle before the synchronization of the prescaler clock.
Advance Information
328
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Memory Map and Registers
16.7.6 Timer System Control Register 1
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_0006
TIM2 — 0x00cf_0006
Bit 7
Read:
6
5
0
0
TIMEN
Write:
Reset:
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TFFCA
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-8. Timer System Control Register (TIMSCR1)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
TIMEN — Timer Enable Bit
TIMEN enables the timer. When the timer is disabled, only the
registers are accessible. Clearing TIMEN reduces power
consumption.
1 = Timer enabled
0 = Timer and timer counter disabled
TFFCA — Timer Fast Flag Clear All Bit
TFFCA enables fast clearing of the main timer interrupt flag registers
(TIMFLG1 and TIMFLG2) and the PA Flag Register (TIMPAFLG).
TFFCA eliminates the software overhead of a separate clear
sequence.
When TFFCA is set:
• An input capture read or a write to an output compare channel
clears the corresponding channel flag, CxF.
•
Any access of the timer count registers (TIMCNTH/L) clears the
TOF flag.
•
Any access of the PA counter registers (TIMPACNT) clears
both the PAOVF and PAIF flags in TIMPAFLG.
Writing logic 1s to the flags clears them only when TFFCA is clear.
1 = Fast flag clearing
0 = Normal flag clearing
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
329
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
WRITE TIMFLG1 REGISTER
DATA BIT x
CxF
CLEAR
CxF FLAG
TFFCA
READ TIMCx REGISTERS
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
WRITE TIMCx REGISTERS
Figure 16-9. Fast Clear Flag Logic
16.7.7 Timer Toggle-On-Overflow Register
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_0008
TIM2 — 0x00cf_0008
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
TOV3
TOV2
TOV1
TOV0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-10. Timer Toggle-On-Overflow Register (TIMTOV)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
TOV[3:0]— Toggle-On-Overflow Bits
TOV[3:0] toggles the output compare pin on overflow. This feature
only takes effect when in output compare mode. When set, it takes
precedence over forced output compare but not channel 3 override
events.
1 = Toggle output compare pin on overflow feature enabled
0 = Toggle output compare pin on overflow feature disabled
Advance Information
330
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Memory Map and Registers
16.7.8 Timer Control Register 1
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_0009
TIM2 — 0x00cf_0009
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
OM3
OL3
OM2
OL2
OM1
OL1
OM0
OL0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 16-11. Timer Control Register 1 (TIMCTL1)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
OMx/OLx — Output Mode/Output Level Bits
These bit pairs select the output action to be taken as a result of a
successful output compare. When either OMx or OLx is set and the
IOSx bit is set, the pin is an output regardless of the state of the
corresponding DDR bit.
Table 16-3. Output Compare Action Selection
OMx:OLx
Action on Output Compare
00
Timer disconnected from output pin logic
01
Toggle OCx output line
10
Clear OCx output line
11
Set OCx line
Channel 3 shares a pin with the pulse accumulator input pin. To use
the PAI input, clear both the OM3 and OL3 bits and clear the OC3M3
bit in the Output Compare 3 Mask Register.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
331
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.7.9 Timer Control Register 2
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_000b
TIM2 — 0x00cf_000b
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
EDG3B
EDG3A
EDG2B
EDG2A
EDG1B
EDG1A
EDG0B
EDG10
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 16-12. Timer Control Register 2 (TIMCTL2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
EDGx[B:A] — Input Capture Edge Control Bits
These eight bit pairs configure the input capture edge detector
circuits.
Table 16-4. Input Capture Edge Selection
EDGx[B:A]
Advance Information
332
Edge Selection
00
Input capture disabled
01
Input capture on rising edges only
10
Input capture on falling edges only
11
Input capture on any edge (rising or falling)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Memory Map and Registers
16.7.10 Timer Interrupt Enable Register
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_000c
TIM2 — 0x00cf_000c
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
C3I
C2I
C1I
C0I
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-13. Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIMIE)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
C[3:0]I — Channel Interrupt Enable Bits
C[3:0]I enable the C[3:0]F flags in Timer Flag Register 1 to generate
interrupt requests.
1 = Corresponding channel interrupt requests enabled
0 = Corresponding channel interrupt requests disabled
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
333
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.7.11 Timer System Control Register 2
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_000d
TIM2 — 0x00cf_000d
Bit 7
6
Read:
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PUPT
RDPT
TCRE
PR2
PR1
PR0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TOI
Write:
Reset:
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-14. Timer System Control Register 2 (TIMSCR2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
TOI — Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
TOI enables timer overflow interrupt requests.
1 = Overflow interrupt requests enabled
0 = Overflow interrupt requests disabled
PUPT — Timer Pullup Enable Bit
PUPT enables pullup resistors on the timer ports when the ports are
configured as inputs.
1 = Pullup resistors enabled
0 = Pullup resistors disabled
RDPT — Timer Drive Reduction Bit
RDPT reduces the output driver size.
1 = Output drive reduction enabled
0 = Output drive reduction disabled
TCRE — Timer Counter Reset Enable Bit
TCRE enables a counter reset after a channel 3 compare.
1 = Counter reset enabled
0 = Counter reset disabled
NOTE:
Advance Information
334
When the timer channel 3 registers contain $0000 and TCRE is set, the
timer counter registers remain at $0000 all the time.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Memory Map and Registers
When the timer channel 3 registers contain $FFFF and TCRE is set,
TOF never gets set even though the timer counter registers go from
$FFFF to $0000.
PR[2:0] — Prescaler Bits
These bits select the prescaler divisor for the timer counter.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 16-5. Prescaler Selection
NOTE:
PR[2:0]
Prescaler Divisor
000
1
001
2
010
4
011
8
100
16
101
32
110
64
111
128
The newly selected prescaled clock does not take effect until the next
synchronized edge of the prescaled clock when the clock count
transitions to $0000.)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
335
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.7.12 Timer Flag Register 1
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_000e
TIM2 — 0x00cf_000e
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
C3F
C2F
C1F
C0F
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-15. Timer Flag Register 1 (TIMFLG1)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime; writing 1 clears flag; writing 0 has no effect
C[3:0]F — Channel Flags
A channel flag is set when an input capture or output compare event
occurs. Clear a channel flag by writing a 1 to the flag.
NOTE:
When the fast flag clear all bit, TFFCA, is set, an input capture read or
an output compare write clears the corresponding channel flag. TFFCA
is in timer System Control Register 1 (TIMSCR1).
When a channel flag is set, it does not inhibit subsequent output
compares or input captures.
Advance Information
336
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Memory Map and Registers
16.7.13 Timer Flag Register 2
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_000f
TIM2 — 0x00cf_000f
Bit 7
Read:
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TOF
Write:
Reset:
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-16. Timer Flag Register 2 (TIMFLG2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime; writing 1 clears flag; writing 0 has no effect
TOF — Timer Overflow Flag
TOF is set when the timer counter rolls over from $FFFF to $0000. If
the TOI bit in TIMSCR2 is also set, TOF generates an interrupt
request. Clear TOF by writing a 1 to it.
1 = Timer overflow
0 = No timer overflow
NOTE:
When the timer channel 3 registers contain $FFFF and TCRE is set,
TOF never gets set even though the timer counter registers go from
$FFFF to $0000.
When the fast flag clear all bit, TFFCA, is set, any access to the timer
counter registers clears Timer Flag Register 2. The TFFCA bit is in timer
System Control Register 1 (TIMSCR1).
When TOF is set, it does not inhibit subsequent overflow events.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
337
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.7.14 Timer Channel Registers
Address: TIMC0H — 0x00ce_0010/0x00cf_0010
TIMC1H — 0x00ce_0012/0x00cf_0012
TIMC2H — 0x00ce_0014/0x00cf_0014
TIMC3H — 0x00ce_0016/0x00cf_0016
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Figure 16-17. Timer Channel [0:3] Register High (TIMCxH)
Address: TIMC0L — 0x00ce_0011/0x00cf_0011
TIMC1L — 0x00ce_0013/0x00cf_0013
TIMC2L — 0x00ce_0015/0x00cf_0015
TIMC3L — 0x00ce_0017/0x00cf_0017
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 16-18. Timer Channel [0:3] Register Low (TIMCxL)
Read: Anytime
Write: Output compare channel, anytime; input capture channel, no
effect
When a channel is configured for input capture (IOSx = 0), the timer
channel registers latch the value of the free-running counter when a
defined transition occurs on the corresponding input capture pin.
When a channel is configured for output compare (IOSx = 1), the timer
channel registers contain the output compare value.
To ensure coherent reading of the timer counter, such that a timer
rollover does not occur between back-to-back 8-bit reads, it is
recommended that only half-word (16-bit) accesses be used.
Advance Information
338
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Memory Map and Registers
16.7.15 Pulse Accumulator Control Register
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_0018
TIM2 — 0x00cf_0018
Bit 7
Read:
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PAE
PAMOD
PEDGE
CLK1
CLK0
PAOVI
PAI
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-19. Pulse Accumulator Control Register (TIMPACTL)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
PAE — Pulse Accumulator Enable Bit
PAE enables the pulse accumulator.
1 = Pulse accumulator enabled
0 = Pulse accumulator disabled
NOTE:
The pulse accumulator can operate in event mode even when the timer
enable bit, TIMEN, is clear.
PAMOD — Pulse Accumulator Mode Bit
PAMOD selects event counter mode or gated time accumulation
mode.
1 = Gated time accumulation mode
0 = Event counter mode
PEDGE — Pulse Accumulator Edge Bit
PEDGE selects falling or rising edges on the PAI pin to increment the
counter.
In event counter mode (PAMOD = 0):
1 = Rising PAI edge increments counter
0 = Falling PAI edge increments counter
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
339
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
In gated time accumulation mode (PAMOD = 1):
1 = Low PAI input enables divide-by-64 clock to pulse accumulator
and trailing rising edge on PAI sets PAIF flag.
0 = High PAI input enables divide-by-64 clock to pulse accumulator
and trailing falling edge on PAI sets PAIF flag.
NOTE:
The timer prescaler generates the divide-by-64 clock. If the timer is not
active, there is no divide-by-64 clock.
To operate in gated time accumulation mode:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
1. Apply logic 0 to RESET pin.
2. Initialize registers for pulse accumulator mode test.
3. Apply appropriate level to PAI pin.
4. Enable timer.
CLK[1:0] — Clock Select Bits
CLK[1:0] select the timer counter input clock as shown in Table 16-6.
Table 16-6. Clock Selection
CLK[1:0]
Timer Counter Clock(1)
00
Timer prescaler clock(2)
01
PACLK
10
PACLK/256
11
PACLK/65536
1. Changing the CLKx bits causes an immediate change in the timer counter clock input.
2. When PAE = 0, the timer prescaler clock is always the timer counter clock.
PAOVI — Pulse Accumulator Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
PAOVI enables the PAOVF flag to generate interrupt requests.
1 = PAOVF interrupt requests enabled
0 = PAOVF interrupt requests disabled
PAI — Pulse Accumulator Input Interrupt Enable Bit
PAI enables the PAIF flag to generate interrupt requests.
1 = PAIF interrupt requests enabled
0 = PAIF interrupt requests disabled
Advance Information
340
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Memory Map and Registers
16.7.16 Pulse Accumulator Flag Register
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_0019
TIM2 — 0x00cf_0019
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
Bit 0
PAOVF
PAIF
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-20. Pulse Accumulator Flag Register (TIMPAFLG)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime; writing 1 clears the flag; writing 0 has no effect
PAOVF — Pulse Accumulator Overflow Flag
PAOVF is set when the 16-bit pulse accumulator rolls over from
$FFFF to $0000. If the PAOVI bit in TIMPACTL is also set, PAOVF
generates an interrupt request. Clear PAOVF by writing a 1 to it.
1 = Pulse accumulator overflow
0 = No pulse accumulator overflow
PAIF — Pulse Accumulator Input Flag
PAIF is set when the selected edge is detected at the PAI pin. In event
counter mode, the event edge sets PAIF. In gated time accumulation
mode, the trailing edge of the gate signal at the PAI pin sets PAIF. If
the PAI bit in TIMPACTL is also set, PAIF generates an interrupt
request. Clear PAIF by writing a 1 to it.
1 = Active PAI input
0 = No active PAI input
NOTE:
When the fast flag clear all enable bit, TFFCA, is set, any access to the
pulse accumulator counter registers clears all the flags in TIMPAFLG.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
341
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.7.17 Pulse Accumulator Counter Registers
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_001a
TIM2 — 0x00cf_001a
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 16-21. Pulse Accumulator Counter Register High
(TIMPACNTH)
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_001b
TIM2 — 0x00cf_001b
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 16-22. Pulse Accumulator Counter Register Low
(TIMPACNTL)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
These registers contain the number of active input edges on the PAI pin
since the last reset.
NOTE:
Reading the pulse accumulator counter registers immediately after an
active edge on the PAI pin may miss the last count since the input first
has to be synchronized with the bus clock.
To ensure coherent reading of the PA counter, such that the counter
does not increment between back-to-back 8-bit reads, it is
recommended that only half-word (16-bit) accesses be used.
Advance Information
342
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Memory Map and Registers
16.7.18 Timer Port Data Register
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_001d
TIM2 — 0x00cf_001d
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
PORTT3
PORTT2
PORTT1
PORTT0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-23. Timer Port Data Register (TIMPORT)
Read: Anytime; read pin state when corresponding TIMDDR bit is 0;
read pin driver state when corresponding TIMDDR bit is 1
Write: Anytime
PORTT[3:0] — Timer Port Input Capture/Output Compare Data Bits
Data written to TIMPORT is buffered and drives the pins only when
they are configured as general-purpose outputs.
Reading an input (DDR bit = 0) reads the pin state; reading an output
(DDR bit = 1) reads the latch.
Writing to a pin configured as a timer output does not change the pin
state.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
343
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.7.19 Timer Port Data Direction Register
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_001e
TIM2 — 0x00cf_001e
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRT3
DDRT2
DDRT1
DDRT0
0
0
0
0
IC/OC3
IC/OC2
IC/OC1
IC/OC0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Timer function:
Pulse accumulator function:
0
0
PAI
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-24. Timer Port Data Direction Register (TIMDDR)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
DDRT[3:0] — TIMPORT Data Direction Bits
These bits control the port logic of TIMPORT. Reset clears the Timer
Port Data Direction Register, configuring all timer port pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding pin configured as input
Advance Information
344
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Functional Description
16.7.20 Timer Test Register
The Timer Test Register (TIMTST) is only for factory testing. When not
in test mode, TIMTST is read-only.
Address: TIM1 — 0x00ce_001f
TIM2 — 0x00cf_001f
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 16-25. Timer Test Register (TIMTST)
16.8 Functional Description
The timer module is a 16-bit, 4-channel timer with input capture and
output compare functions and a pulse accumulator.
16.8.1 Prescaler
The prescaler divides the module clock by 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, or 128.
The PR[2:0] bits in TIMSCR2 select the prescaler divisor.
16.8.2 Input Capture
Clearing an I/O select bit, IOSx, configures channel x as an input capture
channel. The input capture function captures the time at which an
external event occurs. When an active edge occurs on the pin of an input
capture channel, the timer transfers the value in the timer counter into
the timer channel registers, TIMCxH and TIMCxL.
The minimum pulse width for the input capture input is greater than two
module clocks.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
345
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
The input capture function does not force data direction. The Timer Port
Data Direction Register controls the data direction of an input capture
pin. Pin conditions such as rising or falling edges can trigger an input
capture only on a pin configured as an input.
An input capture on channel x sets the CxF flag. The CxI bit enables the
CxF flag to generate interrupt requests.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
16.8.3 Output Compare
Setting an I/O select bit, IOSx, configures channel x as an output
compare channel. The output compare function can generate a periodic
pulse with a programmable polarity, duration, and frequency. When the
timer counter reaches the value in the channel registers of an output
compare channel, the timer can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin. An
output compare on channel x sets the CxF flag. The CxI bit enables the
CxF flag to generate interrupt requests.
The output mode and level bits, OMx and OLx, select, set, clear, or
toggle on output compare. Clearing both OMx and OLx disconnects the
pin from the output logic.
Setting a force output compare bit, FOCx, causes an output compare on
channel x. A forced output compare does not set the channel flag.
A successful output compare on channel 3 overrides output compares
on all other output compare channels. A channel 3 output compare can
cause bits in the Output Compare 3 Data Register to transfer to the
Timer Port Data Register, depending on the Output Compare 3 Mask
Register. The Output Compare 3 Mask Register masks the bits in the
Output Compare 3 Data Register. The timer counter reset enable bit,
TCRE, enables channel 3 output compares to reset the timer counter. A
channel 3 output compare can reset the timer counter even if the
OC3/PAI pin is being used as the pulse accumulator input.
An output compare overrides the data direction bit of the output compare
pin but does not change the state of the data direction bit.
Advance Information
346
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Functional Description
Writing to the timer port bit of an output compare pin does not affect the
pin state. The value written is stored in an internal latch. When the pin
becomes available for general-purpose output, the last value written to
the bit appears at the pin.
16.8.4 Pulse Accumulator
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The pulse accumulator (PA) is a 16-bit counter that can operate in two
modes:
1. Event counter mode — Counts edges of selected polarity on the
pulse accumulator input pin, PAI
2. Gated time accumulation mode — Counts pulses from a
divide-by-64 clock
The PA mode bit, PAMOD, selects the mode of operation.
The minimum pulse width for the PAI input is greater than two module
clocks.
16.8.4.1 Event Counter Mode
Clearing the PAMOD bit configures the PA for event counter operation.
An active edge on the PAI pin increments the PA. The PA edge bit,
PEDGE, selects falling edges or rising edges to increment the PA.
An active edge on the PAI pin sets the PA input flag, PAIF. The PA input
interrupt enable bit, PAI, enables the PAIF flag to generate interrupt
requests.
NOTE:
The PAI input and timer channel 3 use the same pin. To use the PAI
input, disconnect it from the output logic by clearing the channel 3 output
mode and output level bits, OM3 and OL3. Also clear the channel 3
output compare 3 mask bit, OC3M3.
The PA counter registers, TIMPACNTH/L, reflect the number of active
input edges on the PAI pin since the last reset.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
347
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
The PA overflow flag, PAOVF, is set when the PA rolls over from $FFFF
to $0000. The PA overflow interrupt enable bit, PAOVI, enables the
PAOVF flag to generate interrupt requests.
NOTE:
The PA can operate in event counter mode even when the timer enable
bit, TIMEN, is clear.
16.8.4.2 Gated Time Accumulation Mode
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Setting the PAMOD bit configures the PA for gated time accumulation
operation. An active level on the PAI pin enables a divide-by-64 clock to
drive the PA. The PA edge bit, PEDGE, selects low levels or high levels
to enable the divide-by-64 clock.
The trailing edge of the active level at the PAI pin sets the PA input flag,
PAIF. The PA input interrupt enable bit, PAI, enables the PAIF flag to
generate interrupt requests.
NOTE:
The PAI input and timer channel 3 use the same pin. To use the PAI
input, disconnect it from the output logic by clearing the channel 3 output
mode and output level bits, OM3 and OL3. Also clear the channel 3
output compare mask bit, OC3M3.
The PA counter registers, TIMPACNTH/L reflect the number of pulses
from the divide-by-64 clock since the last reset.
NOTE:
The timer prescaler generates the divide-by-64 clock. If the timer is not
active, there is no divide-by-64 clock.
PULSE
ACCUMULATOR
PAD
CHANNEL 3 OUTPUT COMPARE
OM3
OL3
OC3M3
Figure 16-26. Channel 3 Output Compare/Pulse Accumulator Logic
Advance Information
348
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Functional Description
16.8.5 General-Purpose I/O Ports
An I/O pin used by the timer defaults to general-purpose I/O unless an
internal function which uses that pin is enabled.
The timer pins can be configured for either an input capture function or
an output compare function. The IOSx bits in the Timer IC/OC Select
Register configure the timer port pins as either input capture or output
compare pins.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The Timer Port Data Direction Register controls the data direction of an
input capture pin. External pin conditions trigger input captures on input
capture pins configured as inputs.
To configure a pin for input capture:
1. Clear the pin’s IOS bit in TIMIOS.
2. Clear the pin’s DDR bit in TIMDDR.
3. Write to TIMCTL2 to select the input edge to detect.
TIMDDR does not affect the data direction of an output compare pin. The
output compare function overrides the Data Direction Register but does
not affect the state of the Data Direction Register.
To configure a pin for output compare:
1. Set the pin’s IOS bit in TIMIOS.
2. Write the output compare value to TIMCxH/L.
3. Clear the pin’s DDR bit in TIMDDR.
4. Write to the OMx/OLx bits in TIMCTL1 to select the output action.
Table 16-7 shows how various timer settings affect pin functionality.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
349
350
Advance Information
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1 (OC)
0
0
0
0
0
0 (IC)
X(4)
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
<> 0
<> 0
0
0(5)
X(3)
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
X
X
Out
Out
Out
Out
Out
In
Out
In
Out
In
Out
In
Out
In
Pin
OMx/
(3)
Data
(2) OC3Mx
OLx
Direction
<> 0
<> 0
<> 0
<> 0
X
0 (IC
disabled)
0
X
EDGx
[B:A]
Digital output
Digital input
Digital output
Digital output
IC and
digital input
Digital output
IC and
digital input
Digital input
Digital output
Digital input
Pin
Function
OC3M setting has no effect because IOS = 0;
input capture of data driven to output pin by CPU
Output compare takes place but does not affect
the pin because of the OMx/OLx setting
Output compare takes place but does not affect
the pin because of the OMx/OLx setting
OC3M setting has no effect because IOS = 0
Input capture of data driven to output pin by CPU
Normal settings for input capture
Input capture disabled by EDGx setting
Input capture disabled by EDGx setting
Timer disabled by TIMEN = 0
Timer disabled by TIMEN = 0
Comments
OC action Output compare Pin driven by OC action(5)
OC
Output compare
action/
Pin readable only if DDR = 0(6)
(ch 3)
OC3Dx
Output
OC
Pin driven by channel OC action and OC3Dx via
compare/
action/
OC3Dx
channel 3 OC(6)
OC3Dx
(ch 3)
OC action Output compare Pin readable only if DDR = 0(5)
Data reg.
Ext.
Data reg.
Ext.
Data reg.
Ext.
Data reg.
Ext.
Data reg.
Ext.
Pin
Driven
by
1. When DDR set the pin as input (0), reading the data register will return the state of the pin. When DDR set the pin as output (1), reading the data
register will return the content of the data latch. Pin conditions such as rising or falling edges can trigger an input capture on a pin configured as an
input.
2. OMx/OLx bit pairs select the output action to be taken as a result of a successful output compare. When either OMx or OLx is set and the IOSx bit is
set, the pin is an output regardless of the state of the corresponding DDR bit.
3. Setting an OC3M bit configures the corresponding TIMPORT pin to be output. OC3Mx makes the timer port pin an output regardless of the data
direction bit when the pin is configured for output compare (IOSx = 1). The OC3Mx bits do not change the state of the TIMDDR bits.
4. X = Don’t care
5. An output compare overrides the data direction bit of the output compare pin but does not change the state of the data direction bit. Enabling output
compare disables data register drive of the pin.
6. A successful output compare on channel 3 causes an output value determined by OC3Dx value to temporarily override the output compare pin state
of any other output compare channel.The next OC action for the specific channel will still be output to the pin. A channel 3 output compare can cause
bits in the output compare 3 data register to transfer to the timer port data register, depending on the output compare 3 mask register.
0
0
TIMEN DDR(1) TIMIOS
Table 16-7. Timer Settings and Pin Functions
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
Reset
16.9 Reset
Reset initializes the timer registers to a known startup state as described
in 16.7 Memory Map and Registers.
16.10 Interrupts
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 16-8 lists the interrupt requests generated by the timer.
Table 16-8. Timer Interrupt Requests
Interrupt Request
Flag
Enable Bit
Channel 3 IC/OC
C3F
C3I
Channel 2 IC/OC
C2F
C2I
Channel 1 IC/OC
C1F
C1I
Channel 0 IC/OC
C0F
C0I
PAOVF
PAOVI
PA input
PAIF
PAI
Timer overflow
TOF
TOI
PA overflow
16.10.1 Timer Channel Interrupts (CxF)
A channel flag is set when an input capture or output compare event
occurs. Clear a channel flag by writing a 1 to the flag.
NOTE:
When the fast flag clear all bit, TFFCA, is set, an input capture read or
an output compare write clears the corresponding channel flag. TFFCA
is in Timer System Control Register 1 (TIMSCR1).
When a channel flag is set, it does not inhibit subsequent output
compares or input captures
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
351
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
16.10.2 Pulse Accumulator Overflow (PAOVF)
PAOVF is set when the 16-bit pulse accumulator rolls over from $FFFF
to $0000. If the PAOVI bit in TIMPACTL is also set, PAOVF generates
an interrupt request. Clear PAOVF by writing a 1 to this flag.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
NOTE:
When the fast flag clear all enable bit, TFFCA, is set, any access to the
pulse accumulator counter registers clears all the flags in TIMPAFLG.
16.10.3 Pulse Accumulator Input (PAIF)
PAIF is set when the selected edge is detected at the PAI pin. In event
counter mode, the event edge sets PAIF. In gated time accumulation
mode, the trailing edge of the gate signal at the PAI pin sets PAIF. If the
PAI bit in TIMPACTL is also set, PAIF generates an interrupt request.
Clear PAIF by writing a 1 to this flag.
NOTE:
When the fast flag clear all enable bit, TFFCA, is set, any access to the
pulse accumulator counter registers clears all the flags in TIMPAFLG.
16.10.4 Timer Overflow (TOF)
TOF is set when the timer counter rolls over from $FFFF to $0000. If the
TOI bit in TIMSCR2 is also set, TOF generates an interrupt request.
Clear TOF by writing a 1 to this flag.
NOTE:
When the timer channel 3 registers contain $FFFF and TCRE is set,
TOF never gets set even though the timer counter registers go from
$FFFF to $0000.
When the fast flag clear all bit, TFFCA, is set, any access to the timer
counter registers clears Timer Flag Register 2. The TFFCA bit is in Timer
System Control Register 1 (TIMSCR1).
When TOF is set, it does not inhibit future overflow events.
Advance Information
352
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Timer Modules (TIM1 and TIM2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 17. Serial Communications Interface Modules
(SCI1 and SCI2)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
17.1 Contents
17.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354
17.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355
17.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
17.5 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
17.5.1 Doze Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
17.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .357
17.6 Signal Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
17.6.1 RXD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
17.6.2 TXD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
17.7 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358
17.7.1 SCI Baud Rate Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 360
17.7.2 SCI Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .361
17.7.3 SCI Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
17.7.4 SCI Status Register 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366
17.7.5 SCI Status Register 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369
17.7.6 SCI Data Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370
17.7.7 SCI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371
17.7.8 SCI Port Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .372
17.7.9 SCI Data Direction Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 373
17.8
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374
17.9
Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374
17.10 Baud Rate Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375
17.11 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376
17.11.1 Frame Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377
17.11.2 Transmitting a Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
353
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
17.11.3 Break Frames. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380
17.11.4 Idle Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380
17.12 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
17.12.1 Frame Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
17.12.2 Receiving a Frame . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
17.12.3 Data Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
17.12.4 Framing Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
17.12.5 Baud Rate Tolerance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
17.12.5.1 Slow Data Tolerance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388
17.12.5.2
Fast Data Tolerance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389
17.12.6 Receiver Wakeup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390
17.12.6.1 Idle Input Line Wakeup (WAKE = 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390
17.12.6.2 Address Mark Wakeup (WAKE = 1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391
17.13 Single-Wire Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 392
17.14 Loop Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 393
17.15 I/O Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394
17.16 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
17.17 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
17.17.1 Transmit Data Register Empty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
17.17.2 Transmission Complete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395
17.17.3 Receive Data Register Full. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
17.17.4 Idle Receiver Input . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
17.17.5 Overrun . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396
17.2 Introduction
The serial communications interface (SCI) allows asynchronous serial
communications with peripheral devices and other microcontroller units
(MCU).
The MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112 have two identical SCI
modules, each with its own control registers and input/output (I/O) pins.
In the text that follows, SCI register names are denoted generically.
Thus, SCIPORT refers interchangeably to SCI1PORT and SCI2PORT,
the port data registers for SCI1 and SCI2, respectively.
Advance Information
354
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Features
17.3 Features
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Features of each SCI module include:
•
Full-duplex operation
•
Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format
•
13-bit baud rate selection
•
Programmable 8-bit or 9-bit data format
•
Separately enabled transmitter and receiver
•
Separate receiver and transmitter central processor unit (CPU)
interrupt requests
•
Programmable transmitter output polarity
•
Two receiver wakeup methods:
– Idle line wakeup
– Address mark wakeup
•
Interrupt-driven operation with eight flags:
– Transmitter empty
– Transmission complete
– Receiver full
– Idle receiver input
– Receiver overrun
– Noise error
– Framing error
– Parity error
•
Receiver framing error detection
•
Hardware parity checking
•
1/16 bit-time noise detection
•
General-purpose, I/O capability
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
355
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.4 Block Diagram
IPBUS
SCI DATA
REGISTER
RAF
R8
FE
IDLE
PF
RDRF
NF
OR
RECEIVE
SHIFT REGISTER
RXD
PIN
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SCBR[12:0]
RE
SYSTEM
CLOCK
RECEIVE
AND WAKEUP
CONTROL
BAUD RATE
GENERATOR
ILIE
IDLE
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
RDRF/OR
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
RIE
RWU
LOOPS
RSRC
÷16
M
WAKE
DATA FORMAT
CONTROL
ILT
PE
PT
TE
TRANSMIT
CONTROL
LOOPS
SBK
RSRC
TIE
TDRE
TXD
PIN
TRANSMIT
SHIFT REGISTER
TC
T8
TCIE
TDRE
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
TC
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
SCI DATA
REGISTER
IPBUS
Figure 17-1. SCI Block Diagram
Advance Information
356
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Modes of Operation
17.5 Modes of Operation
SCI operation is identical in run, special, and emulation modes. The SCI
has two low-power modes, doze and stop.
NOTE:
Run mode is the normal mode of operation and the WAIT instruction
does not affect SCI operation.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
17.5.1 Doze Mode
When the SCIDOZ bit in the SCI Pullup and Reduced Drive (SCIPURD)
Register is set, the DOZE instruction stops the SCI clock and puts the
SCI in a low-power state. The DOZE instruction does not affect SCI
register states. Any transmission or reception in progress stops at doze
mode entry and resumes when an internal or external interrupt request
brings the CPU out of doze mode. Exiting doze mode by reset aborts any
transmission or reception in progress and resets the SCI. See 17.7.7
SCI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register.
When the SCIDOZ bit is clear, execution of the DOZE instruction has no
effect on the SCI. Normal module operation continues, allowing any SCI
interrupt to bring the CPU out of doze mode.
17.5.2 Stop Mode
The STOP instruction stops the SCI clock and puts the SCI in a
low-power state. The STOP instruction does not affect SCI register
states. Any transmission or reception in progress halts at stop mode
entry and resumes when an external interrupt request brings the CPU
out of stop mode. Exiting stop mode by reset aborts any transmission or
reception in progress and resets the SCI.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
357
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.6 Signal Description
Table 17-1 gives an overview of the signals which are described here.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 17-1. Signal Properties
Name
Function
Port
Reset
State
Default
Pullup
State
RXD
Receive data pin
SCIPORT0
0
Disabled
TXD
Transmit data pin
SCIPORT1
0
Disabled
17.6.1 RXD
RXD is the SCI receiver pin. RXD is available for general-purpose I/O
when it is not configured for receiver operation.
17.6.2 TXD
TXD is the SCI transmitter pin. TXD is available for general-purpose I/O
when it is not configured for transmitter operation.
17.7 Memory Map and Registers
Table 17-1 shows the SCI memory map.
NOTE:
Advance Information
358
Reading unimplemented addresses (0x00cc_000b through
0x00cc_000f) returns 0s. Writing to unimplemented addresses has no
effect. Accessing unimplemented addresses does not generate an error
response.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Memory Map and Registers
Table 17-2. Serial Communications Interface Module Memory Map(1)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address
Bits 7–0
Access(2)
0x00cd_0000
SCI Baud Register High (SCIBDH)
S/U
0x00cc_0001
0x00cd_0001
SCI Baud Register Low (SCIBDL)
S/U
0x00cc_0002
0x00cd_0002
SCI Control Register 1 (SCICR1)
S/U
0x00cc_0003
0x00cd_0003
SCI Control Register 2 (SCICR2)
S/U
0x00cc_0004
0x00cd_0004
SCI Status Register 1 (SCISR1)
S/U
0x00cc_0005
0x00cd_0005
SCI Status Register 2 (SCISR2)
S/U
0x00cc_0006
0x00cd_0006
SCI Data Register High (SCIDRH)
S/U
0x00cc_0007
0x00cd_0007
SCI Data Register Low (SCIDRL)
S/U
0x00cc_0008
0x00cd_0008
SCI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register (SCIPURD)
S/U
0x00cc_0009
0x00cd_0009
SCI Port Data Register (SCIPORT)
S/U
0x00cc_000a
0x00cd_000a
SCI Data Direction Register (SCIDDR)
S/U
0x00cc_000b
to
0x00cc_000f
0x00cd_000b
to
0x00cd_000f
Reserved(3)
S/U
SCI1
SCI2
0x00cc_0000
1. Each module is assigned 64 Kbytes of address space, all of which may not be decoded. Accesses outside of the specified
module memory map generate a bus error exception.
2. S/U = CPU supervisor or user mode access. User mode accesses to supervisor only addresses have no effect and result
in a cycle termination transfer error.
3. Within the specified module memory map, accessing reserved addresses does not generate a bus error exception. Reads
of reserved addresses return 0s and writes have no effect.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
359
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.7.1 SCI Baud Rate Registers
Address: SCI1 — 0x00cc_0000
SCI2 — 0x00cd_0000
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
0
0
0
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SBR12
SBR11
SBR10
SBR9
SBR8
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 17-2. SCI Baud Rate Register High (SCIBDH)
Address: SCI1 — 0x00cc_0001
SCI2 — 0x00cd_0001
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SBR7
SBR6
SBR5
SBR4
SBR3
SBR2
SBR1
SBR0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Write:
Reset:
Figure 17-3. SCI Baud Rate Register Low (SCIBDL)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
SBR[12:8], SBR[7:0] — SCI Baud Rate Bits
These read/write bits control the SCI baud rate:
SCI baud rate =
fsys
16 x SBR[12:0]
where:
1 ≤ SBR[12:0] ≤ 8191
NOTE:
The baud rate generator is disabled until the TE bit or the RE bit in
SCICR2 is set for the first time after reset. The baud rate generator is
disabled when SBR[12:0] = 0.
Writing to SCIBDH has no effect without also writing to SCIBDL. Writing
to SCIBDH puts the data in a temporary location until data is written to
SCIBDL.
Advance Information
360
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Memory Map and Registers
17.7.2 SCI Control Register 1
Address: SCI1 — 0x00cc_0002
SCI2 — 0x00cd_0002
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
LOOPS
WOMS
RSRC
M
WAKE
ILT
PE
PT
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 17-4. SCI Control Register 1 (SCICR1)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
LOOPS — Loop Select Bit
This read/write control bit switches the SCI between normal mode
and loop mode. Reset clears LOOPS.
1 = Loop mode SCI operation
0 = Normal mode SCI operation
The SCI operates normally (LOOPS = 0, RSRC = X) when the output
of its transmitter is connected to the TXD pin, and the input of its
receiver is connected to the RXD pin.
In loop mode (LOOPS =1, RSRC = 0), the input to the SCI receiver is
internally disconnected from the RXD pin logic and instead connected
to the output of the SCI transmitter. The behavior of TXD is governed
by the DDRSC1 bit in SCIDDR. If DDRSC1 = 1, the TXD pin is driven
with the output of the SCI transmitter. If DDRSC1 = 0, the TXD pin
idles high. See 17.14 Loop Operation for additional information.
For either loop mode or single-wire mode to function, both the SCI
receiver and transmitter must be enabled by setting the RE and TE
bits in SCIxCR2.
NOTE:
The RXD pin becomes general-purpose I/O when LOOPS = 1,
regardless of the state of the RSRC bit. DDRSC0 in SCIDDR is the data
direction bit for the RXD pin.
Table 17-3 shows how the LOOPS, RSRC, and DDRSC0 bits affect
SCI operation and the configuration of the RXD and TXD pins.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
361
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
RSRC
SCI
Mode
0
X
Normal
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0
Loop
Receiver
Input
Tied to RXD input buffer
Tied to transmitter output
1
1
RXD
Pin
Function
Receive pin
Generalpurpose
I/O
DDRSC0
LOOPS
Table 17-3. SCI Normal, Loop, and Single-Wire Mode Pin Configurations
Transmitter
Output
TXD
Pin
Function
X Tied to TXD output driver
Transmit pin
0 Tied to receiver input only
None (idles high)
1
Tied to receiver input
and TXD output driver
Transmit pin
0 No connection
Receive pin
1 Tied to TXD output driver
Transmit pin
Single-wire Tied to TXD
WOMS — Wired-OR Mode Select Bit
This read/write bit configures the TXD and RXD pins for open-drain
operation. This allows all of the TXD pins to be tied together in a
multiple-transmitter system. WOMS also affects the TXD and RXD
pins when they are general-purpose outputs. External pullup resistors
are necessary on open-drain outputs. Reset clears WOMS.
1 = TXD and RXD pins open-drain when outputs
0 = TXD and RXD pins CMOS drive when outputs
RSRC — Receiver Source Bit
This read/write bit selects the internal feedback path to the receiver
input when LOOPS = 1. Reset clears RSRC.
1 = Receiver input tied to TXD pin when LOOPS = 1
0 = Receiver input tied to transmitter output when LOOPS = 1
M — Data Format Mode Bit
This read/write bit selects 11-bit or 10-bit frames. Reset clears M.
1 = Frames have 1 start bit, 9 data bits, and 1 stop bit.
0 = Frames have 1 start bit, 8 data bits, and 1 stop bit.
Advance Information
362
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Memory Map and Registers
WAKE — Wakeup Bit
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This read/write bit selects the condition that wakes up the SCI
receiver when it has been placed in a standby state by setting the
RWU bit in SCICR2. When WAKE is set, a logic 1 (address mark) in
the most significant bit position of a received data character wakes the
receiver. An idle condition on the RXD pin does so when WAKE = 0.
Reset clears WAKE.
1 = Address mark receiver wakeup
0 = Idle line receiver wakeup
ILT — Idle Line Type Bit
This read/write bit determines when the receiver starts counting logic
1s as idle character bits. The counting begins either after the start bit
or after the stop bit. If the count begins after the start bit, then a string
of logic 1s preceding the stop bit may cause false recognition of an
idle character. Beginning the count after the stop bit avoids false idle
character recognition, but requires properly synchronized
transmissions. Reset clears ILT.
1 = Idle frame bit count begins after stop bit.
0 = Idle frame bit count begins after start bit.
PE — Parity Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the parity function. When enabled, the
parity function inserts a parity bit in the most significant bit position of
an SCI data word. Reset clears PE.
1 = Parity function enabled
0 = Parity function disabled
PT — Parity Type Bit
This read/write bit selects even parity or odd parity. With even parity,
an even number of 1s clears the parity bit and an odd number of 1s
sets the parity bit. With odd parity, an odd number of 1s clears the
parity bit and an even number of 1s sets the parity bit. Reset clears
PT.
1 = Odd parity when PE = 1
0 = Even parity when PE = 1
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
363
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.7.3 SCI Control Register 2
Address: SCI1 — 0x00cc_0003
SCI2 — 0x00cd_0003
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
TIE
TCIE
RIE
ILIE
TE
RE
RWU
SBK
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 17-5. SCI Control Register 2 (SCICR2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
TIE — Transmitter Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit allows the TDRE flag to generate interrupt
requests. Reset clears TIE.
1 = TDRE interrupt requests enabled
0 = TDRE interrupt requests disabled
TCIE — Transmission Complete Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit allows the TC flag to generate interrupt requests.
Reset clears TCIE.
1 = TC interrupt requests enabled
0 = TC interrupt requests disabled
RIE — Receiver Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit allows the RDRF and OR flags to generate interrupt
requests. Reset clears RIE.
1 = RDRF and OR interrupt requests enabled
0 = RDRF and OR interrupt requests disabled
ILIE — Idle Line Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit allows the IDLE flag to generate interrupt requests.
Reset clears ILIE.
1 = IDLE interrupt requests enabled
0 = IDLE interrupt requests disabled
Advance Information
364
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Memory Map and Registers
TE — Transmitter Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the transmitter and configures the TXD pin
as the transmitter output. Toggling TE queues an idle frame. Reset
clears TE.
1 = Transmitter enabled
0 = Transmitter disabled
RE — Receiver Enable Bit
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This read/write bit enables the receiver. Reset clears RE.
1 = Receiver enabled
0 = Receiver disabled
NOTE:
When LOOPS = 0 and TE = RE = 1, the RXD pin is an input and the
TXD pin is an output regardless of the state of the DDRSC1 (TXD) and
DDRSC0 (RXD) bits.
RWU — Receiver Wakeup Bit
This read/write bit puts the receiver in a standby state that inhibits
receiver interrupt requests. The WAKE bit determines whether an idle
input or an address mark wakes up the receiver and clears RWU.
Reset clears RWU.
1 = Receiver asleep when RE = 1
0 = Receiver awake when RE = 1
SBK — Send Break Bit
Setting this read/write bit causes the SCI to send break frames of 10
(M = 0) or 11 (M =1) logic 0s. To send one break frame, set SBK and
then clear it before the break frame is finished transmitting. As long as
SBK is set, the transmitter continues to send break frames.
1 = Transmitter sends break frames.
0 = Transmitter does not send break frames.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
365
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.7.4 SCI Status Register 1
Address: SCI1 — 0x00cc_0004
SCI2 — 0x00cd_0004
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
TDRE
TC
RDRF
IDLE
OR
NF
FE
PF
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 17-6. SCI Status Register 1 (SCISR1)
Read: Anytime
Write: Has no meaning or effect
TDRE — Transmit Data Register Empty Flag
The TDRE flag is set when the transmit shift register receives a word
from the SCI Data Register. It signals that the SCIDRH and SCIDRL
are empty and can receive new data to transmit. If the TIE bit in the
SCICR2 is also set, TDRE generates an interrupt request. Clear
TDRE by reading SCISR1 and then writing to SCIDRL. Reset sets
TDRE.
1 = Transmit data register empty
0 = Transmit data register not empty
TC — Transmit Complete Flag
The TC flag is set when TDRE = 1 and no data, preamble, or break
frame is being transmitted. It signals that no transmission is in
progress. If the TCIE bit is set in SCICR2, TC generates an interrupt
request. When TC is set, the TXD pin is idle (logic 1). TC is cleared
automatically when a data, preamble, or break frame is queued. Clear
TC by reading SCISR1 with TC set and then writing to SCIDRL. TC
cannot be cleared while a transmission is in progress. Reset sets TC.
1 = No transmission in progress
0 = Transmission in progress
Advance Information
366
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Memory Map and Registers
RDRF — Receive Data Register Full Flag
The RDRF flag is set when the data in the receive shift register is
transferred to SCIDRH and SCIDRL. It signals that the received data
is available to the MCU. If the RIE bit is set in SCICR2, RDRF
generates an interrupt request. Clear RDRF by reading the SCISR1
and then reading SCIDRL. Reset clears RDRF.
1 = Received data available in SCIDRH and SCIDRL
0 = Received data not available in SCIDRH and SCIDRL
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
IDLE — Idle Line Flag
The IDLE flag is set when 10 (if M = 0) or 11 (if M = 1) consecutive
logic 1s appear on the receiver input. If the ILIE bit in SCICR2 is set,
IDLE generates an interrupt request. Once IDLE is cleared, a valid
frame must again set the RDRF flag before an idle condition can set
the IDLE flag. Clear IDLE by reading SCISR1 and then reading
SCIDRL. Reset clears IDLE.
1 = Receiver idle
0 = Receiver active or idle since reset or idle since IDLE flag last
cleared
NOTE:
When RWU of SCICR2 =1, an idle line condition does not set the IDLE
flag.
OR — Overrun Flag
The OR flag is set if data is not read from SCIDRL before the receive
shift register receives the stop bit of the next frame. This is a receiver
overrun condition. If the RIE bit in SCICR2 is set, OR generates an
interrupt request. The data in the shift register is lost, but the data
already in the SCIDRH and SCIDRL is not affected. Clear OR by
reading SCISR1 and then reading SCIDRL. Reset clears OR.
1 = Overrun
0 = No overrun
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
367
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
NF — Noise Flag
The NF flag is set when the SCI detects noise on the receiver input.
NF is set during the same cycle as the RDRF flag but does not get set
in the case of an overrun. Clear NF by reading SCISR1 and then
reading SCIDRL. Reset clears NF.
1 = Noise
0 = No noise
FE — Framing Error Flag
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The FE flag is set when a logic 0 is accepted as the stop bit. FE is set
during the same cycle as the RDRF flag but does not get set in the
case of an overrun. FE inhibits further data reception until it is cleared.
Clear FE by reading SCISR1 and then reading SCIDRL. Reset clears
FE.
1 = Framing error
0 = No framing error
PF — Parity Error Flag
The PF flag is set when PE = 1 and the parity of the received data
does not match its parity bit. Clear PF by reading SCISR1 and then
reading SCIDRL. Reset clears PF.
1 = Parity error
0 = No parity error
Advance Information
368
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Memory Map and Registers
17.7.5 SCI Status Register 2
Address: SCI1 — 0x00cc_0005
SCI2 — 0x00cd_0005
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RAF
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 17-7. SCI Status Register 2 (SCISR2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Has no meaning or effect
RAF — Receiver Active Flag
The RAF flag is set when the receiver detects a logic 0 during the RT1
time period of the start bit search. When the receiver detects an idle
character, it clears RAF. Reset clears RAF.
1 = Reception in progress
0 = No reception in progress
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
369
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.7.6 SCI Data Registers
Address: SCI1 — 0x00cc_0006
SCI2 — 0x00cd_0006
Bit 7
Read:
6
R8
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
T8
Write:
Reset:
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 17-8. SCI Data Register High (SCIDRH)
Address: SCI1 — 0x00cc_0007
SCI2 — 0x00cd_0007
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
R7
R6
R5
R4
R3
R2
R1
R0
Write:
T7
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
T0
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 17-9. SCI Data Register Low (SCIDRL)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime; writing to R8 has no effect
R8 — Receive Bit 8
The R8 bit is the ninth received data bit when using the 9-bit data
format (M = 1). Reset clears R8.
T8 — Transmit Bit 8
The T8 bit is the ninth transmitted data bit when using the 9-bit data
format (M = 1). Reset clears T8.
R[7:0] — Receive Bits [7:0]
The R[7:0] bits are receive bits [7:0] when using the 9-bit or 8-bit data
format. Reset clears R[7:0].
Advance Information
370
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Memory Map and Registers
T[7:0] — Transmit Bits [7:0]
The T[7:0] bits are transmit bits [7:0] when using the 9-bit or 8-bit data
format. Reset clears T[7:0].
NOTE:
If the value of T8 is the same as in the previous transmission, T8 does
not have to be rewritten. The same value is transmitted until T8 is
rewritten.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When using the 8-bit data format, only SCIDRL needs to be accessed.
When using 8-bit write instructions to transmit 9-bit data, write first to
SCIDRH, then to SCIDRL.
17.7.7 SCI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register
Address: SCI1 — 0x00cc_0008
SCI2 — 0x00cd_0008
Bit 7
6
Read:
Write:
Reset:
5
4
RSVD5
RDPSCI
0
0
0
SCISDOZ
0
0
3
2
0
0
0
0
1
Bit 0
RSVD1
PUPSCI
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 17-10. SCI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register (SCIPURD)
Write: Anytime
SCISDOZ — SCI Stop in Doze Mode Bit
The SCISDOZ bit disables the SCI in doze mode.
1 = SCI disabled in doze mode
0 = SCI enabled in doze mode
RSVD[5:1] — Reserved
Writing to these read/write bits updates their values but has no effect
on functionality.
RDPSCI — Reduced Drive Bit
This read/write bit controls the drive capability of TXD and RXD.
1 = Reduced TXD and RXD pin drive
0 = Full TXD and RXD pin drive
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
371
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
PUPSCI — Pullup Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the pullups on pins TXD and RXD. If a pin
is programmed as an output, the pullup is disabled.
1 = TXD and RXD pullups enabled
0 = TXD and RXD pullups disabled
17.7.8 SCI Port Data Register
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: SCI1 — 0x00cc_0009
SCI2 — 0x00cd_0009
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
Bit 0
Read:
PORTSC1 PORTSC0
Write:
Reset:
Pin function:
0
0
TXD
RXD
Figure 17-11. SCI Port Data Register (SCIPORT)
Read: Anytime; when DDRSCx = 0, its pin is configured as an input, and
reading PORTSCx returns the pin level; when DDRSCx = 1, its pin is
configured as an output, and reading PORTSCx returns the pin driver
output level.
Write: Anytime; data stored in internal latch drives pin only if DDRSC
bit = 1
RSVD[7:2] — Reserved
Writing to these read/write bits updates their values but has no effect
on functionality.
PORTSC[1:0] — SCIPORT Data Bits
These are the read/write data bits of the SCI port.
NOTE:
Writes to SCIPORT do not change the pin state when the pin is
configured for SCI input.
To ensure correct reading of the SCI pin values from SCIPORT, always
wait at least one cycle after writing to SCIDDR before reading SCIPORT.
Advance Information
372
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Memory Map and Registers
17.7.9 SCI Data Direction Register
Address: SCI1 — 0x00cc_000a
SCI2 — 0x00cd_000a
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
RSVD3
RSVD2
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
Bit 0
Read:
DDRSC1 DDRSC0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 17-12. SCI Data Direction Register (SCIDDR)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
RSVD[7:2] — Reserved
Writing to these read/write bits updates their values but has no effect
on functionality.
DDRSC[1:0] — SCIPORT Data Direction Bits
These bits control the data direction of the SCIPORT pins. Reset
clears DDRSC[1:0].
1 = Corresponding pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding pin configured as input
NOTE:
When LOOPS = 0 and TE = RE = 1, the RXD pin is an input and the
TXD pin is an output regardless of the state of the DDRSC1 (TXD) and
DDRSC0 (RXD) bits.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
373
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.8 Functional Description
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The SCI allows full-duplex, asynchronous, non-return-to-zero (NRZ)
serial communication between the MCU and remote devices, including
other MCUs. The SCI transmitter and receiver operate independently,
although they use the same baud rate generator. The CPU monitors the
status of the SCI, writes the data to be transmitted, and processes
received data.
17.9 Data Format
The SCI uses the standard NRZ mark/space data format shown in
Figure 17-13.
Each frame has a start bit, eight or nine data bits, and one or two stop
bits. Clearing the M bit in SCCR1 configures the SCI for 10-bit frames.
Setting the M bit configures the SCI for 11-bit frames.
When the SCI is configured for 9-bit data, the ninth data bit is the T8 bit
in SCI Data Register high (SCIDRH). It remains unchanged after
transmission and can be used repeatedly without rewriting it. A frame
with nine data bits has a total of 11 bits.
10-BIT FRAME
M = 0 in SCICR1
START
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 6
BIT 7
STOP
BIT
NEXT
START
BIT
11-BIT FRAME
M = 1 IN SCICR1
START
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 6
BIT 7
BIT 8
STOP
BIT
NEXT
START
BIT
Figure 17-13. SCI Data Formats
Advance Information
374
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Baud Rate Generation
17.10 Baud Rate Generation
A 13-bit modulus counter in the baud rate generator derives the baud
rate for both the receiver and the transmitter. The value from 0 to 8191
written to SCIBDH and SCIBDL determines the system clock divisor.
The baud rate clock is synchronized with the bus clock and drives the
receiver. The baud rate clock divided by 16 drives the transmitter. The
receiver acquisition rate is 16 samples per bit time.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Baud rate generation is subject to two sources of error:
1. Integer division of the module clock may not give the exact target
frequency.
2. Synchronization with the bus clock can cause phase shift.
Table 17-4. Example Baud Rates
(System Clock = 33 MHz)
SBR[12:0]
Receiver Clock
(Hz)
Transmitter Clock
(Hz)
Target
Baud Rate
Percent
Error
0x0012
1,833,333.3
114,583.3
115,200
0.54
0x0024
916,666.7
57,291.7
57,600
0.54
0x0036
611,111.1
38,194.4
38,400
0.54
0x003d
540,983.6
33,811.4
33,600
0.63
0x0048
458,333.3
28,645.8
28,800
0.54
0x006b
308,411.2
19,275.7
19,200
0.39
0x0008f
230,769.2
14,423.1
14,400
0.16
0x00d7
153,488.4
95,93.0
9,600
0.07
0x01ae
76,744.2
4,796.5
4,800
0.07
0x035b
38,416.8
2,401.0
2,400
0.04
0x06b7
19,197.2
1,199.8
1,200
0.01
0x0d6d
9,601.4
600.1
600
0.01
0x1adb
4,800.0
300.0
300
0
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
375
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.11 Transmitter
IPBUS
SYSTEM
CLOCK
BAUD
DIVIDER
÷ 16
LOOPS
SCI DATA REGISTER
LOOP
CONTROL
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
H
11-BIT TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
L
PIN BUFFER
AND CONTROL
MSB
M
START
STOP
SBR[12:0]
FORCE PIN DIRECTION
BREAK (ALL 0s)
PREAMBLE (ALL 1s)
PARITY
GENERATION
SHIFT ENABLE
PT
TXD
PIN
WOMS
LOAD FROM SCIDR
PE
TO
RECEIVER
TRANSMITTER CONTROL
TDRE
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
TC
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
TDRE
TE
SBK
TIE
TC
TCIE
Figure 17-14. Transmitter Block Diagram
Advance Information
376
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Transmitter
17.11.1 Frame Length
The transmitter can generate either 10-bit or 11-bit frames. In SCICR1,
the M bit selects frame length, and the PE bit enables the parity function.
One data bit may be an address mark or an extra stop bit. All frames
begin with a start bit and end with one or two stop bits. When transmitting
9-bit data, bit T8 in SCI Data Register high (SCIDRH) is the ninth bit
(bit 8).
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 17-5. Example 10-Bit and 11-Bit Frames
M Bit
0
1
Frame
Length
Start
Bit
Data
Bits
Parity
Bit
Address
Mark(1)
Stop
Bit(s)
1
8
No
No
1
1
7
No
No
2
1
7
No
Yes
1
1
7
Yes
No
1
1
9
No
No
1
1
8
No
No
2
1
8
No
Yes
1
1
8
Yes
No
1
1
7
No
Yes
2
1
7
Yes
No
2
10 bits
11 bits
1. When implementing a multidrop network using the SCI, the address mark bit is used to
designate subsequent data frames as a network address and not device data.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
377
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.11.2 Transmitting a Frame
To begin an SCI transmission:
1. Configure the SCI:
a. Write a baud rate value to SCIBDH and SCIBDL.
b. Write to SCICR1 to:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
i. Enable or disable loop mode and select the receiver
feedback path
ii. Select open-drain or wired-OR SCI outputs
iii. Select 10-bit or 11-bit frames
iv. Select the receiver wakeup condition: address mark or
idle line
v. Select idle line type
vi. Enable or disable the parity function and select odd or
even parity
c. Write to SCICR2 to:
i. Enable or disable TDRE, TC, RDRF, and IDLE interrupt
requests
ii. Enable the transmitter and queue a break frame
iii. Enable or disable the receiver
iv. Put the receiver in standby if required
2. Transmit a byte:
a. Clear the TDRE flag by reading SCISR1 and, if sending 9-bit
data, write the ninth data bit to SCDRH.
b. Write the byte to be transmitted (or low-order 8 bits if sending
9-bit data) to SCIDRL.
3. Repeat step 2 for each subsequent transmission.
Writing the TE bit from 0 to 1 loads the transmit shift register with a
preamble of 10 (if M = 0) or 11 (if M = 1) logic 1s. When the preamble
shifts out, the SCI transfers the data from SCIDRH and SCIDRL to the
transmit shift register. The transmit shift register prefaces the data with
a 0 start bit and appends the data with a 1 stop bit and begins shifting
out the frame.
The SCI sets the TDRE flag every time it transfers data from SCIDRH
and SCIDRL to the transmit shift register. TDRE indicates that SCIDRH
Advance Information
378
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Transmitter
and SCIDRL can accept new data. If the TIE bit is set, TDRE generates
an interrupt request.
NOTE:
SCIDRH and SCIDRL transfer data to the transmit shift register and sets
TDRE 9/16ths of a bit time after the previous frame’s stop bit starts to
shift out.
Hardware supports odd or even parity. When parity is enabled, the most
significant data bit is the parity bit.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When the transmit shift register is not transmitting a frame, the TXD pin
goes to the idle condition, logic 1. Clearing the TE bit while the
transmitter is idle will return control of the TXD pin to the SCI data
direction (SCIDDR) and SCI port (SCIPORT) registers.
If the TE bit is cleared while a transmission is in progress (while TC = 0),
the frame in the transmit shift register continues to shift out. Then the
TXD pin reverts to being a general-purpose I/O pin even if there is data
pending in the SCI Data Register. To avoid accidentally cutting off a
message, always wait until TDRE is set after the last frame before
clearing TE.
To separate messages with preambles with minimum idle line time, use
this sequence between messages:
1. Write the last byte of the first message to SCIDRH and SCIDRL.
2. Wait until the TDRE flag is set, indicating the transfer of the last
frame to the transmit shift register.
3. Queue a preamble by clearing and then setting the TE bit.
4. Write the first byte of the second message to SCIDRH and
SCIDRL.
When the SCI relinquishes the TXD pin, the SCIPORT and SCIDDR
registers control the TXD pin.
To force TXD high when turning off the transmitter, set bit 1 of the SCI
Port Register (SCIPORT) and bit 1 of the SCI Data Direction Register
(SCIDDR). The TXD pin goes high as soon as the SCI relinquishes
control of it. See 17.7.8 SCI Port Data Register and 17.7.9 SCI Data
Direction Register.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
379
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.11.3 Break Frames
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Setting the SBK bit in SCICR2 loads the transmit shift register with a
break frame. A break frame contains all logic 0s and has no start, stop,
or parity bit. Break frame length depends on the M bit in the SCICR1
register. As long as SBK is set, the SCI continuously loads break frames
into the transmit shift register. After SBK is clear, the transmit shift
register finishes transmitting the last break frame and then transmits at
least one logic 1. The automatic logic 1 at the end of a break frame
guarantees the recognition of the next start bit.
The SCI recognizes a break frame when a start bit is followed by eight
or nine 0 data bits and a 0 where the stop bit should be. Receiving a
break frame has these effects on SCI registers:
•
Sets the FE flag
•
Sets the RDRF flag
•
Clears the SCIDRH and SCIDRL
•
May set the OR flag, NF flag, PE flag, or the RAF flag
17.11.4 Idle Frames
An idle frame contains all logic 1s and has no start, stop, or parity bit. Idle
frame length depends on the M bit in the SCICR1 register. The preamble
is a synchronizing idle frame that begins the first transmission after
writing the TE bit from 0 to 1.
If the TE bit is cleared during a transmission, the TXD pin becomes idle
after completion of the transmission in progress. Clearing and then
setting the TE bit during a transmission queues an idle frame to be sent
after the frame currently being transmitted.
NOTE:
Advance Information
380
When queueing an idle frame, return the TE bit to logic 1 before the stop
bit of the current frame shifts out to the TXD pin. Setting TE after the stop
bit appears on TXD causes data previously written to SCIDRH and
SCIDRL to be lost. Toggle TE to queue an idle frame, while the TDRE
flag is set, immediately before writing new data to SCIDRH and SCIDRL.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Receiver
17.12 Receiver
IPBUS
STOP
BAUD DIVIDER
DATA
RECOVERY
FROM TXD OR
TRANSMITTER
LOOP
CONTROL
RE
11-BIT RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
L
MSB
RXD
H
ALL 1s
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SYSTEM
CLOCK
START
SCI DATA REGISTER
SBR[12:0]
RAF
LOOPS
FE
M
RSRC
WAKE
ILT
PE
PT
IDLE
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
RDRF/OR
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
NF
WAKEUP
LOGIC
RWU
PE
R8
PARITY
CHECKING
IDLE
ILIE
RDRF
RIE
OR
Figure 17-15. SCI Receiver Block Diagram
17.12.1 Frame Length
The receiver can handle either 8-bit or 9-bit data. The state of the M bit
in SCICR1 selects frame length. When receiving 9-bit data, bit R8 in
SCIDRH is the ninth bit (bit 8).
17.12.2 Receiving a Frame
When the SCI receives a frame, the receive shift register shifts the frame
in from the RXD pin.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
381
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
After an entire frame shifts into the receive shift register, the data portion
of the frame transfers to SCIDRH and SCIDRL. The RDRF flag is set,
indicating that the received data can be read. If the RIE bit is also set,
RDRF generates an interrupt request.
17.12.3 Data Sampling
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The receiver samples the RXD pin at the RT clock rate. The RT clock is
an internal signal with a frequency 16 times the baud rate. To adjust for
baud rate mismatch, the RT clock resynchronizes:
•
After every start bit
•
After the receiver detects a data bit change from logic 1 to logic 0
(after the majority of data bit samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10
returns a valid logic 1 and the majority of the next RT8, RT9, and
RT10 samples returns a valid logic 0)
To locate the start bit, data recovery logic does an asynchronous search
for a 0 preceded by three 1s. When the falling edge of a possible start bit
occurs, the RT clock begins to count to 16.
START BIT
LSB
RXD
SAMPLES
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
START BIT
QUALIFICATION
0
0
START BIT
VERIFICATION
0
0
0
DATA
SAMPLING
RT4
RT3
RT2
RT1
RT16
RT15
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT9
RT10
RT8
RT7
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT3
RT2
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT CLOCK COUNT
RT1
RT CLOCK
RESET RT CLOCK
Figure 17-16. Receiver Data Sampling
Advance Information
382
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Receiver
To verify the start bit and to detect noise, data recovery logic takes
samples at RT3, RT5, and RT7.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 17-6. Start Bit Verification
RT3, RT5, and RT7 Samples
Start Bit Verification
Noise Flag
000
Yes
0
001
Yes
1
010
Yes
1
011
No
0
100
Yes
1
101
No
0
110
No
0
111
No
0
If start bit verification is not successful, the RT clock is reset and a new
search for a start bit begins.
To determine the value of a data bit and to detect noise, recovery logic
takes samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10.
Table 17-7. Data Bit Recovery
NOTE:
RT8, RT9, and RT10 Samples
Data Bit Determination
Noise Flag
000
0
0
001
0
1
010
0
1
011
1
1
100
0
1
101
1
1
110
1
1
111
1
0
The RT8, RT9, and RT10 data samples do not affect start bit verification.
If any or all of the RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples are logic 1s following a
successful start bit verification, the NF flag is set and the receiver
interprets the bit as a start bit (logic 0).
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
383
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
The RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples also verify stop bits.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 17-8. Stop Bit Recovery
RT8, RT9, and RT10 Samples
Framing Error Flag
Noise Flag
000
1
0
001
1
1
010
1
1
011
0
1
100
1
1
101
0
1
110
0
1
111
0
0
In Figure 17-17, the verification samples RT3 and RT5 determine that
the first low detected was noise and not the beginning of a start bit. The
RT clock is reset and the start bit search begins again. The NF flag is not
set because the noise occurred before the start bit was verified.
START BIT
LSB
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RT10
1
RT9
RT1
1
RT8
RT1
1
RT7
0
RT1
1
RT1
1
RT5
1
RT1
SAMPLES
RT1
RXD
RT3
RT2
RT1
RT16
RT15
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT3
RT2
RT4
RT3
RT CLOCK COUNT
RT2
RT CLOCK
RESET RT CLOCK
Figure 17-17. Start Bit Search Example 1
Advance Information
384
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Receiver
In Figure 17-18, noise is perceived as the beginning of a start bit
although the RT3 sample is high. The RT3 sample sets the noise flag.
Although the perceived bit time is misaligned, the RT8, RT9, and RT10
data samples are within the bit time, and data recovery is successful.
PERCEIVED START BIT
ACTUAL START BIT
LSB
RT1
1
0
0
0
0
RT9
RT1
0
RT8
RT1
1
RT7
1
RT1
1
RT1
1
0
RT7
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT3
RT2
RT1
RT16
RT15
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT10
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT3
RT CLOCK COUNT
RT2
RT CLOCK
RESET RT CLOCK
Figure 17-18. Start Bit Search Example 2
In Figure 17-19 a large burst of noise is perceived as the beginning of a
start bit, although the RT5 sample is high. The RT5 sample sets the
noise flag. Although this is a worst-case misalignment of perceived bit
time, the data samples RT8, RT9, and RT10 are within the bit time and
data recovery is successful.
PERCEIVED START BIT
ACTUAL START BIT
LSB
RT1
RT1
0
1
0
0
0
0
RT9
0
RT10
1
RT8
1
RT7
1
RT1
RXD
SAMPLES
RT1
RT9
RT8
RT7
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT3
RT2
RT1
RT16
RT15
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT CLOCK COUNT
RT3
RT CLOCK
RT2
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
1
RT1
RXD
SAMPLES
RESET RT CLOCK
Figure 17-19. Start Bit Search Example 3
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
385
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Figure 17-20 shows the effect of noise early in the start bit time.
Although this noise does not affect proper synchronization with the start
bit time, it does set the noise flag.
PERCEIVED AND ACTUAL START BIT
LSB
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
SAMPLES
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
1
RT1
RXD
1
0
RT3
RT2
RT1
RT16
RT15
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT10
RT9
RT8
RT7
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT3
RT CLOCK COUNT
RT2
RT CLOCK
RESET RT CLOCK
Figure 17-20. Start Bit Search Example 4
Figure 17-21 shows a burst of noise near the beginning of the start bit
that resets the RT clock. The sample after the reset is low but is not
preceded by three high samples that would qualify as a falling edge.
Depending on the timing of the start bit search and on the data, the frame
may be missed entirely or it may set the framing error flag.
1
0
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RT1
1
RT1
1
RT1
1
RT1
1
RT1
1
RT1
1
RT1
1
RT1
1
RT1
SAMPLES
LSB
RT7
START BIT
NO START BIT FOUND
RXD
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT3
RT CLOCK COUNT
RT2
RT CLOCK
RESET RT CLOCK
Figure 17-21. Start Bit Search Example 5
Advance Information
386
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Receiver
In Figure 17-22 a noise burst makes the majority of data samples RT8,
RT9, and RT10 high. This sets the noise flag but does not reset the RT
clock. In start bits only, the RT8, RT9, and RT10 data samples are
ignored.
START BIT
LSB
1
1
1
1
1
0
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
0
0
0
1
0
1
RT10
1
RT9
1
RT8
1
RT7
1
RT1
RT3
RT2
RT1
RT16
RT15
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT CLOCK COUNT
RT3
RT CLOCK
RT2
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SAMPLES
RT1
RXD
RESET RT CLOCK
Figure 17-22. Start Bit Search Example 6
17.12.4 Framing Errors
If the data recovery logic does not detect a 1 where the stop bit should
be in an incoming frame, it sets the FE flag in SCISR1. A break frame
also sets the FE flag because a break frame has no stop bit. The FE flag
is set at the same time that the RDRF flag is set.
17.12.5 Baud Rate Tolerance
A transmitting device may be operating at a baud rate below or above
the receiver baud rate. Accumulated bit time misalignment can cause
one of the RT8, RT9, and RT10 stop bit data samples to fall outside the
stop bit. A noise error occurs if the samples are not all the same value.
If more than one of the samples is outside the stop bit, a framing error
occurs. In most applications, the baud rate tolerance is much more than
the degree of misalignment that is likely to occur.
As the receiver samples an incoming frame, it resynchronizes the RT
clock on any valid falling edge within the frame. Resynchronization
within frames corrects misalignments between transmitter bit times and
receiver bit times.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
387
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.12.5.1 Slow Data Tolerance
Figure 17-23 shows how much a slow received frame can be misaligned
without causing a noise error or a framing error. The slow stop bit begins
at RT8 instead of RT1 but arrives in time for the stop bit data samples at
RT8, RT9, and RT10.
MSB
STOP
RT16
RT15
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT10
RT9
RT8
RT7
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT3
RT2
RT1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
RECEIVER
RT CLOCK
DATA
SAMPLES
Figure 17-23. Slow Data
For 8-bit data, sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver:
9 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 154 RT cycles.
With the misaligned data shown in Figure 17-23, the receiver counts
154 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is:
9 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 3 RT cycles = 147 RT cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the
transmitter count for slow 8-bit data with no errors is:
154 – 147 × 100 = 4.54%
-------------------------154
For 9-bit data, sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver:
10 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 170 RT cycles.
With the misaligned data shown in Figure 17-23, the receiver counts
170 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is:
10 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 3 RT cycles = 163 RT cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the
transmitter count for slow 9-bit data with no errors is:
170 – 163 × 100 = 4.12%
-------------------------170
Advance Information
388
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Receiver
17.12.5.2 Fast Data Tolerance
Figure 17-24 shows how much a fast received frame can be misaligned
without causing a noise error or a framing error. The fast stop bit ends at
RT10 instead of RT16 but is still sampled at RT8, RT9, and RT10.
STOP
IDLE OR NEXT FRAME
RT16
RT15
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT10
RT9
RT8
RT7
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT3
RT2
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
RT1
RECEIVER
RT CLOCK
DATA
SAMPLES
Figure 17-24. Fast Data
For 8-bit data, sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver:
9 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 154 RT cycles.
With the misaligned data shown in Figure 17-24, the receiver counts
154 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is:
10 bit times × 16 RT cycles = 160 RT cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the
transmitter count for fast 8-bit data with no errors is:
154 – 160 × 100 = 3.90%
-------------------------154
For 9-bit data, sampling of the stop bit takes the receiver:
10 bit times × 16 RT cycles + 10 RT cycles = 170 RT cycles.
With the misaligned data shown in Figure 17-24, the receiver counts
170 RT cycles at the point when the count of the transmitting device is:
11 bit times × 16 RT cycles = 176 RT cycles.
The maximum percent difference between the receiver count and the
transmitter count for fast 9-bit data with no errors is:
170 – 176 × 100 = 3.53%
-------------------------170
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
389
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.12.6 Receiver Wakeup
So that the SCI can ignore transmissions intended only for other devices
in multiple-receiver systems, the receiver can be put into a standby
state. Setting the RWU bit in SCICR2 puts the receiver into a standby
state during which receiver interrupts are disabled.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The transmitting device can address messages to selected receivers by
including addressing information in the initial frame or frames of each
message.
The WAKE bit in SCICR1 determines how the SCI is brought out of the
standby state to process an incoming message. The WAKE bit enables
either idle line wakeup or address mark wakeup.
17.12.6.1 Idle Input Line Wakeup (WAKE = 0)
When WAKE = 0, an idle condition on the RXD pin clears the RWU bit
and wakes up the receiver. The initial frame or frames of every message
contain addressing information. All receivers evaluate the addressing
information, and receivers for which the message is addressed process
the frames that follow. Any receiver for which a message is not
addressed can set its RWU bit and return to the standby state. The RWU
bit remains set and the receiver remains on standby until another idle
frame appears on the RXD pin.
Idle line wakeup requires that messages be separated by at least one
idle frame and that no message contains idle frames.
The idle frame that wakes up the receiver does not set the IDLE flag or
the RDRF flag.
The ILT bit in SCICR1 determines whether the receiver begins counting
logic 1s as idle frame bits after the start bit or after the stop bit.
Advance Information
390
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Receiver
17.12.6.2 Address Mark Wakeup (WAKE = 1)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When WAKE = 1, an address mark clears the RWU bit and wakes up the
receiver. An address mark is a 1 in the most significant data bit position.
The receiver interprets the data as address data. When using address
mark wakeup, the MSB of all non-address data must be 0. User code
must compare the address data to the receiver’s address and, if the
addresses match, the receiver processes the frames that follow. If the
addresses do not match, user code must put the receiver back to sleep
by setting the RWU bit. The RWU bit remains set and the receiver
remains on standby until another address frame appears on the RXD
pin.
The address mark clears the RWU bit before the stop bit is received and
sets the RDRF flag.
Address mark wakeup allows messages to contain idle frames but
requires that the most significant byte (MSB) be reserved for address
data.
NOTE:
With the WAKE bit clear, setting the RWU bit after the RXD pin has been
idle can cause the receiver to wake up immediately.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
391
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.13 Single-Wire Operation
Normally, the SCI uses the TXD pin for transmitting and the RXD pin for
receiving (LOOPS = 0, RSRC = X). In single-wire mode, the RXD pin is
disconnected from the SCI and is available as a general-purpose I/O pin.
The SCI uses the TXD pin for both receiving and transmitting.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
In single-wire mode (LOOPS = 1, RXRC = 1), setting the data direction
bit for the TXD pin configures TXD as the output for transmitted data.
Clearing the data direction bit configures TXD as the input for received
data.
TRANSMITTER
TXD SCIDDR
BIT = 1
TXD
WOMS
RECEIVER
TRANSMITTER
RXD
NC
GENERAL-PURPOSE I/O
TXD
TXD SCIDDR
BIT = 0
RECEIVER
RXD
GENERAL-PURPOSE I/O
Figure 17-25. Single-Wire Operation (LOOPS = 1, RSRC = 1)
Enable single-wire operation by setting the LOOPS bit and the RSRC bit
in SCICR1. Setting the LOOPS bit disables the path from the RXD pin to
the receiver. Setting the RSRC bit connects the receiver input to the
output of the TXD pin driver. Both the transmitter and receiver must be
enabled (TE = 1 and RE = 1).
The WOMS bit in the SCICR1 register configures the TXD pin for full
CMOS drive or for open-drain drive. WOMS controls the TXD pin in both
normal operation and in single-wire operation. When WOMS is set, the
DDR bit for the TXD pin does not have to be cleared for transmitter to
receive data.
Advance Information
392
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Loop Operation
17.14 Loop Operation
In loop mode (LOOPS = 1, RSRC = 0), the transmitter output goes to the
receiver input. The RXD pin is disconnected from the SCI and is
available as a general-purpose I/O pin.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Setting the DDR bit for the TXD pin connects the transmitter output to the
TXD pin. Clearing the data direction bit disconnects the transmitter
output from the TXD pin.
TRANSMITTER
TXD
TXD SCIDDR
BIT = 1
WOMS
RECEIVER
RXD
H
TXD
TRANSMITTER
TXD SCIDDR
BIT = 0
GENERAL-PURPOSE I/O
WOMS
RECEIVER
RXD
GENERAL-PURPOSE I/O
Figure 17-26. Loop Operation (LOOPS = 1, RSRC = 0)
Enable loop operation by setting the LOOPS bit and clearing the RSRC
bit in SCICR1. Setting the LOOPS bit disables the path from the RXD pin
to the receiver. Clearing the RSRC bit connects the transmitter output to
the receiver input. Both the transmitter and receiver must be enabled
(TE = 1 and RE = 1).
The WOMS bit in SCICR1 configures the TXD pin for full CMOS drive or
for open-drain drive. WOMS controls the TXD pin during both normal
operation and loop operation.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
393
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.15 I/O Ports
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The SCIPORT register is associated with two pins:
•
The TXD pin is connected to SCIPORT1.
•
The RXD pin is connected to SCIPORT0.
The SCI Data Direction Register (SCIDDR) configures the pins as inputs
or outputs (see 17.7.9 SCI Data Direction Register). The SCI Pullup
and Reduced Drive Register (SCIPURD) controls pin drive capability
and enables or disables pullups (see 17.7.7 SCI Pullup and Reduced
Drive Register). The WOMS bit in SCI Control Register 1 (SCICR1)
configures output ports as full CMOS drive outputs or as open-drain
outputs (see 17.7.2 SCI Control Register 1).
Table 17-9. SCI Port Control Summary
Pullup Enable Control
Reduced Drive Control
Wired-OR Mode Control
Register
Bit
Reset
State
Register
Bit
Reset
State
Register
Bit
Reset
State
SCIPURD
PUPSCI
0
SCIPURD
RDPSCI
0
SCICR1
WOMS
CMOS
drive
Advance Information
394
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
Reset
17.16 Reset
Reset initializes the SCI registers to a known startup state as described
in 17.7 Memory Map and Registers.
17.17 Interrupts
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 17-10 lists the five interrupt requests associated with each SCI
module.
Table 17-10. SCI Interrupt Request Sources
Source
Transmitter
Receiver
Flag
Enable Bit
TDRE
TIE
TC
TCIE
RDRF
RIE
OR
RIE
IDLE
ILIE
17.17.1 Transmit Data Register Empty
The TDRE flag is set when the transmit shift register receives a byte from
the SCI Data Register. It signals that SCIDRH and SCIDRL are empty
and can receive new data to transmit. If the TIE bit in SCICR2 is also set,
TDRE generates an interrupt request. Clear TDRE by reading SCISR1
and then writing to SCIDRL. Reset sets TDRE.
17.17.2 Transmission Complete
The TC flag is set when TDRE = 1 and no data, preamble, or break
frame is being transmitted. It signals that no transmission is in progress.
If the TCIE bit is set in SCICR2, TC generates an interrupt request.
When TC is set, the TXD pin is idle (logic 1). TC is cleared automatically
when a data, preamble, or break frame is queued. Clear TC by reading
SCISR1 with TC set and then writing to the SCIDRL register. TC cannot
be cleared while a transmission is in progress.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
395
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
17.17.3 Receive Data Register Full
The RDRF flag is set when the data in the receive shift register transfers
to SCIDRH and SCIDRL. It signals that the received data is available to
be read. If the RIE bit is set in SCICR2, RDRF generates an interrupt
request. Clear RDRF by reading SCISR1 and then reading SCIDRL.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
17.17.4 Idle Receiver Input
The IDLE flag is set when 10 (if M = 0) or 11 (if M = 1) consecutive
logic 1s appear on the receiver input. This signals an idle condition on
the receiver input. If the ILIE bit in SCICR2 is set, IDLE generates an
interrupt request. Once IDLE is cleared, a valid frame must again set the
RDRF flag before an idle condition can set the IDLE flag. Clear IDLE by
reading SCISR1 with IDLE set and then reading SCIDRL.
17.17.5 Overrun
The OR flag is set if data is not read from SCIDRL before the receive
shift register receives the stop bit of the next frame. This signals a
receiver overrun condition. If the RIE bit in SCICR2 is set, OR generates
an interrupt request. The data in the shift register is lost, but the data
already in SCIDRH and SCIDRL is not affected. Clear OR by reading
SCISR1 and then reading SCIDRL.
Advance Information
396
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Communications Interface Modules (SCI1 and SCI2)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 18. Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
18.1 Contents
18.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
18.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 398
18.4
Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .399
18.5
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399
18.6 Signal Description. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
18.6.1 MISO (Master In/Slave Out) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
18.6.2 MOSI (Master Out/Slave In) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400
18.6.3 SCK (Serial Clock) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
18.6.4 SS (Slave Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
18.7 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401
18.7.1 SPI Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402
18.7.2 SPI Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405
18.7.3 SPI Baud Rate Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 406
18.7.4 SPI Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
18.7.5 SPI Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409
18.7.6 SPI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410
18.7.7 SPI Port Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .411
18.7.8 SPI Port Data Direction Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 412
18.8 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413
18.8.1 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414
18.8.2 Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
18.8.3 Transmission Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
18.8.3.1
Transfer Format When CPHA = 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
18.8.3.2
Transfer Format When CPHA = 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 417
18.8.4 SPI Baud Rate Generation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
18.8.5 Slave-Select Output . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 420
18.8.6 Bidirectional Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
397
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
18.8.7 Error Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .422
18.8.7.1
Write Collision Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .422
18.8.7.2
Mode Fault Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422
18.8.8 Low-Power Mode Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423
18.8.8.1
Run Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423
18.8.8.2
Doze Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 423
18.8.8.3
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
18.9
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
18.10 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
18.10.1 Mode Fault (MODF) Flag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
18.10.2 SPI Interrupt Flag (SPIF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
18.2 Introduction
The serial peripheral interface (SPI) module allows full-duplex,
synchronous, serial communication between the microcontroller unit
(MCU) and peripheral devices. Software can poll the SPI status flags or
SPI operation can be interrupt driven.
18.3 Features
Features include:
Advance Information
398
•
Master mode and slave mode
•
Wired-OR mode
•
Slave-select output
•
Mode fault error flag with central processor unit (CPU) interrupt
capability
•
Double-buffered operation
•
Serial clock with programmable polarity and phase
•
Control of SPI operation during doze mode
•
Reduced drive control for lower power consumption
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Modes of Operation
18.4 Modes of Operation
The SPI functions in these three modes:
1. Run mode — Run mode is the normal mode of operation.
2. Doze mode — Doze mode is a configurable low-power mode.
18.5 Block Diagram
SPE
MSTR
WCOL
SPI
CONTROL
SPIF
SPI
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
MODF
SPIE
SPI CLOCK
PUPSP
RDPSP
SHIFT
CONTROL
LSBFE
BAUD RATE GENERATOR
DIVIDER
2
4
8
MISO
16 32 64 128 256
BAUD RATE SELECT
CLOCK
CONTROL
SHIFT REGISTER
MSB
PIN
CONTROL
LSB
SPIPORT
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
3. Stop mode — The SPI is inactive in stop mode.
MOSI
SCK
SS
SPPR[6:4]
SPR[2:0]
MSTR
SPI DATA REGISTER
CPOL
SSOE
CPHA
SPISDOZ
MSTR
SWOM
DDRSP[7:0]
SPC0
IP INTERFACE
Figure 18-1. SPI Block Diagram
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
399
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
18.6 Signal Description
An overview of the signals is provided in Table 18-1.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 18-1. Signal Properties
Function(1)
Name
Port
Reset State
MISO
SPIPORT0
Master data in/slave data out
0
MOSI
SPIPORT1
Master data out/slave data in
0
SCK
SPIPORT2
Serial clock
0
SS
SPIPORT3
Slave select
0
1. The SPI ports (MISO, MOSI, SCK, and SS) are general-purpose I/O ports when the SPI is
disabled (SPE = 0).
18.6.1 MISO (Master In/Slave Out)
MISO is one of the two SPI data pins.
•
In master mode, MISO is the data input.
•
In slave mode, MISO is the data output and is three-stated until a
master drives the SS input pin low.
•
In bidirectional mode, a slave MISO pin is the SISO pin (slave
in/slave out).
•
In a multiple-master system, all MISO pins are tied together.
18.6.2 MOSI (Master Out/Slave In)
MOSI is one of the two SPI data pins.
Advance Information
400
•
In master mode, MOSI is the data output.
•
In slave mode, MOSI is the data input.
•
In bidirectional mode, a master MOSI pin is the MOMI pin (master
out/master in).
•
In a multiple-master system, all MOSI pins are tied together.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Memory Map and Registers
18.6.3 SCK (Serial Clock)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The SCK pin is the serial clock pin for synchronizing transmissions
between master and slave devices.
•
In master mode, SCK is an output.
•
In slave mode, SCK is an input.
•
In a multiple-master system, all SCK pins are tied together.
18.6.4 SS (Slave Select)
In master mode, the SS pin can be:
•
A mode-fault input
•
A general-purpose input
•
A general-purpose output
•
A slave-select output
In slave mode, the SS pin is always a slave-select input.
18.7 Memory Map and Registers
Table 18-2 shows the SPI memory map.
NOTE:
Reading reserved addresses (0x00cb_004 and 0x00cb_0009 through
0x00cb_000b) and unimplemented addresses (0x00cb_000c through
0x00cb_000f) returns 0s. Writing to unimplemented addresses has no
effect. Accessing unimplemented addresses does not generate an error
response.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
401
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 18-2. SPI Memory Map
Address
Bits 7–0
Access(1)
0x00cb_0000
SPI Control Register 1 (SPICR1)
S/U
0x00cb_0001
SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2)
S/U
0x00cb_0002
SPI Baud Rate Register (SPIBR)
S/U
0x00cb_0003
SPI Status Register (SPISR)
S/U
0x00cb_0005
SPI Data Register (SPIDR)
S/U
0x00cb_0006
SPI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register (SPIPURD)
S/U
0x00cb_0007
SPI Port Data Register (SPIPORT)
S/U
0x00cb_0008
SPI Port Data Direction Register (SPIDDR)
S/U
1. S/U = CPU supervisor or user mode access. User mode accesses to supervisor only addresses have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
18.7.1 SPI Control Register 1
Address: 0x00cb_0000
%LW
%LW
SPIE
SPE
SWOM
MSTR
CPOL
CPHA
SSOE
LSBFE
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 18-2. SPI Control Register 1 (SPICR1)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
SPIE — SPI Interrupt Enable Bit
The SPIE bit enables the SPIF and MODF flags to generate interrupt
requests. Reset clears SPIE.
1 = SPIF and MODF interrupt requests enabled
0 = SPIF and MODF interrupt requests disabled
Advance Information
402
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Memory Map and Registers
SPE — SPI System Enable Bit
The SPE bit enables the SPI and dedicates SPI port pins [3:0] to SPI
functions. When SPE is clear, the SPI system is initialized but in a
low-power disabled state. Reset clears SPE.
1 = SPI enabled
0 = SPI disabled
SWOM — SPI Wired-OR Mode Bit
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The SWOM bit configures the output buffers of SPI port pins [3:0] as
open-drain outputs. SWOM controls SPI port pins [3:0] whether they
are SPI outputs or general-purpose outputs. Reset clears SWOM.
1 = Output buffers of SPI port pins [3:0] open-drain
0 = Output buffers of SPI port pins [3:0] CMOS drive
MSTR — Master Bit
The MSTR bit selects SPI master mode or SPI slave mode operation.
Reset clears MSTR.
1 = Master mode
0 = Slave mode
CPOL — Clock Polarity Bit
The CPOL bit selects an inverted or non-inverted SPI clock. To
transmit data between SPI modules, the SPI modules must have
identical CPOL values. Reset clears CPOL.
1 = Active-low clock; SCK idles high
0 = Active-high clock; SCK idles low
CPHA — Clock Phase Bit
The CPHA bit delays the first edge of the SCK clock. Reset sets
CPHA.
1 = First SCK edge at start of transmission
0 = First SCK edge 1/2 cycle after start of transmission
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
403
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
SSOE — Slave Select Output Enable Bit
The SSOE bit and the DDRSP3 bit configure the SS pin as a
general-purpose input or a slave-select output. Reset clears SSOE.
Table 18-3. SS Pin I/O Configurations
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
DDRSP3 SSOE
NOTE:
Master Mode
Slave Mode
0
0
Mode-fault input
Slave-select input
0
1
General-purpose input
Slave-select input
1
0
General-purpose output
Slave-select input
1
1
Slave-select output
Slave-select input
Setting the SSOE bit disables the mode fault detect function.
LSBFE — LSB-First Enable Bit
The LSBFE enables data to be transmitted LSB first. Reset clears
LSBFE.
1 = Data transmitted LSB first.
0 = Data transmitted MSB first
NOTE:
Advance Information
404
In SPIDR, the MSB is always bit 7 regardless of the LSBFE bit.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Memory Map and Registers
18.7.2 SPI Control Register 2
Address: 0x00cb_0001
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
Bit 0
SPISDOZ
SPC0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 18-3. SPI Control Register 2 (SPICR2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime; writing to unimplemented bits has no effect
SPISDOZ — SPI Stop in Doze Bit
The SPIDOZ bit stops the SPI clocks when the CPU is in doze mode.
Reset clears SPISDOZ.
1 = SPI inactive in doze mode
0 = SPI active in doze mode
SPC0 — Serial Pin Control Bit 0
The SPC0 bit enables the bidirectional pin configurations shown in
Table 18-4. Reset clears SPC0.
Table 18-4. Bidirectional Pin Configurations
Pin Mode
SPC0 MSTR
MISO Pin(1)
MOSI Pin(2)
SCK Pin(3)
SS Pin(4)
0
Slave data
output
Slave data input SCK input
Slave-select input
B
1
Master data input
Master data
output
SCK output
MODF/GP input (DDRSP3 = 0)
or GP output (DDRSP3 = 1)
C
0
Slave data I/O
GP(5) I/O
SCK input
Slave-select input
1
GP I/O
Master data I/O SCK output
A
Normal
Bidirectional
D
0
1
MODF/GP input (DDRSP3 = 0)
or GP output (DDRSP3 = 1)
1. Slave output is enabled if SPIDDR bit 0 = 1, SS = 0, and MSTR = 0 (A, C).
2. Master output is enabled if SPIDDR bit 1 = 1 and MSTR = 1 (B, D).
3. SCK output is enabled if SPIDDR bit 2 = 1 and MSTR = 1 (B, D).
4. SS output is enabled if SPIDDR bit 3 = 1, SPICR1 bit 1 (SSOE) = 1, and MSTR = 1 (B, D). MODF input is enabled if SPI
DDR bit 3 = 0 and SSOE = 0. GP input is enabled if SPI DDR bit 3 = 0 and SSOE = 1.
5. GP = General-purpose
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
405
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
18.7.3 SPI Baud Rate Register
Address: 0x00cb_0002
Bit 7
Read:
5
4
SPPR6
SPPR5
SPPR4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
SPR2
SPR1
SPR0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
6
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 18-4. SPI Baud Rate Register (SPIBR)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime; writing to unimplemented bits has no effect
SPPR[6:4] — SPI Baud Rate Preselection Bits
The SPPR[6:4] and SPR[2:0] bits select the SPI clock divisor as
shown in Table 18-5. Reset clears SPPR[6:4] and SPR[2:0], selecting
an SPI clock divisor of 2.
SPR[2:0] — SPI Baud Rate Bits
The SPPR[6:4] and SPR[2:0] bits select the SPI clock divisor as
shown in Table 18-5. Reset clears SPPR[6:4] and SPR[2:0], selecting
an SPI clock divisor of 2.
NOTE:
Advance Information
406
Writing to SPIBR during a transmission may cause spurious results.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Memory Map and Registers
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 18-5. SPI Baud Rate Selection (33-MHz Module Clock)
SPPR[6:4]
SPR[2:0]
SPI Clock
Divisor
Baud Rate
SPPR[6:4]
SPR[2:0]
SPI Clock
Divisor
Baud Rate
000
000
2
16.5 MHz
100
000
10
3.3 MHz
000
001
4
8.25 MHz
100
001
20
1.65 MHz
000
010
8
4.125 MHz
100
010
40
825 MHz
000
011
16
2.06 MHz
100
011
80
412.5 kHz
000
100
32
1.03 MHz
100
100
160
206.25 kHz
000
101
64
515.62 kHz
100
101
320
103.13 kHz
000
110
128
257.81 kHz
100
110
640
51.56 kHz
000
111
256
128.9 kHz
100
111
1280
25.78 kHz
001
000
4
8.25 MHz
101
000
12
2.75 MHz
001
001
8
4.12 MHz
101
001
24
1.375 MHz
001
010
16
2.06 MHz
101
010
48
687.5 kHz
001
011
32
1.03 MHz
101
011
96
343.75 kHz
001
100
64
515.62 kHz
101
100
192
171.88 kHz
001
101
128
257.81 kHz
101
101
384
85.94 kHz
001
110
256
128.9 kHz
101
110
768
42.97 kHz
001
111
512
64.45 kHz
101
111
1536
21.48 kHz
010
000
6
5.5 MHz
110
000
14
2.36 MHz
010
001
12
2.75 MHz
110
001
28
1.18 MHz
010
010
24
1.375 MHz
110
010
56
589.29 kHz
010
011
48
687.5 kHz
110
011
112
296.64 kHz
010
100
96
343.75 kHz
110
100
224
147.32 kHz
010
101
192
171.88 kHz
110
101
448
73.66 kHz
010
110
384
85.94 kHz
110
110
896
36.83 kHz
010
111
768
42.97 kHz
110
111
1792
18.42 kHz
011
000
8
4.13 MHz
111
000
16
2.06 MHz
011
001
16
2.06 MHz
111
001
32
1.03 MHz
011
010
32
1.03 MHz
111
010
64
515.63 kHz
011
011
64
515.63 kHz
111
011
128
257.81 kHz
011
100
128
257.81 kHz
111
100
256
128.91 kHz
011
101
256
128.91 kHz
111
101
512
64.45 kHz
011
110
512
64.45 kHz
111
110
1024
32.23 kHz
011
111
1024
32.23 kHz
111
111
2048
16.11 kHz
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
407
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
18.7.4 SPI Status Register
Address: 0x00cb_0003
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SPIF
WCOL
0
MODF
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 18-5. SPI Status Register (SPISR)
Read: Anytime
Write: Has no meaning or effect
SPIF — SPI Interrupt Flag
The SPIF flag is set after the eighth SCK cycle in a transmission when
received data transfers from the shift register to SPIDR. If the SPIE bit
is also set, SPIF generates an interrupt request. Once SPIF is set, no
new data can be transferred into SPIDR until SPIF is cleared. Clear
SPIF by reading SPISR with SPIF set and then accessing SPIDR.
Reset clears SPIF.
1 = New data available in SPIDR
0 = No new data available in SPIDR
WCOL — Write Collision Flag
The WCOL flag is set when software writes to SPIDR during a
transmission. Clear WCOL by reading SPISR with WCOL set and
then accessing SPIDR. Reset clears WCOL.
1 = Write collision
0 = No write collision
MODF — Mode Fault Flag
The MODF flag is set when the SS pin of a master SPI is driven low
and the SS pin is configured as a mode-fault input. If the SPIE bit is
also set, MODF generates an interrupt request. A mode fault clears
the SPE, MSTR, and DDRSP[2:0] bits. Clear MODF by reading
SPISR with MODF set and then writing to SPICR1. Reset clears
MODF.
1 = Mode fault
0 = No mode fault
Advance Information
408
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Memory Map and Registers
18.7.5 SPI Data Register
Address: 0x00cb_0005
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
BIT 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
BIT 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 18-6. SPI Data Register (SPIDR)
Read: Anytime; normally read only after SPIF is set
Write: Anytime; see WCOL
SPIDR is both the input and output register for SPI data. Writing to
SPIDR while a transmission is in progress sets the WCOL flag and
disables the attempted write. Read SPIDR after the SPIF flag is set and
before the end of the next transmission. If the SPIF flag is not serviced
before a new byte enters the shift register, the new byte and any
successive bytes are lost. The byte already in the SPIDR remains there
until SPIF is serviced.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
409
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
18.7.6 SPI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register
Address: 0x00cb_0006
Read:
Bit 7
6
0
0
5
4
RSVD5
RDPSP
0
0
3
2
0
0
1
Bit 0
RSVD1
PUPSP
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 18-7. SPI Pullup and Reduced Drive Register (SPIPURD)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime; writing to unimplemented bits has no effect
RSVD5 and RSVD1 — Reserved
Writing to these read/write bits updates their values but has no effect
on functionality.
RDPSP — SPI Port Reduced Drive Control Bit
1 = Reduced drive capability on SPIPORT bits [7:4]
0 = Full drive enabled on SPIPORT bits [7:4]
PUPSP — SPI Port Pullup Enable Bit
1 = Pullup devices enabled for SPIPORT bits [3:0]
0 = Pullup devices disabled for SPIPORT bits [3:0]
Advance Information
410
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Memory Map and Registers
18.7.7 SPI Port Data Register
Address: 0x00cb_0007
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
0
0
0
0
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
PORTSP3 PORTSP2 PORTSP1 PORTSP0
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Pin function:
0
0
0
0
SS
SCK
MOSI/
MOMI
MISO/
SISO
Figure 18-8. SPI Port Data Register (SPIPORT)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
RSVD[7:4] — Reserved
Writing to these read/write bits updates their values but has no effect
on functionality.
PORTSP[3:0] — SPI Port Data Bits
Data written to SPIPORT drives pins only when they are configured
as general-purpose outputs.
Reading an input (DDRSP bit clear) returns the pin level; reading an
output (DDRSP bit set) returns the pin driver input level.
Writing to any of the PORTSP[3:0] pins does not change the pin state
when the pin is configured for SPI output.
SPIPORT I/O function depends upon the state of the SPE bit in
SPICR1 and the state the DDRSP bits in SPIDDR.
Table 18-6. SPI Port Summary
Pullup Enable Control
Wired-OR
Mode Control
Reduced Drive Control
Register
Bit
Reset
State
Register
Bit
Reset
State
Register
Bit
Reset
State
SPIPURD
PUPSP
0
SPIPURD
RDPSP[1:0]
Full drive
SPICR1
SWOM
Normal
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
411
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
18.7.8 SPI Port Data Direction Register
Address: 0x00cb_0008
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RSVD7
RSVD6
RSVD5
RSVD4
DDRSP3
DDRSP2
DDRSP1
DDRSP0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SS
SCK
MOSI/
MOMI
MISO/
SISO
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Pin function:
Figure 18-9. SPI Port Data Direction Register (SPIDDR)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime
RSVD[7:4] — Reserved
Writing to these read/write bits updates their values but has no effect
on functionality.
DDRSP[3:0] — Data Direction Bits
The DDRSP[3:0] bits control the data direction of SPIPORT pins.
Reset clears DDRSP[3:0].
1 = Corresponding pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding pin configured as input
In slave mode, DDRSP3 has no meaning or effect. In master mode,
the DDRSP3 and the SSOE bits determine whether SPI port pin 3 is
a mode-fault input, a general-purpose input, a general-purpose
output, or a slave-select output.
NOTE:
Advance Information
412
When the SPI is enabled (SPE = 1), the MISO, MOSI, and SCK pins:
•
Are inputs if their SPI functions are input functions regardless of
the state of their DDRSP bits.
•
Are outputs if their SPI functions are output functions only if their
DDRSP bits are set.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Functional Description
18.8 Functional Description
The SPI module allows full-duplex, synchronous, serial communication
between the MCU and peripheral devices. Software can poll the SPI
status flags or SPI operation can be interrupt driven.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Setting the SPE bit in SPICR1 enables the SPI and dedicates four SPI
port pins to SPI functions:
•
Slave select (SS)
•
Serial clock (SCK)
•
Master out/slave in (MOSI)
•
Master in/slave out (MISO)
When the SPE bit is clear, the SS, SCK, MOSI, and MISO pins are
general-purpose I/O pins controlled by SPIDDR.
The 8-bit shift register in a master SPI is linked by the MOSI and MISO
pins to the 8-bit shift register in the slave. The linked shift registers form
a distributed 16-bit register. In an SPI transmission, the SCK clock from
the master shifts the data in the 16-bit register eight bit positions, and the
master and slave exchange data. Data written to the master SPIDR
register is the output data to the slave. After the exchange, data read
from the master SPIDR is the input data from the slave.
SPIDR
SHIFT REGISTER
BAUD RATE
GENERATOR
SPIDR
MISO
MISO
MOSI
MOSI
SCK
SCK
SS
VDD
SHIFT REGISTER
SS
MASTER SPI
SLAVE SPI
Figure 18-10. Full-Duplex Operation
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
413
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
18.8.1 Master Mode
Setting the MSTR bit in SPICR1 puts the SPI in master mode. Only a
master SPI can initiate a transmission. Writing to the master SPIDR
begins a transmission. If the shift register is empty, the byte transfers to
the shift register and begins shifting out on the MOSI pin under the
control of the master SCK clock. The SCK clock starts one-half SCK
cycle after writing to SPIDR.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The SPR[2:0] and SPPR[6:4] bits in SPIBR control the baud rate
generator and determine the speed of the shift register. The SCK pin is
the SPI clock output. Through the SCK pin, the baud rate generator of
the master controls the shift register of the slave.
The MSTR bit in SPICR1 and the SPC0 bit in SPICR2 control the
function of the data pins, MOSI and MISO.
The SS pin is normally an input that remains in the inactive high state.
Setting the DDRSP3 bit in SPIDDR configures SS as an output. The
DDRSP3 bit and the SSOE bit in SPICR1 can configure SS for
general-purpose I/O, mode fault detection, or slave selection.
See Table 18-3.
The SS output goes low during each transmission and is high when the
SPI is in the idle state. Driving the master SS input low sets the MODF
flag in SPISR, indicating a mode fault. More than one master may be
trying to drive the MOSI and SCK lines simultaneously. A mode fault
clears the data direction bits of the MISO, MOSI (or MOMI), and SCK
pins to make them inputs. A mode fault also clears the SPE and MSTR
bits in SPICR1. If the SPIE bit is also set, the MODF flag generates an
interrupt request.
Advance Information
414
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Functional Description
18.8.2 Slave Mode
Clearing the MSTR bit in SPICR1 puts the SPI in slave mode. The SCK
pin is the SPI clock input from the master, and the SS pin is the
slave-select input. For a transmission to occur, the SS pin must be driven
low and remain low until the transmission is complete.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The MSTR bit and the SPC0 bit in SPICR2 control the function of the
data pins, MOSI and MISO. The SS input also controls the MISO pin. If
SS is low, the MSB in the shift register shifts out on the MISO pin. If SS
is high, the MISO pin is in a high impedance state, and the slave ignores
the SCK input.
NOTE:
When using peripherals with full-duplex capability, do not simultaneously
enable two receivers that drive the same MISO output line.
As long as only one slave drives the master input line, it is possible for
several slaves to receive the same transmission simultaneously.
If the CPHA bit in SPICR1 is clear, odd-numbered edges on the SCK
input latch the data on the MOSI pin. Even-numbered edges shift the
data into the LSB position of the SPI shift register and shift the MSB out
to the MISO pin.
If the CPHA bit is set, even-numbered edges on the SCK input latch the
data on the MOSI pin. Odd-numbered edges shift the data into the LSB
position of the SPI shift register and shift the MSB out to the MISO pin.
The transmission is complete after the eighth shift. The received data
transfers to SPIDR, setting the SPIF flag in SPISR.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
415
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
18.8.3 Transmission Formats
The CPHA and CPOL bits in SPICR1 select one of four combinations of
serial clock phase and polarity. Clock phase and polarity must be
identical for the master SPI device and the communicating slave device.
18.8.3.1 Transfer Format When CPHA = 1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Some peripherals require the first SCK edge to occur before the slave
MSB becomes available at its MISO pin. When the CPHA bit is set, the
master SPI waits for a synchronization delay of one-half SCK clock
cycle. Then it issues the first SCK edge at the beginning of the
transmission. The first edge causes the slave to transmit its MSB to the
MISO pin of the master. The second edge and the following
even-numbered edges latch the data. The third edge and the following
odd-numbered edges shift the latched slave data into the master shift
register and shift master data out on the master MOSI pin.
After the 16th and final SCK edge:
•
Data that was in the master SPIDR register is in the slave SPIDR.
Data that was in the slave SPIDR register is in the master SPIDR.
•
The SCK clock stops and the SPIF flag in SPISR is set, indicating
that the transmission is complete. If the SPIE bit in SPCR1 is set,
SPIF generates an interrupt request.
Figure 18-11 shows the timing of a transmission with the CPHA bit set.
The SS pin of the master must be either high or configured as a
general-purpose output not affecting the SPI.
When CPHA = 1, the slave SS line can remain low between bytes. This
format is good for systems with a single master and a single slave driving
the MISO data line.
Writing to SPIDR while a transmission is in progress sets the WCOL flag
to indicate a write collision and inhibits the write. WCOL does not
generate an interrupt request; the SPIF interrupt request comes at the
end of the transfer that was in progress at the time of the error.
Advance Information
416
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Functional Description
BEGIN TRANSMISSION
END TRANSMISSION
SCK (CPOL = 0)
IF NEXT TRANSFER BEGINS HERE
SCK (CPOL = 1)
SAMPLE INPUT
MOSI/MISO
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
CHANGE OUTPUT
MOSI PIN
CHANGE OUTPUT
MISO PIN
SS PIN OUTPUT
MASTER ONLY
SLAVE SS PIN
tT
tL
MSB FIRST (LSBFE = 0):
LSB FIRST (LSBFE = 1):
MSB
LSB
BIT 6
BIT 1
BIT 5
BIT 2
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 2
BIT 5
BIT 1
BIT 6
LSB
MSB
tI
tL
MINIMUM 1/2 SCK
FOR tT, tL, tl
Legend:
tL = Minimum leading time before the first SCK edge
tT = Minimum trailing time after the last SCK edge
tI = Minimum idling time between transmissions (minimum SS high time)
tL, tT , and tI are guaranteed for master mode and required for slave mode.
Figure 18-11. SPI Clock Format 1 (CPHA = 1)
18.8.3.2 Transfer Format When CPHA = 0
In some peripherals, the slave MSB is available at its MISO pin as soon
as the slave is selected. When the CPHA bit is clear, the master SPI
delays its first SCK edge for half a SCK cycle after the transmission
starts. The first edge and all following odd-numbered edges latch the
slave data. Even-numbered SCK edges shift slave data into the master
shift register and shift master data out on the master MOSI pin.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
417
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
After the 16th and final SCK edge:
•
Data that was in the master SPIDR is in the slave SPIDR. Data
that was in the slave SPIDR is in the master SPIDR.
•
The SCK clock stops and the SPIF flag in SPISR is set, indicating
that the transmission is complete. If the SPIE bit in SPCR1 is set,
SPIF generates an interrupt request.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 18-12 shows the timing of a transmission with the CPHA bit clear.
The SS pin of the master must be either high or configured as a
general-purpose output not affecting the SPI.
When CPHA = 0, the slave SS pin must be negated and reasserted
between bytes.
BEGIN TRANSMISSION
END TRANSMISSION
SCK (CPOL = 0)
IF NEXT TRANSFER BEGINS HERE
SCK (CPOL = 1)
SAMPLE INPUT
MOSI/MISO
CHANGE OUTPUT
MOSI PIN
CHANGE OUTPUT
MISO PIN
SS PIN OUTPUT
MASTER ONLY
SLAVE SS PIN
tT
tL
MSB FIRST (LSBFE = 0):
LSB FIRST (LSBFE = 1):
MSB
LSB
Bit 6
Bit 1
Bit 5
Bit 2
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 2
Bit 5
Bit 1
Bit 6
LSB
MSB
tI
tL
MINIMUM 1/2 SCK
FOR tT, tL, tl
Legend:
tL = Minimum leading time before the first SCK edge
tT = Minimum trailing time after the last SCK edge
tI = Minimum idling time between transmissions (minimum SS high time)
tL, tT, and tI are guaranteed for master mode and required for slave mode.
Figure 18-12. SPI Clock Format 0 (CPHA = 0)
Advance Information
418
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Functional Description
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
NOTE:
Clock skew between the master and slave can cause data to be lost
when:
•
CPHA = 0, and,
•
The baud rate is the SPI clock divided by two, and
•
The master SCK frequency is half the slave SPI clock frequency,
and
•
Software writes to the slave SPIDR just before the synchronized
SS signal goes low.
The synchronized SS signal is synchronized to the SPI clock. Figure
18-13 shows an example with the synchronized SS signal almost a full
SPI clock cycle late. While the synchronized SS of the slave is high,
writing is allowed even though the SS pin is already low. The write can
change the MISO pin while the master is sampling the MISO line. The
first bit of the transfer may not be stable when the master samples it, so
the byte sent to the master may be corrupted.
SCK (CPOL = 0)
SCK (CPOL = 1)
SAMPLE I
MOSI/MISO
CHANGE O
MOSI PIN
CHANGE O
MISO PIN
SS PIN (I)
SPI CLOCK
SS SYNCHRONIZED
TO SPI CLOCK
MISO PIN
SPIDR WRITE
THIS CYCLE
Figure 18-13. Transmission Error Due to Master/Slave Clock Skew
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
419
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Also, if the slave generates a late write, its state machine may not have
time to reset, causing it to incorrectly receive a byte from the master.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This error is most likely when the SCK frequency is half the slave SPI
clock frequency. At other baud rates, the SCK skew is no more than one
SPI clock, and there is more time between the synchronized SS signal
and the first SCK edge. For example, with a SCK frequency one-fourth
the slave SPI clock frequency, there are two SPI clocks between the fall
of SS and the SCK edge.
As long as another late SPIDR write does not occur, the following bytes
to and from the slave are correctly transmitted.
18.8.4 SPI Baud Rate Generation
The baud rate generator divides the SPI clock to produce the SPI baud
clock. The SPPR[6:4] and SPR[2:0] bits in SPIBR select the SPI clock
divisor:
SPI clock divisor = (SPPR + 1) × 2(SPR+1)
where:
SPPR = the value written to bits SPPR[6:4]
SPR = the value written to bits SPR[2:0]
The baud rate generator is active only when the SPI is in master mode
and transmitting. Otherwise, the divider is inactive to reduce IDD current.
18.8.5 Slave-Select Output
The slave-select output feature automatically drives the SS pin low
during transmission to select external devices and drives it high during
idle to deselect external devices. When SS output is selected, the SS
output pin is connected to the SS input pin of the external device.
In master mode only, setting the SSOE bit in SPICR1 and the DDRSP[3]
bit in SPIDDR configures the SS pin as a slave-select output.
Setting the SSOE bit disables the mode fault feature.
NOTE:
Advance Information
420
Be careful when using the slave-select output feature in a multimaster
system. The mode fault feature is not available for detecting system
errors between masters.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Functional Description
18.8.6 Bidirectional Mode
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Setting the SPC0 bit in SPICR1 selects bidirectional mode (see
Table 18-7). The SPI uses only one data pin for the interface with
external device(s). The MSTR bit determines which pin to use. In master
mode, the MOSI pin is the master out/master in pin, MOMI. In slave
mode, the MISO pin is the slave out/slave in pin, SISO. The MISO pin in
master mode and MOSI pin in slave mode are general-purpose I/O pins.
The direction of each data I/O pin depends on its data direction register
bit. A pin configured as an output is the output from the shift register. A
pin configured as an input is the input to the shift register, and data
coming out of the shift register is discarded.
The SCK pin is an output in master mode and an input in slave mode.
The SS pin can be an input or an output in master mode, and it is always
an input in slave mode.
In bidirectional mode, a mode fault does not clear DDRSP0, the data
direction bit for the SISO pin.
Table 18-7. Normal Mode and Bidirectional Mode
SPE = 1
Master Mode, MSTR = 1
SERIAL OUT
Normal Mode
SPC0 = 0
SPI
MOSI
MISO
SWOM enables open drain output.
SERIAL OUT
Bidirectional Mode
SPC0 = 1
SPI
MOMI
SERIAL IN
SPI PORT
PIN 0
SWOM enables open drain output.
SPI port pin 0 is general-purpose I/O.
MISO
SWOM enables open drain output.
SPI PORT
PIN 1
SERIAL IN
SERIAL OUT
DDRSP0
SISO
SWOM enables open drain output.
SPI port pin 1 is general-purpose I/O.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
DDRSP0
SERIAL OUT
SPI
DDRSP1
MOSI
SERIAL IN
SPI
DDRSP1
SERIAL IN
Slave Mode, MSTR = 0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
421
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
18.8.7 Error Conditions
The SPI has two error conditions:
•
Write collision error
•
Mode fault error
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
18.8.7.1 Write Collision Error
The WCOL flag in SPISR indicates that a serial transfer was in progress
when the MCU tried to write new data to SPIDR. Valid write times are
listed below (see Figure 18-11 and Figure 18-12 for definitions of tT
and tI):
•
In master mode, a valid write is within tI (when SS is high).
•
In slave phase 0, a valid write within tI (when SS is high).
•
In slave phase 1, a valid write is within tT or tI (after the last SCK
edge and before SS goes low), excluding the first two SPI clocks
after the last SCK edge (the beginning of tT is an illegal write).
A write during any other time causes a WCOL error. The write is disabled
to avoid writing over the data being transmitted. WCOL does not
generate an interrupt request because the WCOL flag can be read upon
completion of the transmission that was in progress at the time of the
error.
18.8.7.2 Mode Fault Error
If the SS input of a master SPI goes low, it indicates a system error in
which more than one master may be trying to drive the MOSI and SCK
lines simultaneously. This condition is not permitted in normal operation;
it sets the MODF flag in SPISR. If the SPIE bit in SPICR1 is also set,
MODF generates an interrupt request.
Configuring the SS pin as a general-purpose output or a slave-select
output disables the mode fault function.
Advance Information
422
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Functional Description
A mode fault clears the SPE and MSTR bits and the DDRSP bits of the
SCK, MISO, and MOSI (or MOMI) pins. This forces those pins to be
high-impedance inputs to avoid any conflict with another output driver.
If the mode fault error occurs in bidirectional mode, the DDRSP bit of the
SISO pin is not affected, since it is a general-purpose I/O pin.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
18.8.8 Low-Power Mode Options
This subsection describes the low-power mode options.
18.8.8.1 Run Mode
Clearing the SPE bit in SPICR1 puts the SPI in a disabled, low-power
state. SPI registers are accessible, but SPI clocks are disabled.
18.8.8.2 Doze Mode
SPI operation in doze mode depends on the state of the SPISDOZ bit in
SPICR2.
•
If SPISDOZ is clear, the SPI operates normally in doze mode.
•
If SPISDOZ is set, the SPI clock stops, and the SPI enters a
low-power state in doze mode.
– Any master transmission in progress stops at doze mode entry
and resumes at doze mode exit.
– Any slave transmission in progress continues if a master
continues to drive the slave SCK pin. The slave stays
synchronized to the master SCK clock.
NOTE:
Although the slave shift register can receive MOSI data, it cannot
transfer data to SPIDR or set the SPIF flag in doze or stop mode. If the
slave enters doze mode in an idle state and exits doze mode in an idle
state, SPIF remains clear and no transfer to SPIDR occurs.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
423
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
18.8.8.3 Stop Mode
SPI operation in stop mode is the same as in doze mode with the
SPISDOZ bit set.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
18.9 Reset
Reset initializes the SPI registers to a known startup state as described
in 18.7 Memory Map and Registers. A transmission from a slave after
reset and before writing to the SPIDR register is either indeterminate or
the byte last received from the master before the reset. Reading the
SPIDR after reset returns 0s.
18.10 Interrupts
Table 18-8. SPI Interrupt Request Sources
Interrupt Request
Mode fault
Flag
Enable Bit
MODF
SPIE
Transmission complete
SPIF
18.10.1 Mode Fault (MODF) Flag
MODF is set when the SS pin of a master SPI is driven low and the SS
pin is configured as a mode-fault input. If the SPIE bit is also set, MODF
generates an interrupt request. A mode fault clears the SPE, MSTR, and
DDRSP[2:0] bits. Clear MODF by reading SPISR with MODF set and
then writing to SPICR1. Reset clears MODF.
18.10.2 SPI Interrupt Flag (SPIF)
SPIF is set after the eighth SCK cycle in a transmission when received
data transfers from the shift register to SPIDR. If the SPIE bit is also set,
SPIF generates an interrupt request. Once SPIF is set, no new data can
be transferred into SPIDR until SPIF is cleared. Clear SPIF by reading
SPISR with SPIF set and then accessing SPIDR. Reset clears SPIF.
Advance Information
424
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 19. Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.1 Contents
19.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 427
19.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 428
19.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429
19.5 Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .430
19.5.1 Debug Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 430
19.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .431
19.6 Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 431
19.6.1 Port QA Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 432
19.6.1.1
Port QA Analog Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .432
19.6.1.2
Port QA Digital Input/Output Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433
19.6.2 Port QB Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433
19.6.2.1
Port QB Analog Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .433
19.6.2.2
Port QB Digital Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .433
19.6.3 External Trigger Input Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
19.6.4 Multiplexed Address Output Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
19.6.5 Multiplexed Analog Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
19.6.6 Voltage Reference Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
19.6.7 Dedicated Analog Supply Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
19.6.8 Dedicated Digital I/O Port Supply Pin. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
19.7
Memory Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436
19.8 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 437
19.8.1 QADC Module Configuration Register (QADCMCR) . . . . .437
19.8.2 QADC Test Register (QADCTEST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .438
19.8.3 Port Data Registers (PORTQA and PORTQB) . . . . . . . . .438
19.8.4 Port QA and QB Data Direction Register
(DDRQA and DDRQB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
425
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.8.5
19.8.5.1
19.8.5.2
19.8.5.3
19.8.6
19.8.6.1
19.8.6.2
19.8.7
19.8.8
19.8.8.1
19.8.8.2
19.8.8.3
Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .442
QADC Control Register 0 (QACR0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442
QADC Control Register 1 (QACR1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 445
QADC Control Register 2 (QACR2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448
Status Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .453
QADC Status Register 0 (QASR0). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
QADC Status Register 1 (QASR1). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 462
Conversion Command Word Table (CCW) . . . . . . . . . . . . 463
Result Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .468
Right-Justified Unsigned Result Register (RJURR) . . . . 468
Left-Justified Signed Result Register (LJSRR) . . . . . . . 469
Left-Justified Unsigned Result Register (LJURR) . . . . . 470
19.9 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470
19.9.1 Result Coherency. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 470
19.9.2 External Multiplexing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 471
19.9.2.1
External Multiplexing Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .471
19.9.2.2
Module Version Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 473
19.9.3 Analog Subsystem . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 474
19.9.3.1
Analog-to-Digital Converter Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . .474
19.9.3.2
Conversion Cycle Times . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 475
19.9.3.3
Channel Decode and Multiplexer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 476
19.9.3.4
Sample Buffer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .476
19.9.3.5
Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) Array . . . . . . . . . . . . 476
19.9.3.6
Comparator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
19.9.3.7
Bias . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
19.9.3.8
Successive Approximation Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 477
19.9.3.9
State Machine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .477
19.10 Digital Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .478
19.10.1 Queue Priority Timing Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 478
19.10.1.1 Queue Priority . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .478
19.10.1.2 Queue Priority Schemes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 481
19.10.2 Boundary Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 492
19.10.3 Scan Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 493
19.10.4 Disabled Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
19.10.5 Reserved Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
19.10.6 Single-Scan Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 494
19.10.6.1 Software-Initiated Single-Scan Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 495
Advance Information
426
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Introduction
19.10.6.2 Externally Triggered Single-Scan Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . 496
19.10.6.3 Externally Gated Single-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
19.10.6.4 Interval Timer Single-Scan Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 497
19.10.7 Continuous-Scan Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 499
19.10.7.1 Software-Initiated Continuous-Scan Mode. . . . . . . . . . . 500
19.10.7.2 Externally Triggered Continuous-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . 501
19.10.7.3 Externally Gated Continuous-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . 501
19.10.7.4 Periodic Timer Continuous-Scan Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . 502
19.10.8 QADC Clock (QCLK) Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 503
19.10.9 Periodic/Interval Timer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .504
19.10.10 Conversion Command Word Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .505
19.10.11 Result Word Table . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 509
19.11 Pin Connection Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .509
19.11.1 Analog Reference Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .509
19.11.2 Analog Power Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 510
19.11.3 Conversion Timing Schemes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .512
19.11.4 Analog Supply Filtering and Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 515
19.11.5 Accommodating Positive/Negative Stress Conditions . . . .517
19.11.6 Analog Input Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .519
19.11.7 Analog Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 521
19.11.7.1 Settling Time for the External Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 522
19.11.7.2 Error Resulting from Leakage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 523
19.12 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524
19.12.1 Interrupt Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 524
19.12.2 Interrupt Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .525
19.2 Introduction
The queued analog-to-digital converter (QADC) is a 10-bit, unipolar,
successive approximation converter. Up to eight analog input channels
can be supported using internal multiplexing. A maximum of 18 input
channels can be supported in the expanded, externally multiplexed
mode.
The QADC consists of an analog front-end and a digital control
subsystem, which includes an IPbus interface block.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
427
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
The analog section includes input pins, an analog multiplexer, and
sample and hold analog circuits. The analog conversion is performed by
the digital-to-analog converter (DAC) resistor-capacitor (RC) array and
a high-gain comparator.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The digital control section contains queue control logic to sequence the
conversion process and interrupt generation logic. Also included are the
periodic/interval timer, control and status registers, the conversion
command word (CCW) table, random-access memory (RAM), and the
result table RAM.
The bus interface unit (BIU) provides access to registers that configure
the QADC, control the analog-to-digital converter and queue
mechanism, and present formatted conversion results.
19.3 Features
Features of the QADC module include:
•
Internal sample and hold
•
Up to eight analog input channels using internal multiplexing
•
Up to four external analog multiplexers directly supported
•
Up to 18 total input channels with internal and external
multiplexing
•
Programmable input sample time for various source impedances
•
Two conversion command word (CCW) queues with a total of 64
entries for setting conversion parameters of each A/D conversion
•
Subqueues possible using pause mechanism
•
Queue complete and pause interrupts available on both queues
•
Queue pointers indicating current location for each queue
•
Automated queue modes initiated by:
– External edge trigger and gated trigger
– Periodic/interval timer, within QADC module (queues 1 and 2)
– Software command
Advance Information
428
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Block Diagram
•
Single scan or continuous scan of queues
•
64 result registers
•
Output data readable in three formats:
– Right-justified unsigned
– Left-justified signed
– Left-justified unsigned
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
•
Unused analog channels can be used as discrete input/output
pins.
19.4 Block Diagram
EXTERNAL
MUX ADDRESS
ANALOG POWER
INPUTS
8 ANALOG CHANNELS
(18 WITH EXTERNAL MUXING)
REFERENCE
INPUTS
EXTERNAL
TRIGGERS
ANALOG INPUT MUX
AND DIGITAL
PIN FUNCTIONS
10-BIT
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL
CONVERTER
DIGITAL
CONTROL
64-ENTRY QUEUE
OF 10-BIT
CONVERSION
COMMAND WORDS
(CCWs)
IPBUS
INTERFACE
64-ENTRY TABLE
OF 10-BIT
RESULTS
10-BIT TO 16-BIT
RESULT ALIGNMENT
Figure 19-1. QADC Block Diagram
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
429
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.5 Modes of Operation
This subsection describes the two modes of operation in which the
QADC does not perform conversions in a regular fashion:
•
Debug mode
•
Stop mode
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.5.1 Debug Mode
The QDBG bit in the Module Configuration Register (QADCMCR)
governs behavior of the QADC when the CPU enters background debug
mode. When QDBG is clear, the QADC operates normally and is
unaffected by CPU background debug mode. See 19.8.1 QADC Module
Configuration Register (QADCMCR).
When QDBG is set and the CPU enters background debug mode, the
QADC finishes any conversion in progress and then freezes. This is
QADC debug mode. Depending on when debug mode is entered, the
three possible queue freeze scenarios are:
•
When a queue is not executing, the QADC freezes immediately.
•
When a queue is executing, the QADC completes the current
conversion and then freezes.
•
If during the execution of the current conversion, the queue
operating mode for the active queue is changed, or a queue 2
abort occurs, the QADC freezes immediately.
When the QADC enters debug mode while a queue is active, the current
CCW location of the queue pointer is saved.
Debug mode:
Advance Information
430
•
Stops the analog clock
•
Holds the periodic/interval timer in reset
•
Prevents external trigger events from being captured
•
Keeps all QADC registers and RAM accessible
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Signals
Although the QADC saves a pointer to the next CCW in the current
queue, software can force the QADC to execute a different CCW by
reconfiguring the QADC. When the QADC exits debug mode, it looks at
the queue operating modes, the current queue pointer, and any pending
trigger events to decide which CCW to execute.
19.5.2 Stop Mode
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The QADC enters a low-power idle state whenever the QSTOP bit is set
or the CPU enters low-power stop mode.
QADC stop:
•
Disables the analog-to-digital converter, effectively turning off the
analog circuit
•
Aborts the conversion sequence in progress
•
Makes the Data Direction Register (DDRQA), Port Data Registers
(PORTQA and PORTQB), Control Registers (QACR2, QACR1,
and QACR0) and the Status Registers (QASR1 and QASR0)
read-only. Only the Module Configuration Register (QADCMCR)
remains writable.
•
Makes the RAM inaccessible, so that valid data cannot be read
from RAM (result word table and CCW) or written to RAM (result
word table and CCW)
•
Resets QACR1, QACR2, QASR0, and QASR1
•
Holds the QADC periodic/interval timer in reset
Because the bias currents to the analog circuit are turned off in stop
mode, the QADC requires some recovery time (tSR) to stabilize the
analog circuits.
19.6 Signals
The QADC uses the external pins shown in Figure 19-2. There are eight
channel/port pins that can support up to 18 channels when external
multiplexing is used (including internal channels). All of the channel pins
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
431
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
also have some general-purpose input or input/output functionality. In
addition, there are also two analog reference pins and two analog
submodule power pins.
The QADC has external trigger inputs and multiplexer outputs that are
shared with some of the analog input pins.
The four port QA pins can be used as analog inputs or as a bidirectional
4-bit digital input/output port.
19.6.1.1 Port QA Analog Input Pins
INTERNAL DIGITAL POWER
SHARED WITH OTHER MODULES
VSSI
VDDI
ANALOG POWER AND GROUND
VSSA
VDDA
ANALOG REFERENCES
VRH
VRL
PORT QB ANALOG INPUTS
EXTERNAL MUX INPUTS
DIGITAL INPUTS
PORT QA ANALOG INPUTS
EXTERNAL TRIGGER INPUTS
EXTERNAL MUX ADDRESS OUTPUTS
DIGITAL I/O
AN0/ANW/PQB0
AN1/ANX/PQB1
AN2/ANY/PQB2
AN3/ANZ/PQB3
PORT QB
When used as analog inputs, the four port QA pins are referred to as
AN[56:55, 53:52]. Due to the digital output drivers associated with
port QA, the analog characteristics of port QA may be different from
those of port QB.
ANALOG
MUX AND
PORT LOGIC
AN52/MA0/PQA0
AN53/MA1/PQA1
AN55/ETRIG1/PQA3
AN56/ETRIG2/PQA4
ANALOG
CONVERTER
DIGITAL
RESULTS
AND
CONTROL
PORT QA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.6.1 Port QA Pin Functions
Figure 19-2. QADC Input and Output Signals
Advance Information
432
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Signals
19.6.1.2 Port QA Digital Input/Output Pins
Port QA pins are referred to as PQA[4:3, 1:0] when used as a
bidirectional 4-bit digital input/output port. These four pins may be used
for general-purpose digital input signals or digital output signals.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Port QA pins are connected to a digital input synchronizer during reads
and may be used as general-purpose digital inputs when the applied
voltages meet high-voltage input (VIH) and low-voltage input (VIL)
requirements.
Each port QA pin is configured as an input or output by programming the
Port Data Direction Register (DDRQA). The digital input signal states are
read from the port QA Data Register (PORTQA) when DDRQA specifies
that the pins are inputs. The digital data in PORTQA is driven onto the
port QA pins when the corresponding bits in DDRQA specify output.
See 19.8.4 Port QA and QB Data Direction Register (DDRQA and
DDRQB).
19.6.2 Port QB Pin Functions
The four port QB pins can be used as analog inputs or as a 4-bit digital
input-only port.
19.6.2.1 Port QB Analog Input Pins
When used as analog inputs, the four port QB pins are referred to as
AN[3:0]. Because port QB functions as analog and digital input only, the
analog characteristics may be different from those of port QA.
19.6.2.2 Port QB Digital Input Pins
Port QB pins are referred to as PQB[3:0] when used as a 4-bit digital
input/output port. In addition to functioning as analog input pins, the port
QB pins are also connected to the input of a synchronizer during reads
and may be used as general-purpose digital inputs when the applied
voltages meet VIH and VIL requirements.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
433
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Each port QB pin is configured as an input or output by programming the
Port Data Direction Register (DDRQB). The digital input signal states are
read from the port QB Data Register (PORTQB) when DDRQB specifies
that the pins are inputs. The digital data in PORTQB is driven onto the
port QB pins when the corresponding bits in DDRQB specify output.
See 19.8.4 Port QA and QB Data Direction Register (DDRQA and
DDRQB).
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.6.3 External Trigger Input Pins
The QADC has two external trigger pins, ETRIG2 and ETRIG1. Each
external trigger input is associated with one of the scan queues, queue
1 or queue 2. The assignment of ETRIG[2:1] to a queue is made by the
TRG bit in QADC Control Register 0 (QACR0). When TRG = 0, ETRIG1
triggers queue 1 and ETRIG2 triggers queue 2. When TRG = 1, ETRIG1
triggers queue 2 and ETRIG2 triggers queue 1. See 19.8.5 Control
Registers.
19.6.4 Multiplexed Address Output Pins
In non-multiplexed mode, the QADC analog input pins are connected to
an internal multiplexer which routes the analog signals into the internal
A/D converter.
In externally multiplexed mode, the QADC allows automatic channel
selection through up to four external 4-to-1 multiplexer chips. The QADC
provides a 2-bit multiplexed address output to the external multiplexer
chips to allow selection of one of four inputs. The multiplexed address
output signals, MA1 and MA0, can be used as multiplexed address
output bits or as general-purpose I/O when external multiplexed mode is
not being used.
MA[1:0] are used as the address inputs for up to four 4-channel
multiplexer chips. Because the MA[1:0] pins are digital outputs in
multiplexed mode, the state of their corresponding data direction bits in
DDRQA is ignored.
Advance Information
434
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Signals
19.6.5 Multiplexed Analog Input Pins
In external multiplexed mode, four of the port QB pins are redefined to
each represent four analog input channels. See Table 19-1.
Table 19-1. Multiplexed Analog Input Channels
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Multiplexed
Analog Input
Channels
ANw
Even numbered channels from 0 to 6
ANx
Odd numbered channels from 1 to 7
ANy
Even numbered channels from 16 to 22
ANz
Odd numbered channels from 17 to 23
19.6.6 Voltage Reference Pins
VRH and VRL are the dedicated input pins for the high and low reference
voltages. Separating the reference inputs from the power supply pins
allows for additional external filtering, which increases reference voltage
precision and stability, and subsequently contributes to a higher degree
of conversion accuracy.
NOTE:
VRH and VRL must be set to VDDA and VSSA potential, respectively.
19.6.7 Dedicated Analog Supply Pins
The VDDA and VSSA pins supply power to the analog subsystems of the
QADC module. Dedicated power is required to isolate the sensitive
analog circuitry from the normal levels of noise present on the digital
power supply.
19.6.8 Dedicated Digital I/O Port Supply Pin
VDDH provides 5-V power to the digital I/O functions of QADC port QA
and port QB. This allows those pins to tolerate 5 volts when configured
as inputs and drive 5 volts when configured as outputs.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
435
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.7 Memory Map
The QADC occupies 1 Kbyte, or 512 half-word (16-bit) entries, of
address space. Ten half-word registers are control, port, and status
registers, 64 half-word entries are the CCW table, and 64 half-word
entries are the result table which occupies 192 half-word address
locations because the result data is readable in three data alignment
formats. Table 19-2 is the QADC memory map.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 19-2. QADC Memory Map
Address
MSB
LSB
Access (1)
0x00ca_0000
QADC Module Configuration Register (QADCMCR)
S
0x00ca_0002
QADC Test Register (QADCTEST)(2)
S
0x00ca_0004
Reserved
(3)
—
0x00ca_0006
Port QA Data Register (PORTQA)
Port QB Data Register (PORTQB)
S/U
0x00ca_0008
Port QA Data Direction Register
(DDRQA)
Port QB Data Direction Register
(DDRQB)
S/U
0x00ca_000a
QADC Control Register 0 (QACR0)
S/U
0x00ca_000c
QADC Control Register 1 (QACR1)
S/U
0x00ca_000e
QADC Control Register 2 (QACR2)
S/U
0x00ca_0010
QADC Status Register 0 (QASR0)
S/U
0x00ca_0012
QADC Status Register 1 (QASR1)
S/U
0x00ca_0014–
0x00ca_01fe
Reserved(3)
—
0x00ca_0200–
0x00ca_027e
Conversion Command Word Table (CCW)
S/U
0x00ca_0280–
0x00ca_02fe
Right Justified, Unsigned Result Register (RJURR)
S/U
0x00ca_0300–
0x00ca_037e
Left Justified, Signed Result Register (LJSRR)
S/U
0x00ca_0380–
0x00ca_03fe
Left Justified, Unsigned Result Register (LJURR)
S/U
1. S = CPU supervisor mode access only. S/U = CPU supervisor or user mode access. User mode accesses to supervisor
only addresses have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
2. Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error if not in test mode.
3. Read/writes have no effect and the access terminates with a transfer error exception.
Advance Information
436
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
19.8 Register Descriptions
This subsection describes the QADC registers.
19.8.1 QADC Module Configuration Register (QADCMCR)
QADCMCR contains bits that control QADC debug and stop modes and
determines the privilege level required to access most registers.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: 0x00ca_0000 and 0x00ca_0001
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
QSTOP
QDBG
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
SUPV
Write:
Reset:
1
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 19-3. QADC Module Configuration Register (QADCMCR)
QSTOP — Stop Enable Bit
1 = Force QADC to idle state.
0 = QADC operates normally.
QDBG — Debug Enable Bit
1 = Finish any conversion in progress, then freeze in debug mode
0 = QADC operates normally.
SUPV — Supervisor/Unrestricted Data Space Bit
1 = All QADC registers are accessible in supervisor mode only;
user mode accesses have no effect and result in a cycle
termination error.
0 = Only QADCMCR and QADCTEST require supervisor mode
access; access to all other QADC registers is unrestricted
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
437
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.8.2 QADC Test Register (QADCTEST)
QADCTEST is used only during factory testing of the MCU. Attempts to
access this register outside of factory test mode will result in access
privilege violation.
Address: 0x00ca_0002 and 0x00ca_0003
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Read:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error if not in test mode.
Write:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Access results in the module generating an access termination transfer error if not in test mode.
Write:
Figure 19-4. QADC Test Register (QADCTEST)
19.8.3 Port Data Registers (PORTQA and PORTQB)
QADC ports QA and QB are accessed through two 8-bit port data
registers (PORTQA and PORTQB).
Port QA pins are referred to as PQA[4:3, 1:0] when used as a
bidirectional, 4-bit, input/output port. Port QA can also be used for
analog inputs (AN[56:55, 53:52]), external trigger inputs (ETRIG[2:1]),
and external multiplexer address outputs (MA[1:0]).
Port QB pins are referred to as PQB[3:0] when used as a 4-bit, digital
input-only port. Port QB can also be used for non-multiplexed (AN[3:0])
and multiplexed (ANz, ANy, ANx, ANw) analog inputs.
PORTQA and PORTQB are not initialized by reset.
Advance Information
438
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
Address: 0x00ca_0006
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
0
0
0
4
3
PQA4
PQA3
P
P
2
1
Bit 0
PQA1
PQA0
P
P
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
P = Current pin state if DDR is input; otherwise, undefined
Analog Channel:
Muxed Address Outputs:
External Trigger Inputs:
AN56
AN55
ETRIG2
ETRIG1
AN53
MA1
AN52
MA0
Figure 19-5. QADC Port QA Data Register (PORTQA)
Address: 0x00ca_0007
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
PQB3
PQB2
PQB1
PQB0
P
P
P
P
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
P = Current pin state if DDR is input; otherwise, undefined
Analog Channel:
Muxed Analog Inputs:
AN3
AN2
AN2
ANy
AN1
ANx
AN0
ANw
Figure 19-6. QADC Port QB Data Register (PORTQB)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime except during stop mode
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
439
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.8.4 Port QA and QB Data Direction Register (DDRQA and DDRQB)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The Port QA and QB Data Direction Register (DDRQA and DDRQB) are
associated with port QA and QB digital I/O pins. Setting a bit in these
registers configures the corresponding pin as an output. Clearing a bit in
these registers configures the corresponding pin as an input. During
QADC initialization, port QA and QB pins that will be used as direct or
multiplexed analog inputs must have their corresponding data direction
register bits cleared. When a port QA or QB pin that is programmed as
an output is selected for analog conversion, the voltage sampled is that
of the output digital driver as influenced by the load.
When the MUX (externally multiplexed) bit is set in QACR0, the data
direction register settings are ignored for the bits corresponding to
PQA[1:0], the two multiplexed address (MA[1:0]) output pins. The
MA[1:0] pins are forced to be digital outputs, regardless of their data
direction setting, and the multiplexed address outputs are driven. The
data returned during a port data register read is the value of the MA[1:0]
pins, regardless of their data direction setting.
Similarly, when the external trigger pins are assigned to port pins and
external trigger queue operating mode is selected, the data direction
setting for the corresponding pins, PQA3 and/or PQA4, is ignored. The
port pins are forced to be digital inputs for ETRIG1 and/or ETRIG2. The
data returned during a port data register read is the value of ETRIG[2:1]
pins, regardless of their data direction setting.
NOTE:
Advance Information
440
Use caution when mixing digital and analog inputs. They should be
isolated as much as possible. Rise and fall times should be as large as
possible to minimize ac coupling effects.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
Address: 0x00ca_0008 and 0x00ca_0009
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
0
0
0
12
11
DDQA4
DDQA3
10
9
Bit 8
DDQA1
DDQA0
0
Write:
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
DDQB3
DDQB2
DDQB1
DDQB0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 19-7. QADC Port QA Data Direction Register (DDRQA)
and Port QB Data Direction Register (DDRQB)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime except during stop mode
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
441
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.8.5 Control Registers
This subsection describes the QADC control registers.
19.8.5.1 QADC Control Register 0 (QACR0)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
QADC Control Register 0 (QACR0) establishes the QADC sampling
clock (QCLK) with prescaler parameter fields and defines whether
external multiplexing is enabled. Typically, these bits are written once
when the QADC is initialized and not changed thereafter.
Address: 0x00ca_000a and 0x00ca_000b
Bit 15
Read:
14
13
0
0
MUX
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
TRG
Write:
Reset:
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
QPR6
QPR5
QPR4
QPR3
QPR2
QPR1
QPR0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
Write:
Reset:
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 19-8. QADC Control Register 0 (QACR0)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime except during stop mode
MUX — Externally Multiplexed Mode Bit
The MUX bit configures the QADC for operation in externally
multiplexed mode, which affects the interpretation of the channel
numbers and forces the MA[1:0] pins to be outputs.
1 = Externally multiplexed, up to 18 possible channels
0 = Internally multiplexed, up to 8 possible channels
Advance Information
442
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
TRG — Trigger Assignment Bit
The TRG bit determines the queue assignment of the ETRIG[2:1]
pins.
1 = ETRIG1 triggers queue 2; ETRIG2 triggers queue 1.
0 = ETRIG1 triggers queue 1; ETRIG2 triggers queue 2.
QPR[6:0] — Prescaler Clock Divider Bits
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The read/write QPR[6:0] bits select the system clock divisor to
generate the QADC clock as Table 19-3 shows. The resulting QADC
clock rate can be given as:
fQCLK =
fSYS
QPR[6:0] + 1
where:
1 <= QPR[6:0] <= 127.
If QPR[6:0] = 0, then the QPR register field value is read as a 1 and
the prescaler divisor is 2.
The prescaler should be selected so that the QADC clock rate is
within the required fQCLK range. See Table 23-8. QADC
Conversion Specifications (Operating).
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
443
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 19-3. Prescaler fSYS Divide-by Values
QPR[6:0]
fSYS
Divisor
QPR[6:0]
fSYS
Divisor
QPR[6:0]
fSYS
Divisor
QPR[6:0]
fSYS
Divisor
0000000
2
0100000
33
1000000
65
1100000
97
0000001
2
0100001
34
1000001
66
1100001
98
0000010
3
0100010
35
1000010
67
1100010
99
0000011
4
0100011
36
1000011
68
1100011
100
0000100
5
0100100
37
1000100
69
1100100
101
0000101
6
0100101
38
1000101
70
1100101
102
0000110
7
0100110
39
1000110
71
1100110
103
0000111
8
0100111
40
1000111
72
1100111
104
0001000
9
0101000
41
1001000
73
1101000
105
0001001
10
0101001
42
1001001
74
1101001
106
0001010
11
0101010
43
1001010
75
1101010
107
0001011
12
0101011
44
1001011
76
1101011
108
0001100
13
0101100
45
1001100
77
1101100
109
0001101
14
0101101
46
1001101
78
1101101
110
0001110
15
0101110
47
1001110
79
1101110
111
0001111
16
0101111
48
1001111
80
1101111
112
0010000
17
0110000
49
1010000
81
1110000
113
0010001
18
0110001
50
1010001
82
1110001
114
0010010
19
0110010
51
1010010
83
1110010
115
0010011
20
0110011
52
1010011
84
1110011
116
0010100
21
0110100
53
1010100
85
1110100
117
0010101
22
0110101
54
1010101
86
1110101
118
0010110
23
0110110
55
1010110
87
1110110
119
0010111
24
0110111
56
1010111
88
1110111
120
0011000
25
0111000
57
1011000
89
1111000
121
0011001
26
0111001
58
1011001
90
1111001
122
0011010
27
0111010
59
1011010
91
1111010
123
0011011
28
0111011
60
1011011
92
1111011
124
0011100
29
0111100
61
1011100
93
1111100
125
0011101
30
0111101
62
1011101
94
1111101
126
0011110
31
0111110
63
1011110
95
1111110
127
0011111
32
0111111
64
1011111
96
1111111
128
Advance Information
444
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
19.8.5.2 QADC Control Register 1 (QACR1)
QADC Control Register 1 (QACR1) is the mode control register for
queue 1. This register governs queue operating mode and the use of
completion and/or pause interrupts. Typically, these bits are written once
when the QADC is initialized and not changed thereafter.
Stop mode resets this register ($0000).
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: 0x00ca_000c and 0x00ca_000d
Read:
Bit 15
14
CIE1
PIE1
Write:
Reset:
Read:
13
0
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
MQ112
MQ111
MQ110
MQ19
MQ18
SSE1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 19-9. QADC Control Register 1 (QACR1)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime except during stop mode
CIE1 — Queue 1 Completion Interrupt Enable Bit
CIE1 enables an interrupt request upon completion of queue 1. The
interrupt request is initiated when the conversion is complete for the
last CCW in queue 1.
1 = Enable queue 1 completion interrupt.
0 = Disable queue 1 completion interrupt.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
445
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
PIE1 — Queue 1 Pause Interrupt Enable Bit
PIE1 enables an interrupt request when queue 1 enters the pause
state. The interrupt request is initiated when conversion is complete
for a CCW that has the pause bit set.
1 = Enable the queue 1 pause interrupt.
0 = Disable the queue 1 pause interrupt.
SSE1 — Queue 1 Single-Scan Enable Bit
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SSE1 enables a single-scan of queue 1 after a trigger event occurs.
SSE1 may be set during the same write cycle that sets the MQ1 bits
for one of the single-scan queue operating modes. The single-scan
enable bit can be written to 1 or 0, but is always read as a 0, unless
the QADC is in test mode. The QADC clears SSE1 when the
single-scan is complete.
1 = Allow a trigger event to start queue 1 in a single-scan mode.
0 = Trigger events are ignored for queue 1 single-scan modes.
MQ1[12:8] — Queue 1 Operating Mode Field
The MQ1 field selects the operating mode for queue 1.
Table 19-4 shows the bits in the MQ1 field which enable different
queue 1 operating modes.
Table 19-4. Queue 1 Operating Modes
MQ1[12:8]
Advance Information
446
Operating Mode
00000
Disabled mode, conversions do not occur
00001
Software-triggered single-scan mode (started with SSE1)
00010
External-trigger rising-edge single-scan mode
00011
External-trigger falling-edge single-scan mode
00100
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 27
00101
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 28
00110
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 29
00111
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 210
01000
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 211
01001
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 212
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
Table 19-4. Queue 1 Operating Modes (Continued)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
MQ1[12:8]
Operating Mode
01010
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 213
01011
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 214
01100
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 215
01101
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 216
01110
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 217
01111
Externally gated single-scan mode (started with SSE1)
10000
Reserved mode
10001
Software-triggered continuous-scan mode
10010
External-trigger rising-edge continuous-scan mode
10011
External-trigger falling-edge continuous-scan mode
10100
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 27
10101
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 28
10110
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 29
10111
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 210
11000
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 211
11001
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 212
11010
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 213
11011
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 214
11100
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 215
11101
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 216
11110
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period × 217
11111
Externally gated continuous-scan mode
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
447
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.8.5.3 QADC Control Register 2 (QACR2)
QADC Control Register 2 (QACR2) is the mode control register for
queue 2. This register governs queue operating mode and the use of
completion and/or pause interrupts. Typically, these bits are written once
when the QADC is initialized and not changed thereafter.
Stop mode resets this register ($007f).
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: 0x00ca_000e and 0x00ca_000f
Bit 15
14
CIE2
PIE2
Read:
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
MQ212
MQ211
MQ210
MQ29
MQ28
0
Write:
Reset:
13
SSE2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
RESUME
BQ26
BQ25
BQ24
BQ23
BQ22
BQ21
BQ20
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 19-10. QADC Control Register 2 (QACR2)
Read: Anytime
Write: Anytime except during stop mode
CIE2 — Queue 2 Completion Software Interrupt Enable Bit
CIE2 enables an interrupt request upon completion of queue 2. The
interrupt request is initiated when the conversion is complete for the
last CCW in queue 2.
1 = Enable queue 2 completion interrupts.
0 = Disable queue 2 completion interrupts.
Advance Information
448
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
PIE2 — Queue 2 Pause Software Interrupt Enable Bit
PIE2 enables an interrupt request when queue 2 enters the pause
state. The interrupt request is initiated when conversion is complete
for a CCW that has the pause bit set.
1 = Enable the queue 2 pause interrupt.
0 = Disable the queue 2 pause interrupt.
SSE2 — Queue 2 Single-Scan Enable Bit
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SSE2 enables a single-scan of queue 2 after a trigger event occurs.
SSE2 may be set during the same write cycle that sets the MQ2 bits
for one of the single-scan queue operating modes. The single-scan
enable bit can be written to 1 or 0, but is always read as a 0, unless
the QADC is in test mode. The QADC clears SSE2 when the
single-scan is complete.
1 = Allow a trigger event to start queue 2 in a single-scan mode.
0 = Trigger events are ignored for queue 2 single-scan modes.
MQ2[12:8] — Queue 2 Operating Mode Field
The MQ2 field selects the operating mode for queue 2.
Table 19-5 shows the bits in the MQ2 field which enable different
queue 2 operating modes.
Table 19-5. Queue 2 Operating Modes
MQ2[12:8]
Operating Modes
00000
Disabled mode, conversions do not occur
00001
Software triggered single-scan mode (started with SSE2)
00010
Externally triggered rising edge single-scan mode
00011
Externally triggered falling edge single-scan mode
00100
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 27
00101
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 28
00110
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 29
00111
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 210
01000
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 211
01001
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 212
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
449
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Table 19-5. Queue 2 Operating Modes (Continued)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
MQ2[12:8]
Advance Information
450
Operating Modes
01010
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 213
01011
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 214
01100
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 215
01101
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 216
01110
Interval timer single-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 217
01111
Reserved mode
10000
Reserved mode
10001
Software triggered continuous-scan mode
10010
Externally triggered rising edge continuous-scan mode
10011
Externally triggered falling edge continuous-scan mode
10100
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 27
10101
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 28
10110
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 29
10111
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 210
11000
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 211
11001
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 212
11010
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 213
11011
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 214
11100
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 215
11101
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 216
11110
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode: time = QCLK period x 217
11111
Reserved mode
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
RESUME — Queue 2 Resume Bit
RESUME selects the resumption point for queue 2 after its operation
is suspended due to a queue 1 trigger event. If RESUME is changed
during the execution of queue 2, the change is not recognized until an
end-of-queue condition is reached or the operating mode of queue 2
is changed.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The primary reason for selecting re-execution of the entire queue or
subqueue is to guarantee that all samples are taken consecutively in
one scan (coherency).
When subqueues are not used, queue 2 execution restarts after
suspension with the first CCW in queue 2. When a pause has
previously occurred in queue 2 execution, queue execution restarts
after suspension with the first CCW in the current subqueue.
A subqueue is considered to be a stand-alone sequence of
conversions. Once a pause flag has been set to report subqueue
completion, that subqueue is not repeated until all CCWs in queue 2
are executed.
An example of using the RESUME bit is when the frequency of
queue 1 trigger events prohibit queue 2 completion. If the rate of
queue 1 execution is too high, it is best for queue 2 execution to
continue with the CCW that was being converted when queue 2 was
suspended. This allows queue 2 to eventually complete execution.
1 = After suspension, begin execution with the aborted CCW in
queue 2.
0 = After suspension, begin execution with the first CCW of
queue 2 or the current subqueue of queue 2.
BQ2[6:0] — Beginning of Queue 2 Field
BQ2[6:0] denotes the CCW location where queue 2 begins. This
allows the length of queue 1 and queue 2 to vary. The BQ2 field also
serves as an end-of-queue condition for queue 1.
The beginning of queue 2 is defined by programming the BQ2 field in
QACR2. BQ2 is usually set before or at the same time as the queue
operating mode for queue 2 is selected. If BQ2[6:0] ≥ 64, queue 2 has
no entries, the entire CCW table is dedicated to queue 1, and CCW63
is the end-of-queue 1. If BQ2[6:0] is 0, the entire CCW table is
dedicated to queue 2. A special case occurs when an operating mode
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
451
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
is selected for queue 1 and a trigger event occurs for queue 1 with
BQ2 set to 0. Queue 1 execution starts momentarily, but is terminated
after CCW0 is read. No conversions occur.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The BQ2[6:0] pointer may be changed dynamically to alternate
between queue 2 scan sequences. A change in BQ2 after queue 2
has begun or when queue 2 has a trigger pending does not affect
queue 2 until it is started again. For example, two scan sequences
could be defined as follows: The first sequence starts at CCW10, with
a pause after CCW11 and an end of queue (EOQ) programmed in
CCW15; the second sequence starts at CCW16, with a pause after
CCW17 and an EOQ programmed in CCW39.
With BQ2[6:0] set to CCW10 and the continuous-scan mode
selected, queue execution begins. When the pause is encountered in
CCW11, an interrupt service routine can retarget BQ2[6:0] to CCW16.
When the end-of-queue is recognized in CCW15, an internal retrigger
event is generated and execution restarts at CCW16. When the
pause software interrupt occurs again, BQ2 can be changed back to
CCW10. After the end-of-queue is recognized in CCW39, an internal
retrigger event is created and execution now restarts at CCW10.
If BQ2[6:0] is changed while queue 1 is active, the effect of BQ2[6:0]
as an end-of-queue indication for queue 1 is immediate. However,
beware of the risk of losing the end-of-queue 1 when changing
BQ2[6:0]. Using EOQ (channel 63) to end queue 1 is recommended.
NOTE:
If BQ2[6:0] was assigned to the CCW that queue 1 is currently working
on, then that conversion is completed before the change to BQ2[6:0]
takes effect.
Each time a CCW is read for queue 1, the CCW location is compared
with the current value of the BQ2[6:0] pointer to detect a possible
end-of-queue condition. For example, if BQ2[6:0] is changed to
CCW3 while queue 1 is converting CCW2, queue 1 is terminated after
the conversion is completed. However, if BQ2[6:0] is changed to
CCW1 while queue 1 is converting CCW2, the QADC would not
recognize a BQ2[6:0] end-of-queue condition until queue 1 execution
reached CCW1 again, presumably on the next pass through the
queue.
Advance Information
452
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
19.8.6 Status Registers
This subsection describes the QADC status registers.
19.8.6.1 QADC Status Register 0 (QASR0)
QADC Status Register 0 (QASR0) contains information about the state
of each queue and the current A/D conversion.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Stop mode resets this register ($0000).
Address: 0x00ca_0010 and 0x00ca_0011
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
CF1
PF1
CF2
PF2
TOR1
TOR2
QS9
QS8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
QS7
QS6
CWP5
CWP4
CWP3
CWP2
CWP1
CWP0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 19-11. QADC Status Register 0 (QASR0)
Read: Anytime
Write:
For flag bits (CF1, PF1, CF2, PF2, TOR1, TOR2): Writing a 1 has no
effect, write a 0 to clear.
For QS[9:6] and CWP: Writes have no effect.
CF1 — Queue 1 Completion Flag
CF1 indicates that a queue 1 scan has been completed. CF1 is set by
the QADC when the input channel sample requested by the last CCW
in queue 1 is converted, and the result is stored in the result table.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
453
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
The end-of-queue 1 is identified when execution is complete on the
CCW in the location prior to that pointed to by BQ2, when the current
CCW contains the end-of-queue code (channel 63) instead of a valid
channel number, or when the currently completed CCW is in the last
location of the CCW RAM.
When CF1 is set and queue 1 completion interrupts are enabled
(CIE1 = 1), the QADC requests an interrupt. The interrupt request is
cleared when a 0 is written to the CF1 bit after it has been read as a
1. Once set, CF1 can be cleared only by a reset or by writing a 0 to it.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
CF1 is updated by the QADC regardless of whether the
corresponding interrupt is enabled. This allows polled recognition of
queue 1 scan completion.
PF1 — Queue 1 Pause Flag
PF1 indicates that a queue 1 scan has reached a pause. PF1 is set
by the QADC when the current queue 1 CCW has the pause bit set,
the selected input channel has been converted, and the result has
been stored in the result table.
Once PF1 is set, the queue enters the paused state and waits for a
trigger event to allow queue execution to continue. However, a
special case occurs when the CCW with the pause bit set is the last
CCW in a queue; queue execution is complete. The queue status
becomes idle, not paused, and both the pause and completion flags
are set.
Another special case occurs when queue 1 is operating in
software-initiated single-scan or continuous-scan mode and a CCW
pause bit is set. The QADC will set PF1 and will also automatically
generate a retrigger event that restarts execution after two QCLK
cycles. Pause mode is never entered.
When PF1 is set and interrupts are enabled (PIE1 = 1), the QADC
requests an interrupt. The interrupt request is cleared when a 0 is
written to PF1, after it has been read as a 1. Once set, PF1 can be
cleared only by reset or by writing a 0 to it.
In externally gated single-scan and continuous-scan mode, the
behavior of PF1 has been redefined. When the gate closes before the
end-of-queue 1 is reached, PF1 is set to indicate that an incomplete
scan has occurred. In single-scan mode, a resultant interrupt can be
Advance Information
454
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
used to determine if queue 1 should be enabled again. In either
externally gated mode, setting PF1 indicates that the results for
queue 1 have not been collected during one scan (coherently).
NOTE:
If a set CCW pause bit is encountered in either externally gated mode,
the pause flag will not set, and execution continues without pausing. This
has allowed for the modified behavior of PF1 in the externally gated
modes.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
PF1 is maintained by the QADC regardless of whether the
corresponding interrupt is enabled. PF1 may be polled to determine if
the QADC has reached a pause in scanning a queue.
1 = Queue 1 has reached a pause or gate closed before
end-of-queue in gated mode.
0 = Queue 1 has not reached a pause or gate has not closed before
end-of-queue in gated mode.
See Table 19-6 for a summary of CCW pause bit response in all scan
modes.
Table 19-6. CCW Pause Bit Response
Scan Mode
Queue Operation
PF Asserts?
Externally triggered single-scan
Pauses
Yes
Externally triggered continuous-scan
Pauses
Yes
Interval timer trigger single-scan
Pauses
Yes
Interval timer continuous-scan
Pauses
Yes
Software-initiated single-scan
Continues
Yes
Software-initiated continuous-scan
Continues
Yes
Externally gated single-scan
Continues
No
Externally gated continuous-scan
Continues
No
CF2 — Queue 2 Completion Flag
CF2 indicates that a queue 2 scan has been completed. CF2 is set by
the QADC when the input channel sample requested by the last CCW
in queue 2 is converted, and the result is stored in the result table.
The end-of-queue 2 is identified when the current CCW contains
an end-of-queue code (channel 63) instead of a valid channel number
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
455
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
or when the currently completed CCW is in the last location of the
CCW RAM.
When CF2 is set and queue 2 completion interrupts are enabled
(CIE2 = 1), the QADC requests an interrupt. The interrupt request is
cleared when a 0 is written to the CF2 bit after it has been read as a
1. Once set, CF2 can be cleared only by a reset or by writing a 0 to it.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
CF2 is updated by the QADC regardless of whether the
corresponding interrupt is enabled. This allows polled recognition of
queue 2 scan completion.
PF2 — Queue 2 Pause Flag
PF2 indicates that a queue 2 scan has reached a pause. PF2 is set
by the QADC when the current queue 2 CCW has the pause bit set,
the selected input channel has been converted, and the result has
been stored in the result table.
Once PF2 is set, the queue enters the paused state and waits for a
trigger event to allow queue execution to continue. However, a
special case occurs when the CCW with the pause bit set is the last
CCW in a queue: Queue execution is complete. The queue status
becomes idle, not paused, and both the pause and completion flags
are set.
Another special case occurs when queue 2 is operating in
software-initiated single-scan or continuous-scan mode and a CCW
pause bit is set. The QADC will set PF2 and will also automatically
generate a retrigger event that restarts execution after two QCLK
cycles. Pause mode is never entered.
When PF2 is set and interrupts are enabled (PIE2 = 1), the QADC
requests an interrupt. The interrupt request is cleared when a 0 is
written to PF2, after it has been read as a 1. Once set, PF2 can be
cleared only by a reset or by writing a 0 to it.
PF2 is maintained by the QADC regardless of whether the
corresponding interrupt is enabled. PF2 may be polled to determine if
the QADC has reached a pause in scanning a queue.
1 = Queue 2 has reached a pause.
0 = Queue 2 has not reached a pause.
See Table 19-6 for a summary of pause response in all scan modes.
Advance Information
456
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
TOR1 — Queue 1 Trigger Overrun Flag
TOR1 indicates that an unexpected trigger event has occurred for
queue 1. TOR1 can be set only while queue 1 is in the active state.
A trigger event generated by a transition on the external trigger pin or
by the periodic/interval timer may be captured as a trigger overrun.
TOR1 cannot be set when the software-initiated single-scan mode or
the software-initiated continuous-scan mode is selected.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
TOR1 is set when a trigger event is received while a queue is
executing and before the scan has completed or paused. TOR1 has
no effect on queue execution.
After a trigger event has occurred for queue 1, and before the scan
has completed or paused, additional queue 1 trigger events are not
retained. Such trigger events are considered unexpected, and the
QADC sets the TOR1 error status bit. An unexpected trigger event
may denote a system overrun situation.
In externally gated continuous-scan mode, the behavior of TOR1 has
been redefined. In the case when queue 1 reaches an end-of-queue
condition for the second time during an open gate, TOR1 is set. This
is considered an overrun condition. In this case CF1 has been set for
the first end-of-queue 1 condition and then TOR1 sets for the second
end-of-queue 1 condition. For TOR1 to set, CF2 must not be cleared
before the second end-of-queue 1.
Once set, TOR1 is cleared only by a reset or by writing a 0 to it.
1 = At least one unexpected queue 1 trigger event has occurred or
queue 1 reaches an end-of-queue condition for the second
time in externally gated continuous scan.
0 = No unexpected queue 1 trigger events have occurred.
TOR2 — Queue 2 Trigger Overrun Flag
TOR2 indicates that an unexpected trigger event has occurred for
queue 2. TOR2 can be set when queue 2 is in the active, suspended,
and trigger pending states.
The TOR2 trigger overrun can occur only when using an external
trigger mode or a periodic/interval timer mode. Trigger overruns
cannot occur when the software-initiated single-scan mode and the
software-initiated continuous-scan mode are selected.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
457
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
TOR2 is set when a trigger event is received while queue 2 is
executing, suspended, or a trigger is pending. TOR2 has no effect on
queue execution. A trigger event that causes a trigger overrun is not
retained since it is considered unexpected. An unexpected trigger
event may be a system overrun situation.
Once set, TOR2 is cleared only by a reset or by writing a 0 to it.
1 = At least one unexpected queue 2 trigger event has occurred.
0 = No unexpected queue 2 trigger events have occurred.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
QS[9:6] — Queue Status Field
The 4-bit read-only QS field indicates the current condition of queue 1
and queue 2. The five queue status conditions are:
– Idle
– Active
– Paused
– Suspended
– Trigger pending
The two most significant bits are associated primarily with queue 1,
and the remaining two bits are associated with queue 2. Because the
priority scheme between the two queues causes the status to be
interlinked, the status bits must be considered as one 4-bit field.
Table 19-7 shows the bits in the QS field and how they denote the
status of queue 1 and queue 2.
Table 19-7. Queue Status
QS[9:6]
Advance Information
458
Queue 1/Queue 2 States
0000
Queue 1 idle, queue 2 idle
0001
Queue 1 idle, queue 2 paused
0010
Queue 1 idle, queue 2 active
0011
Queue 1 idle, queue 2 trigger pending
0100
Queue 1 paused, queue 2 idle
0101
Queue 1 paused, queue 2 paused
0110
Queue 1 paused, queue 2 active
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
Table 19-7. Queue Status (Continued)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
QS[9:6]
Queue 1/Queue 2 States
0111
Queue 1 paused, queue 2 trigger pending
1000
Queue 1 active, queue 2 idle
1001
Queue 1 active, queue 2 paused
1010
Queue 1 active, queue 2 suspended
1011
Queue 1 active, queue 2 trigger pending
1100
Reserved
1101
Reserved
1110
Reserved
1111
Reserved
One or both queues may be in the idle state. When a queue is idle,
CCWs are not being executed for that queue, the queue is not in the
pause state, and no trigger is pending.
The idle state occurs when a queue is disabled, when a queue is in a
reserved mode, or when a queue is in a valid queue operating mode
awaiting a trigger event to initiate queue execution.
A queue is in the active state when a valid queue operating mode is
selected, when the selected trigger event has occurred, or when the
QADC is performing a conversion specified by a CCW from that
queue.
Only one queue can be active at a time. One or both queues can be
in the paused state. A queue is paused when the previous CCW
executed from that queue had the pause bit set. The QADC does not
execute any CCWs from the paused queue until a trigger event
occurs. Consequently, the QADC can service queue 2 while queue 1
is paused.
Only queue 2 can be in the suspended state. When a trigger event
occurs on queue 1 while queue 2 is executing, the current queue 2
conversion is aborted. The queue 2 status is reported as suspended.
Queue 2 transitions back to the active state when queue 1 becomes
idle or paused.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
459
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
A trigger pending state is required because both queues cannot be
active at the same time. The status of queue 2 is changed to trigger
pending when a trigger event occurs for queue 2 while queue 1 is
active. In the opposite case, when a trigger event occurs for queue 1
while queue 2 is active, queue 2 is aborted and the status is reported
as queue 1 active, queue 2 suspended. So due to the priority scheme,
only queue 2 can be in the trigger pending state.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Two transition cases cause the queue 2 status to be trigger pending
before queue 2 is shown to be in the active state. When queue 1 is
active and there is a trigger pending on queue 2, after queue 1
completes or pauses, queue 2 continues to be in the trigger pending
state for a few clock cycles. The fleeting status conditions are:
• Queue 1 idle with queue 2 trigger pending
• Queue 1 paused with queue 2 trigger pending
Figure 19-12 displays the status conditions of the QS field as the
QADC goes through the transition from queue 1 active to queue 2
active.
The queue status field is affected by QADC stop mode. Because all
of the analog logic and control registers are reset, the queue status
field is reset to queue 1 idle, queue 2 idle.
During debug mode, the queue status field is not modified. The queue
status field retains the status it held prior to freezing. As a result, the
queue status can show queue 1 active, queue 2 idle, even though
neither queue is being executed during freeze.
CWP[5:0] — Command Word Pointer Field
The command word pointer (CWP) denotes which CCW is executing
at present or was last completed. CWP is a read-only field with a valid
range of 0 to 63; write operations have no effect.
When a queue enters the paused state, CWP points to the CCW with
the pause bit set. While in pause, the CWP value is maintained until
a trigger event occurs on either queue. Usually, the CWP is updated
a few clock cycles before the queue status field shows that the queue
has become active. For example, a read of CWP may point to a CCW
in queue 2, while the queue status field shows queue 1 paused and
queue 2 trigger pending.
Advance Information
460
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
Q2 TRIGGER EVENT
Q1 TRIGGER EVENT
Q1 IDLE/
Q2 IDLE
Q2 COMPLETE
Q1 IDLE/
Q2 ACTIVE
Q1 COMPLETE
Q1 ACTIVE/
Q2 IDLE
DELAYED TRANSITION
Q2 PAUSE BIT SET
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Q2 TRIGGER EVENT
Q1 TRIGGER EVENT
Q1 PAUSE BIT SET
Q1 IDLE/
Q2 TRIGGER
PENDING
(TEMPORARY)
Q2 TRIGGER EVENT
Q1 TRIGGER EVENT
Q1 PAUSED/
Q2 IDLE
Q1 COMPLETE
Q1 COMPLETE
Q1 IDLE/
Q2 PAUSED
Q1 TRIGGER EVENT
Q1 ACTIVE/
Q2 TRIGGER
PENDING
Q1 ACTIVE/
Q2 SUSPENDED
Q1 PAUSE BIT SET
Q1 COMPLETE
Q1 PAUSED/
Q2 TRIGGER
PENDING
(TEMPORARY)
Q1 PAUSE BIT SET
Q1 ACTIVE/
Q2 PAUSED
DELAYED TRANSITION
Q1 TRIGGER EVENT
Q2 COMPLETE
Q1 PAUSE BIT SET
Q1 PAUSED/
Q2 ACTIVE
Q1 TRIGGER EVENT
Q2 TRIGGER EVENT
Q1 PAUSED/
Q2 PAUSED
Q2 PAUSE BIT SET
Figure 19-12. Queue Status Transition
When the QADC finishes a queue scan, the CWP points to the CCW
where the end-of-queue condition was detected. Therefore, when the
end-of-queue condition is a CCW with the EOQ code (channel 63),
the CWP points to the CCW containing the EOQ.
When the last CCW in a queue is the last CCW table location
(CCW63), and it does not contain the EOQ code, the end-of-queue is
detected when the following CCW is read, so the CWP points to word
CCW0.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
461
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Finally, when queue 1 operation is terminated after a CCW is read
that is pointed to by BQ2, the CWP points to the same CCW as BQ2.
During stop mode, CWP is reset to 0 because the control registers
and the analog logic are reset. When debug mode is entered, CWP is
not changed; it points to the last executed CCW.
19.8.6.2 QADC Status Register 1 (QASR1)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Stop mode resets this register ($3f3f).
Address: 0x00ca_0012 and 0x00ca_0013
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
CWPQ15
CWPQ14
CWPQ13
CWPQ12
CWPQ11
CWPQ10
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
CWPQ25
CWPQ24
CWPQ23
CWPQ22
CWPQ21
CWPQ20
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 19-13. QADC Status Register 1 (QASR1)
Read: Anytime
Write: Never
CWPQ1[5:0] — Queue 1 Command Word Pointer Field
CWPQ1[5:0] points to the last queue 1 CCW executed. This is a
read-only field with a valid range of 0 to 63; writes have no effect.
CWPQ1 always points to the last executed CCW in queue 1,
regardless of which queue is active.
In contrast to CWP, CPWQ1 is updated when a conversion result is
written. When the QADC finishes a conversion in queue 1, both the
result register is written and CWPQ1 is updated.
Advance Information
462
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
Finally, when queue 1 operation is terminated after a CCW is read
that is pointed to by BQ2, CWP points to BQ2 while CWPQ1 points to
the last queue 1 CCW.
During stop mode, CWPQ1 is reset to 63, because the control
registers and the analog logic are reset. When debug mode is
entered, CWPQ1 is not changed; it points to the last executed CCW
in queue 1.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
CWPQ2[5:0] — Queue 2 Command Word Pointer Field
CWPQ2[5:0] points to the last queue 2 CCW executed. This is a
read-only field with a valid range of 0 to 63; writes have no effect.
CWPQ2 always points to the last executed CCW in queue 2,
regardless which queue is active.
In contrast to CWP, CPWQ2 is updated when a conversion result is
written. When the QADC finishes a conversion in queue 2, both the
result register is written and CWPQ2 is updated.
During stop mode, CWPQ2 is reset to 63 because the control
registers and the analog logic are reset. When debug mode is
entered, CWPQ2 is not changed; it points to the last executed CCW
in queue 2.
19.8.7 Conversion Command Word Table (CCW)
The conversion command word (CCW) table is 64 half-word (128 byte)
long RAM with 10 bits of each entry implemented. The CCW table is
written by the user and is not modified by the QADC. Each CCW
requests the conversion of one analog channel to a digital result. The
CCW specifies the analog channel number, the input sample time, and
whether the queue is to pause after the current CCW.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
463
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Address: 0x00ca_0200 through 0x00ca_027e
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
0
0
0
0
0
0
9
Bit 8
P
BYP
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
U
U
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
IST1
IST0
CHAN5
CHAN4
CHAN3
CHAN2
CHAN1
CHAN0
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
U
Read:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
U = Unaffected
Figure 19-14. Conversion Command Word Table (CCW)
Read: Anytime except reads during stop mode are invalid
Write: Anytime except during stop mode
P — Pause Bit
The pause bit allows subqueues to be created within queue 1 and
queue 2. The QADC performs the conversion specified by the CCW
with the pause bit set and then the queue enters the pause state.
Another trigger event causes execution to continue from the pause to
the next CCW.
1 = Enter pause state after execution of current CCW.
0 = Do not enter pause state after execution of current CCW.
NOTE:
The P bit does not cause the queue to pause in the software. Initiated
modes or externally gated modes.
BYP — Sample Amplifier Bypass Bit
Setting BYP in a CCW enables the amplifier bypass mode for a
conversion and subsequently changes the timing. The initial sample
time is eliminated, reducing the potential conversion time by two
QCLKs. However, due to internal RC effects, a minimum final sample
time of four QCLKs must be allowed. When using this mode, the
Advance Information
464
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
external circuit should be of low source impedance. Loading effects of
the external circuitry need to be considered because the benefits of
the sample amplifier are not present.
1 = Amplifier bypass mode enabled
0 = Amplifier bypass mode disabled
NOTE:
BYP is maintained for software compatibility but has no functional
benefit on this version of the QADC.
IST[1:0] — Input Sample Time Field
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The IST field specifies the length of the sample window. The input
sample time can be varied, under software control, to accommodate
various input channel source impedances. Longer sample times
permit more accurate A/D conversions of signals with higher source
impedances.
Table 19-8 shows the four selectable input sample times.
Table 19-8. Input Sample Times
IST[1:0]
Input Sample Times
00
Input sample time = QCLK period × 2
01
Input sample time = QCLK period × 4
10
Input sample time = QCLK period × 8
11
Input sample time = QCLK period × 16
The programmable sample time can also be used to adjust queue
execution time or sampling rate by increasing the time interval
between conversions.
CHAN[5:0] — Channel Number Field
The CHAN field selects the input channel number. The CCW channel
field is programmed with the channel number corresponding to the
analog input pin to be sampled and converted. The analog input pin
channel number assignments and the pin definitions vary depending
on whether the QADC multiplexed or non-multiplexed mode is used
by the application. As far as queue scanning operations are
concerned, there is no distinction between an internally or externally
multiplexed analog input.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
465
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Table 19-9 shows the channel number assignments for
non-multiplexed mode. Table 19-10 shows the channel number
assignments for multiplexed mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Programming the channel field to channel 63 denotes the end of the
queue. Channels 60 to 62 are special internal channels. When one of
the special channels is selected, the sampling amplifier is not used.
The value of VRL, VRH, or (VRH–VRL)/2 is converted directly.
Programming any input sample time other than two has no benefit for
the special internal channels except to lengthen the overall
conversion time.
Table 19-9. Non-Multiplexed Channel Assignments
and Pin Designations
Channel Number(1)
in CCW CHAN Field
Non-Multiplexed Input Pins
Port Pin Name
Analog Pin Name
Other
Functions
Pin Type
Binary
Decimal
PQB0
PQB1
PQB2
PQB3
AN0
AN1
AN2
AN3
—
—
—
—
Input
Input
Input
Input
000000
000001
000010
000011
0
1
2
3
PQA0
PQA1
AN52
AN53
—
—
Input/output
Input/output
110100
110101
52
53
PQA3
PQA4
AN55
AN56
ETRIG1
ETRIG2
Input/output
Input/output
110111
111000
55
56
VRL
—
Low reference
High reference
—
—
—
(VRH–VRL)/2
Input
Input
—
111100
111101
111110
60
61
62
—
—
End-of-queue code
—
111111
63
VRH
1. All channels not listed are reserved or unimplemented and return undefined results.
Advance Information
466
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
Table 19-10. Multiplexed Channel Assignments
and Pin Designations
Channel Number(1)
in CCW CHAN Field
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Multiplexed Input Pins
Port Pin
Name
Analog
Pin Name
Other
Functions
Pin Type
Binary
Decimal
PQB0
PQB1
PQB2
PQB3
ANw
ANx
ANy
ANz
—
—
—
—
Input
Input
Input
Input
000XX0
000XX1
010XX0
010XX1
0, 2, 4, 6
1, 3, 5, 7
16, 18, 20, 22
17, 19, 21, 23
PQA0
PQA1
—
—
MA0
MA1
Output
Output
110100
110101
52
53
PQA3
PQA4
AN55
AN56
ETRIG1
ETRIG2
Input/output
Input/output
110111
111000
55
56
VRL
VRH
—
Low reference
High reference
—
—
—
(VRH–VRL)/2
Input
Input
—
111100
111101
111110
60
61
62
—
—
End-of-queue code
—
111111
63
1. All channels not listed are reserved or unimplemented and return undefined results.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
467
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.8.8 Result Registers
The result word table is a 64 half-word (128 byte) long by 10-bit wide
RAM. An entry is written by the QADC after completing an analog
conversion specified by the corresponding CCW table entry.
19.8.8.1 Right-Justified Unsigned Result Register (RJURR)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address: 0x00ca_0280 through 0x00ca_02fe
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
0
0
0
0
0
0
9
Bit 8
RESULT
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
RESULT
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 19-15. Right-Justified Unsigned Result Register (RJURR)
Read: Anytime except reads during stop mode are invalid
Write: Anytime except during stop mode
RESULT[9:0] — Result Field
The conversion result is unsigned, right-justified data.
Advance Information
468
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Register Descriptions
19.8.8.2 Left-Justified Signed Result Register (LJSRR)
Address: 0x00ca_0300 through 0x00ca_037e
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
S
RESULT
Reset:
Bit 7
6
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Read:
Write:
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
RESULT
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 19-16. Left-Justified Signed Result Register (LJSRR)
S — Sign Bit
The left justified, signed format corresponds to a half-scale, offset
binary, two’s complement data format. Conversion values
corresponding to 1/2 full scale, 0x0200, or higher are interpreted as
positive values and have a sign bit of 0. An unsigned, right justified
conversion of 0x0200 would be represented as 0x0000 in this signed
register, where the sign = 0 and the result = 0. For an unsigned, right
justified conversion of 0x3FF (full range or VRH), the signed
equivalent in this register would be 0x7FC0, sign = 0 and
result = 0x1FF. For an unsigned, right justified conversion of 0x0000
(VRL), the signed equivalent in this register would be 0x8000, sign = 1
and result = 0x000, a two’s complement value representing –512.
RESULT[14:6] — Result Field
The conversion result is signed, left-justified data.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
469
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.8.8.3 Left-Justified Unsigned Result Register (LJURR)
Address: 0x00ca_0380 through 0x00ca_03fe
Bit 15
14
13
12
Read:
11
10
9
Bit 8
RESULT
Write:
Reset:
Bit 7
Read:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Write:
6
RESULT
Reset:
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 19-17. Left-Justified Unsigned Result Register (LJURR)
RESULT[15:6] — Result Field
The conversion result is unsigned, left-justified data.
19.9 Functional Description
This subsection provides a functional description of the QADC.
19.9.1 Result Coherency
The QADC supports byte and half-word reads and writes across a 16-bit
data bus interface. All conversion results are stored in half-word
registers, and the QADC does not allow more than one result register to
be read at a time. For this reason, the QADC does not guarantee read
coherency.
Specifically, this means that while the QADC is operating, the data in the
result registers can change from one read to the next. Simply initiating a
read of one result register will not prevent another from being updated
with a new conversion result.
Thus, to read any given number of result registers coherently, the queue
or queues capable of modifying these registers must be inactive. This
can be guaranteed by system operating conditions (such as, known
completion of a software-initiated queue single-scan or no possibility of
an externally triggered/gated queue scan) or by simply disabling the
queues (writing MQ1 and/or MQ2 to 0).
Advance Information
470
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Functional Description
19.9.2 External Multiplexing
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
External multiplexer chips concentrate a number of analog signals onto
a few QADC inputs. This is useful for applications that need to convert
more analog signals than the QADC converter can normally support.
External multiplexing also puts the multiplexed chip closer to the signal
source. This minimizes the number of analog signals that need to be
shielded due to the proximity of noisy high speed digital signals at the
microcontroller chip.
For example, four 4-input multiplexer chips can be put at the connector
where the analog signals first arrive on the printed circuit board. As a
result, only four analog signals need to be shielded from noise as they
approach the microcontroller chip, rather than having to protect 16
analog signals. However, external multiplexer chips may introduce
additional noise and errors if not properly utilized. Therefore, it is
necessary to maintain low “on” resistance (the impedance of an analog
switch when active within a multiplexed chip) and insert a low pass filter
(R/C) on the input side of the multiplexed chip.
19.9.2.1 External Multiplexing Operation
The QADC can use from one to four external multiplexer chips to expand
the number of analog signals that may be converted. Up to 16 analog
channels can be converted through external multiplexer selection. The
externally multiplexed channels are automatically selected from the
channel field of the CCW, the same as internally multiplexed channels.
The QADC is configured for the externally multiplexed mode by setting
the MUX bit in Control Register 0 (QACR0).
Figure 19-18 shows the maximum configuration of four external
multiplexer chips connected to the QADC. The external multiplexer chips
select one of four analog inputs and connect it to one analog output,
which becomes an input to the QADC. The QADC provides two
multiplexed address signals — MA[1:0] — to select one of four inputs.
These inputs are connected to all four external multiplexer chips. The
analog output of the four multiplexer chips are each connected to
separate QADC inputs (ANw, ANx, ANy, and ANz) as shown in
Figure 19-18.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
471
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
AN1
AN3
AN5
AN7
MUX
MUX
AN0/ANW/PQB0
AN1/ANX/PQB1
AN2/ANY/PQB2
AN3/ANZ/PQB3
PORT QB
AN0
AN2
AN4
AN6
AN55/ETRIG1PQA3
AN56/ETRIG2/PQA4
AN16
AN18
AN20
AN22
AN17
AN19
AN21
AN23
PORT QA
AN52/MA0/PQA0
AN53/MA1/PQA1
MUX
MUX
Figure 19-18. External Multiplexing Configuration
Advance Information
472
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Functional Description
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When externally multiplexed mode is selected, the QADC automatically
drives the MA output signals from the channel number in each CCW.
The QADC also converts the proper input channel (ANw, ANx, ANy, and
ANz) by interpreting the CCW channel number. As a result, up to 16
externally multiplexed channels appear to the conversion queues as
directly connected signals. User software simply puts the channel
number of externally multiplexed channels into CCWs.
Figure 19-18 shows that the two MA signals may also be analog input
pins. When external multiplexing is selected, none of the MA pins can be
used for analog or digital inputs. They become multiplexed address
outputs and are unaffected by DDRQA[1:0].
19.9.2.2 Module Version Options
The number of available analog channels varies, depending on whether
external multiplexing is used. A maximum of eight analog channels are
supported by the internal multiplexing circuitry of the converter.
Table 19-11 shows the total number of analog input channels supported
with 0 to 4 external multiplexer chips.
Table 19-11. Analog Input Channels
Number of Analog Input Channels Available
Directly Connected + External Multiplexed = Total Channels(1), (2)
No External
Mux
One External
Mux
Two External
Muxes
Three External
Muxes
Four External
Muxes
8
5+4=9
4 + 8 = 12
3 + 12 = 15
2 + 16 = 18
1. The external trigger inputs are not shared with two analog input pins.
2. When external multiplexing is used, two input channels are configured as multiplexed address outputs, and for each external multiplexer chip, one input channel is a multiplexed
analog input.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
473
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.9.3 Analog Subsystem
This section describes the QADC analog subsystem, which includes the
front-end analog multiplexer and analog-to-digital converter.
19.9.3.1 Analog-to-Digital Converter Operation
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The analog subsystem consists of the path from the input pins to the A/D
converter block. Signals from the queue control logic are fed to the
multiplexer and state machine. The end-of-conversion (EOC) signal and
the Successive Approximation Register (SAR) reflect the result of the
conversion. Figure 19-19 shows a block diagram of the QADC analog
subsystem.
16
PQA4
4
CHAN. DECODE & MUX
16:1
6
PQA0
10-BIT A/D CONVERTER
INPUT
BIAS CIRCUIT
PQB3
INTERNAL
CHANNEL
DECODE
SAMPLE
BUFFER
PQB0
POWERDOWN
STATE MACHINE & LOGIC
CSAMP
VRH
VRL
10-BIT RC
DAC
VSSA
ANALOG
POWER
COMPARATOR
QCLK
2
IST
START CONV
END OF CONV
SAR TIMING
10
SAR[9:0]
10
10
VDDA
STOP
RST
SIGNALS FROM/TO QUEUE CONTROL LOGIC
CHAN[5:0]
SUCCESSIVE
APPROXIMATION
REGISTER
Figure 19-19. QADC Analog Subsystem Block Diagram
Advance Information
474
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Functional Description
19.9.3.2 Conversion Cycle Times
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Total conversion time is made up of initial sample time, final sample time,
and resolution time. Initial sample time refers to the time during which the
selected input channel is coupled through the sample buffer amplifier to
the sample capacitor. The sample buffer is used to quickly reproduce its
input signal on the sample capacitor and minimize charge sharing errors.
During the final sampling period the amplifier is bypassed, and the
multiplexer input charges the sample capacitor array directly for
improved accuracy. During the resolution period, the voltage in the
sample capacitor is converted to a digital value and stored in the SAR.
Initial sample time is fixed at two QCLK cycles. Final sample time can be
2, 4, 8, or 16 QCLK cycles, depending on the value of the IST field in the
CCW. Resolution time is 10 QCLK cycles.
A conversion requires a minimum of 14 QCLK cycles (7 µs with a
2.0-MHz QCLK). If the maximum final sample time period of 16 QCLKs
is selected, the total conversion time is 28 QCLKs or 14 µs (with a
2.0-MHz QCLK).
BUFFER
SAMPLE
TIME:
2 CYCLES
FINAL
SAMPLE
TIME:
N CYCLES
(2,4,8,16)
RESOLUTION
TIME:
10 CYCLES
QCLK
SAMPLE TIME
SUCCESSIVE APPROXIMATION RESOLUTION SEQUENCE
Figure 19-20. Conversion Timing
If the amplifier bypass mode is enabled for a conversion by setting the
amplifier bypass (BYP) field in the CCW, the timing changes to that
shown in Figure 19-21. See 19.8.7 Conversion Command Word
Table (CCW) for more information on the BYP field. The initial sample
time is eliminated, reducing the potential conversion time by two QCLKs.
When using the bypass mode, the external circuit should be of low
source impedance (typically less than 10 kΩ). Also, the loading effects
on the external circuitry of the QADC need to be considered, because
the benefits of the sample amplifier are not present.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
475
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
NOTE:
Because of internal RC time constants, use of a two QCLK sample time
in bypass mode will cause serious errors when operating the QADC at
high frequencies.
SAMPLE
TIME:
N CYCLES
(2,4,8,16)
RESOLUTION
TIME:
10 CYCLES
SAMPLE TIME
SUCCESSIVE APPROXIMATION RESOLUTION SEQUENCE
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
QCLK
Figure 19-21. Bypass Mode Conversion Timing
19.9.3.3 Channel Decode and Multiplexer
The internal multiplexer selects one of the eight analog input pins for
conversion. The selected input is connected to the sample buffer
amplifier or to the sample capacitor. The multiplexer also includes
positive and negative stress protection circuitry, which prevents
deselected channels from affecting the selected channel when current is
injected into the deselected channels.
19.9.3.4 Sample Buffer
The sample buffer is used to raise the effective input impedance of the
A/D converter, so that external factors (higher bandwidth or higher
impedance) are less critical to accuracy. The input voltage is buffered
onto the sample capacitor to reduce crosstalk between channels.
19.9.3.5 Digital-to-Analog Converter (DAC) Array
The digital-to-analog converter (DAC) array consists of binary-weighted
capacitors and a resistor-divider chain. The reference voltages, VRH and
VRL, are used by the DAC to perform ratiometric conversions. The DAC
also converts the following three internal channels:
Advance Information
476
•
VRH — reference voltage high
•
VRL — reference voltage low
•
(VRH–VRL)/2 — reference voltage
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Functional Description
The DAC array provides a mechanism for the successive approximation
A/D conversion.
Resolution begins with the most significant bit (MSB) and works down to
the least significant bit (LSB). The switching sequence is controlled by
the comparator and SAR logic. The sample capacitor samples and holds
the voltage to be converted.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.9.3.6 Comparator
During the approximation process, the comparator senses whether the
digitally selected arrangement of the DAC array produces a voltage level
higher or lower than the sampled input. The comparator output feeds
into the SAR which accumulates the A/D conversion result sequentially,
beginning with the MSB.
19.9.3.7 Bias
The bias circuit is controlled by the STOP signal to power-up and
power-down all the analog circuits.
19.9.3.8 Successive Approximation Register
The input of the SAR is connected to the comparator output. The SAR
sequentially receives the conversion value one bit at a time, starting with
the MSB. After accumulating the 10 bits of the conversion result, the
SAR data is transferred to the appropriate result location, where it may
be read by user software.
19.9.3.9 State Machine
The state machine generates all timing to perform an A/D conversion. An
internal start-conversion signal indicates to the A/D converter that the
desired channel has been sent to the MUX. IST[1:0] denotes the desired
sample time. BYP determines whether to bypass the sample amplifier.
Once the end of conversion has been reached a signal is sent to the
queue control logic indicating that a result is available for storage in the
result RAM.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
477
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.10 Digital Control
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The digital control subsystem includes the control logic to sequence the
conversion activity, the clock and periodic/interval timer, control and
status registers, the conversion command word table RAM, and the
result word table RAM.
The central element for control of QADC conversions is the 64-entry
conversion command word (CCW) table. Each CCW specifies the
conversion of one input channel. Depending on the application, one or
two queues can be established in the CCW table. A queue is a scan
sequence of one or more input channels. By using a pause mechanism,
subqueues can be created in the two queues. Each queue can be
operated using one of several different scan modes. The scan modes for
queue 1 and queue 2 are programmed in control registers QACR1 and
QACR2. Once a queue has been started by a trigger event (any of the
ways to cause the QADC to begin executing the CCWs in a queue or
subqueue), the QADC performs a sequence of conversions and places
the results in the result word table.
19.10.1 Queue Priority Timing Examples
This subsection describes the QADC priority scheme when trigger
events on two queues overlap or conflict.
19.10.1.1 Queue Priority
Queue 1 has priority over queue 2 execution. These cases show the
conditions under which queue 1 asserts its priority:
Advance Information
478
•
When a queue is not active, a trigger event for queue 1 or queue
2 causes the corresponding queue execution to begin.
•
When queue 1 is active and a trigger event occurs for queue 2,
queue 2 cannot begin execution until queue 1 reaches completion
or the paused state. The status register records the trigger event
by reporting the queue 2 status as trigger pending. Additional
trigger events for queue 2, which occur before execution can
begin, are flagged as trigger overruns.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
•
When queue 2 is active and a trigger event occurs for queue 1, the
current queue 2 conversion is aborted. The status register reports
the queue 2 status as suspended. Any trigger events occurring for
queue 2 while it is suspended are flagged as trigger overruns.
Once queue 1 reaches the completion or the paused state, queue
2 begins executing again. The programming of the RESUME bit in
QACR2 determines which CCW is executed in queue 2.
•
When simultaneous trigger events occur for queue 1 and queue 2,
queue 1 begins execution and the queue 2 status is changed to
trigger pending.
•
When subqueues are paused
The pause feature can be used to divide queue 1 and/or queue 2 into
multiple subqueues. A subqueue is defined by setting the pause bit in
the last CCW of the subqueue.
Figure 19-22 shows the CCW format and an example of using pause to
create subqueues. Queue 1 is shown with four CCWs in each subqueue
and queue 2 has two CCWs in each subqueue.
The operating mode selected for queue 1 determines what type of
trigger event causes the execution of each of the subqueues within
queue 1. Similarly, the operating mode for queue 2 determines the type
of trigger event required to execute each of the subqueues within
queue 2.
For example, when the external trigger rising edge continuous-scan
mode is selected for queue 1, and there are six subqueues within
queue 1, a separate rising edge is required on the external trigger pin
after every pause to begin the execution of each subqueue (refer to
Figure 19-22).
The choice of single-scan or continuous-scan applies to the full queue,
and is not applied to each subqueue. Once a subqueue is initiated, each
CCW is executed sequentially until the last CCW in the subqueue is
executed and the pause state is entered. Execution can only continue
with the next CCW, which is the beginning of the next subqueue. A
subqueue cannot be executed a second time before the overall queue
execution has been completed.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
479
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
CONVERSION COMMAND
WORD (CCW) TABLE
RESULT WORD TABLE
P
00
0
BEGINNING OF QUEUE 1
00
0
0
1
PAUSE
0
0
0
1
PAUSE
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
•
•
•
P
•
0
BQ2
0
END OF QUEUE 1
0
BEGINNING OF QUEUE 2
1
PAUSE
•
CHANNEL SELECT,
SAMPLE, HOLD,
A/D CONVERSION
•
0
1
PAUSE
0
1
PAUSE
0
63
•
•
•
•
P
•
•
1
PAUSE
0
END OF QUEUE 2
63
Figure 19-22. QADC Queue Operation with Pause
Trigger events which occur during the execution of a subqueue are
ignored, except that the trigger overrun flag is set. When a
continuous-scan mode is selected, a trigger event occurring after the
completion of the last subqueue (after the queue completion flag is set),
causes the execution to continue with the first subqueue, starting with
the first CCW in the queue.
When the QADC encounters a CCW with the pause bit set, the queue
enters the paused state after completing the conversion specified in the
CCW with the pause bit. The pause flag is set and a pause interrupt may
optionally be requested. The status of the queue is shown to be paused,
indicating completion of a subqueue. The QADC then waits for another
trigger event to again begin execution of the next subqueue.
Advance Information
480
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
19.10.1.2 Queue Priority Schemes
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Because there are two conversion command queues and only one A/D
converter, a priority scheme determines which conversion occurs. Each
queue has a variety of trigger events that are intended to initiate
conversions, and they can occur asynchronously in relation to each
other and other conversions in progress. For example, a queue can be
idle awaiting a trigger event; a trigger event can have occurred, but the
first conversion has not started; a conversion can be in progress; a
pause condition can exist awaiting another trigger event to continue the
queue; and so on.
The following paragraphs and figures outline the prioritizing criteria used
to determine which conversion occurs in each overlap situation.
NOTE:
Each situation in Figure 19-23 through Figure 19-33 is labeled S1
through S19. In each diagram, time is shown increasing from left to right.
The execution of queue 1 and queue 2 (Q1 and Q2) is shown as a string
of rectangles representing the execution time of each CCW in the queue.
In most of the situations, there are four CCWs (labeled C1 to C4) in both
queue 1 and queue 2. In some of the situations, CCW C2 is presumed
to have the pause bit set, to show the similarities of pause and
end-of-queue as terminations of queue execution.
Trigger events are described in Table 19-12.
Table 19-12. Trigger Events
Trigger
Events
T1
Events that trigger queue 1 execution (external trigger, software-initiated
single-scan enable bit, or completion of the previous continuous loop)
T2
Events that trigger queue 2 execution (external trigger, software-initiated
single-scan enable bit, timer period/interval expired, or completion of the
previous continuous loop)
When a trigger event causes a CCW execution in progress to be
aborted, the aborted conversion is shown as a ragged end of a
shortened CCW rectangle.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
481
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
The situation diagrams also show when key status bits are set.
Table 19-13 describes the status bits.
Table 19-13. Status Bits
Bit
CF flag
Set when the end of the queue is reached
PF flag
Set when a queue completes execution up through a pause bit
Trigger overrun
error (TOR)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Function
Set when a new trigger event occurs before the queue is finished
servicing the previous trigger event
Below the queue execution flows are three sets of blocks that show the
status information that is made available to the user. The first two rows
of status blocks show the condition of each queue as:
• Idle
• Active
• Pause
• Suspended (queue 2 only)
• Trigger pending
The third row of status blocks shows the 4-bit QS status register field that
encodes the condition of the two queues. Two transition status cases,
QS = 0011 and QS = 0111, are not shown because they exist only very
briefly between stable status conditions.
The first three examples in Figure 19-23 through Figure 19-25 (S1, S2,
and S3) show what happens when a new trigger event is recognized
before the queue has completed servicing the previous trigger event on
the same queue.
In situation S1 (Figure 19-23), one trigger event is being recognized on
each queue while that queue is still working on the previously recognized
trigger event. The trigger overrun error status bit is set, and the
premature trigger event is otherwise ignored. A trigger event that occurs
before the servicing of the previous trigger event is through does not
disturb the queue execution in progress.
Advance Information
482
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
T1
Q1:
T1
C1
C2
C3
C4
T2
TOR1
T2
CF1
Q2:
C1
C2
C3
TOR2
IDLE
Q1:
IDLE
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
IDLE
ACTIVE
0000
QS:
CF2
IDLE
ACTIVE
Q2:
C4
1000
0000
0010
0000
Figure 19-23. CCW Priority Situation 1
In situation S2 (Figure 19-24), more than one trigger event is recognized
before servicing of a previous trigger event is complete. The trigger
overrun bit is again set, but the additional trigger events are otherwise
ignored. After the queue is complete, the first newly detected trigger
event causes queue execution to begin again. When the trigger event
rate is high, a new trigger event can be seen very soon after completion
of the previous queue, leaving little time to retrieve the previous results.
Also, when trigger events are occurring at a high rate for queue 1, the
lower priority queue 2 channels may not get serviced at all.
T1
T1
T1
T1
T1
T2
Q1:
C1
C2
C3
C4
C1
C2
C3
Q2:
TOR1 TOR1 TOR1
CF1
T2
T2
C2
C3
C4
C1
TOR2 TOR2
Q1:
IDLE
ACTIVE
ACTIVE
1000
1000
CF2
IDLE
IDLE
Q2:
QS:
IDLE
C4
CF1
0000
ACTIVE
IDLE
0010
0000
Figure 19-24. CCW Priority Situation 2
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
483
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Situation S3 (Figure 19-25) shows that when the pause feature is used,
the trigger overrun error status bit is set the same way and that queue
execution continues unchanged.
T1
Q1:
T1
C1
T1
C2
C3
T2
TOR1
T2
TOR1
C1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0000
C3
PF2
0100
PAUSE
0101
0110
CF2
IDLE
ACTIVE
ACTIVE
1000
C4
TOR2
PAUSE
IDLE
Q2:
QS:
ACTIVE
T2
CF1
C2
TOR2
IDLE
C4
T2
PF1
Q2:
Q1:
T1
1001
0001
ACTIVE
IDLE
0010
0000
Figure 19-25. CCW Priority Situation 3
The next two situations consider trigger events that occur for the lower
priority queue 2, while queue 1 is actively being serviced.
Situation S4 (Figure 19-26) shows that a queue 2 trigger event is
recognized while queue 1 is active is saved, and as soon as queue 1 is
finished, queue 2 servicing begins.
T1
Q1:
C1
C2
C3
C4
CF1
T2
C1
C2
C3
C4
Q2:
CF2
Q1:
IDLE
IDLE
Q2:
QS:
ACTIVE
0000
1000
IDLE
TRIGGERED
ACTIVE
IDLE
1011
0010
0000
Figure 19-26. CCW Priority Situation 4
Advance Information
484
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
Situation S5 (Figure 19-27) shows that when multiple queue 2 trigger
events are detected while queue 1 is busy, the trigger overrun error bit
is set, but queue 1 execution is not disturbed. Situation S5 also shows
that the effect of queue 2 trigger events during queue 1 execution is the
same when the pause feature is used for either queue.
T1
T1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Q1:
C1
C2
T2 T2
C3
T2 T2
PF1
Q2:
C1
Q2:
QS:
IDLE
ACTIVE
IDLE
0000
1000
CF1
C2
TOR2
Q1:
C4
C3
TOR2
PF2
PAUSE
TRIG
ACTIVE
1011
0110
C4
CF2
IDLE
ACTIVE
ACTIVE
PAUSE
0101
1001
TRIG
ACTIVE
IDLE
1011
0010
0000
Figure 19-27. CCW Priority Situation 5
The remaining situations, S6 through S11, show the impact of a queue 1
trigger event occurring during queue 2 execution. Because queue 1 has
higher priority, the conversion taking place in queue 2 is aborted so that
there is no variable latency time in responding to queue 1 trigger events.
In situation 6 (Figure 19-28), the conversion initiated by the second
CCW in queue 2 is aborted just before the conversion is complete, so
that queue 1 execution can begin. Queue 2 is considered suspended.
After queue 1 is finished, queue 2 starts over with the first CCW, when
the RESUME control bit is set to 0. Situation S7 (Figure 19-29) shows
that when pause operation is not used with queue 2, queue 2
suspension works the same way.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
485
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
T1
Q1:
T1
C1
C2
C3
C4
RESUME = 0
T2
PF1
CF1
Q2:
C1
C1
C2
C2
C3
C4
CF2
IDLE
Q1:
PAUSE
IDLE
Q2:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
ACTIVE
0000
QS
1000
IDLE
ACTIVE
ACTIVE
ACTIVE
SUSPEND
ACTIVE
0110
1010
0010
0100
IDLE
0000
Figure 19-28. CCW Priority Situation 6
T1
Q1:
T1
C1
C2
T2
Q2:
C3
PF1
C1
C1
C4
T2
C1
CF1
C3
C2
C3
C4
CF2
PF2
IDLE
Q1:
ACTIVE
PAUSE
Q2:
IDLE
ACTIVE
SUSPEND
ACTIVE
QS:
0000
0010
1010
0110
ACTIVE
PAUSE ACT
0101
0110
IDLE
SUSPEND
ACTIVE
IDLE
1010
0010
0000
Figure 19-29. CCW Priority Situation 7
Advance Information
486
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
Situations S8 and S9 (Figure 19-30 and Figure 19-31) repeat the same
two situations with the RESUME bit set to a 1. When the RESUME bit is
set, following suspension, queue 2 resumes execution with the aborted
CCW, not the first CCW, in the queue.
T1
Q1:
T1
C1
C2
C3
C4
T2
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
PF1
CF1
Q2:
C1
C2
C2
C3
C4
RESUME=1
CF2
IDLE
Q1:
ACTIVE
PAUSE
IDLE
Q2:
0000
QS:
1000
IDLE
ACTIVE
ACTIVE
ACTIVE
SUSPEND
ACTIVE
IDLE
0110
1010
0010
0000
0100
Figure 19-30. CCW Priority Situation 8
T1
Q1:
T1
C1
C2
T2
Q2:
C3
PF1
C1
C1
C2
C4
T2
CF1
C3
C2
C4
C4
CF2
PF2
IDLE
Q1:
ACTIVE
RESUME=1
PAUSE
Q2:
IDLE
ACTIVE
SUSPEND
ACT
PAUSE
QS:
0000
0010
1010
0110
0101
ACTIVE
ACTIVE
0110
IDLE
SUSPEND
ACT
IDLE
1010
0010
0000
Figure 19-31. CCW Priority Situation 9
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
487
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Situations S10 and S11 (Figure 19-32 and Figure 19-33) show that
when an additional trigger event is detected for queue 2 while the queue
is suspended, the trigger overrun error bit is set, the same as if queue 2
were being executed when a new trigger event occurs. Trigger overrun
on queue 2 thus allows the user to know that queue 1 is taking up so
much QADC time that queue 2 trigger events are being lost.
T1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Q1:
C1
T2
Q2:
T1
C2
T2
C1
C3
PF1
T2
C1
C2
C2
TOR2
IDLE
Q1:
T2
C3
IDLE
ACTIVE
SUSPEND
ACTIVE
QS:
0000
0010
1010
0110
C4
TOR2
PAUSE
Q2:
CF1
C3
PF2
ACTIVE
C4
CF2
ACTIVE
PAUSE ACT
0101
0110
RESUME = 0
IDLE
SUSPEND
ACTIVE
IDLE
1010
0010
0000
Figure 19-32. CCW Priority Situation 10
T1
Q1:
T2
Q2:
T1
C1
C2
T2
C1
C2
IDLE
PF1
T2
Q2:
IDLE
ACTIVE
SUSPEND
QS:
0000
0010
1010
C4
PAUSE
ACT PAUSE
0110
CF1
0101
RESUME = 1
C4
TOR2
PF2
ACTIVE
C4
T2
C3
C2
TOR2
Q1:
C3
CF2
ACTIVE
IDLE
ACTIVE
SUSPEND
ACT
IDLE
0110
1010
0010
0000
Figure 19-33. CCW Priority Situation 11
Advance Information
488
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The previous situations cover normal overlap conditions that arise with
asynchronous trigger events on the two queues. An additional conflict to
consider is that the freeze condition can arise while the QADC is actively
executing CCWs. The conventional use for the debug mode is for
software/hardware debugging. When the CPU enters background
debug mode, peripheral modules can cease operation. When freeze is
detected, the QADC completes the conversion in progress, unlike the
abort that occurs when queue 1 suspends queue 2. After the freeze
condition is removed, the QADC continues queue execution with the
next CCW in sequence.
Trigger events that occur during freeze are not captured. When a trigger
event is pending for queue 2 before freeze begins, that trigger event is
remembered when the freeze is passed. Similarly, when freeze occurs
while queue 2 is suspended, after freeze, queue 2 resumes execution as
soon as queue 1 is finished.
Situations 12 through 19 (Figure 19-34 to Figure 19-41) show examples
of all of the freeze situations.
FREEZE
T1
Q1:
C1
C2
C3
C4
CF1
Figure 19-34. CCW Freeze Situation 12
FREEZE
T2
Q2:
C1
C2
C3
C4
CF2
Figure 19-35. CCW Freeze Situation 13
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
489
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
TRIGGERS IGNORED
FREEZE
T1
Q1:
T1
C1
T1
C2
C3
T2
C4
T2
CF1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 19-36. CCW Freeze Situation 14
TRIGGERS IGNORED
FREEZE
T2
Q2:
T2
C1
T2
C2
C3
T1
C4
T1
CF2
Figure 19-37. CCW Freeze Situation 15
TRIGGERS IGNORED
FREEZE
T1
Q1:
T1
C1
T1
C2
C3
PF1
C4
CF1
Figure 19-38. CCW Freeze Situation 16
Advance Information
490
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
TRIGGERS IGNORED
FREEZE
T2
T2
Q2:
C1
T2
C2
C3
C4
PF2
CF2
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 19-39. CCW Freeze Situation 17
FREEZE
T1
Q1:
C1
C2
C3
C4
T2
CF1
TRIGGER CAPTURED, RESPONSE DELAYED AFTER FREEZE
Q2:
C1
C2
C3
C4
CF2
Figure 19-40. CCW Freeze Situation 18
FREEZE
T1
Q1:
C1
C2
C3
T2
Q2:
C4
CF1
C1
C2
C3
C4
C4
CF2
Figure 19-41. CCW Freeze Situation 19
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
491
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.10.2 Boundary Conditions
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The queue operation boundary conditions are:
NOTE:
•
The first CCW in a queue specifies channel 63, the end-of-queue
(EOQ) code. The queue becomes active and the first CCW is
read. The end-of-queue is recognized, the completion flag is set,
and the queue becomes idle. A conversion is not performed.
•
BQ2 (beginning of queue 2) is set at the end of the CCW table (63)
and a trigger event occurs on queue 2. The end-of-queue
condition is recognized, a conversion is performed, the completion
flag is set, and the queue becomes idle.
•
BQ2 is set to CCW0 and a trigger event occurs on queue 1. After
reading CCW0, the end-of-queue condition is recognized, the
completion flag is set, and the queue becomes idle. A conversion
is not performed.
•
BQ2 (beginning of queue 2) is set beyond the end of the CCW
table (64–127) and a trigger event occurs on queue 2. The
end-of-queue condition is recognized immediately, the completion
flag is set, and the queue becomes idle. A conversion is not
performed.
Multiple end-of-queue conditions may be recognized simultaneously,
although there is no change in QADC behavior. For example, if BQ2 is
set to CCW0, CCW0 contains the EOQ code, and a trigger event occurs
on queue 1, the QADC reads CCW0 and detects both end-of-queue
conditions. The completion flag is set and queue 1 becomes idle.
Boundary conditions also exist for combinations of pause and
end-of-queue. One case is when a pause bit is in one CCW and an
end-of-queue condition is in the next CCW. The conversion specified by
the CCW with the pause bit set completes normally. The pause flag is
set. However, because the end-of-queue condition is recognized, the
completion flag is also set and the queue status becomes idle, not
paused. Examples of this situation include:
Advance Information
492
•
The pause bit is set in CCW5 and the channel 63 (EOQ) code is
in CCW6.
•
The pause is in CCW63.
•
During queue 1 operation, the pause bit is set in CCW20 and BQ2
points to CCW21.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Another pause and end-of-queue boundary condition occurs when the
pause and an end-of-queue condition occur in the same CCW. Both the
pause and end-of-queue conditions are recognized simultaneously. The
end-of-queue condition has precedence so a conversion is not
performed for the CCW and the pause flag is not set. The QADC sets the
completion flag and the queue status becomes idle. Examples of this
situation are:
•
The pause bit is set in CCW10 and EOQ is programmed into
CCW10.
•
During queue 1 operation, the pause bit set in CCW32, which is
also BQ2.
19.10.3 Scan Modes
The QADC queuing mechanism allows application software to utilize
different requirements for automatically scanning input channels.
In single-scan mode, a single pass through a sequence of conversions
defined by a queue is performed. In continuous-scan mode, multiple
passes through a sequence of conversions defined by a queue are
executed.
The possible modes are:
•
Disabled mode and reserved mode
•
Software-initiated single-scan mode
•
Externally triggered single-scan mode
•
Externally gated single-scan mode
•
Interval timer single-scan mode
•
Software-initiated continuous-scan mode
•
Externally triggered continuous-scan mode
•
Externally gated continuous-scan mode
•
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode
The following paragraphs describe single-scan and continuous-scan
operations.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
493
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.10.4 Disabled Mode
When disabled mode is selected, the queue is not active. Trigger events
cannot initiate queue execution. When both queue 1 and queue 2 are
disabled, there is no possibility of encountering wait states when
accessing CCW table and result RAM. When both queues are disabled,
it is safe to change the QCLK prescaler values.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.10.5 Reserved Mode
Reserved mode is available for future mode definitions. When reserved
mode is selected, the queue is not active. The behavior is the same as
disabled mode.
19.10.6 Single-Scan Modes
A single-scan queue operating mode is used to execute a single pass
through a sequence of conversions defined by a queue. By
programming the MQ1 field in QACR1 or the MQ2 field in QACR2, these
modes can be selected:
NOTE:
•
Software-initiated single-scan mode
•
Externally triggered single-scan mode
•
Externally gated single-scan mode
•
Interval timer single-scan mode
Queue 2 cannot be programmed for externally gated single-scan mode.
In all single-scan queue operating modes, queue execution is enabled
by writing the single-scan enable bit to a 1 in the queue’s control register.
The single-scan enable bits, SSE1 and SSE2, are provided for queue 1
and queue 2, respectively.
Until a queue’s single-scan enable bit is set, any trigger events for that
queue are ignored. The single-scan enable bit may be set to a 1 during
the same write cycle that selects the single-scan queue operating mode.
The single-scan enable bit can be written only to 1, but will always
read 0. Once set, writing the single-scan enable bit to 0 has no effect.
Advance Information
494
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Only the QADC can clear the single-scan enable bit. The completion
flag, completion interrupt, or queue status is used to determine when the
queue has completed.
After the single-scan enable bit is set, a trigger event causes the QADC
to begin execution with the first CCW in the queue. The single-scan
enable bit remains set until the queue is completed. After the queue
reaches completion, the QADC resets the single-scan enable bit to 0.
Writing the single-scan enable bit to a 1 or a 0 before the queue scan is
complete has no effect; however, if the queue operating mode is
changed, the new queue operating mode and the value of the
single-scan enable bit are recognized immediately. The conversion in
progress is aborted, and the new queue operating mode takes effect.
In software-initiated single-scan mode, writing a 1 to the single-scan
enable bit causes the QADC to generate a trigger event internally, and
queue execution begins immediately. In the other single-scan queue
operating modes, once the single-scan enable bit is written, the selected
trigger event must occur before the queue can start. The single-scan
enable bit allows the entire queue to be scanned once. A trigger overrun
is captured if a trigger event occurs during queue execution in an
edge-sensitive external trigger mode or a periodic/interval timer mode.
In the interval timer single-scan mode, the next expiration of the timer is
the trigger event for the queue. After queue execution is complete, the
queue status is shown as idle. The queue can be restarted by setting the
single-scan enable bit to 1. Queue execution begins with the first CCW
in the queue.
19.10.6.1 Software-Initiated Single-Scan Mode
Software can initiate the execution of a scan sequence for queue 1 or 2
by selecting software-initiated single-scan mode and writing the
single-scan enable bit in QACR1 or QACR2. A trigger event is generated
internally and the QADC immediately begins execution of the first CCW
in the queue. If a pause occurs, another trigger event is generated
internally, and then execution continues without pausing.
The QADC automatically performs the conversions in the queue until an
end-of-queue condition is encountered. The queue remains idle until the
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
495
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
single-scan enable bit is again set. While the time to internally generate
and act on a trigger event is very short, the queue status field can be
read as momentarily indicating that the queue is paused. The trigger
overrun flag is never set while in software-initiated single-scan mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The software-initiated single-scan mode is useful when:
•
Complete control of queue execution is required
•
There is a need to easily alternate between several queue
sequences
19.10.6.2 Externally Triggered Single-Scan Mode
The externally triggered single-scan mode is available on both queue 1
and queue 2. Both rising and falling edge triggered modes are available.
A scan must be enabled by setting the single-scan enable bit for the
queue.
The first external trigger edge causes the queue to be executed one
time. Each CCW is read and the indicated conversions are performed
until an end-of-queue condition is encountered. After the queue is
completed, the QADC clears the single-scan enable bit. The single-scan
enable bit can be written again to allow another scan of the queue to be
initiated by the next external trigger edge.
The externally triggered single-scan mode is useful when the input
trigger rate can exceed the queue execution rate. Analog samples can
be taken in sync with an external event, even though application
software does not require data taken from every edge. Externally
triggered single-scan mode can be enabled to get one set of data and,
at a later time, be enabled again for the next set of samples.
When a pause bit is encountered during externally triggered single-scan
mode, another trigger event is required for queue execution to continue.
Software involvement is not required for queue execution to continue
from the paused state.
Advance Information
496
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
19.10.6.3 Externally Gated Single-Scan Mode
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The QADC provides external gating for queue 1 only. When externally
gated single-scan mode is selected, the input level on the associated
external trigger pin enables and disables queue execution. The polarity
of the external gate signal is fixed so that only a high level opens the gate
and a low level closes the gate. Once the gate is open, each CCW is
read and the indicated conversions are performed until the gate is
closed. Queue scan must be enabled by setting the single-scan enable
bit for queue 1. If a pause is encountered, the pause flag does not set,
and execution continues without pausing.
While the gate is open, queue 1 executes one time. Each CCW is read
and the indicated conversions are performed until an end-of-queue
condition is encountered. When queue 1 completes, the QADC sets the
completion flag (CF1) and clears the single-scan enable bit. Set the
single-scan enable bit again to allow another scan of queue 1 to be
initiated during the next open gate.
If the gate closes before queue 1 completes execution, the current CCW
completes, execution of queue 1 stops, the single-scan enable bit is
cleared, and the PF1 bit is set. The CWPQ1 field can be read to
determine the last valid conversion in the queue. The single-scan enable
bit must be set again and the PF1 bit should be cleared before another
scan of queue 1 is initiated during the next open gate. The start of
queue 1 is always the first CCW in the CCW table.
Because the gate level is only sampled after each conversion during
queue execution, closing the gate for a period less than a conversion
time interval does not guarantee the closure will be captured.
19.10.6.4 Interval Timer Single-Scan Mode
Both queues can use the periodic/interval timer in a single-scan queue
operating mode. The timer interval can range from 27 to 217 QCLK
cycles in binary multiples. When the interval timer single-scan mode is
selected and the single-scan enable bit is set in QACR1 or QACR2, the
timer begins counting. When the time interval elapses, an internal trigger
event is generated to start the queue and the QADC begins execution
with the first CCW.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
497
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
The QADC automatically performs the conversions in the queue until a
pause or an end-of-queue condition is encountered. When a pause
occurs, queue execution stops until the timer interval elapses again, and
queue execution continues. When queue execution reaches an
end-of-queue situation, the single-scan enable bit is cleared. Set the
single-scan enable bit again to allow another scan of the queue to be
initiated by the interval timer.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The interval timer generates a trigger event whenever the time interval
elapses. The trigger event may cause queue execution to continue
following a pause or may be considered a trigger overrun. Once queue
execution is completed, the single-scan enable bit must be set again to
allow the timer to count again.
Normally, only one queue is enabled for interval timer single-scan mode,
and the timer will reset at the end-of-queue. However, if both queues are
enabled for either single-scan or continuous interval timer mode, the
end-of-queue condition will not reset the timer while the other queue is
active. In this case, the timer will reset when both queues have reached
end-of-queue. See 19.10.9 Periodic/Interval Timer for a definition of
interval timer reset conditions.
The interval timer single-scan mode can be used in applications that
need coherent results. For example:
Advance Information
498
•
When it is necessary that all samples are guaranteed to be taken
during the same scan of the analog pins
•
When the interrupt rate in the periodic timer continuous-scan
mode would be too high
•
In sensitive battery applications, where the interval timer
single-scan mode uses less power than the software-initiated
continuous-scan mode
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
19.10.7 Continuous-Scan Modes
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
A continuous-scan queue operating mode is used to execute multiple
passes through a sequence of conversions defined by a queue. By
programming the MQ1 field in QACR1 or the MQ2 field in QACR2, these
modes can be selected:
NOTE:
•
Software-initiated continuous-scan mode
•
Externally triggered continuous-scan mode
•
Externally gated continuous-scan mode
•
Periodic timer continuous-scan mode
Queue 2 cannot be programmed for externally gated continuous-scan
mode.
When a queue is programmed for a continuous-scan mode, the
single-scan enable bit in the queue control register does not have any
meaning or effect. As soon as the queue operating mode is
programmed, the selected trigger event can initiate queue execution.
In the case of software-initiated continuous-scan mode, the trigger event
is generated internally and queue execution begins immediately. In the
other continuous-scan queue operating modes, the selected trigger
event must occur before the queue can start. A trigger overrun is
captured if a trigger event occurs during queue execution in the
externally triggered continuous-scan mode or the periodic timer
continuous-scan mode.
After queue execution is complete, the queue status is shown as idle.
Because the continuous-scan queue operating modes allow the entire
queue to be scanned multiple times, software involvement is not needed
for queue execution to continue from the idle state. The next trigger
event causes queue execution to begin again, starting with the first CCW
in the queue.
NOTE:
In continuous-scan modes, all samples are guaranteed to be taken
during one pass through the queue (coherently), except when a queue 1
trigger event halts queue 2 execution. The time between consecutive
conversions has been designed to be consistent. However, for queues
that end with a CCW containing the EOQ code (channel 63), the time
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
499
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
between the last queue conversion and the first queue conversion
requires one additional CCW fetch cycle. Continuous samples are not
coherent at this boundary.
In addition, the time from trigger to first conversion cannot be
guaranteed, because it is a function of clock synchronization,
programmable trigger events, queue priorities, and so on.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.10.7.1 Software-Initiated Continuous-Scan Mode
When software-initiated continuous-scan mode is selected, the trigger
event is generated automatically by the QADC. Queue execution begins
immediately. If a pause is encountered, another trigger event is
generated internally, and execution continues without pausing. When
the end-of-queue is reached, another internal trigger event is generated
and queue execution restarts at the beginning of the queue.
While the time to internally generate and act on a trigger event is very
short, the queue status field can be read as momentarily indicating that
the queue is idle. The trigger overrun flag is never set while in
software-initiated continuous-scan mode.
The software-initiated continuous-scan mode keeps the result registers
updated more frequently than any of the other queue operating modes.
The result table can always be read to get the latest converted value for
each channel. The channels scanned are kept up to date by the QADC
without software involvement.
The software-initiated continuous-scan mode may be chosen for either
queue, but is normally used only with queue 2. When software-initiated
continuous-scan mode is chosen for queue 1, that queue operates
continuously and queue 2, being lower in priority, never gets executed.
The short interval of time between a queue 1 completion and the
subsequent trigger event is not sufficient to allow queue 2 execution to
begin.
The software-initiated continuous-scan mode is a useful choice with
queue 2 for converting channels that do not need to be synchronized to
anything or for slow-to-change analog channels. Interrupts are normally
not used with the software-initiated continuous-scan mode. Rather, the
Advance Information
500
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
latest conversion results can be read from the result table at any time.
Once initiated, software action is not needed to sustain conversions of
channel.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
19.10.7.2 Externally Triggered Continuous-Scan Mode
The QADC provides external trigger pins for both queues. When
externally triggered continuous-scan mode is selected, a transition on
the associated external trigger pin initiates queue execution. The polarity
of the external trigger signal is programmable, so that a mode which
begins queue execution on the rising or falling edge can be selected.
Each CCW is read and the indicated conversions are performed until an
end-of-queue condition is encountered. When the next external trigger
edge is detected, queue execution begins again automatically. Software
involvement is not needed between trigger events.
When a pause bit is encountered in externally triggered continuous-scan
mode, another trigger event is required for queue execution to continue.
Software involvement is not needed for queue execution to continue
from the paused state.
Some applications need to synchronize the sampling of analog channels
to external events. There are cases when it is not possible to use
software initiation of the queue scan sequence, because interrupt
response times vary. Externally triggered continuous-scan mode is
useful in these cases.
19.10.7.3 Externally Gated Continuous-Scan Mode
The QADC provides external gating for queue 1 only. When externally
gated continuous-scan mode is selected, the input level on the
associated external trigger pin enables and disables queue execution.
The polarity of the external gate signal is fixed so that a high level opens
the gate and a low level closes the gate. Once the gate is open, each
CCW is read and the indicated conversions are performed until the gate
is closed. When the gate opens again, queue execution automatically
restarts at the beginning of the queue. Software involvement is not
needed between trigger events. If a pause in a CCW is encountered, the
pause flag does not set, and execution continues without pausing.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
501
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The purpose of externally gated continuous-scan mode is to
continuously collect digitized samples while the gate is open and to have
the most recent samples available. It is up to the programmer to ensure
that the gate is not opened so long that an end-of-queue is reached.
In the event that the queue completes before the gate closes, the CF1
flag will set, and the queue will roll over to the beginning and continue
conversions until the gate closes. If the gate remains open and the CF1
flag is not cleared, when the queue completes a second time the TOR1
flag will set and the queue will roll-over again. The queue will continue to
execute until the gate closes or the mode is disabled.
If the gate closes before queue 1 completes execution, the QADC stops
and sets the PF1 bit to indicate an incomplete queue. The CWPQ1 field
can be read to determine the last valid conversion in the queue. If the
gate opens again, execution of queue 1 restarts. The start of queue 1 is
always the first CCW in the CCW table. The condition of the gate is only
sampled after each conversion during queue execution, so closing the
gate for a period less than a conversion time interval does not guarantee
the closure will be captured.
19.10.7.4 Periodic Timer Continuous-Scan Mode
The QADC includes a dedicated periodic timer for initiating a scan
sequence on queue 1 and/or queue 2. A programmable timer interval
ranging from 27 to 217 times the QCLK period in binary multiples can be
selected. The QCLK period is prescaled down from the MCU clock.
When a periodic timer continuous-scan mode is selected, the timer
begins counting. After the programmed interval elapses, the timer
generated trigger event starts the appropriate queue. The QADC
automatically performs the conversions in the queue until an
end-of-queue condition or a pause is encountered. When a pause
occurs, the QADC waits for the periodic interval to expire again, then
continues with the queue. Once EOQ has been detected, the next trigger
event causes queue execution to restart with the first CCW in the queue.
The periodic timer generates a trigger event whenever the time interval
elapses. The trigger event may cause queue execution to continue
following a pause or queue completion or may be considered a trigger
Advance Information
502
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
overrun. As with all continuous-scan queue operating modes, software
action is not needed between trigger events. Because both queues may
be triggered by the periodic/interval timer, see 19.10.9 Periodic/Interval
Timer for a summary of periodic/interval timer reset conditions.
19.10.8 QADC Clock (QCLK) Generation
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 19-42 is a block diagram of the clock subsystem. The QCLK
provides the timing for the A/D converter state machine which controls
the timing of the conversion. The QCLK is also the input to a 17-stage
binary divider which implements the periodic/interval timer. To retain the
specified analog conversion accuracy, the QCLK frequency (fQCLK)
must be within the tolerance specified in Table 23-8. QADC Conversion
Specifications (Operating).
Before using the QADC, the prescaler must be initialized with values that
put the QCLK within the specified range. Though most applications
initialize the prescaler once and do not change it, write operations to the
prescaler fields are permitted.
QPR[6:0]
SYSTEM CLOCK
PRESCALER
SAR CONTROL
INPUT SAMPLE TIME
FROM CCW
2
ATD CONVERTER
STATE MACHINE
SAR
10
BINARY COUNTER
7
2
QUEUE 1 AND QUEUE 2 TIMER
MODE RATE SELECTION
8
8
2
9
2
10
2
211 212 213 214 215 216 217
PERIODIC TIMER/INTERVAL TIMER
SELECT
2
PERIODIC/INTERVAL TRIGGER
EVENT FOR Q1 AND Q2
Figure 19-42. QADC Clock Subsystem Functions
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
503
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
CAUTION:
A change in the prescaler value while a conversion is in progress is likely
to corrupt the result. Therefore, any prescaler write operation should be
done only when both queues are in the disabled modes.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
To accommodate the wide range of the main MCU clock frequency,
QCLK is generated by a programmable prescaler which divides the
MCU system clock. To allow the A/D conversion time to be maximized
across the spectrum of system clock frequencies, the QADC prescaler
permits the QCLK frequency to be software selectable. The frequency of
QCLK is set with the QPR field in QACR0.
The MCU system clock frequency is the basis of QADC timing. The
QADC requires that the system clock frequency be at least twice the
QCLK frequency.
19.10.9 Periodic/Interval Timer
The QADC periodic/interval timer can be used to generate trigger events
at a programmable interval, initiating execution of queue 1 and/or
queue 2. The periodic/interval timer stays reset under these conditions:
NOTE:
•
Both queue 1 and queue 2 are programmed to any mode which
does not use the periodic/interval timer.
•
System reset is asserted.
•
Stop mode is enabled.
•
Debug mode is enabled.
Interval timer single-scan mode does not start the periodic/interval timer
until the single-scan enable bit is set.
These conditions will cause a pulsed reset of the periodic/interval timer
during use:
Advance Information
504
•
A queue 1 operating mode change to a mode which uses the
periodic/interval timer, even if queue 2 is already using the timer
•
A queue 2 operating mode change to a mode which uses the
periodic/interval timer, provided queue 1 is not in a mode which
uses the periodic/interval timer
•
Roll over of the timer
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
During stop mode, the periodic/interval timer is held in reset. Because
stop mode causes QACR1 and QACR2 to be reset to 0, a valid periodic
or interval timer mode must be written after leaving stop mode to release
the timer from reset.
When QADC debug mode is entered and a periodic or interval timer
mode is selected, the timer counter is reset after the conversion in
progress completes. When the periodic or interval timer mode has been
enabled (the timer is counting), but a trigger event has not been issued,
debug mode takes effect immediately, and the timer is held in reset.
Removal of the QADC debug condition restarts the counter from the
beginning. Refer to 19.5.1 Debug Mode for more information.
19.10.10 Conversion Command Word Table
The conversion command word (CCW) table is 64 half-word (128 byte)
long RAM with 10 bits of each entry implemented. The CCW table is
written by the user and is not modified by the QADC. Each CCW
requests the conversion of one analog channel to a digital result. The
CCW specifies the analog channel number, the input sample time, and
whether the queue is to pause after the current CCW. The 10
implemented bits of the CCW can be read and written. The remaining six
bits are unimplemented and read as 0s; write operations have no effect.
Each location in the CCW table corresponds to a location in the result
word table. When a conversion is completed for a CCW entry, the 10-bit
result is written in the corresponding result word entry.
The beginning of queue 1 is the first location in the CCW table. The first
location of queue 2 is specified by the beginning of queue 2 pointer field
(BQ2) in QACR2. To dedicate the entire CCW table to queue 1, place
queue 2 in disabled mode and write BQ2 to 64 or greater. To dedicate
the entire CCW table to queue 2, place queue 1 in disabled mode and
set BQ2 to the first location in the CCW table (CCW0).
Figure 19-43 illustrates the operation of the queue structure.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
505
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
CONVERSION COMMAND
WORD (CCW) TABLE
00
RESULT WORD TABLE
BEGINNING OF QUEUE 1
00
•
•
•
•
•
•
CHANNEL SELECT,
SAMPLE, HOLD,
A/D CONVERSION
END OF QUEUE 1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
BEGINNING OF QUEUE 2
63
•
•
•
•
•
•
63
END OF QUEUE 2
10-BIT CONVERSION COMMAND
WORD FORMAT
10-BIT RESULT, READABLE IN
THREE 16-BIT FORMATS
9
8
[7:6]
[5:0]
15 14 13 12 11 10
[9:0]
P
BYP
IST
CHAN
0 0 0 0 0 0
RESULT
RIGHT-JUSTIFIED, UNSIGNED RESULT
[15:6]
P — PAUSE AFTER CONVERSION
UNTIL NEXT TRIGGER
BYP — BYPASS BUFFER AMPLIFIER
IST — INPUT SAMPLE TIME
CHAN — CHANNEL NUMBER AND
END-OF-QUEUE CODE
S
RESULT
[5:0]
0 0 0 0 0 0
LEFT-JUSTIFIED, SIGNED RESULT
[15:6]
[5:0]
RESULT
0 0 0 0 0 0
LEFT-JUSTIFIED, UNSIGNED RESULT
Figure 19-43. QADC Conversion Queue Operation
To prepare the QADC for a scan sequence, write to the CCW table to
specify the desired channel conversions. The criteria for queue
execution is established by selecting the queue operating mode. The
queue operating mode determines what type of trigger event starts
queue execution. A trigger event refers to any of the ways that cause the
QADC to begin executing the CCWs in a queue or subqueue. An
external trigger is only one of the possible trigger events.
A scan sequence may be initiated by:
Advance Information
506
•
A software command
•
Expiration of the periodic/interval timer
•
An external trigger signal
•
An external gated signal (queue 1 only)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Digital Control
The queue can be scanned in single pass or continuous fashion. When
a single-scan mode is selected, the scan must be engaged by setting the
single-scan enable bit. When a continuous-scan mode is selected, the
queue remains active in the selected queue operating mode after the
QADC completes each queue scan sequence.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
During queue execution, the QADC reads each CCW from the active
queue and executes conversions in three stages:
•
Initial sample
•
Final sample
•
Resolution
During initial sample, a buffered version of the selected input channel is
connected to the sample capacitor at the input of the sample buffer
amplifier.
During the final sample period, the sample buffer amplifier is bypassed,
and the multiplexer input charges the sample capacitor directly. Each
CCW specifies a final input sample time of 2, 4, 8, or 16 QCLK cycles.
When an analog-to-digital conversion is complete, the result is written to
the corresponding location in the result word table. The QADC continues
to sequentially execute each CCW in the queue until the end of the
queue is detected or a pause bit is found in a CCW.
When the pause bit is set in the current CCW, the QADC stops execution
of the queue until a new trigger event occurs. The pause status flag bit
is set, and an interrupt may optionally be requested. After the trigger
event occurs, the paused state ends, and the QADC continues to
execute each CCW in the queue until another pause is encountered or
the end of the queue is detected.
An end-of-queue condition occurs when:
•
The CCW channel field is programmed with 63 to specify the end
of the queue.
•
The end-of-queue 1 is implied by the beginning of queue 2, which
is specified by the BQ2 field in QACR2.
•
The physical end of the queue RAM space defines the end of
either queue.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
507
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When any of the end-of-queue conditions is recognized, a queue
completion flag is set, and if enabled, an interrupt is requested. These
situations prematurely terminate queue execution:
Advance Information
508
•
Queue 1 is higher in priority than queue 2. When a trigger event
occurs on queue 1 during queue 2 execution, the execution of
queue 2 is suspended by aborting the execution of the CCW in
progress, and queue 1 execution begins. When queue 1 execution
is complete, queue 2 conversions restart with the first CCW entry
in queue 2 or the first CCW of the queue 2 subqueue being
executed when queue 2 was suspended. Alternately, conversions
can restart with the aborted queue 2 CCW entry. The RESUME bit
in QACR2 selects where queue 2 begins after suspension. By
choosing to re-execute all of the suspended queue 2 CCWs
(RESUME = 0), all of the samples are guaranteed to have been
taken during the same scan pass. However, a high trigger event
rate for queue 1 can prevent completion of queue 2. If this occurs,
execution of queue 2 can begin with the aborted CCW entry
(RESUME = 1).
•
Any conversion in progress for a queue is aborted when that
queue’s operating mode is changed to disabled. Putting a queue
into the disabled mode does not power down the converter.
•
Changing a queue’s operating mode to another valid mode aborts
any conversion in progress. The queue restarts at its beginning
once an appropriate trigger event occurs.
•
For low-power operation, the stop bit can be set to prepare the
module for a loss of clocks. The QADC aborts any conversion in
progress when stop mode is entered.
•
When the QADC debug bit is set and the CPU enters background
debug mode, the QADC freezes at the end of the conversion in
progress. After leaving debug mode, the QADC resumes queue
execution beginning with the next CCW entry. Refer to 19.5.1
Debug Mode for more information.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Pin Connection Considerations
19.10.11 Result Word Table
The result word table is a 64 half-word (128 byte) long by 10-bit wide
RAM. An entry is written by the QADC after completing an analog
conversion specified by the corresponding CCW table entry. The result
word table can be read or written, but in normal operation is only read to
obtain analog conversions from the QADC. Unimplemented bits read as
0s and writes have no effect.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
NOTE:
Although the result RAM can be written, some write operations, like bit
manipulation, may not operate as expected because the hardware
cannot access a true 16-bit value.
While there is only one result word table, the half-word (16-bit) data can
be accessed in three different data formats:
•
Right justified with 0s in the higher order unused bits
•
Left justified with the most significant bit inverted to form a sign bit,
and 0s in the unused lower order bits
•
Left justified with 0s in the lower order unused bits
The left justified, signed format corresponds to a half-scale, offset binary,
two’s complement data format. The address used to read the result table
determines the data alignment format. All write operations to the result
word table are right justified.
19.11 Pin Connection Considerations
The QADC requires accurate, noise-free input signals for proper
operation. This section discusses the design of external circuitry to
maximize QADC performance.
19.11.1 Analog Reference Pins
No A/D converter can be more accurate than its analog reference. Any
noise in the reference can result in at least that much error in a
conversion. The reference for the QADC, supplied by pins VRH and VRL,
should be low-pass filtered from its source to obtain a noise-free, clean
signal. In many cases, simple capacitive bypassing may suffice. In
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
509
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
extreme cases, inductors or ferrite beads may be necessary if noise or
RF energy is present. Series resistance is not advisable, because there
is an effective DC current required from the reference voltage by the
internal resistor string in the RC DAC array. External resistance may
introduce error in this architecture under certain conditions. Any series
devices in the filter network should contain a minimum amount of DC
resistance.
For accurate conversion results, the analog reference voltages must be
within the limits defined by VDDA and VSSA, as explained in this
subsection.
19.11.2 Analog Power Pins
The analog supply pins (VDDA and VSSA) define the limits of the analog
reference voltages (VRH and VRL) and of the analog multiplexer inputs.
Figure 19-44 is a diagram of the analog input circuitry.
VDDA
VRH
SAMPLE
AMP
S/H
RC DAC
COMPARATOR
16 CHANNELS TOTAL
CP
VSSA
VRL
Figure 19-44. Equivalent Analog Input Circuitry
Because the sample amplifier is powered by VDDA and VSSA, it can
accurately transfer input signal levels up to but not exceeding VDDA and
down to but not below VSSA. If the input signal is outside of this range,
the output from the sample amplifier is clipped.
Advance Information
510
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Pin Connection Considerations
In addition, VRH and VRL must be within the range defined by VDDA and
VSSA. As long as VRH is less than or equal to VDDA, and VRL is greater
than or equal to VSSA, and the sample amplifier has accurately
transferred the input signal, resolution is ratiometric within the limits
defined by VRL and VRH. If VRH is greater than VDDA, the sample
amplifier can never transfer a full-scale value. If VRL is less than VSSA,
the sample amplifier can never transfer a 0 value.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Figure 19-45 shows the results of reference voltages outside the range
defined by VDDA and VSSA. At the top of the input signal range, VDDA is
10 mV lower than VRH. This results in a maximum obtainable 10-bit
conversion value 0x03fe. At the bottom of the signal range, VSSA is
15 mV higher than VRL, resulting in a minimum obtainable 10-bit
conversion value of 0x0003.
3FF
3FE
3FD
10-BIT RESULT (HEXADECIMAL)
3FC
3FB
3FA
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
.010
.020
.030
5.100
5.110
5.120
5.130
INPUTS IN VOLTS (VRH = 5.120 V, VRL = 0 V)
Figure 19-45. Errors Resulting from Clipping
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
511
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
19.11.3 Conversion Timing Schemes
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This section contains some conversion timing examples. Figure 19-46
shows the timing for basic conversions where it is assumed that:
•
Q1 begins with CCW0 and ends with CCW3.
•
CCW0 has pause bit set.
•
CCW1 does not have pause bit set.
•
External trigger rising edge for Q1
•
CCW4 = BQ2 and Q2 is disabled.
•
Q1 RES shows relative result register updates.
Recall that when QS = 0, both queues are disabled; when QS = 8,
queue 1 is active and queue 2 is idle; and when QS = 4; queue 1 is
paused and queue 2 is disabled.
TIME BETWEEN
TRIGGERS
CONVERSION TIME
= 14 QCLKS
CONVERSION TIME
= 14 QCLKS
QCLK
TRIG1
EOC
QS
CWP
0
LAST
CWPQ1
Q1 RES
4
8
8
CCW0
LAST
CCW1
CCW2
CCW0
CCW1
R0
R1
Figure 19-46. External Positive Edge Trigger Mode Timing with Pause
Advance Information
512
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Pin Connection Considerations
A time separator is provided between the triggers and the end of
conversion (EOC). The relationship to QCLK displayed is not
guaranteed.
CWPQ1 and CWPQ2 typically lag CWP and only match CWP when the
associated queue is inactive. Another way to view CWPQ1 and CWPQ2
is that these registers update when EOC triggers the write to the result
register.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
For the CCW with the pause bit set (CCW0), CWP does not increment
until triggered. For the CCW with the pause bit clear (CCW1), the CWP
increments with the EOC.
The conversion results Q1 RESx show the result associated with CCWx,
such that R0 represents the result associated with CCW0.
Figure 19-47 shows the timing for conversions in externally gated
single-scan with same assumptions in example 1 except:
•
No pause bits set in any CCW
•
Externally gated single scan mode for Q1
•
Single scan enable bit (SSE1) is set.
When the gate closes and opens again, the conversions start with the
first CCW in Q1.
When the gate closes, the active conversion completes before the
queue goes idle.
When Q1 completes, both the CF1 bit sets and the SSE bit clears.
In this mode, the PF1 bit sets to reflect that a gate closing occurred
before the queue completed.
Figure 19-48 shows the timing for conversions in externally gated
continuous scan mode with the same assumptions as in Figure 19-47.
At the end of Q1,the completion flag CF1 sets and the queue restarts. If
the queue starts a second time and completes, the trigger overrun flag
TOR1 sets.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
513
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
TRIG1 (GATE)
EOC
QS
0
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
CWP
8
LAST
0
CCW0
8
CCW1
CCW0
0
CCW1
CCW2
CCW3
CWPQ1
LAST
CCW0
CCW1
CCW0
CCW1
CCW2
CCW3
Q1 RES
LAST
R0
R1
R0
R1
R2
R3
SSE
CF1
PF1
Figure 19-47. Gated Mode, Single Scan Timing
TRIG1 (GATE)
EOC
QS
CWP
0
8
LAST
CCW0
CCW1
CCW2
CCW3
CCW0
CCW3
CCW0
CSPQ1
LAST
CCW0
CCW1
CCW2
CCW3
CCW2
CCW3
Q1 RES
LAST
XX
R0
R1
R2
R3
R2
R3
CF1
TOR1
QUEUE RESTART
QUEUE RESTART
Figure 19-48. Gated Mode, Continuous Scan Timing
Advance Information
514
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Pin Connection Considerations
19.11.4 Analog Supply Filtering and Grounding
Two important factors influencing performance in analog integrated
circuits are supply filtering and grounding. Generally, digital circuits use
bypass capacitors on every VDD/VSS pin pair. This applies to analog
subsystems and submodules also. Equally important as bypassing is the
distribution of power and ground.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Analog supplies should be isolated from digital supplies as much as
possible. This necessity stems from the higher performance
requirements often associated with analog circuits. Therefore, deriving
an analog supply from a local digital supply is not recommended.
However, if for cost reasons digital and analog power are derived from a
common regulator, filtering of the analog power is recommended in
addition to the bypassing of the supplies already mentioned. For
example, an RC low pass filter could be used to isolate the digital and
analog supplies when generated by a common regulator. If multiple high
precision analog circuits are locally employed (for example, two A/D
converters), the analog supplies should be isolated from each other as
sharing supplies introduces the potential for interference between
analog circuits.
Grounding is the most important factor influencing analog circuit
performance in mixed signal systems (or in standalone analog systems).
Close attention must be paid not to introduce additional sources of noise
into the analog circuitry. Common sources of noise include ground
loops, inductive coupling, and combining digital and analog grounds
together inappropriately.
The problem of how and when to combine digital and analog grounds
arises from the large transients which the digital ground must handle. If
the digital ground is not able to handle the large transients, the
associated current can return to ground through the analog ground. It is
this excess current overflowing into the analog ground which causes
performance degradation by developing a differential voltage between
the true analog ground and the microcontroller’s ground pins. The end
result is that the ground observed by the analog circuit is no longer true
ground and thus skews converter performance.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
515
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Two similar approaches to improving or eliminating the problems
associated with grounding excess transient currents involve star-point
ground systems. One approach is to star-point the different grounds at
the power supply origin, thus keeping the ground isolated. Refer to
Figure 19-49.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Another approach is to star-point the different grounds near the analog
ground pin on the microcontroller by using small traces for connecting
the non-analog grounds to the analog ground. The small traces are
meant only to accommodate dc differences, not ac transients.
NOTE:
This star-point scheme still requires adequate grounding for digital and
analog subsystems in addition to the star-point ground.
ANALOG POWER SUPPLY
+5 V
PGND
+5 V
VDDA
VSSA
AGND
VRL
VRH
+5 V
DIGITAL POWER SUPPLY
VSS
QADC
VDD
PCB
Figure 19-49. Star-Ground at the Point of Power Supply Origin
Advance Information
516
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Pin Connection Considerations
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Other suggestions for PCB layout in which the QADC is employed
include:
•
Analog ground must be low impedance to all analog ground points
in the circuit.
•
Bypass capacitors should be as close to the power pins as
possible.
•
The analog ground should be isolated from the digital ground. This
can be done by cutting a separate ground plane for the analog
ground.
•
Non-minimum traces should be utilized for connecting bypass
capacitors and filters to their corresponding ground/power points.
•
Minimum distance for trace runs when possible.
19.11.5 Accommodating Positive/Negative Stress Conditions
Positive or negative stress refers to conditions which exceed nominally
defined operating limits. Examples include applying a voltage exceeding
the normal limit on an input (for example, voltages outside of the
suggested supply/reference ranges) or causing currents into or out of
the pin which exceed normal limits. QADC specific considerations are
voltages greater than VDDA or less than VSSA applied to an analog input
which cause excessive currents into or out of the input. Refer to
Table 23-6. QADC Absolute Maximum Ratings and Table 23-7.
QADC Electrical Specifications (Operating) for more information on
exact magnitudes.
Either stress conditions can potentially disrupt conversion results on
neighboring inputs. Parasitic devices, associated with CMOS
processes, can cause an immediate disruptive influence on neighboring
pins. Common examples of parasitic devices are diodes to substrate and
bipolar devices with the base terminal tied to substrate (VSS/VSSA
ground). Under stress conditions, current injected on an adjacent pin can
cause errors on the selected channel by developing a voltage drop
across the selected channel’s impedances.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
517
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Figure 19-50 shows an active parasitic bipolar NPN transistor when an
input pin is subjected to negative stress conditions. Figure 19-51 shows
positive stress conditions can activate a similar PNP transistor.
VStress
IINJN
RStress
+
ANn
10 kΩ
PARASITIC
DEVICE
IIn
RSelected
ADJACENT
PIN
ANn+1
VIn
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
PIN UNDER
STRESS
Figure 19-50. Input Pin Subjected to Negative Stress
VStress
RStress
+
IINJP
10 kΩ
RSelected
IIn
ANn
VDDA
PARASITIC
DEVICE
ANn+1
VIn
PIN UNDER
STRESS
ADJACENT
PIN
Figure 19-51. Input Pin Subjected to Positive Stress
The current into the pin (IINJN or IINJP) under negative or positive stress is
determined by these equations:
I
I
– ( V Stress – V BE )
= ----------------------------------------------INJN
R Stress
INJP
V Stress – V EB – V DDA
= --------------------------------------------------------------R Stress
Where:
VStress
= Adjustable voltage source
VEB
= Parasitic PNP emitter/base voltage
VBE
= Parasitic NPN base/emitter voltage
RStress
= Source impedance (10 kΩ resistor in Figure 19-50 and
Figure 19-51 on stressed channel)
= Source impedance on channel selected for conversion
RSelected
Advance Information
518
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Pin Connection Considerations
The current into (IIn) the neighboring pin is determined by the KN (current
coupling ratio) of the parasitic bipolar transistor (KN ‹‹ 1). The IIn can be
expressed by this equation:
IIn = – KN * IINJ
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Where:
IINJ is either IINJN or IINJP.
A method for minimizing the impact of stress conditions on the QADC is
to strategically allocate QADC inputs so that the lower accuracy inputs
are adjacent to the inputs most likely to see stress conditions.
Also, suitable source impedances should be selected to meet design
goals and minimize the effect of stress conditions.
19.11.6 Analog Input Considerations
The source impedance of the analog signal to be measured and any
intermediate filtering should be considered whether external
multiplexing is used or not. Figure 19-52 shows the connection of eight
typical analog signal sources to one QADC analog input pin through a
separate multiplexer chip. Also, an example of an analog signal source
connected directly to a QADC analog input channel is displayed.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
519
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
ANALOG SIGNAL SOURCE
R Source2
FILTERING AND
INTERCONNECT
R Filter2
TYPICAL MUX CHIP
(MC54HC4051, MC74HC4051,
MC54HC4052, MC74HC4052,
MC54HC4053, ETC.)
INTERCONNECT
QADC
~
0.01 µF1
C Source
R Source2
~
R Filter2
C MUXIN
0.01 µF1
C Source
R Source2
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
C Filter
~
R Filter2
C Filter
C MUXIN
0.01 µF1
C Source
R Source2
R Filter2
C Filter
R MUXOUT
C MUXIN
~
C MUXOUT
0.01 µF1
C Source
R Source2
~
R Filter2
C Filter
C PCB
C MUXIN
CP
C SAMP
CIn = CP + CSAMP
0.01 µF1
C Source
R Source2
~
R Filter2
C Filter
C MUXIN
0.01 µF1
C Source
R Source2
~
R Filter2
C Filter
C MUXIN
0.01 µF1
C Source
R Source2
~
R Filter2
C Filter
C MUXIN
0.01 µF1
C Source
R Source2
~
C Filter
C MUXIN
R Filter2
0.01 µF1
C Source
C Filter
Notes:
1. Typical value
2. RFilter, typically 10 kΩ–20 kΩ
C PCB
CP
C SAMP
Figure 19-52. External Multiplexing of Analog Signal Sources
Advance Information
520
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Pin Connection Considerations
19.11.7 Analog Input Pins
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Analog inputs should have low ac impedance at the pins. Low ac
impedance can be realized by placing a capacitor with good high
frequency characteristics at the input pin of the part. Ideally, that
capacitor should be as large as possible (within the practical range of
capacitors that still have good high-frequency characteristics). This
capacitor has two effects:
•
It helps attenuate any noise that may exist on the input.
•
It sources charge during the sample period when the analog signal
source is a high-impedance source.
Series resistance can be used with the capacitor on an input pin to
implement a simple RC filter. The maximum level of filtering at the input
pins is application dependent and is based on the bandpass
characteristics required to accurately track the dynamic characteristics
of an input. Simple RC filtering at the pin may be limited by the source
impedance of the transducer or circuit supplying the analog signal to be
measured. (See 19.11.7.2 Error Resulting from Leakage.) In some
cases, the size of the capacitor at the pin may be very small.
Figure 19-53 is a simplified model of an input channel. Refer to this
model in the following discussion of the interaction between the external
circuitry and the circuitry inside the QADC.
SOURCE
EXTERNAL FILTER
RSRC
INTERNAL CIRCUIT MODEL
S1
S2
S3
RF
AMP
CSAMP
CF
VSRC
VSRC = Source voltage
RSRC = Source impedance
VI
CP
RF = Filter impedance
CF = Filter capacitor
CP = Internal parasitic capacitance
CSAMP = Sample capacitor
VI = Internal voltage source during sample and hold
Figure 19-53. Electrical Model of an A/D Input Pin
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
521
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
In Figure 19-53, RF, RSRC, and CF comprise the external filter circuit. CP
is the internal parasitic capacitor. CSamp is the capacitor array used to
sample and hold the input voltage. VI is an internal voltage source used
to provide charge to Csamp during sample phase.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The following paragraphs provide a simplified description of the
interaction between the QADC and the user’s external circuitry. This
circuitry is assumed to be a simple RC low-pass filter passing a signal
from a source to the QADC input pin. These simplifying assumptions are
made:
•
The external capacitor is perfect (no leakage, no significant
dielectric absorption characteristics, etc.).
•
All parasitic capacitance associated with the input pin is included
in the value of the external capacitor.
•
Inductance is ignored.
•
The "on" resistance of the internal switches is 0 ohms and the "off"
resistance is infinite.
19.11.7.1 Settling Time for the External Circuit
The values for RSRC, RF, and CF in the user's external circuitry
determine the length of time required to charge CF to the source voltage
level (VSRC). At time t = 0, VSRC changes in Figure 19-53 while S1 is
open, disconnecting the internal circuitry from the external circuitry.
Assume that the initial voltage across CF is 0. As CF charges, the voltage
across it is determined by the equation, where t is the total charge time:
VCF = VSRC (1 –e–t/(RF + RSRC) CF)
As t approaches infinity, VCF will equal VSRC. (This assumes no internal
leakage.) With 10-bit resolution, 1/2 of a count is equal to 1/2048
full-scale value. Assuming worst case (VSRC = full scale), Table 19-14
shows the required time for CF to charge to within 1/2 of a count of the
actual source voltage during 10-bit conversions. Table 19-14 is based
on the RC network in Figure 19-53.
NOTE:
Advance Information
522
The following times are completely independent of the A/D converter
architecture (assuming the QADC is not affecting the charging).
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Pin Connection Considerations
Table 19-14. External Circuit Settling Time to 1/2 LSB
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Filter Capacitor (CF)
Source Resistance (RF + RSRC)
100 Ω
1 kΩ
10 kΩ
100 kΩ
1 µF
760 µs
7.6 ms
76 ms
760 ms
0.1 µF
76 µs
760 µs
7.6 ms
76 ms
0.01 µF
7.6 µs
76 µs
760 µs
7.6 ms
0.001 µF
760 ns
7.6 µs
76 µs
760 µs
100 pF
76 ns
760 ns
7.6 µs
76 µs
The external circuit described in Table 19-14 is a low-pass filter.
Measurements of an AC component of the external signal must take the
characteristics of this filter into account.
19.11.7.2 Error Resulting from Leakage
A series resistor limits the current to a pin therefore, input leakage acting
through a large source impedance can degrade A/D accuracy. The
maximum input leakage current is specified in Table 23-7. QADC
Electrical Specifications (Operating). Input leakage is greater at
higher operating temperatures. In the temperature range from 125°C to
50°C, the leakage current is halved for every 8°C to 12°C reduction in
temperature.
Assuming VRH–VRL = 5.12 V, 1 count (with 10-bit resolution)
corresponds to 5 mV of input voltage. A typical input leakage of 200 nA
acting through 10 kΩ of external series resistance results in an error of
0.4 count (2.0 mV). If the source impedance is 100 kΩ and a typical
leakage of 100 nA is present, an error of 2 counts (10 mV) is introduced.
In addition to internal junction leakage, external leakage (for example, if
external clamping diodes are used) and charge sharing effects with
internal capacitors also contribute to the total leakage current.
Table 19-15 illustrates the effect of different levels of total leakage on
accuracy for different values of source impedance. The error is listed in
terms of 10-bit counts.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
523
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
CAUTION:
Leakage below 200 nA is obtainable only within a limited temperature
range.
Table 19-15. Error Resulting from Input Leakage (IOff)
Leakage Value (10-Bit Conversions)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Source Impedance
100 nA
200 nA
500 nA
1000 nA
1 kΩ
—
—
0.1 counts
0.2 counts
10 kΩ
0.2 counts
0.4 counts
1 counts
2 counts
100 kΩ
2 counts
4 count
10 counts
20 counts
19.12 Interrupts
The four interrupt lines are outputs of the module and have no priority or
arbitration within the module.
19.12.1 Interrupt Operation
QADC inputs can be monitored by polling or by using interrupts. When
interrupts are not needed, the completion flag and the pause flag for
each queue can be monitored in the Status Register (QASR0). In other
words, flag bits can be polled to determine when new results are
available.
Table 19-16 shows the status flag and interrupt enable bits which
correspond to queue 1 and queue 2 activity.
Table 19-16. QADC Status Flags and Interrupt Sources
Queue
Queue Activity
Result written for last CCW in queue 1
Queue 1 Result written for a CCW with pause bit set in
queue 1
Result written for last CCW in queue 2
Queue 2 Result written for a CCW with pause bit set in
queue 2
Advance Information
524
Status
Flag
Interrupt
Enable Bit
CF1
CIE1
PF1
PIE1
CF2
CIE2
PF2
PIE2
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Interrupts
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
If interrupts are enabled for an event, the QADC requests interrupt
service when the event occurs. Using interrupts does not require
continuously polling the status flags to see if an event has taken place;
however, status flags must be cleared after an interrupt is serviced, in
order to remove the interrupt request
In both polled and interrupt-driven operating modes, status flags must be
re-enabled after an event occurs. Flags are re-enabled by clearing the
appropriate QASR0 bits in a particular sequence. QASR0 must first be
read, then 0s must be written to the flags that are to be cleared. If a new
event occurs between the time that the register is read and the time that
it is written, the associated flag is not cleared.
19.12.2 Interrupt Sources
The QADC includes four sources of interrupt requests, each of which is
separately enabled. Each time the result is written for the last conversion
command word (CCW) in a queue, the completion flag for the
corresponding queue is set, and when enabled, an interrupt is
requested. In the same way, each time the result is written for a CCW
with the pause bit set, the queue pause flag is set, and when enabled,
an interrupt is requested. Refer to Table 19-16.
The pause and complete interrupts for queue 1 and queue 2 have
separate interrupt vector levels, so that each source can be separately
serviced.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
525
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
Advance Information
526
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Queued Analog-to-Digital Converter (QADC)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 20. External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
20.1 Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
20.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 528
20.3 Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .529
20.3.1 Data Bus (D[31:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 530
20.3.2 Show Cycle Strobe (SHS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 530
20.3.3 Transfer Acknowledge (TA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 530
20.3.4 Transfer Error Acknowledge (TEA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .530
20.3.5 Emulation Mode Chip Selects (CSE[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 530
20.3.6 Transfer Code (TC[2:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.7 Read/Write (R/W) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.8 Address Bus (A[22:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.9 Enable Byte (EB[3:0]). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.10 Chip Selects (CS[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.11 Output Enable (OE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 531
20.3.12 Transfer Size (TSIZ[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532
20.3.13 Processor Status (PSTAT[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532
20.4
Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532
20.5
Operand Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 532
20.6
Enable Byte Pins (EB[3:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534
20.7 Bus Master Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 534
20.7.1 Read Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 535
20.7.1.1
State 1 (X1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536
20.7.1.2
Optional Wait States (X2W) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536
20.7.1.3
State 2 (X2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 536
20.7.2 Write Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 537
20.7.2.1
State 1 (X1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 538
20.7.2.2
Optional Wait States (X2W) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 538
20.7.2.3
State 2 (X2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 538
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
527
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
20.8 Bus Exception Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
20.8.1 Transfer Error Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
20.8.2 Transfer Abort Termination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
20.9 Emulation Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 540
20.9.1 Emulation Chip-Selects (CSE[1:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .540
20.9.2 Internal Data Transfer Display (Show Cycles) . . . . . . . . . . 541
20.9.3 Show Strobe (SHS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 542
20.9.4 Transfer Code (TC[2:0]) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543
20.9.5 Processor Status (PSTAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 543
20.10 Bus Monitor. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
20.11 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 545
20.2 Introduction
The external bus interface (EBI) module is responsible for controlling the
transfer of information between the internal M•CORE local bus and
external address space. The external bus has 23 address lines and 32
data lines.
In master mode and emulation mode, the EBI functions as a bus master
and allows internal bus cycles to access external resources. In
single-chip mode, the EBI is active, but the external data bus is not
available, and no external data or termination signals are transferred to
the internal bus.
The EBI supports data transfers to both 32-bit and 16-bit ports.
Chip-select channels are programmed to define the port size for specific
address ranges. When no chip-select is active during an external data
transfer, the port size is defaults to 32 bits.
The EBI supports a variable length external bus cycle to accommodate
the access speed of any device. During an external data transfer, the
EBI drives the address pins, byte enable pins, output enable pins, size
pins, and read/write pins. Wait states are inserted until the bus cycle is
terminated by the assertion of the internal transfer acknowledge signal
by a chip-select channel or by the assertion of the external TA or TEA
pins. The minimum external bus cycle is one clock.
Advance Information
528
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
Signal Descriptions
The EBI may drive the address, size, and read/write pins during internal
data transfers if show cycles is enabled, but the output enable and byte
enable pins are not asserted.
Only internal sources can terminate internal data transfers. Chip-select
channels, external TA assertion, and external TEA assertion cannot
terminate internal data transfers.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
20.3 Signal Descriptions
Table 20-1 provides an overview of the signal properties which are
discussed in this subsection.
Table 20-1. Signal Properties
Name
Port
Function
D[31:0]
PA, PB, PC, PD
SHS
PE7
Show cycle strobe
Active
TA
PE6
Transfer acknowledge
Active
TEA
PE5
Transfer error acknowledge
Active
CSE[1:0]
PE[4:3]
Emulation chip selects
Active
TC[2:0]
PE[2:0]
Transfer code
Active
R/W
PF7
Read/write
Active
A[22:0]
PF[6:0], PG, PH
Address bus
Active
EB[3:0]
PI[7:4]
Enable byte
Active
CS[3:0]
PI[3:0]
Chip selects
Active
OE
—
Output enable
—
TSIZ[1:0]
—
Transfer size
—
PSTAT[3:0]
—
Processor status
—
Data bus
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Pullup
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
—
Advance Information
529
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
20.3.1 Data Bus (D[31:0])
The three-state bidirectional data bus (D[31:0]) signals are the
general-purpose data path between the microcontroller unit (MCU) and
all other devices.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
20.3.2 Show Cycle Strobe (SHS)
In master and emulation modes, show cycle strobe (SHS) is the strobe
for capturing address, controls, and data during show cycles. In master
mode this default functionality can be overridden to make the pin
function as digital I/O. See 12.4.2.6 Port E Pin Assignment Register
and Table 12-3. Ports A–I Supported Pin Functions. In single-chip
mode, the SHS pin is configured as digital I/O (PE7) by default.
20.3.3 Transfer Acknowledge (TA)
The transfer acknowledge (TA) signal indicates that the external data
transfer is complete. During a read cycle, when the processor
recognizes TA, it latches the data and then terminates the bus cycle.
During a write cycle, when the processor recognizes TA, the bus cycle
is terminated. TA is an input in master and emulation modes. In
single-chip mode, the TA pin is configured as digital I/O (PE6) by default.
20.3.4 Transfer Error Acknowledge (TEA)
The transfer error acknowledge (TEA) indicates an error condition exists
for the bus transfer. The bus cycle is terminated and the CPU begins
execution of the access error exception. TEA is an input in master and
emulation modes. In single-chip mode the TEA pin is configured a digital
I/O (PE5) by default.
20.3.5 Emulation Mode Chip Selects (CSE[1:0])
The emulation mode chip select (CSE[1:0]) output signals provide
information for development support. In single-chip mode and master
mode, these pins are configured as digital I/O (PE4 and PE3) by default.
Advance Information
530
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
Signal Descriptions
20.3.6 Transfer Code (TC[2:0])
The transfer code (TC[2:0]) output signals indicate the data transfer
code for the current bus cycle. See 20.9.4 Transfer Code (TC[2:0]) for
codes. In single-chip mode and master mode, these pins are configured
as digital I/O (PE2, PE1, PE0) by default.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
20.3.7 Read/Write (R/W)
The read/write (R/W) output signal indicates the direction of the data
transfer on the bus. A logic 1 indicates a read from a slave device and a
logic 0 indicates a write to a slave device.
20.3.8 Address Bus (A[22:0])
The address bus (A[22:0]) output signals provide the address for the
current bus transfer.
20.3.9 Enable Byte (EB[3:0])
The enable byte (EB[3:0]) output signals indicate which byte of data is
valid during external cycles.
20.3.10 Chip Selects (CS[3:0])
The chip select (CS[3:0]) output signals select external devices for
external bus transactions.
20.3.11 Output Enable (OE)
The output enable (OE) signal indicates when an external device can
drive data during external read cycles.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
531
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
20.3.12 Transfer Size (TSIZ[1:0])
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
TSIZ[1:0] provides an indication of the M•CORE transfer size. See Table
20-2. This function is enabled by default in master mode and emulation
mode, and disabled by default in single-chip mode. Selection of this
function is through the Chip Configuration Register (see 4.7.3.1 Chip
Configuration Register). When this feature is disabled, these pins act
as pins INT7 and INT6 of the EPORT module.
20.3.13 Processor Status (PSTAT[3:0])
PSTAT[3:0] provides an indication of the M•CORE processor status.
See Table 20-6 for status indication codes. This function is enabled by
default in emulation mode, and disabled by default in master mode and
single-chip mode. Selection of this function is through the Chip
Configuration Register. When this feature is disabled, these pins act as
pins INT5, INT4, INT3, and INT2 of the EPORT module.
20.4 Memory Map and Registers
The EBI is not memory-mapped and has no software-accessible
registers.
20.5 Operand Transfer
The possible operand accesses for the internal M•CORE bus are:
•
Byte
•
Aligned upper half-word
•
Aligned lower half-word
•
Aligned word
No misaligned transfers are supported. The EBI controls the byte,
half-word, or word operand transfers between the M•CORE bus and a
16-bit or 32-bit port. “Port” refers to the width of the data path that an
external device uses during a data transfer. Each port is assigned to
Advance Information
532
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
Operand Transfer
particular bits of the data bus. A 16-bit port is assigned to pins D[31:16]
and a 32-bit port is assigned to pins D[31:0].
Table 20-2 shows each possible transfer size, alignment, and port width.
The data bytes shown in the table represent external data pins. This data
is multiplexed and driven to the external data bus as shown. The bytes
labeled with a dash are not required; the M•CORE will ignore them on
read transfers, and drive them with undefined data on write transfers.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 20-2. Data Transfer Cases
External Pins
Transfer Port
Size
Width TSIZ1 TSIZ0 A1 A0
16
0
16
0
1
16
1
16
0
1
0
0
—
—
D[23:16]
—
—
—
D[23:16]
—
—
—
—
D[31:24]
—
—
—
D[15:8]
—
—
—
—
D[23:16]
—
—
—
D[7:0]
D[31:24] D[23:16]
—
—
D[31:24] D[23:16]
—
—
0
—
—
D[31:24] D[23:16]
—
—
D[15:8]
D[7:0]
—
—
0
32
32
—
0
16
1
—
0
32
Word
D[31:24]
1
32
16(1)
—
0
32
1
—
1
16
Half-word
—
1
32
Byte
D[31:24]
0
32
0
Data Bus Transfer
0
0
1
0
0
0
D[31:24] D[23:16]
—
—
D[31:24] D[23:16]
D[31:24] D[23:16]
D[15:8]
D[7:0]
1. The EBI runs two cycles for word accesses to 16-bit ports. The table shows the data placement for both bus cycles.
In the case of a word (32-bit) access to a 16-bit port, the EBI runs two
external bus cycles to complete the transfer. During the first external bus
cycle, the A[1:0] pins are driven low, and the TSIZ[1:0] pins are driven to
indicate word size. During the second cycle, A1 is driven high to
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
533
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
increment the external address by two bytes, A0 is still driven low, and
the TSIZ[1:0] pins are driven to indicate half-word size.
During any word-size transfer, the EBI always drives the A[1:0] pins low
during a word transfer (except on the second cycle of a word to half-word
port transfer in which A1 is incremented).
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
20.6 Enable Byte Pins (EB[3:0])
The enable byte pins (EB[3:0]) are configurable as byte enables for read
and write cycles, or as write enables for write cycles only. The default
function is byte enable unless there is an active chip-select match with
the WE bit set. In all external cycles when one or more EB pins are
asserted, the encoding corresponds to the external data pins to be used
for the transfer as outlined in Table 20-3.
Table 20-3. EB[3:0] Assertion Encoding
EB Pin
External Data Pins
EB0
D[31:24]
EB1
D[23:16]
EB2
D[15:8]
EB3
D[7:0]
20.7 Bus Master Cycles
In this subsection, each EBI bus cycle type is defined in terms of actions
associated with a succession of internal states.
Read or write operations may require multiple bus cycles to complete
based on the operand size and target port size. Refer to 20.5 Operand
Transfer for more information. In the discussion that follows, it is
assumed that only a single bus cycle is required for a transfer.
In the waveform diagrams (Figure 20-3 through Figure 20-6), data
transfers are related to clock cycles, independent of the clock frequency.
The external bus states are also noted.
Advance Information
534
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
Bus Master Cycles
20.7.1 Read Cycles
During a read cycle, the EBI receives data from an external memory or
peripheral device. During external read cycles, the OE pin is asserted
regardless of operand size. See Figure 20-1. Also see Figure 20-3 and
Figure 20-4 for read cycle timing diagrams with and without wait states.
MMC2114, MMC2113, AND MMC2112
EXTERNAL PERIPHERAL
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
ADDRESS DEVICE
1. SET R/W TO READ.
2. DRIVE ADDRESS ON A[22:0].
3. DRIVE TSIZ[1:0] PINS FOR OPERAND SIZE.
4. ASSERT CS IF USED.
5. ASSERT OE AND EB IF USED.
PRESENT DATA
1. RECEIVE CS.
2. DECODE ADDRESS.
3. PUT DATA ON D[31:16] AND/OR D[15:0].
4. ASSERT TA IF NECESSARY FROM SLAVE DEVICE.
ACQUIRE DATA
1. RECEIVE DATA FROM D[31:16] AND/OR D[15:0].
2. DRIVE DATA TO INTERNAL DATA BUS.
3. NEGATE OE AND EB.
TERMINATE CYCLE
1. REMOVE DATA FROM D[31:16] AND/OR D[15:0].
2. NEGATE TA.
TERMINATE CYCLE
1. NEGATE EB AND CS IF USED.
START NEXT CYCLE
Figure 20-1. Read Cycle Flowchart
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
535
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
20.7.1.1 State 1 (X1)
The EBI drives the address bus. R/W is driven high to indicate a read
cycle. The TSIZ[1:0] pins are driven to indicate the number of bytes in
the transfer. TC[2:0] pins are driven to indicate the type of access. CS
may be asserted to drive a device.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Later in state 1, OE is asserted. If the EB pins are not configured as write
enables for this cycle, one or more EB pins are also asserted, depending
on the size and position of the data to be transferred.
If either the external TA pin or internal chip-select transfer acknowledge
signal is asserted before the end of state 1, the EBI proceeds to state 2.
20.7.1.2 Optional Wait States (X2W)
Wait states are inserted until the slave asserts the TA pin or the internal
chip-select transfer acknowledge signal is asserted. Wait states are
counted in full clocks.
20.7.1.3 State 2 (X2)
One-half clock later in state 2, the selected device puts its information on
D[31:16] and/or D[15:0]. One or both half-words of the external data bus
are driven to the internal data bus.
The address bus, R/W, CS, OE, EB, TC, and TSIZ pins remain valid
through state 2 to allow for static memory operation and signal skew.
The slave device asserts data until it detects the negation of OE, after
which it must remove its data within one-half state. Note that the data
bus may not become free until state 1.
Advance Information
536
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
Bus Master Cycles
20.7.2 Write Cycles
On a write cycle, the EBI transfers data to an external memory or
peripheral device. See Figure 20-2. Also see Figure 20-3 and
Figure 20-4 for write cycle timing diagrams with and without wait states.
MMC2114, MMC2113, AND MMC2112
EXTERNAL PERIPHERAL
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
ADDRESS DEVICE
1. DRIVE ADDRESS ON A[22:0].
2. DRIVE TSIZ[1:0] PINS FOR OPERAND SIZE.
3. ASSERT CS IF USED.
4. CLEAR R/W TO WRITE.
5. ASSERT EB (ONE OR MORE DEPENDING ON DATA SIZE AND POSITION.
6. DRIVE DATA ON D[31:16] AND/OR D[15:0].
ACCEPT DATA
1. RECEIVE CS.
2. DECODE ADDRESS.
3. RECEIVE DATA FROM D[31:16] AND/OR D[15:0].
4. ASSERT TA IF NECESSARY FROM SLAVE DEVICE.
TERMINATE OUTPUT TRANSFER
1. NEGATE EB.
TERMINATE CYCLE
1. NEGATE TA.
TERMINATE CYCLE
1. NEGATE CS IF USED.
2. REMOVE DATA FROM D[31:16] AND/OR D[15:0].
START NEXT CYCLE
Figure 20-2. Write Cycle Flowchart
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
537
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
20.7.2.1 State 1 (X1)
The EBI drives the address bus. The TSIZ[1:0] pins are driven to indicate
the number of bytes in the transfer. TC[2:0] pins are driven to indicate
the type of access. CS may be asserted to drive a device. OE is negated.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Later in state 1, R/W is driven low indicating a write cycle. One or more
EB pins are asserted, depending on the size and position of the data to
be transferred.
If either the external TA pin or internal chip-select transfer acknowledge
signal is asserted before the end of state 1, the EBI proceeds to state 2.
20.7.2.2 Optional Wait States (X2W)
Wait states are inserted until the slave asserts the TA pin or the internal
chip-select transfer acknowledge signal is asserted. The EBI drives its
data onto data bus lines D[31:16] and/or D[15:0] on the first optional wait
state. Wait states are counted in full clocks.
20.7.2.3 State 2 (X2)
If the data was not already driven during optional wait states, the EBI
drives its data onto D[31:16] and/or D[15:0] in state 2.
EB is negated by the end of state 2. The address bus, data bus, R/W,
CS, TC[2:0], and TSIZ[1:0] pins remain valid through state 2 to allow for
static memory operation and signal skew.
Figure 20-3 and Figure 20-4 illustrate external bus master cycles with
and without wait states and show M•CORE bus activity.
Advance Information
538
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
Bus Master Cycles
READ
CLKOUT
WRITE
X1
X2
X1
X2
R/W
A[22:0], TSIZ[1:0]
A1
D[31:0]
A2
D1
D2
CS
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
OE
EB[3:0]
EB[3:0] (EB SET
AS WRITE ENABLE)
TA, TEA
Figure 20-3. Master Mode — 1-Clock Read and Write Cycle
READ
CLKOUT
X1
X2
X2W
WRITE
X2
X1
X2
X2W
X2
R/W
A[22:0], TSIZ[1:0]
A1
D[31:0]
A2
D1
D2
CS
OE
EB[3:0]
EB[3:0] (EB SET
AS WRITE ENABLE)
TA, TEA
Figure 20-4. Master Mode — 2-Clock Read and Write Cycle
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
539
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
20.8 Bus Exception Operation
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
20.8.1 Transfer Error Termination
Normal bus cycle termination requires the assertion of the TA pin or the
internal transfer acknowledge signal. Minimal bus exception support is
provided by transfer error cycle termination. For transfer error cycle
termination, the external TEA pin or the internal transfer error
acknowledge signal is asserted. Transfer error cycle termination takes
precedence over normal cycle termination, provided TEA assertion
meets its timing constraints.
The internal bus monitor will assert the internal transfer error
acknowledge signal when TA response time is too long, based upon the
BMT[1:0] settings in the Chip Configuration Registers (CCR). See
4.7.3.1 Chip Configuration Register.
20.8.2 Transfer Abort Termination
External bus cycles which are aborted by the M•CORE, still have the
address, R/W, TC[2:0], TSIZ[1:0], CS (if used), OE (reads only), and
SHS (if used) driven to the external pins.
20.9 Emulation Support
20.9.1 Emulation Chip-Selects (CSE[1:0])
While in emulation mode or master mode, special emulator chip-selects
(CSE[1:0]) are driven externally to allow internal/external accesses to be
tracked by external hardware See Table 20-4.
In emulation mode, all port registers are mapped externally.
CSE[1:0] = 10 whenever any emulated port registers are addressed.
The lower bits of the address bus indicate the register accessed within
the block.
Advance Information
540
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
Emulation Support
Accesses to the address space which contains the registers for the
internal modules (except ports) are indicated by CSE[1:0] = 11.
Internal accesses, other than to the specific module control registers, are
indicated by CSE[1:0] = 01. It should be noted that at higher frequencies
writes to external memories emulating the internal memories may
require one clock for read accesses and two clocks for write accesses.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 20-4. Emulation Mode Chip-Select Summary(1)
CSE1
CSE0
Indication in Emulation Mode
1
1
Internal access to any register space (excluding ports)
Reset state
(0x00c1_0000:0x00ff_ffff)
1
0
Internal access to ports register space
(0x00c0_0000:0x00c0_ffff)
0
1
Internal access not covered by CSE encoding = 11, 10
(0x0000_0000:0x00bf_ffff; 0x0100_0000:0x07ff_ffff)
0
0
External access
(0x8000_0000 to 0xffff_ffff)
1. CSE[1:0] is valid only for the duration of valid bus cycles or reset. Undefined otherwise.
20.9.2 Internal Data Transfer Display (Show Cycles)
Internal data transfers normally occur without showing the internal data
bus activity on the external data bus. For debugging purposes, however,
it may be desirable to have internal cycle data appear on the external
bus. These external bus cycles are referred to as show cycles and are
distinguished from normal external cycles by the fact that OE and
EB[3:0] remain negated.
Regardless of whether show cycles are enabled, the EBI drives the
address bus, TC[2:0], TSIZ[1:0] and R/W signals, indicating the internal
cycle activity. When show cycles are disabled, D[31:0] remains in a high
impedance state. When show cycles are enabled, OE and EB[3:0]
remain negated while the internal data is presented on D[31:0] on the
first clock tick after the termination of the internal cycle.
Show cycles are always enabled in emulation mode. In master mode,
show cycles are disabled coming out of reset and must be enabled by
writing to the SHEN bit in the Chip Configuration Register (CCR).
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
541
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
NOTE:
The PEPA and PCDPA bits in the ports must also be set to 1 to obtain
full visibility. The waveforms shown in Figure 20-5 describe show
cycles.
20.9.3 Show Strobe (SHS)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The show strobe (SHS) pin provides an indication to an external device
(emulator or logic analyzer) when to latch address, TC[2:0], TSIZ[1:0],
R/W, CSE, PSTAT, and data from the external pins. In master and
emulation modes, show cycle strobe (SHS) is enabled coming out of
reset. In master mode this default functionality can be overridden to
make the pin function as digital I/O.
For any external cycle or show cycle, the SHS pin is driven low to
indicate valid address, TC, TSIZ, R/W, CSE, and PSTAT are present at
the pins, and driven back high to indicate valid data. The SHS pin is
driven low and back high only once per external bus cycle. See
Figure 20-5 and Figure 20-6.
INTERNAL CYCLE
EXTERNAL READ
CLKOUT
X1
X2
R/W
A{22:0], TSIZ[1:0]
D[31:0]
A1
A2
SHOW
D1
DATA
D2
SHS
CSE[1:0]
00
CS
OE
EB[3:0]
TA, TEA
Figure 20-5. Internal (Show) Cycle Followed by External 1-Clock Read
Advance Information
542
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
Emulation Support
INTERNAL CYCLE
EXTERNAL WRITE
CLKOUT
R/W
A1
A{22:0], TSIZ[1:0]
A2
SHOW
D[31:0]
D1
DATA
D2
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SHS
00
CSE[1:0]
CS
OE
EB[3:0]
TA, TEA
Figure 20-6. Internal (Show) Cycle Followed by External 1-Clock Write
20.9.4 Transfer Code (TC[2:0])
These signals are outputs from a master and inputs to a slave device.
They are enabled by default in emulation mode and can be enabled in
other modes by setting PEPA[2:0] of Port E Pin Assignment Register
(PEPAR). See 12.4.2.6 Port E Pin Assignment Register. These
signals identify the processor state (supervisor or user) and the address
space of the current bus cycle. The space and state are defined in
Table 20-5.
20.9.5 Processor Status (PSTAT)
These signals are outputs from the CPU and may be applied to external
pins (INT[5:2]). They are enabled by default in emulation mode and can
be enabled in other modes by setting PSTEN of CCR. See 4.7.3.1 Chip
Configuration Register. The PSTAT pins indicate the internal state and
events occurring within the core, and may be monitored by a debug
block to condition events, and/or may be reflected off-chip as well.
Table 20-6 shows the definitions of the processor status encoding.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
543
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 20-5. Transfer Code Definitions
TC[2]
TC[1]
TC[0]
Transfer Type
0
0
0
User data access(1)
0
0
1
Reserved
0
1
0
User instruction access(2)
0
1
1
User change of flow instruction access(3)
1
0
0
Supervisor data access(1)
1
0
1
Supervisor exception vector access
1
1
0
Supervisor instruction access(2)
1
1
1
Supervisor change of flow instruction access(3)
1. Except lrw accesses.
2. Except change of flow related instruction accesses, includes lrw accesses.
3. Change of flow related instruction access for taken branches, jumps, and loopt instructions
(includes table accesses for jmpi, jsri).
Table 20-6. Processor Status Encoding
PST[3]
PST[2]
PST[1]
PST[0]
Internal Processor State
0
0
0
0
Execution stalled
0
0
0
1
Execution stalled
0
0
1
0
Execute exception
0
0
1
1
Reserved
0
1
0
0
Processor in STOP, WAIT, or DOZE state
0
1
0
1
Execution stalled
0
1
1
0
Processor in debug mode
0
1
1
1
Reserved
1
0
0
0
Launch instruction(1)
1
0
0
1
Launch ldm, stm, ldq, or stq
1
0
1
0
Launch hardware accelerator instruction
1
0
1
1
Launch lrw
1
1
0
0
Launch change of program flow instruction
1
1
0
1
Launch rte or rfi
1
1
1
0
Reserved
1
1
1
1
Launch jmpi or jsri
1. Except ldm, stm, ldq, stq, hardware accelerator, lrw, change of flow, rte, or rfi instructions.
Advance Information
544
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
Bus Monitor
20.10 Bus Monitor
The bus monitor can be set to detect excessively long bus access
termination response times. Whenever an undecoded address is
accessed or a peripheral is inoperative, the access is not terminated and
the bus is potentially locked up while it waits for the required response.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The bus monitor monitors the cycle termination response time during a
bus cycle. If the cycle termination response time exceeds a programmed
count, the bus monitor asserts an internal bus error.
The bus monitor monitors the cycle termination response time (in system
clock cycles) by using a programmable maximum allowable response
period. There are four selectable response time periods for the bus
monitor, selectable among 8, 16, 32, and 64 system clock cycles. The
periods are selectable with the BMT[1:0] field in the chip configuration
module CCR (see 4.7.3.1 Chip Configuration Register). The
programmability of the timeout allows for varying external peripheral
response times. The monitor is cleared and restarted on all bus
accesses. If the cycle is not terminated within the selected response
time, a timeout occurs and the bus monitor terminates the bus cycle.
The bus monitor can be configured with the BME bit in the chip
configuration module CCR to monitor only internal bus accesses or both
internal and external bus accesses. Also, the bus monitor can be
disabled during debug mode for both internal and external accesses.
Two external bus cycles are required for a single 32-bit access to a 16-bit
port. If the bus monitor is enabled to monitor external accesses, then the
bus monitor views the 32-bit access as two separate external bus cycles
and not as one internal bus cycle.
20.11 Interrupts
The EBI does not generate interrupt requests.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
545
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
Advance Information
546
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
External Bus Interface Module (EBI)
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 21. Chip Select Module
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
21.1 Contents
21.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 547
21.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 548
21.4
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 549
21.5
Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
21.6 Memory Map and Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
21.6.1 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 550
21.6.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 551
21.7
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 556
21.8
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 557
21.2 Introduction
The chip select module provides chip enable signals for external
memory and peripheral devices. The chip selects can also be
programmed to terminate bus cycles. Up to four asynchronous chip
select signals are available.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
547
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Select Module
21.3 Features
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Features of the chip select module include:
Advance Information
548
•
Reduced system complexity — No external glue logic required for
typical systems if chip selects are used.
•
Four programmable asynchronous active-low chip selects
(CS[3:0]) — Chip selects can be independently programmed with
various features.
•
Control for external boot device — CS0 can be enabled at reset to
select an external boot device.
•
Fixed base addresses with 8-Mbyte block sizes
•
Support for emulating internal memory space — When the EMINT
bit is set in the Chip Configuration Register (CCR), CS1 matches
only addresses in the internal memory space.
•
Support for 16-bit and 32-bit external devices — The external port
size can be programmed to be 16 or 32 bits.
•
Programmable write protection — Each chip select address range
can be designated for read access only.
•
Programmable access protection — Each chip select address
range can be designated for supervisor access only.
•
Write-enable selection — The enable byte pins (EB[3:0]) can be
configured as byte enables (assert on both external read and write
accesses) or write enables (only assert on external write
accesses).
•
Bus cycle termination — This option allows the chip select logic to
terminate the bus cycle.
•
Programmable wait states — To interface with various devices, up
to seven wait states can be programmed before the access is
terminated.
•
Programmable extra wait state for write accesses — One wait
state can be added to write accesses to allow writing to memories
that require additional data setup time.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Select Module
Block Diagram
21.4 Block Diagram
Figure 21-1 shows a programmable asynchronous chip select. All
asynchronous chip selects have the same structure. All signals used to
generate chip select signals are taken from the internal bus. Each chip
select has a chip select control register to individually program the chip
select characteristics.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
All the chip selects share the same cycle termination generator. The
active chip select for a particular bus cycle determines the number of
wait states produced by the cycle termination generator before the cycle
is terminated.
ADDRESS
M•CORE LOCAL BUS
ADDRESS COMPARE
MATCH
DATA
CHIP SELECT
CONTROL REGISTERS
PAD
CONTROL
ACCESS
ATTRIBUTES
CSx
MATCH
OPTION COMPARE
TO CYCLE TERMINATION GENERATOR
Figure 21-1. Chip Select Block Diagram
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
549
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Select Module
21.5 Signals
Table 21-1 provides an overview of the signals described here.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 21-1. Signal Properties
Name
Function
Reset State
Pullup
CS0
Chip select 0 pin
1
Active
CS1
Chip select 1 pin
1
Active
CS2
Chip select 2 pin
1
Active
CS3
Chip select 3 pin
1
Active
CS[3:0] are chip-select outputs. CS[3:0] are available for
general-purpose input/output (I/O) when not configured for chip select
operation.
21.6 Memory Map and Registers
Table 21-2 shows the chip select memory map. The registers are
described in 21.6.2 Registers.
21.6.1 Memory Map
Table 21-2. Chip Select Memory Map
Address
Bits 31–16
Bits 15–0
Access(1), (2)
0x00c2_0000
CSCR0 — Chip Select
Control Register 0
CSCR1 — Chip Select
Control Register 1
S
0x00c2_0004
CSCR2 — Chip Select
Control Register 2
CSCR3 — Chip Select
Control Register 3
S
1. User mode accesses to supervisor-only address locations have no effect and result in a cycle termination transfer error.
2. S = CPU supervisor mode access only.
Advance Information
550
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Select Module
Memory Map and Registers
21.6.2 Registers
The chip programming model consists of four Chip Select Control
Registers (CSCR0–CSCR3), one for each chip select (CS[3:0]).
CSCR0–CSCR3 are read/write always and define the conditions for
asserting the chip select signals.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
All the chip select control registers are the same except for the reset
states of the CSEN and PS bits in CSCR0 and the CSEN bit in CSCR1.
This allows CS0 to be enabled at reset with either a 16-bit or 32-bit port
size for selecting an external boot device and allows CS1 to be used to
emulate internal memory.
Address: 0x00c2_0000 and 0x00c2_0001
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SO
RO
PS
WWS
WE
WS2
WS1
WS0
0
0
See note
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TAEN
CSEN
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
See note
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Note: Reset state determined during reset configuration.
Figure 21-2. Chip Select Control Register 0 (CSCR0)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
551
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Select Module
Address: 0x00c2_0002 and 0x00c2_0003
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SO
RO
PS
WWS
WE
WS2
WS1
WS0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TAEN
CSEN
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
See note
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Note: Reset state determined during reset configuration.
Figure 21-3. Chip Select Control Register 1 (CSCR1)
Address: 0x00c2_0004 and 0x00c2_0005
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SO
RO
PS
WWS
WE
WS2
WS1
WS0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TAEN
CSEN
1
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 21-4. Chip Select Control Register 2 (CSCR2)
Advance Information
552
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Select Module
Memory Map and Registers
Address: 0x00c2_00006 and 0x00c2_0007
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
SO
RO
PS
WWS
WE
WS2
WS1
WS0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TAEN
CSEN
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
= Writes have no effect and the access terminates without a transfer error exception.
Figure 21-5. Chip Select Control Register 3 (CSCR3)
SO — Supervisor-Only Bit
The SO bit restricts user mode access to the address range defined
by the corresponding chip select. If the SO bit is 1, only supervisor
mode access is permitted. If the SO bit is 0, both supervisor and user
level accesses are permitted.
When an access is made to a memory space assigned to the chip
select, the chip select logic compares the SO bit with bit 2 of the
internal transfer code, which indicates whether the access is at the
supervisor or user level. If the chip select logic detects a protection
violation, the access is ignored.
1 = Only supervisor mode accesses allowed; user mode accesses
ignored by chip select logic
0 = Supervisor and user mode accesses allowed
RO — Read-Only Bit
The RO bit restricts write accesses to the address range defined by
the corresponding chip select. If the RO bit is 1, only read access is
permitted. If the RO bit is 0, both read and write accesses are
permitted.
When an access is made to a memory space assigned to the chip
select, the chip select logic compares the RO bit with the internal
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
553
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Select Module
read/write signal, which indicates whether the access is a read
(read/write = 1) or a write (read/write = 0). If the chip select logic
detects a violation (RO = 1 with read/write = 0), the access is ignored.
1 = Only read accesses allowed; write accesses ignored by the
chip select logic
0 = Read and write accesses allowed
PS — Port Size Bit
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The PS bit defines the width of the external data port supported by the
chip select as either 16-bit or 32-bit. When a chip select is
programmed as a 16-bit port, the external device must be connected
to D[31:16]. For 32-bit accesses to 16-bit ports, the external memory
interface initiates two bus cycles and multiplexes data as needed to
complete the data transfer.
1 = 32 bit port
0 = 16 bit port
WWS — Write Wait State Bit
The WWS bit determines if an additional wait state is required for write
cycles. WWS does not affect read cycles.
1 = One additional wait state added for write cycles
0 = No additional wait state added for write cycles
WE — Write Enable Bit
The WE bit defines when the enable byte output pins (EB[3:0]) are
asserted. When WE is 0, EB[3:0] are configured as byte enables and
assert for both external read and external write accesses. When WE
is 1, EB[3:0] are configured as write enables and assert only for
external write accesses.
1 = EB[3:0] configured as write enables
0 = EB[3:0] configured as byte enables
NOTE:
Advance Information
554
The WE bit has no effect on the EB[3:0] pin function if the chip select is
not active. If the chip select is not active, the EB[3:0] pin function is byte
enable by default.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Select Module
Memory Map and Registers
WS[2:0] — Wait States Field
The WS field determines the number of wait states for the chip select
logic to insert before asserting the internal cycle termination signal.
One wait state is equal to one system clock cycle. If WS is configured
for zero wait states, then the internal cycle termination signal is
asserted in the clock cycle following the start of the cycle access,
resulting in one-clock transfers. A WS configured for one wait state
means that the internal cycle termination signal is asserted two clock
cycles after the start of the cycle access.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Since the internal cycle termination signal is asserted internally after
the programmed number of wait states, software can adjust the bus
timing to accommodate the access speed of the external device. With
up to seven possible wait states, even slow devices can be interfaced
with the MCU.
Table 21-3. Chip Select Wait States Encoding
Number of Wait States
WS[2:0]
WWS = 0
WWS = 1
Read Access
Write Access
Read Access
Write Access
000
0
0
0
1
001
1
1
1
2
010
2
2
2
3
011
3
3
3
4
100
4
4
4
5
101
5
5
5
6
110
6
6
6
7
111
7
7
7
8
TAEN — Transfer Acknowledge Enable Bit
The TAEN bit determines whether the internal cycle termination
signal is asserted by the chip select logic when accesses occur to the
address range defined by the corresponding chip select. When TAEN
is 0, an external device is responsible for asserting the external TA pin
to terminate the bus access. When TAEN is 1, the chip select logic
asserts the internal cycle termination signal after a time determined
by the programmed number of wait states. When TAEN is 1, external
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
555
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Select Module
logic can still terminate the access before the internal cycle
termination signal is asserted by asserting the external TA pin.
1 = Internal cycle termination signal asserted by chip select logic
0 = Internal cycle termination signal asserted by external logic
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
CSEN — Chip Select Enable Bit
The CSEN bit enables the chip select logic. When the chip select
function is disabled, the CSx signal is negated high.
1 = Chip select function enabled
0 = Chip select function disabled
21.7 Functional Description
Each chip select can provide a chip enable signal for an external device
and assert the internal bus cycle termination signal.
Setting the CSEN bit in CSCR enables the chip select to provide an
external chip enable signal.
Setting both the CSEN and TAEN bits in CSCR enables the chip select
to generate the internal bus cycle termination signal.
Both the chip select pin assertion and the bus cycle termination function
depend on an initial address/option match for activation. During the
matching process, the fixed base address of each chip select is
compared to the corresponding address for the bus cycle to determine
whether an address match has occurred. This match is further qualified
by comparing the internal read/write indication and access type with the
programmed values in CSCR of each chip select. When the address and
option information match the current cycle, the chip select is activated. If
no chip select matches the bus cycle information for the current access,
the chip select logic does not respond in any way.
Only one chip select can be active for a given bus cycle. The
configuration of the active chip select, determined by the wait state
(WS/WWS) field, the port size (PS) field, and the write enable (WE) field,
is used for the access.
NOTE:
Advance Information
556
WWS and WS are valid only if the TAEN bit is 1 for the active chip select.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Chip Select Module
Interrupts
When no chip select pin is available, the active chip select can still
terminate the bus cycle. If both the CSEN and TAEN bits are 1 and the
address/options match the chip select configuration, then the chip select
logic asserts the internal termination signal; the bus cycle terminates
after the programmed number of wait states. If the external TA or TEA
pin is asserted before the chip select logic asserts the internal cycle
termination signal, then the bus cycle is terminated early.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
If internal address bit 31 is 0, then the access is internal. If internal
address bit 31 is 1, then the access is external.
NOTE:
Chip select logic does not decode internal address bits A[30:25].
Table 21-4. Chip Select Address Range Encoding
Chip Select Block Size
Address Range
Address Bits Compared
(A[31:23])(1)
CS0
8 MB
0x8000_0000–0x807f_ffff
1xxx_xxx0_0
CS1
8 MB
0x8080_0000–0x80ff_ffff
1xxx_xxx0_1(2)
CS2
8 MB
0x8100_0000–0x817f_ffff
1xxx_xxx1_0
CS3
8 MB
0x8180_0000–0x81ff_ffff
1xxx_xxx1_1
1. The chip selects do not decode A[30:25]. Thus, the total 32-Mbyte block size is repeated/mirrored in external memory space.
2. If the EMINT bit in the chip configuration module CCR is set, then CS1 matches only internal accesses to the 8-MB block starting at address 0 to support emulation of internal memory. Thus, A[31:23] match 0xxx_xxx0_0.
21.8 Interrupts
The chip select module does not generate interrupt requests.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
557
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Chip Select Module
Advance Information
558
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Chip Select Module
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 22. JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.1 Contents
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 561
22.3 Top-Level Test Access Port (TAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 563
22.3.1 Test Clock (TCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.3.2 Test Mode Select (TMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.3.3 Test Data Input (TDI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.3.4 Test Data Output (TDO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.3.5 Test Reset (TRST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.3.6 Debug Event (DE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 564
22.4 Top-Level TAP Controller . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .566
22.5 Instruction Shift Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567
22.5.1 EXTEST Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 567
22.5.2 IDCODE Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 568
22.5.3 SAMPLE/PRELOAD Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 569
22.5.4 ENABLE_MCU_ONCE Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .569
22.5.5 HIGHZ Instruction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570
22.5.6 CLAMP Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570
22.5.7 BYPASS Instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 570
22.6 IDCODE Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 571
22.7 Bypass Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572
22.8 Boundary Scan Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572
22.9 Restrictions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 572
22.10 Non-Scan Chain Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573
22.11 Boundary Scan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 573
22.12 Low-Level TAP (OnCE) Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .579
22.13 Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .581
22.13.1 Debug Serial Input (TDI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 581
22.13.2 Debug Serial Clock (TCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 581
22.13.3 Debug Serial Output (TDO) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 581
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
559
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.13.4 Debug Mode Select (TMS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 582
22.13.5 Test Reset (TRST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 582
22.13.6 Debug Event (DE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 582
22.14 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 582
22.14.1 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 583
22.14.2 OnCE Controller and Serial Interface. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 584
22.14.3 OnCE Interface Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 585
22.14.3.1 Internal Debug Request Input (IDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 585
22.14.3.2 CPU Debug Request (DBGRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .586
22.14.3.3 CPU Debug Acknowledge (DBGACK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .586
22.14.3.4 CPU Breakpoint Request (BRKRQ). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 586
22.14.3.5 CPU Address, Attributes (ADDR, ATTR) . . . . . . . . . . . . 587
22.14.3.6 CPU Status (PSTAT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587
22.14.3.7 OnCE Debug Output (DEBUG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587
22.14.4 OnCE Controller Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 587
22.14.4.1 OnCE Command Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .588
22.14.4.2 OnCE Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 590
22.14.4.3 OnCE Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 594
22.14.5 OnCE Decoder (ODEC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 596
22.14.6 Memory Breakpoint Logic. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 596
22.14.6.1 Memory Address Latch (MAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597
22.14.6.2 Breakpoint Address Base Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597
22.14.7 Breakpoint Address Mask Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 597
22.14.7.1 Breakpoint Address Comparators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 598
22.14.7.2 Memory Breakpoint Counters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 598
22.14.8 OnCE Trace Logic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 598
22.14.8.1 OnCE Trace Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 599
22.14.8.2 Trace Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600
22.14.9 Methods of Entering Debug Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 600
22.14.9.1 Debug Request During RESET . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .600
22.14.9.2 Debug Request During Normal Activity . . . . . . . . . . . . . 601
22.14.9.3 Debug Request During Stop, Doze, or Wait Mode . . . .601
22.14.9.4 Software Request During Normal Activity . . . . . . . . . . . 601
22.14.10 Enabling OnCE Trace Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .601
22.14.11 Enabling OnCE Memory Breakpoints. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 602
22.14.12 Pipeline Information and Write-Back Bus Register . . . . . . 602
22.14.12.1 Program Counter Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .603
22.14.12.2 Instruction Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 603
Advance Information
560
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Introduction
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.14.12.3 Control State Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 603
22.14.12.4 Writeback Bus Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 605
22.14.12.5 Processor Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .605
22.14.13 Instruction Address FIFO Buffer (PC FIFO) . . . . . . . . . . . . 606
22.14.14 Reserved Test Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 607
22.14.15 Serial Protocol . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 607
22.14.16 OnCE Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 608
22.14.17 Target Site Debug System Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . 608
22.14.18 Interface Connector for JTAG/OnCE Serial Port . . . . . . . . 608
22.2 Introduction
The MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112 have two JTAG (Joint Test
Action Group) TAP (test access port) controllers:
1. A top-level controller that allows access to the Boundary Scan
(external pins) Register, IDCODE Register, and Bypass Register
2. A low-level OnCE (on-chip emulation) controller that allows
access to the central processor unit (CPU) and debugger-related
registers
At power-up, only the top-level TAP controller will be visible. If desired,
a user can then enable the low-level OnCE controller which will in turn
disable the top-level TAP controller. The top-level TAP controller will
remain disabled until either power is removed and reapplied or until the
test reset signal, TRST, is asserted (logic 0).
The OnCE TAP controller can be enabled in either of two ways:
1. With the top-level TAP controller in its test-logic-reset state:
a. Deassert TRST, test reset (logic1)
b. Assert DE, the debug event (logic 0) for two TCLK, test clock,
cycles
2. Shift the ENABLE_MCU_ONCE instruction, 0x3, into the top-level
TAP controller’s Instruction Register (IR) and pass through the
TAP controller state update-IR.
Refer to Figure 22-1.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
561
562
Advance Information
TDI
0
LSB
MSB
3
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
B
TDO
TDO
MUX
A
SELECT
0
LSB
BYPASS
0
LSB
MSB
31
LOW-LEVEL TDO
MUX
MSB
199 IDCODE
(SHIFT)
REGISTER
1 BIT
MUX
OnCE CMD
INSTRUCTION
REGISTER
SELECT
OnCE
TAP
CONTROLLER
LOW-LEVEL
TAP (OnCE)
MODULE
Figure 22-1. Top-Level Tap Module and Low-Level (OnCE) TAP Module
SELECT
TOP-LEVEL TDO
MUX
BOUNDARY
SCAN
(SHIFT)
REGISTER
IF YES, THEN B,
SELECT LOW-LEVEL
(OnCE) TDO;
IF NO, THAN A,
SELECT
TOP-LEVEL TDO
TAP
INSTRUCTION
REGISTER
IR[3:0] = 0 x 3?
ENABLE_MCU_ONCE
CMD
TAP
CONTROLLER
TOP-LEVEL
TAP
MODULE
DE TCLK TMS TRST
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
OnCE
DATA
REGISTERS
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Top-Level Test Access Port (TAP)
22.3 Top-Level Test Access Port (TAP)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
These devices provide a dedicated user-accessible test access port
(TAP) that is fully compatible with the IEEE 1149.1 Standard Test
Access Port and Boundary-Scan Architecture. Problems associated with
testing high-density circuit boards have led to development of this
proposed standard under the sponsorship of the Test Technology
Committee of IEEE and the Joint Test Action Group (JTAG). The
implementation supports circuit-board test strategies based on this
standard.
The top-level TAP consists of five dedicated signal pins, a 16-state TAP
controller, an instruction register, and three data registers, a boundary
scan register for monitoring and controlling the device’s external pins, a
device identification register, and a 1-bit bypass (do nothing) register.
The top-level TAP provides the ability to:
1. Perform boundary scan (external pin) drive and monitor
operations to test circuitry external to these devices
2. Disable the output pins
3. Read the IDCODE Device Identification Register
CAUTION:
Certain precautions must be observed to ensure that the top-level
TAP module does not interfere with non-test operation. See
22.10 Non-Scan Chain Operation for details.
The top-level TAP module includes a TAP controller, a 4-bit instruction
register, and three test data registers (a 1-bit bypass register, a 200-bit
boundary scan register, and a 32-bit IDCODE register). The top-level tap
controller and the low-level (OnCE) TAP controller share the external
signals described here.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
563
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.3.1 Test Clock (TCLK)
TCLK is a test clock input to synchronize the test logic. TCLK is
independent of the processor clock. It includes an internal pullup
resistor.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.3.2 Test Mode Select (TMS)
TMS is a test mode select input (with an internal pullup resistor) that is
sampled on the rising edge of TCLK to sequence the TAP controller’s
state machine.
22.3.3 Test Data Input (TDI)
TDI is a serial test data input (with an internal pullup resistor) that is
sampled on the rising edge of TCLK.
22.3.4 Test Data Output (TDO)
TDO is a three-state test data output that is actively driven in the shift-IR
and shift-DR controller states. TDO changes on the falling edge of
TCLK.
22.3.5 Test Reset (TRST)
TRST is an active low asynchronous reset with an internal pullup resistor
that forces the TAP controller into the test-logic-reset state.
22.3.6 Debug Event (DE)
This is a bidirectional, active-low signal.
As an output, this signal will be asserted for three system clocks,
synchronous to the rising CLKOUT edge, to acknowledge that the CPU
has entered debug mode as a result of a debug request or a breakpoint
condition.
Advance Information
564
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Top-Level Test Access Port (TAP)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
As an input, this signal provides multiple functions such as:
NOTE:
•
The main function is a means of entering debug mode from an
external command controller. This signal, when asserted, causes
the CPU to finish the current instruction being executed, save the
instruction pipeline information, enter debug mode, and wait for
commands to be entered from the serial debug input line. This
input must be asserted for at least three system clocks, sampled
with the rising CLKOUT edge. This function is ignored during
reset. While the processor is in debug mode, this signal is still
sampled but has no effect until debug mode is exited.
•
Another input function is to enable OnCE. This is an alternate
method to the ENABLE_MCU_ONCE JTAG command to enable
the OnCE logic to be accessible via the JTAG interface. This input
signal must be asserted low (while in the test-logic-reset state with
POR/TRST not asserted) for at least two TCLK rising edges. Once
enabled, the OnCE will remain enabled until the next POR or
TRST resets.
•
Another input function is as a wake-up event from a low-power
mode of operation. Asynchronously asserting this signal will cause
the clock controller to restart. This signal must be held asserted
until the M•CORE receives three valid rising edges on the system
clock. Then the processor will exit the low-power mode and go into
debug mode.
If used to enter debug mode, DE must be negated before the processor
exits debug mode to prevent a still low signal from being unintentionally
recognized as another debug request. Also, asserting this signal to enter
debug mode may prevent external logic from seeing the processor
output acknowledgment since the external pullup may not be able to pull
the signal negated before the handshake is asserted. Finally, if using this
signal to enable OnCE outside of reset it may be seen as a request to
enter debug mode.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
565
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.4 Top-Level TAP Controller
The top-level TAP controller is responsible for interpreting the sequence
of logical values on the TMS signal. It is a synchronous state machine
that controls the operation of the JTAG logic. The machine’s states are
shown in Figure 22-2. The value shown adjacent to each arc represents
the value of the TMS signal sampled on the rising edge of the TCLK
signal.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The top-level TAP controller can be asynchronously reset to the testlogic-reset state by asserting TRST, test reset. As Figure 22-2 shows,
holding TMS high (to logic 1) while clocking TCLK through at least five
rising edges will also cause the state machine to enter its test-logic-reset
state.
TEST-LOGICRESET
1
0
RUN-TEST/IDLE
1
SELECT-DR_SCAN
0
1
SELECT-IR_SCAN
0
0
1
1
CAPTURE-DR
CAPTURE-IR
0
0
SHIFT-DR
1
SHIFT-IR
0
1
1
EXIT1-DR
PAUSE-IR
0
EXIT2-DR
1
0
UPDATE-DR
0
0
EXIT2-IR
1
1
1
1
0
PAUSE-DR
1
0
EXIT1-IR
0
0
1
UPDATE-IR
1
0
Figure 22-2. Top-Level TAP Controller State Machine
Advance Information
566
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Instruction Shift Register
22.5 Instruction Shift Register
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The top-level TAP module uses a 4-bit Instruction Shift Register with no
parity. This register transfers its value to a parallel hold register and
applies an instruction on the falling edge of TCLK when the TAP state
machine is in the update-IR state. To load the instructions into the shift
portion of the register, place the serial data on the TDI pin prior to each
rising edge of TCLK. The MSB of the instruction shift register is the bit
closest to the TDI pin and the LSB is the bit closest to the TDO pin.
Table 22-1 lists the instructions supported along with their opcodes,
IR3–IR0. The last three instructions in the table are reserved for
manufacturing purposes only.
Unused opcodes are currently decoded to perform the BYPASS
operation, but Motorola reserves the right to change their decodings in
the future.
22.5.1 EXTEST Instruction
The external test instruction (EXTEST) selects the Boundary Scan
Register. The EXTEST instruction forces all output pins and bidirectional
pins configured as outputs to the preloaded fixed values (with the
SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction) and held in the boundary-scan update
registers. The EXTEST instruction can also configure the direction of
bidirectional pins and establish high-impedance states on some pins.
EXTEST also asserts internal reset for the system logic to force a
predictable internal state while performing external boundary scan
operations.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
567
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Table 22-1. JTAG Instructions
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Instruction
IR3–IR0
Instruction Summary
EXTEST
0000
Selects the Boundary Scan Register while
applying fixed values to output pins and
asserting functional reset
IDCODE
0001
Selects the IDCODE Register for shift
SAMPLE/PRELOAD
0010
Selects the Boundary Scan Register for
shifting, sampling, and preloading without
disturbing functional operation
ENABLE_MCU_ONCE
0011
Instruction to enable the M•CORE TAP
controller
HIGHZ
1001
Selects the Bypass Register while
three-stating all output pins and asserting
functional reset
CLAMP
1100
Selects bypass while applying fixed values to
output pins and asserting functional reset
BYPASS
1111
Selects the Bypass Register for data
operations
Reserved
0100
0110
0101(1)
1000
Reserved
Instruction for chip manufacturing purposes
only
0111
1101–1110 Decoded to select the Bypass Register (2)
1010–1011
1. To exit this instruction, the TRST pin must be asserted or power-on reset.
2. Motorola reserves the right to change the decoding of the unused opcodes in the future.
22.5.2 IDCODE Instruction
The IDCODE instruction selects the 32-bit IDCODE Register for
connection as a shift path between the TDI pin and the TDO pin. This
instruction allows interrogation of the device to determine its version
number and other part identification data. The IDCODE Register has
been implemented in accordance with the IEEE 1149.1 standard so that
the least significant bit of the shift register stage is set to logic 1 on the
rising edge of TCLK following entry into the capture-DR state. Therefore,
the first bit to be shifted out after selecting the IDCODE Register is
Advance Information
568
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Junction Temperature Determination
always a logic 1. The remaining 31 bits are also set to fixed values on
the rising edge of TCLK following entry into the capture-DR state.
IDCODE is the default instruction placed into the Instruction Shift
Register when the top-level TAP resets. Thus, after a TAP reset, the
IDCODE (data) register will be selected automatically.
22.5.3 SAMPLE/PRELOAD Instruction
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction provides two separate functions.
First, it obtains a sample of the system data and control signals present
at the input pins and just prior to the boundary scan cell at the output
pins. This sampling occurs on the rising edge of TCLK in the capture-DR
state when an instruction encoding of hex 2 is resident in the Instruction
Shift Register. The user can observe this sampled data by shifting it
through the Boundary Scan Register to the output TDO by using the
shift-DR state. Both the data capture and the shift operation are
transparent to system operation.
NOTE:
The user is responsible for providing some form of external
synchronization to achieve meaningful results because there is no
internal synchronization between TCLK and the system clock.
The second function of the SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction is to initialize
the Boundary Scan Register update cells before selecting EXTEST or
CLAMP. This is achieved by ignoring the data being shifted out of the
TDO pin while shifting in initialization data. The update-DR state in
conjunction with the falling edge of TCLK can then transfer this data to
the update cells. This data will be applied to the external output pins
when EXTEST or CLAMP instruction is applied.
22.5.4 ENABLE_MCU_ONCE Instruction
The ENABLE_MCU_ONCE is a public instruction to enable the
M•CORE OnCE TAP controller. When the OnCE TAP controller is
enabled, the top-level TAP controller connects the internal OnCE TDO
to the pin TDO and remains in the run-test/idle state. It will remain in this
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
569
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
state until TRST is asserted. While the OnCE TAP controller is enabled,
the top-level JTAG remains transparent.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.5.5 HIGHZ Instruction
The HIGHZ instruction is provided as a manufacturer’s optional public
instruction to prevent having to backdrive the output pins during
circuit-board testing. When HIGHZ is invoked, all output drivers,
including the 2-state drivers, are turned off (for example, high
impedance). The instruction selects the Bypass Register. HIGHZ also
asserts internal reset for the system logic to force a predictable internal
state.
22.5.6 CLAMP Instruction
The CLAMP instruction selects the Bypass Register and asserts internal
reset while simultaneously forcing all output pins and bidirectional pins
configured as outputs to the fixed values that are preloaded and held in
the Boundary Scan Update Register. This instruction enhances test
efficiency by reducing the overall shift path to a single bit (the Bypass
Register) while conducting an EXTEST type of instruction through the
Boundary Scan Register.
22.5.7 BYPASS Instruction
The BYPASS instruction selects the single-bit Bypass Register, creating
a single-bit shift register path from the TDI pin to the Bypass Register to
the TDO pin. This instruction enhances test efficiency by reducing the
overall shift path when a device other than the processor becomes the
device under test on a board design with multiple chips on the overall
IEEE 1149.1 standard defined boundary scan chain. The Bypass
Register has been implemented in accordance with IEEE 1149.1
standard so that the shift register state is set to logic 0 on the rising edge
of TCLK following entry into the capture-DR state. Therefore, the first bit
to be shifted out after selecting the Bypass Register is always a logic 0
(to differentiate a part that supports an IDCODE register from a part that
supports only the Bypass Register).
Advance Information
570
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
IDCODE Register
22.6 IDCODE Register
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
An IEEE 1149.1 standard compliant JTAG Identification Register
(IDCODE) has been included on these devices.
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
Figure 22-3. IDCODE Register Bit Specification
Bits 31–28 — Version Number (Part Revision Number)
This is equivalent to the lower four bits of the PRN of the chip
identification register located in the chip configuration module.
Bits 27–22 — Design Center
Indicates the Motorola Microcontroller Division
Bits 21–12 — Device Number (Part Identification Number)
Bits 19-12 are equivalent to the PIN of the chip identification register
located in the chip configuration module.
Bits 11–1 — JEDEC ID
Indicates the reduced JEDEC ID for Motorola. JEDEC refers to the
Joint Electron Device Engineering Council. Refer to JEDEC
publication 106-A and chapter 11 of the IEEE 1149.1 standard for
further information on this field.
Bit 0
Differentiates this register as the JTAG IDCODE Register (as
opposed to the Bypass Register), according to the IEEE 1149.1
standard
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
571
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.7 Bypass Register
An IEEE 1149.1 standard-compliant Bypass Register is included. This
register which creates a single bit shift register path from TDI to the
Bypass Register to TDO when the BYPASS instruction is selected.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.8 Boundary Scan Register
An IEEE 1149.1 standard-compliant Boundary Scan Register is
included. The Boundary Scan Register is connected between TDI and
TDO when the EXTEST or SAMPLE/PRELOAD instructions are
selected. This register captures signal pin data on the input pins, forces
fixed values on the output signal pins, and selects the direction and drive
characteristics (a logic value or high impedance) of the bidirectional and
three-state signal pins.
22.9 Restrictions
The test logic is implemented using static logic design, and TCLK can be
stopped in either a high or low state without loss of data. The system
logic, however, operates on a different system clock which is not
synchronized to TCLK internally. Any mixed operation requiring the use
of the IEEE 1149.1 standard test logic, in conjunction with system
functional logic that uses both clocks, must have coordination and
synchronization of these clocks done externally.
The control afforded by the output enable signals using the boundary
scan register and the EXTEST instruction requires a compatible
circuit-board test environment to avoid device-destructive
configurations. The user must avoid situations in which the output
drivers are enabled into actively driven networks.
Advance Information
572
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Non-Scan Chain Operation
These devices feature a low-power stop mode. The interaction of the
scan chain interface with low-power stop mode is:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
1. The TAP controller must be in the test-logic-reset state to either
enter or remain in the low-power stop mode. Leaving the
test-logic-reset state negates the ability to achieve low-power, but
does not otherwise affect device functionality.
2. The TCLK input is not blocked in low-power stop mode. To
consume minimal power, the TCLK input should be externally
connected to VDD.
3. The TMS, TDI, TRST pins include on-chip pullup resistors. In
low-power stop mode, these three pins should remain either
unconnected or connected to VDD to achieve minimal power
consumption.
22.10 Non-Scan Chain Operation
Keeping the TAP controller in the test-logic-reset state will ensure that
the scan chain test logic is kept transparent to the system logic. It is
recommended that TMS, TDI, TCLK, and TRST be pulled up. TRST
could be connected to ground. However, since there is a pullup on
TRST, some amount of current will result. JTAG will be initialized to the
test-logic-reset state on power-up without TRST asserted low due to the
JTAG power-on-reset internal input. The low-level TAP module in the
M•CORE also has the power-on-reset input.
22.11 Boundary Scan
The Boundary Scan Register contains 200 bits. This register can be
connected between TDI and TDO when EXTEST or
SAMPLE/PRELOAD instructions are selected. This register is used for
capturing signal pin data on the input pins, forcing fixed values on the
output signal pins, and selecting the direction and drive characteristics
(a logic value or high impedance) of the bidirectional and three-state
signal pins.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
573
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
This IEEE 1149.1 standard-compliant Boundary Scan Register contains
bits for bonded-out and non-bonded signals excluding JTAG signals,
analog signals, power supplies, compliance enable pins, and clock
signals.To maintain JTAG compliance, TEST should be held to logic 0
and DE should be held to logic 1. These non-scanned pins are shown in
Table 22-2.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 22-2. List of Pins Not Scanned in JTAG Mode
Advance Information
574
Pin Name
Pin Type
EXTAL
Clock/analog
XTAL
Clock/analog
VDDSYN
Supply
VSSSYN
Supply
PQA4–PQA3 and PQA1–PQA0
Analog
PQB3–PQB0
Analog
VRH
Supply
VRL
Supply
VDDA
Supply
VSSA
Supply
VDDH
Supply
TRST
JTAG
TCLK
JTAG
TMS
JTAG
TDI
JTAG
TDO
JTAG
DE
JTAG compliance enable
TEST
JTAG compliance enable
Vpp
Supply
VDDF
Supply
VSSF
Supply
VSTBY
Supply
VDD
Supply
VSS
Supply
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Boundary Scan
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Table 22-3 defines the Boundary Scan Register.
•
The first column shows bit numbers assigned to each of the
register’s cells. The bit nearest to TDO (the first to be shifted in) is
defined as bit 0.
•
The second column lists the logical state bit for each pin
alternately with the read/write direction control bit for that pin. The
logic state bits are non-inverting with respect to their associated
pins, so that a 1 logical state bit equates to a logical high voltage
on its corresponding pin. A direction control bit value of 1 causes
a pin’s logical state to be expressed by its logic state bit, a read of
a pin. A direction control bit value of 0 causes a pin’s logical
voltage to follow the state of its logical state bit, a write to a pin.
Table 22-3. Boundary Scan Register Definition (Sheet 1 of 4)
(Note: Shaded regions indicate optional pins)
Bit
Logical State and Direction
Control Bits for Each Pin
Logical State and Direction
Control Bits for Each Pin
Bit
0
D31 logical state
17
A18 direction control
1
D31 direction control
18
A19 logical state
2
A12 logical state
19
A19 direction control
3
A12 direction control
20
RSTOUT logical state
4
A13 logical state
21
RSTOUT direction control
5
A13 direction control
22
A20 logical state
6
A14 logical state
23
A20 direction control
7
A14 direction control
24
RESET logical state
8
A15 logical state
25
RESET direction control
9
A15 direction control
26
A21 logical state
10
A16 logical state
27
A21 direction control
11
A16 direction control
28
A22 logical state
12
A17 logical state
29
A22 direction control
13
A17 direction control
30
TEA logical state
14
CLKOUT logical state
31
TEA direction control
15
CLKOUT direction control
32
EB0 logical state
16
A18 logical state
33
EB0 direction control
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
575
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Table 22-3. Boundary Scan Register Definition (Sheet 2 of 4)
(Note: Shaded regions indicate optional pins)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Bit
Advance Information
576
Logical State and Direction
Control Bits for Each Pin
Logical State and Direction
Control Bits for Each Pin
Bit
34
EB1 logical state
64
CS2 logical state
35
EB1 direction control
65
CS2 direction control
36
TA logical state
66
INT4 logical state
37
TA direction control
67
INT4 direction control
38
EB2 logical state
68
CS3 logical state
39
EB2 direction control
69
CS3 direction control
40
SHS logical state
70
TC0 logical state
41
SHS direction control
71
TC0 direction control
42
EB3 logical state
72
INT3 logical state
43
EB3 direction control
73
INT3 direction control
44
OE logical state
74
TC1 logical state
45
OE direction control
75
TC1 direction control
46
SS logical state
76
INT2 logical state
47
SS direction control
77
INT2 direction control
48
SCK logical state
78
INT1 logical state
49
SCK direction control
79
INT1 direction control
50
MISO logical state
80
INT0 logical state
51
MISO direction control
81
INT0 direction control
52
MOSI logical state
82
RXD1 logical state
53
MOSI direction control
83
RXD1 direction control
54
INT7 logical state
84
TXD1 logical state
55
INT7 direction control
85
TXD1 direction control
56
INT6 logical state
86
RXD2 logical state
57
INT6 direction control
87
RXD2 direction control
58
CS0 logical state
88
TC2 logical state
59
CS0 direction control
89
TC2 direction control
60
CS1 logical state
90
TXD2 logical state
61
CS1 direction control
91
TXD2 direction control
62
INT5 logical state
92
CSE0 logical state
63
INT5 direction control
93
CSE0 direction control
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Boundary Scan
Table 22-3. Boundary Scan Register Definition (Sheet 3 of 4)
(Note: Shaded regions indicate optional pins)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Bit
Logical State and Direction
Control Bits for Each Pin
Logical State and Direction
Control Bits for Each Pin
Bit
94
ICOC1_0 logical state
124
D2 logical state
95
ICOC1_0 direction control
125
D2 direction control
96
CSE1 logical state
126
D3 logical state
97
CSE1 direction control
127
D3 direction control
98
R/W logical state
128
D4 logical state
99
R/W direction control
129
D4 direction control
100
ICOC1_1 logical state
130
D5 logical state
101
ICOC1_1 direction control
131
D5 direction control
102
ICOC1_2 logical state
132
D6 logical state
103
ICOC1_2 direction control
133
D6 direction control
104
ICOC1_3 logical state
134
D7 logical state
105
ICOC1_3 direction control
135
D7 direction control
106
ICOC2_0 logical state
136
D8 logical state
107
ICOC2_0 direction control
137
D8 direction control
108
ICOC2_1 logical state
138
D9 logical state
109
ICOC2_1 direction control
139
D9 direction control
110
ICOC2_2 logical state
140
D10 logical state
111
ICOC2_2 direction control
141
D10 direction control
112
ICOC2_3 logical state
142
D11 logical state
113
ICOC2_3 direction control
143
D11 direction control
114
D0 logical state
144
D12 logical state
115
D0 direction control
145
D12 direction control
116
A0 logical state
146
D13 logical state
117
A0 direction control
147
D13 direction control
118
A1 logical state
148
D14 logical state
119
A1 direction control
149
D14 direction control
120
D1 logical state
150
A3 logical state
121
D1 direction control
151
A3 direction control
122
A2 logical state
152
A4 logical state
123
A2 direction control
153
A4 direction control
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
577
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Table 22-3. Boundary Scan Register Definition (Sheet 4 of 4)
(Note: Shaded regions indicate optional pins)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Bit
Advance Information
578
Logical State and Direction
Control Bits for Each Pin
Logical State and Direction
Control Bits for Each Pin
Bit
154
D15 logical state
177
A8 direction control
155
D15 direction control
178
A9 logical state
156
A5 logical state
179
A9 direction control
157
A5 direction control
180
D23 logical state
158
D16 logical state
181
D23 direction control
159
D16 direction control
182
A10 logical state
160
A6 logical state
183
A10 direction control
161
A6 direction control
184
D24 logical state
162
A7 logical state
185
D24 direction control
163
A7 direction control
186
D25 logical state
164
D17 logical state
187
D25 direction control
165
D17 direction control
188
A11 logical state
166
D18 logical state
189
A11 direction control
167
D18 direction control
190
D26 logical state
168
D19 logical state
191
D16 direction control
169
D19 direction control
192
D27 logical state
170
D20 logical state
193
D27 direction control
171
D20 direction control
194
D28 logical state
172
D21 logical state
195
D28 direction control
173
D21 direction control
196
D29 logical state
174
D22 logical state
197
D29 direction control
175
D22 direction control
198
D30 logical state
176
A8 logical state
199
D30 direction control
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Low-Level TAP (OnCE) Module
22.12 Low-Level TAP (OnCE) Module
The low-level TAP (OnCE, on-chip emulation) circuitry provides a
simple, inexpensive debugging interface that allows external access to
the processor’s internal registers and to memory/peripherals. OnCE
capabilities are controlled through a serial interface, mapped onto a
JTAG test access port (TAP) protocol.
Refer to Figure 22-4 for a block diagram of the OnCE.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
NOTE:
The interface to the OnCE controller and its resources is based on the
TAP defined for JTAG in the IEEE 1149.1 standard.
PIPELINE
INFORMATION
BREAKPOINT
AND TRACE
LOGIC
OnCE
CONTROLLER
AND SERIAL
INTERFACE
PC
FIFO
TCLK
TDI
TMS
TDO
TRST
DE
BREAKPOINT
REGISTERS
AND
COMPARATORS
Figure 22-4. OnCE Block Diagram
Figure 22-5 shows the OnCE (low-level TAP module) data registers.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
579
580
Advance Information
0x3
MEMORY
BKPT
COUNTER A
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
MBCA
TRACE
COUNTER
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
OTC
OCMR,
RS[4:0] =
0
LSB
MSB
15
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
PROGRAM
COUNTER
FIFO AND
INCREMENT
COUNTER
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
PC FIFO
0x5
0
LSB
MSB
15
0x7
0
LSB
BKPT
ADDRESS
BASE
REGISTER B
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
BABB
MSB
31
BKPT
ADDRESS
BASE
REGISTER
A
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
BABA
0x6
0
LSB
MSB
31
0
LSB
MSB
31
0x9
0
LSB
MSB
31
0
LSB
MSB
31
CPU
SCAN
CHAIN
REGISTER
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
CPUSCR
0xa
TDO
(TEST DATA OUT)
BKPT
ADDRESS
MASK
REGISTER B
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
BAMB
MUX
BKPT
ADDRESS
MASK
REGISTER
A
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
BAMA
0x8
TDI
(TEST DATA IN)
0
LSB
32
31
64
63
96
95
112
111
MSB
127
1 BIT
OnCE
CONTROL
REGISTER
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
OCR
0xc
BYPASS
REGISTER
PASSTHROUGH
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
BYPASS
WBBR
PSR
PC
IR
CTL
0xb
OnCE
STATUS
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
OSR
BCA
RCA
BCB
SQC
DR
IDRE
TME
FRZC
RCB
0xd
Figure 22-5. Low-Level (OnCE) Tap Module Data Registers (DRs)
0
LSB
MSB
15
MEMORY
BKPT
COUNTER
B
(SHIFT)
REGISTER,
MBCB
0x4
RS4–RS0 FROM
ONCE CMD (INSTRUCTION) REGISTER, OCMR
IN FIGURE 22-1
DETAILED VIEW OF OnCE DATA REGISTERS BLOCK FOUND IN FIGURE 22-1
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
0
LSB
6
5
4
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
MSB
31
0x1f
0
LSB
MSB
15
BYPASS 1 BIT
REGISTER
PASSTHROUGH,
BYPASS
0xe
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Signal Descriptions
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.13 Signal Descriptions
The OnCE pin interface is used to transfer OnCE instructions and data
to the OnCE control block. Depending on the particular resource being
accessed, the CPU may need to be placed in debug mode. For
resources outside of the CPU block and contained in the OnCE block,
the processor is not disturbed and may continue execution. If a
processor resource is required, the OnCE controller may assert an
internal debug request (DBGRQ) to the CPU. This causes the CPU to
finish the instruction being executed, save the instruction pipeline
information, enter debug mode, and wait for further commands.
NOTE:
Asserting DBGRQ causes the device to exit stop, doze, or wait mode
and to enter debug mode.
22.13.1 Debug Serial Input (TDI)
Data and commands are provided to the OnCE controller through the
TDI pin. Data is latched on the rising edge of the TCLK serial clock. Data
is shifted into the OnCE serial port least significant bit (LSB) first.
22.13.2 Debug Serial Clock (TCLK)
The TCLK pin supplies the serial clock to the OnCE control block. The
serial clock provides pulses required to shift data and commands into
and out of the OnCE serial port. (Data is clocked into the OnCE on the
rising edge and is clocked out of the OnCE serial port on the falling
edge.) The debug serial clock frequency must be no greater than
50 percent of the processor clock frequency.
22.13.3 Debug Serial Output (TDO)
Serial data is read from the OnCE block through the TDO pin. Data is
always shifted out the OnCE serial port LSB first. Data is clocked out of
the OnCE serial port on the falling edge of TCLK. TDO is three-stateable
and is actively driven in the shift-IR and shift-DR controller states. TDO
changes on the falling edge of TCLK.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
581
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.13.4 Debug Mode Select (TMS)
The TMS input is used to cycle through states in the OnCE debug
controller. Toggling the TMS pin while clocking with TCLK controls the
transitions through the TAP state controller.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.13.5 Test Reset (TRST)
The TRST input is used to reset the OnCE controller externally by
placing the OnCE control logic in a test logic reset state. OnCE operation
is disabled in the reset controller and reserved states.
22.13.6 Debug Event (DE)
The DE pin is a bidirectional open drain pin. As an input, DE provides a
fast means of entering debug mode from an external command
controller. As an output, this pin provides a fast means of acknowledging
debug mode entry to an external command controller.
The assertion of this pin by a command controller causes the CPU to
finish the current instruction being executed, save the instruction
pipeline information, enter debug mode, and wait for commands to be
entered from the TDI line. If DE was used to enter debug mode, then DE
must be negated after the OnCE responds with an acknowledgment and
before sending the first OnCE command.
The assertion of this pin by the CPU acknowledges that it has entered
debug mode and is waiting for commands to be entered from the TDI
line.
22.14 Functional Description
The on-chip emulation (OnCE) circuitry provides a simple, inexpensive
debugging interface that allows external access to the processor’s
internal registers and to memory/peripherals. OnCE capabilities are
controlled through a serial interface, mapped onto a JTAG test access
port (TAP) protocol. Figure 22-6 shows the components of the OnCE
circuitry.
Advance Information
582
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
22.14.1 Operation
An instruction is scanned into the OnCE module through the serial
interface and then decoded. Data may then be scanned in and used to
update a register or resource on a write to the resource, or data
associated with a resource may be scanned out for a read of the
resource.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
For accesses to the CPU internal state, the OnCE controller requests the
CPU to enter debug mode via the CPU DBGRQ input. Once the CPU
enters debug mode, as indicated by the OnCE Status Register (OSR),
the processor state may be accessed through the CPU Scan Register.
TEST-LOGIC-RESET
1
0
RUN-TEST/IDLE
1
1
SELECT DRSCAN
0
0
1
1
SELECT — IR
SCAN
0
1
CAPTURE — DR
CAPTURE — IR
0
0
SHIFT — DR
SHIFT — IR
0
1
0
1
1
EXIT1 — DR
0
0
PAUSE — DR
PAUSE — IR
0
1
EXIT2 — DR
0
0
1
0
EXIT2 — IR
1
1
UPDATE — DR
1
1
EXIT1 — IR
0
UPDATE — IR
1
0
Figure 22-6. OnCE Controller
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
583
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The OnCE controller is implemented as a 16-state finite state machine,
with a one-to-one correspondence to the states defined for the JTAG
TAP controller.
CPU registers and the contents of memory locations are accessed by
scanning instructions and data into and out of the CPU scan chain.
Required data is accessed by executing the scanned instructions.
Memory locations may be read by scanning in a load instruction to the
CPU that references the desired memory location, executing the load
instruction, and then scanning out the result of the load. Other resources
are accessed in a similar manner.
Resources contained in the OnCE module that do not require the CPU
to be halted for access may be controlled while the CPU is executing and
do not interfere with normal processor execution. Accesses to certain
resources, such as the PC FIFO and the count registers, while not part
of the CPU, may require the CPU to be stopped to allow access to avoid
synchronization hazards. If it is known that the CPU clock is enabled and
running no slower than the TCLK input, there is sufficient
synchronization performed to allow reads but not writes of these specific
resources. Debug firmware may ensure that it is safe to access these
resources by reading the OSR to determine the state of the CPU prior to
access. All other cases require the CPU to be in the debug state for
deterministic operation.
22.14.2 OnCE Controller and Serial Interface
Figure 22-7 is a block diagram of the OnCE controller and serial
interface.
The OnCE Command Register (OCMR) acts as the Instruction Register
(IR) for the TAP controller. All other OnCE resources are treated as data
registers (DR) by the TAP controller. The Command Register is loaded
by serially shifting in commands during the TAP controller shift-IR state,
and is loaded during the update-IR state. The OCMR selects a OnCE
resource to be accessed as a DR during the TAP controller capture-DR,
shift-DR and update-DR states.
Advance Information
584
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
TDI
OnCE COMMAND REGISTER
TCLK
ISBKPT
OnCE
DECODER
ISTRACE
OnCE TAP
CONTROLLER
TMS
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
ISDR
OnCE STATUS
AND CONTROL
REGISTERS
REGISTER
READ
TDO
REGISTER
WRITE
CPU
CONTROL/
STATUS
Figure 22-7. OnCE Controller and Serial Interface
22.14.3 OnCE Interface Signals
Figure 22-8 shows the interface signals for the OnCE controller.
The following paragraphs describe the OnCE interface signals to other
internal blocks associated with the OnCE controller. These signals are
not available externally, and descriptions are provided to improve
understanding of OnCE operation.
22.14.3.1 Internal Debug Request Input (IDR)
The internal debug request input is a hardware signal which is used in
some implementations to force an immediate debug request to the CPU.
If present and enabled, it functions in an identical manner to the control
function provided by the DR control bit in the OCR. This input is
maskable by a control bit in the OCR.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
585
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
IDR
DBGACK
DBGRQ
BRKRQ
BREAKPOINT
AND
TRACE LOGIC
PIPELINE
INFORMATION
TDI
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
TCK
OnCE
CONTROLLER
AND
SERIAL
INTERFACE
ADDR
ATTR
PSTAT
TMS
TDO
TRST
PC
FIFO
BREAKPOINT
REGISTERS
AND
COMPARATORS
DE
DEBUG
Figure 22-8. OnCE Interface Diagram
22.14.3.2 CPU Debug Request (DBGRQ)
The DBGRQ signal is asserted by the OnCE control logic to request the
CPU to enter the debug state. It may be asserted for a number of
different conditions. Assertion of this signal causes the CPU to finish the
current instruction being executed, save the instruction pipeline
information, enter debug mode, and wait for further commands.
Asserting DBGRQ causes the device to exit stop, doze, or wait mode.
22.14.3.3 CPU Debug Acknowledge (DBGACK)
The CPU asserts the DBGACK signal upon entering the debug state.
This signal is part of the handshake mechanism between the OnCE
control logic and the CPU.
22.14.3.4 CPU Breakpoint Request (BRKRQ)
The BRKRQ signal is asserted by the OnCE control logic to signal that
a breakpoint condition has occurred for the current CPU bus access.
Advance Information
586
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
22.14.3.5 CPU Address, Attributes (ADDR, ATTR)
The CPU address and attribute information may be used in the memory
breakpoint logic to qualify memory breakpoints with access address and
cycle type information.
22.14.3.6 CPU Status (PSTAT)
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The trace logic uses the PSTAT signals to qualify trace count
decrements with specific CPU activity.
22.14.3.7 OnCE Debug Output (DEBUG)
The DEBUG signal is used to indicate to on-chip resources that a debug
session is in progress. Peripherals and other units may use this signal to
modify normal operation for the duration of a debug session. This may
involve the CPU executing a sequence of instructions solely for the
purpose of visibility/system control. These instructions are not part of the
normal instruction stream that the CPU would have executed had it not
been placed in debug mode.
This signal is asserted the first time the CPU enters the debug state and
remains asserted until the CPU is released by a write to the OnCE
Command Register with the GO and EX bits set, and a register specified
as either no register selected or the CPUSCR. This signal remains
asserted even though the CPU may enter and exit the debug state for
each instruction executed under control of the OnCE controller.
22.14.4 OnCE Controller Registers
This section describes the OnCE controller registers:
•
OnCE Command Register (OCMR)
•
OnCE Control Register (OCR)
•
OnCE Status Register (OSR)
All OnCE registers are addressed by means of the RS field in the OCMR,
as shown in Table 22-4.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
587
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.14.4.1 OnCE Command Register
The OnCE Command Register (OCMR) is an 8-bit shift register that
receives its serial data from the TDI pin. This register corresponds to the
JTAG IR and is loaded when the update-IR TAP controller state is
entered. It holds the 8-bit commands shifted in during the shift-IR
controller state to be used as input for the OnCE decoder. The OCMR
contains fields for controlling access to a OnCE resource, as well as
controlling single-step operation, and exit from OnCE mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Although the OCMR is updated during the update-IR TAP controller
state, the corresponding resource is accessed in the DR scan sequence
of the TAP controller, and as such, the update-DR state must be
transitioned through in order for an access to occur. In addition, the
update-DR state must also be transitioned through in order for the
single-step and/or exit functionality to be performed, even though the
command appears to have no data resource requirement associated
with it.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R/W
G
EX
RS4
RS3
RS2
RS1
RS0
Figure 22-9. OnCE Command Register (OCMR)
R/W — Read/Write Bit
1 = Read the data in the register specified by the RS field.
0 = Write the data associated with the command into the register
specified by the RS field.
GO — Go Bit
When the GO bit is set, the device executes the instruction in the IR
Register in the CPUSCR. To execute the instruction, the processor
leaves debug mode, executes the instruction, and if the EX bit is
cleared, returns to debug mode immediately after executing the
instruction. The processor resumes normal operation if the EX bit is
set. The GO command is executed only if the operation is a read/write
to either the CPUSCR or to “no register selected.” Otherwise, the GO
Advance Information
588
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
bit has no effect. The processor leaves debug mode after the TAP
controller update-DR state is entered.
1 = Execute instruction in IR
0 = Inactive (no action taken)
EX — Exit Bit
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When the EX bit is set, the processor leaves debug mode and
resumes normal operation until another debug request is generated.
The exit command is executed only if the GO bit is set and the
operation is a read/write to the CPUSCR or a read/write to “no register
selected.” Otherwise, the EX bit has no effect. The processor exits
debug mode after the TAP controller update-DR state is entered.
1 = Leave debug mode
0 = Remain in debug mode
RS4–RS0 — Register Select Field
The RS field defines the source for the read operation or the
destination for the write operation. Table 22-4 shows OnCE register
addresses.
Table 22-4. OnCE Register Addressing
RS4–RS0
Register Selected
00000
Reserved
00001
Reserved
00010
Reserved
00011
OTC — OnCE trace counter
00100
MBCA — memory breakpoint counter A
00101
MBCB — memory breakpoint counter B
00110
PC FIFO — program counter FIFO and increment counter
00111
BABA — Breakpoint Address Base Register A
01000
BABB — Breakpoint Address Base Register B
01001
BAMA — Breakpoint Address Mask Register A
01010
BAMB — Breakpoint Address Mask Register B
01011
CPUSCR — CPU Scan Chain Register
01100
Bypass — no register selected
01101
OCR — OnCE Control Register
01110
OSR — OnCE Status Register
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
589
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Table 22-4. OnCE Register Addressing (Continued)
RS4–RS0
01111
Reserved (factory test control register — do not access)
10000
Reserved (MEM_BIST — do not access)
10001–10110
10111
11111
Reserved (bypass, do not access)
Reserved (LSRL, do not access)
11000–11110
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Register Selected
Reserved (bypass, do not access)
Bypass
22.14.4.2 OnCE Control Register
The 32-bit OnCE Control Register (OCR) selects the events that put the
device in debug mode and enables or disables sections of the OnCE
logic.
Read:
Bit 31
30
29
28
27
26
25
Bit 24
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 23
22
21
20
19
18
17
Bit 16
0
0
0
0
0
0
SQC1
SQC0
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
DR
IDRE
TME
FRZC
RCB
BCB4
BCB3
BCB2
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
BCB1
BCB0
RCA
BCA4
BCA3
BCA2
BCA1
BCA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
Reset:
= Unimplemented or reserved
Figure 22-10. OnCE Control Register (OCR)
Advance Information
590
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
SQC1 and SQC0 — Sequential Control Field
The SQC field allows memory breakpoint B and trace occurrences to
be suspended until a qualifying event occurs. Test logic reset clears
the SQC field. See Table 22-5.
Table 22-5. Sequential Control Field Settings
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
SQC1
and SQC0
Meaning
00
Disable sequential control operation. Memory breakpoints and trace
operation are unaffected by this field.
01
Suspend normal trace counter operation until a breakpoint condition
occurs for memory breakpoint B. In this mode, memory breakpoint B
occurrences no longer cause breakpoint requests to be generated.
Instead, trace counter comparisons are suspended until the first
memory breakpoint B occurrence. After the first memory breakpoint
B occurrence, trace counter control is released to perform normally,
assuming TME is set. This allows a sequence of breakpoint
conditions to be specified prior to trace counting.
10
Qualify memory breakpoint B matches with a breakpoint occurrence
for memory breakpoint A. In this mode, memory breakpoint A
occurrences no longer cause breakpoint requests to be generated.
Instead, memory breakpoint B comparisons are suspended until the
first memory breakpoint A occurrence. After the first memory
breakpoint A occurrence, memory breakpoint B is enabled to
perform normally. This allows a sequence of breakpoint conditions
to be specified.
11
Combine the 01 and 10 qualifications. In this mode, no breakpoint
requests are generated, and trace count operation is enabled once
a memory breakpoint B occurrence follows a memory breakpoint A
occurrence if TME is set.
DR — Debug Request Bit
DR requests the CPU to enter debug mode unconditionally. The PM
bits in the OnCE Status Register indicate that the CPU is in debug
mode. Once the CPU enters debug mode, it returns there even with
a write to the OCMR with GO and EX set until the DR bit is cleared.
Test logic reset clears the DR bit.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
591
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
IDRE — Internal Debug Request Enable Bit
The internal debug request (IDR) input to the OnCE control logic may
not be used in all implementations. In some implementations, the IDR
control input may be connected and used as an additional hardware
debug request. Test logic reset clears the IDRE bit.
1 = IDR input enabled
0 = IDR input disabled
TME — Trace Mode Enable Bit
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
TME enables trace operation. Test logic reset clears the TME bit.
Trace operation is also affected by the SQC field.
1 = Trace operation enabled
0 = Trace operation disabled
FRZC — Freeze Control Bit
This control bit is used in conjunction with memory breakpoint B
registers to select between asserting a breakpoint condition when a
memory breakpoint B occurs or freezing the PC FIFO from further
updates when memory breakpoint B occurs while allowing the CPU to
continue execution. The PC FIFO remains frozen until the FRZO bit
in the OSR is cleared.
1 = Memory breakpoint B occurrence freezes PC FIFO and does
not assert breakpoint condition.
0 = Memory breakpoint B occurrence asserts breakpoint condition.
RCB and RCA — Memory Breakpoint B and A Range Control Bits
RCB and RDA condition enabled memory breakpoint occurrences
happen when memory breakpoint matches are either within or outside
the range defined by memory base address and mask.
1 = Condition breakpoint on access outside of range
0 = Condition breakpoint on access within range
BCB4–BCB0 and BCA4–BCA0 — Memory Breakpoint B and A Control
Fields
The BCB and BCA fields enable memory breakpoints and qualify the
access attributes to select whether the breakpoint matches are
recognized for read, write, or instruction fetch (program space)
accesses. Test logic reset clears BCB4–BCB0 and BCA4–BCA0.
Advance Information
592
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
Table 22-6. Memory Breakpoint Control Field Settings
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
BCB4–BCB0
BCA4–BCA0
Description
00000
Breakpoint disabled
00001
Qualify match with any access
00010
Qualify match with any instruction access
00011
Qualify match with any data access
00100
Qualify match with any change of flow instruction access
00101
Qualify match with any data write
00110
Qualify match with any data read
00111
Reserved
01XXX
Reserved
10000
Reserved
10001
Qualify match with any user access
10010
Qualify match with any user instruction access
10011
Qualify match with any user data access
10100
Qualify match with any user change of flow access
10101
Qualify match with any user data write
10110
Qualify match with any user data read
10111
Reserved
11000
Reserved
11001
Qualify match with any supervisor access
11010
Qualify match with any supervisor instruction access
11011
Qualify match with any supervisor data access
11100
Qualify match with any supervisor change of flow access
11101
Qualify match with any supervisor data write
11110
Qualify match with any supervisor data read
11111
Reserved
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
593
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.14.4.3 OnCE Status Register
The 16-bit OnCE Status Register (OSR) indicates the reason(s) that
debug mode was entered and the current operating mode of the CPU.
Read:
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
HDRO
DRO
0
0
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
MBO
SWO
TO
FRZO
SQB
SQA
PM1
PM0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
= Unimplemented or reserved
Figure 22-11. OnCE Status Register (OSR)
HDRO — Hardware Debug Request Occurrence Flag
HDRO is set when the processor enters debug mode as a result of a
hardware debug request from the IDR signal or the DE pin. This bit is
cleared on test logic reset or when debug mode is exited with the GO
and EX bits set.
DRO — Debug Request Occurrence Flag
DRO is set when the processor enters debug mode and the debug
request (DR) control bit in the OnCE Control Register is set. This bit
is cleared on test logic reset or when debug mode is exited with the
GO and EX bits set.
MBO — Memory Breakpoint Occurrence Flag
MBO is set when a memory breakpoint request has been issued to
the CPU via the BRKRQ input and the CPU enters debug mode. In
some situations involving breakpoint requests on instruction
prefetches, the CPU may discard the request along with the prefetch.
In this case, this bit may become set due to the CPU entering debug
mode for another reason. This bit is cleared on test logic reset or
when debug mode is exited with the GO and EX bits set.
Advance Information
594
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
SWO — Software Debug Occurrence Flag
SWO bit is set when the processor enters debug mode of operation
as a result of the execution of the BKPT instruction. This bit is cleared
on test logic reset or when debug mode is exited with the GO and EX
bits set.
TO — Trace Count Occurrence Flag
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
TO is set when the trace counter reaches zero with the trace mode
enabled and the CPU enters debug mode. This bit is cleared on test
logic reset or when debug mode is exited with the GO and EX bits set.
FRZO — FIFO Freeze Occurrence Flag
FRZO is set when a FIFO freeze occurs. This bit is cleared on test
logic reset or when debug mode is exited with the GO and EX bits set.
SQB — Sequential Breakpoint B Arm Occurrence Flag
SQB is set when sequential operation is enabled and a memory
breakpoint B event has occurred to enable trace counter operation.
This bit is cleared on test logic reset or when debug mode is exited
with the GO and EX bits set.
SQA — Sequential Breakpoint A Arm Occurrence Flag
SQA is set when sequential operation is enabled and a memory
breakpoint A event has occurred to enable memory breakpoint B
operation. This bit is cleared on test logic reset or when debug mode
is exited with the GO and EX bits set.
PM1 and PM0 — Processor Mode Field
These flags reflect the processor operating mode. They allow
coordination of the OnCE controller with the CPU for synchronization.
Table 22-7. Processor Mode Field Settings
PM1
and PM0
Meaning
00
Processor in normal mode
01
Processor in stop, doze, or wait mode
10
Processor in debug mode
11
Reserved
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
595
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.14.5 OnCE Decoder (ODEC)
The ODEC receives as input the 8-bit command from the OCMR and
status signals from the processor. The ODEC generates all the strobes
required for reading and writing the selected OnCE registers.
22.14.6 Memory Breakpoint Logic
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Memory breakpoints can be set for a particular memory location or on
accesses within an address range. The breakpoint logic contains an
input latch for addresses, registers that store the base address and
address mask, comparators, attribute qualifiers, and a breakpoint
counter. Figure 22-12 illustrates the basic functionality of the OnCE
memory breakpoint logic. This logic is duplicated to provide two
independent breakpoint resources.
ATTR
ADDR[31:0]
BC[4:0], RCx
MEMORY ADDRESS LATCH
DSCK
DSO
DSI
ADDRESS COMPARATOR
MATCH
MEMORY
BREAKPOINT
QUALIFICATION
ADDRESS BASE REGISTER X
BREAKPOINT
MATCH
OCCURRED
ADDRESS MASK REGISTER X
DEC
BREAKPOINT COUNTER
COUNT = 0
ISBKPTx
Figure 22-12. OnCE Memory Breakpoint Logic
Advance Information
596
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Address comparators can be used to determine where a program may
be getting lost or when data is being written to areas which should not
be written. They are also useful in halting a program at a specific point
to examine or change registers or memory. Using address comparators
to set breakpoints enables the user to set breakpoints in RAM or ROM
in any operating mode. Memory accesses are monitored according to
the contents of the OCR.
The address comparator generates a match signal when the address on
the bus matches the address stored in the Breakpoint Address Base
Register, as masked with individual bit masking capability provided by
the Breakpoint Address Mask Register. The address match signal and
the access attributes are further qualified with the RCx4–RCx0 and
BCx4–BCx0 control bits. This qualification is used to decrement the
breakpoint counter conditionally if its contents are non-zero. If the
contents are zero, the counter is not decremented and the breakpoint
event occurs (ISBKPTx asserted).
22.14.6.1 Memory Address Latch (MAL)
The MAL is a 32-bit register that latches the address bus on every
access.
22.14.6.2 Breakpoint Address Base Registers
The 32-bit Breakpoint Address Base Registers (BABA and BABB) store
memory breakpoint base addresses. BABA and BABB can be read or
written through the OnCE serial interface. Before enabling breakpoints,
the external command controller should load these registers.
22.14.7 Breakpoint Address Mask Registers
The 32-bit Breakpoint Address Mask Registers (BAMA and BAMB)
registers store memory breakpoint base address masks. BAMA and
BAMB can be read or written through the OnCE serial interface. Before
enabling breakpoints, the external command controller should load
these registers.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
597
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.14.7.1 Breakpoint Address Comparators
The breakpoint address comparators are not externally accessible. Each
compares the memory address stored in MAL with the contents of BABx,
as masked by BAMx, and signals the control logic when a match occurs.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.14.7.2 Memory Breakpoint Counters
The 16-bit Memory Breakpoint Counter Registers (MBCA and MBCB)
are loaded with a value equal to the number of times, minus one, that a
memory access event should occur before a memory breakpoint is
declared. The memory access event is specified by the RCx4–RCx0 and
BCx4–BCx0 bits in the OCR and by the Memory Base and Mask
Registers. On each occurrence of the memory access event, the
breakpoint counter, if currently non-zero, is decremented. When the
counter has reached the value of zero and a new occurrence takes
place, the ISBKPTx signal is asserted and causes the CPU’s BRKRQ
input to be asserted. The MBCx can be read or written through the OnCE
serial interface.
Anytime the breakpoint registers are changed, or a different breakpoint
event is selected in the OCR, the breakpoint counter must be written
afterward. This assures that the OnCE breakpoint logic is reset and that
no previous events will affect the new breakpoint event selected.
22.14.8 OnCE Trace Logic
The OnCE trace logic allows the user to execute instructions in single or
multiple steps before the device returns to debug mode and awaits
OnCE commands from the debug serial port. The OnCE trace logic is
independent of the M•CORE trace facility, which is controlled through
the trace mode bits in the M•CORE Processor Status Register. The
OnCE trace logic block diagram is shown in Figure 22-13.
Advance Information
598
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
22.14.8.1 OnCE Trace Counter
The OnCE Trace Counter Register (OTC) is a 16-bit counter that allows
more than one instruction to be executed in real time before the device
returns to debug mode. This feature helps the software developer debug
sections of code that are time-critical. The trace counter also enables the
user to count the number of instructions executed in a code segment.
END
OF
INSTRUCTION
DSI
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
DSO
DEC
OnCE TRACE COUNTER
DSCK
COUNT = 0
ISTRACE
Figure 22-13. OnCE Trace Logic Block Diagram
The OTC Register can be read, written, or cleared through the OnCE
serial interface. If N instructions are to be executed before entering
debug mode, the trace counter should be loaded with N – 1. N must not
equal zero unless the sequential breakpoint control capability is being
used. In this case a value of zero (indicating a single instruction) is
allowed.
A hardware reset clears the OTC.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
599
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.14.8.2 Trace Operation
To initiate trace mode operation:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
1. Load the OTC Register with a value. This value must be non-zero,
unless sequential breakpoint control operation is enabled in the
OCR Register. In this case, a value of zero (indicating a single
instruction) is allowed.
2. Initialize the program counter and Instruction Register in the
CPUSCR with values corresponding to the start location of the
instruction(s) to be executed real-time.
3. Set the TME bit in the OCR.
4. Release the processor from debug mode by executing the
appropriate command issued by the external command controller.
When debug mode is exited, the counter is decremented after each
execution of an instruction. Interrupts can be serviced, and all
instructions executed (including interrupt services) will decrement the
trace counter.
When the trace counter decrements to zero, the OnCE control logic
requests that the processor re-enter debug mode, and the trace
occurrence bit TO in the OSR is set to indicate that debug mode has
been requested as a result of the trace count function. The trace counter
allows a minimum of two instructions to be specified for execution prior
to entering trace (specified by a count value of one), unless sequential
breakpoint control operation is enabled in the OCR. In this case, a value
of zero (indicating a single instruction) is allowed.
22.14.9 Methods of Entering Debug Mode
The PM status field in the OSR indicates that the CPU has entered
debug mode. The following paragraphs discuss conditions that invoke
debug mode.
22.14.9.1 Debug Request During RESET
When the DR bit in the OCR is set, assertion of RESET causes the
device to enter debug mode. In this case the device may fetch the reset
Advance Information
600
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
vector and the first instruction of the reset exception handler but does not
execute an instruction before entering debug mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.14.9.2 Debug Request During Normal Activity
Setting the DR bit in the OCR during normal device activity causes the
device to finish the execution of the current instruction and then enter
debug mode. Note that in this case the device completes the execution
of the current instruction and stops after the newly fetched instruction
enters the CPU instruction latch. This process is the same for any newly
fetched instruction, including instructions fetched by interrupt processing
or those that will be aborted by interrupt processing.
22.14.9.3 Debug Request During Stop, Doze, or Wait Mode
Setting the DR bit in the OCR when the device is in stop, doze, or wait
mode (for instance, after execution of a STOP, DOZE, or WAIT
instruction) causes the device to exit the low-power state and enter the
debug mode. Note that in this case, the device completes the execution
of the STOP, DOZE, or WAIT instruction and halts after the next
instruction enters the instruction latch.
22.14.9.4 Software Request During Normal Activity
Executing the BKPT instruction when the FDB (force debug enable
mode) control bit in the Control State Register is set causes the CPU to
enter debug mode after the instruction following the BKPT instruction
has entered the instruction latch.
22.14.10 Enabling OnCE Trace Mode
When the OnCE trace mode mechanism is enabled and the trace count
is greater than zero, the trace counter is decremented for each
instruction executed. Completing execution of an instruction when the
trace counter is zero causes the CPU to enter debug mode.
NOTE:
Only instructions actually executed cause the trace counter to
decrement. An aborted instruction does not decrement the trace counter
and does not invoke debug mode.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
601
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.14.11 Enabling OnCE Memory Breakpoints
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
When the OnCE memory breakpoint mechanism is enabled with a
breakpoint counter value of zero, the device enters debug mode after
completing the execution of the instruction that caused the memory
breakpoint to occur. In case of breakpoints on instruction fetches, the
breakpoint is acknowledged immediately after the execution of the
fetched instruction. In case of breakpoints on data memory addresses,
the breakpoint is acknowledged after the completion of the memory
access instruction.
22.14.12 Pipeline Information and Write-Back Bus Register
A number of on-chip registers store the CPU pipeline status and are
configured in the CPU Scan Chain Register (CPUSCR) for access by the
OnCE controller. The CPUSCR is used to restore the pipeline and
resume normal device activity upon return from debug mode. The
CPUSCR also provides a mechanism for the emulator software to
access processor and memory contents. Figure 22-14 shows the block
diagram of the pipeline information registers contained in the CPUSCR.
31
0
TDO
WBBR
31
0
PSR
31
0
PC
15
TDI
0
15
0
IR
CTL
Figure 22-14. CPU Scan Chain Register (CPUSCR)
Advance Information
602
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
22.14.12.1 Program Counter Register
The Program Counter Register (PC) is a 32-bit latch that stores the value
in the CPU program counter when the device enters debug mode. The
CPU PC is affected by operations performed during debug mode and
must be restored by the external command controller when the CPU
returns to normal mode.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
22.14.12.2 Instruction Register
The Instruction Register (IR) provides a mechanism for controlling the
debug session. The IR allows the debug control block to execute
selected instructions; the debug control module provides single-step
capability.
When scan-out begins, the IR contains the opcode of the next instruction
to be executed at the time debug mode was entered. This opcode must
be saved in order to resume normal execution at the point debug mode
was entered.
On scan-in, the IR can be filled with an opcode selected by debug control
software in preparation for exiting debug mode. Selecting appropriate
instructions allows a user to examine or change memory locations and
processor registers.
Once the debug session is complete and normal processing is to be
resumed, the IR can be loaded with the value originally scanned out.
22.14.12.3 Control State Register
The Control State Register (CTL) is used to set control values when
debug mode is exited. On scan-in, this register is used to control specific
aspects of the CPU. Certain bits reflect internal processor status and
should be restored to their original values.
The CTL register is a 16-bit latch that stores the value of certain internal
CPU state variables before debug mode is entered. This register is
affected by the operations performed during the debug session and
should be restored by the external command controller when returning
to normal mode. In addition to saved internal state variables, the bits are
used by emulation firmware to control the debug process.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
603
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Reserved bits represent the internal processor state. Restore these bits
to their original value after a debug session is completed, for example,
when a OnCE command is issued with the GO and EX bits set and not
ignored. Set these bits to 1s while instructions are executed during a
debug session.
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
RSVD
RSVD
RSVD
RSVD
RSVD
RSVD
RSVD
FFY
Read:
Write:
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Reset:
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
FDB
SZ1
SZ0
TC2
TC1
TC0
RSVD
RSVD
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 22-15. Control State Register (CTL)
FFY — Feed Forward Y Operand Bit
This control bit is used to force the content of the WBBR to be used
as the Y operand value of the first instruction to be executed following
an update of the CPUSCR. This gives the debug firmware the
capability of updating processor registers by initializing the WBBR
with the desired value, setting the FFY bit, and executing a MOV
instruction to the desired register.
FDB — Force Debug Enable Mode Bit
Setting this control bit places the processor in debug enable mode. In
debug enable mode, execution of the BKPT instruction as well as
recognition of the BRKRQ input causes the processor to enter debug
mode, as if the DBGRQ input had been asserted.
SZ1 and SZ0 — Prefetch Size Field
This control field is used to drive the CPU SIZ1 and SIZ0 outputs on
the first instruction pre-fetch caused by issuing a OnCE command
with the GO bit set and not ignored. It should be set to indicate a 16-bit
size, for example, 0b10. This field should be restored to its original
value after a debug session is completed, for example, when a OnCE
command is issued with the GO and EX bits set and not ignored.
Advance Information
604
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
TC — Prefetch Transfer Code
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
This control field is used to drive the CPU TC2–TC0 outputs on the
first instruction pre-fetch caused by issuing a OnCE command with
the GO bit set and not ignored. It should typically be set to indicate a
supervisor instruction access, for example, 0b110. This field should
be restored to its original value after a debug session is completed,
for example, when a OnCE command is issued with the GO and EX
bits set and not ignored.
22.14.12.4 Writeback Bus Register
The Writeback Bus Register (WBBR) is a means of passing operand
information between the CPU and the external command controller.
Whenever the external command controller needs to read the contents
of a register or memory location, it forces the device to execute an
instruction that brings that information to WBBR.
For example, to read the content of processor register r0, a MOV r0,r0
instruction is executed, and the result value of the instruction is latched
into the WBBR. The contents of WBBR can then be delivered serially to
the external command controller.
To update a processor resource, this register is initialized with a data
value to be written, and a MOV instruction is executed which uses this
value as a write-back data value. The FFY bit in the CTL Register forces
the value of the WBBR to be substituted for the normal source value of
a MOV instruction, thus allowing updates to processor registers to be
performed.
22.14.12.5 Processor Status Register
The Processor Status Register (PSR) is a 32-bit latch used to read or
write the M•CORE Processor Status Register. Whenever the external
command controller needs to save or modify the contents of the
M•CORE Processor Status Register, the PSR is used. This register is
affected by the operations performed in debug mode and must be
restored by the external command controller when returning to normal
mode.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
605
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.14.13 Instruction Address FIFO Buffer (PC FIFO)
To ease debugging activity and keep track of program flow, a
first-in-first-out (FIFO) buffer stores the addresses of the last eight
instruction change-of-flow prefetches that were issued.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The FIFO is a circular buffer containing eight 32-bit registers and one
3-bit counter. All the registers have the same address, but any read
access to the FIFO address causes the counter to increment and point
to the next FIFO register. The registers are serially available to the
external command controller through the common FIFO address.
Figure 22-16 shows the structure of the PC FIFO.
INSTRUCTION FETCH ADDRESS
PC FIFO REGISTER 0
PC FIFO REGISTER 1
PC FIFO REGISTER 2
CIRCULAR
BUFFER
POINTER
PC FIFO REGISTER 3
PC FIFO REGISTER 4
PC FIFO REGISTER 5
PC FIFO REGISTER 6
PC FIFO REGISTER 7
TCLK
TDO
PC FIFO SHIFT REGISTER
Figure 22-16. OnCE PC FIFO
Advance Information
606
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The FIFO is not affected by operations performed in debug mode,
except for incrementing the FIFO pointer when the FIFO is read. When
debug mode is entered, the FIFO counter points to the FIFO register
containing the address of the oldest of the eight change-of-flow
pre-fetches. The first FIFO read obtains the oldest address, and the
following FIFO reads return the other addresses from the oldest to the
newest, in order of execution.
To ensure FIFO coherence, a complete set of eight reads of the FIFO
must be performed. Each read increments the FIFO pointer, causing it
to point to the next location. After eight reads, the pointer points to the
same location as before the start of the read procedure.
The data in the FIFO is not affected by the read operations.
22.14.14 Reserved Test Control Registers
The reserved test control registers (MEM_BIST, FTCR, and LSRL) are
reserved for factory testing.
CAUTION:
To prevent damage to the device or system, do not access these
registers during normal operation.
22.14.15 Serial Protocol
The serial protocol permits an efficient means of communication
between the OnCE external command controller and the MCU. Before
starting any debugging activity, the external command controller must
wait for an acknowledgment that the device has entered debug mode.
The external command controller communicates with the device by
sending 8-bit commands to the OnCE Command Register and 16 to 128
bits of data to one of the other OnCE registers. Both commands and data
are sent or received LSB first. After sending a command, the external
command controller must wait for the processor to acknowledge
execution of certain commands before it can properly access another
OnCE Register.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
607
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
22.14.16 OnCE Commands
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The OnCE commands can be classified as:
•
Read commands (the device delivers the required data)
•
Write commands (the device receives data and writes the data in
one of the OnCE registers)
•
Commands with no associated data transfers
22.14.17 Target Site Debug System Requirements
A typical debug environment consists of a target system in which the
MCU resides in the user-defined hardware.
The external command controller acts as the medium between the MCU
target system and a host computer. The external command controller
circuit acts as a serial debug port driver and host computer command
interpreter. The controller issues commands based on the host
computer inputs from a user interface program which communicates
with the user.
22.14.18 Interface Connector for JTAG/OnCE Serial Port
Figure 22-17 shows the recommended connector pinout and interface
requirements for debug controllers that access the JTAG/OnCE port.
The connector has two rows of seven pins with 0.1-inch center-to-center
spacing between pins in each row and each column.
Advance Information
608
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Functional Description
GND
TARGET VDD
TOP VIEW
(0.1 INCH CENTER-TO-CENTER)
10 kΩ
TDI
TDO
10 kΩ
TCLK
10 kΩ
GPIO/SI
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
10 kΩ
TARGET_RESET
WIRED OR WITH TARGET RESET
CIRCUIT. THIS SIGNAL MUST BE
ABLE TO ASSERT/MONITOR SYSTEM
RESET.
TARGET VDD
GPIO/SO
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
KEY (No Connect)
TMS
10 kΩ
DE
10 kΩ
TRST
10 kΩ
TARGET VDD
Note: GPIO/SI and GPIO/SO are not required for OnCE operation at this time.
These pins can be used for high-speed downloads with a recommended interface.
Figure 22-17. Recommended Connector Interface to JTAG/OnCE Port
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
609
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
Advance Information
610
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
JTAG Test Access Port and OnCE
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Advance Information — MMC2114, MMC2113, and MMC2112
Section 23. Preliminary Electrical Specifications
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 612
23.3
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 613
23.4
Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 614
23.5
Junction Temperature Determination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .614
23.6
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 615
23.7
DC Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 616
23.8
PLL Electrical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 618
23.9
QADC Electrical Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .620
in
ar
y
23.2
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
23.1 Contents
23.10 FLASH Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .624
23.11 External Interface Timing Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 625
23.12 General Purpose I/O Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 630
23.13 Reset and Configuration Override Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 631
23.14 SPI Timing Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 632
23.15 OnCE, JTAG, and Boundary Scan Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 635
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
611
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
23.2 Introduction
This section contains electrical and specification tables and reference
timing diagrams for the MMC2114 microcontroller unit (MCU). This
section contains detailed information on power considerations, DC/AC
electrical characteristics, and AC timing specifications of MMC2114.
The parameters specified in this MCU document supersede any values
found in the module specifications.
Pr
el
im
NOTE:
in
ar
y
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
The electrical specifications are preliminary and are from previous
designs or design simulations. These specifications may not be fully
tested or guaranteed at this early stage of the product life cycle;
however, for production silicon these specifications will be met. Finalized
specifications will be published after complete characterization and
device qualifications have been completed.
Advance Information
612
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
Absolute Maximum Ratings
23.3 Absolute Maximum Ratings
in
ar
y
The MCU contains circuitry to protect the inputs against damage from
high static voltages; however, do not apply voltages higher than those
shown in the table. Keep VIn and VOut within the range
VSS ≤ (VIn or VOut) ≤ VDD. Connect unused inputs to the appropriate
voltage level, either VSS or VDD. This device is not guaranteed to operate
properly at the maximum ratings. Refer to 23.7 DC Electrical
Specifications for guaranteed operating conditions.
Table 23-1. Absolute Maximum Ratings
Parameter
Symbol
Value
Unit
VDD
–0.3 to +4.0
V
VDD
–0.3 to +4.0
V
RAM memory standby supply voltage
VSTBY
–0.3 to + 4.0
V
FLASH memory supply voltage
VDDF
–0.3 to +4.0
V
Analog supply voltage
VDDA
–0.3 to +6.0
V
Analog reference supply voltage
VRH
–0.3 to +6.0
V
Analog ESD protection voltage
VDDH
–0.3 to +6.0
V
Digital input voltage(1)
VIN
–0.3 to + 5.0
V
Analog input voltage
VAIN
–0.3 to + 6.0
V
ID
25
mA
TA
(TL to TH)
–40 to 85
°C
TSTG
–65 to 150
°C
Supply voltage
Clock synthesizer (PLL) supply voltage
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Maximum ratings are the extreme limits to which the MCU can be
exposed without permanently damaging it. See Table 23-1.
Instantaneous maximum current single pin limit
(applies to all pins)(2), (3)
Operating temperature range (packaged)
Storage temperature range
1. Input must be current limited to the value specified. To determine the value of the required
current-limiting resistor, calculate resistance values for positive and negative clamp
voltages, then use the larger of the two values.
2. All functional non-supply pins are internally clamped to VSS and V DD.
3. Power supply must maintain regulation within operating VDD range during instantaneous and
operating maximum current conditions. If positive injection current (V in > VDD) is greater than
IDD, the injection current may flow out of VDD and could result in external power supply going
out of regulation. Ensure external VDD load will shunt current greater than maximum
injection current. This will be the greatest risk when the MCU is not consuming power (ex;
no clock). Power supply must maintain regulation within operating VDD range during
instantaneous and operating maximum current conditions.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
613
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
23.4 Thermal Characteristics
Table 23-2. Thermal Characteristics
Parameter
Unit
θJA
44
46
60
°C/W
y
23.5 Junction Temperature Determination
Value
in
ar
The average chip-junction temperature (TJ) in °C can be obtained from:
TJ = TA + PDxθJA
(1)
where:
TA
= Ambient temperature, °C
θJA
= Package thermal resistance, junction-to-ambient, °C/W
PD = PINT + PI/O
PINT = IDD × VDD, watts — chip internal power
PI/O = Power dissipation on input and output pins — user determined
For most applications, PI/O < PINT and can be neglected. An approximate relationship between
PD and TJ (if PI/O is neglected) is:
PD = K ÷ (TJ + 273°C)
(2)
Solving equations 1 and 2 for K gives:
K = PD×(TA + 273°C) + θJA×PD
(3)
where K is a constant pertaining to the particular part. K can be determined from equation (3)
by measuring PD (at equilibrium) for a known TA. Using this value of K, the values of PD and
TJ can be obtained by solving equations (1) and (2) iteratively for any value of TA.
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Thermal Resistance
Plastic 100-pin LQFP surface mount
Plastic 144-pin LQFP surface mount
Plastic 196-ball MAPBGA
Symbol
Advance Information
614
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Protection
23.6 Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Protection
Table 23-3. ESD Protection Characteristics
Parameter(1) (2)
Symbol
Value
Units
ESD target for human body model
HBM
2000
V
ESD target for machine model
MM
200
V
RSeries
1500
W
C
100
pF
RSeries
0
W
y
MM circuit description
C
200
pF
—
1
1
—
Number of pulses per pin (MM)
Positive pulses
Negative pulses
—
3
3
—
Interval of pulses
—
1
Sec
in
ar
Number of pulses per pin (HBM)
Positive pulses
Negative pulses
1. All ESD testing is in conformity with CDF-AEC-Q100 Stress Test Qualification for Automotive
Grade Integrated Circuits.
2. A device will be defined as a failure if after exposure to ESD pulses the device no longer
meets the device specification requirements. Complete DC parametric and functional testing
shall be performed per applicable device specification at room temperature followed by hot
temperature, unless specified otherwise in the device specification.
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
HBM circuit description
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
615
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
23.7 DC Electrical Specifications
Table 23-4. DC Electrical Specifications(1)
(VSS = VSSF = VSSA = 0 V, TA = TL to TH)
Min
Max
Unit
Input high voltage
VIH
0.7 x VDD
5
V
Input low voltage
VIL
VSS –0.3
0.35 x VDD
V
Input hysteresis
VHYS
0.06 x VDD
—
V
Input leakage current, VIn = VDD or VSS, input-only pins
IIn
–1.0
1.0
µA
High impedance (off-state) leakage current
VIn = VDD or VSS, all input/output and output pins
IOZ
y
Symbol
–1.0
1.0
µA
VOH
VDD –0.5
—
V
Output low voltage (all input/output and all output pins)
IOL = 2.0 mA
VOL
—
0.5
V
Weak internal pullup device current, tested at VIL maximum
IAPU
–10
–130
µA
Input capacitance
All input-only pins
All input/output (three-state) pins
CIn
—
—
7
7
pF
CL
—
—
25
50
pF
VDD
2.7
3.6
V
RAM memory standby supply voltage
Normal operation: VDD > VSTBY –0.3 V
Standby mode: VDD < VSTBY –0.3 V
VSTBY
0.0
2.7
3.6
3.6
V
FLASH memory supply voltage
VDDF
2.7
3.6
V
Low-voltage detect trip voltage (VDD falling)
VLDV
2.00
2.20
V
Low-voltage detect hysteresis (VDD rising)
VHYS
60
100
mV
VSLEWLVD
—
5
kV/ms
—
—
—
—
—
60
40
15
10
200
mA
mA
mA
mA
µA
in
ar
Output high voltage (all input/output and all output pins)
IOH = –2.0 mA
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Parameter
Load Capacitance
50% partial drive
100% full drive
Supply voltage, includes core modules and pads
VDD slew rate (rising or falling) for LVD recognition
Operating supply current, external oscillator clocking(2)
Master mode
Single-chip mode
Wait mode
Doze mode
Stop mode
IDD
Continued on next page
Advance Information
616
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
DC Electrical Specifications
Table 23-4. DC Electrical Specifications(1) (Continued)
(VSS = VSSF = VSSA = 0 V, TA = TL to TH)
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
IDDXTAL
—
—
—
—
64
44
19
14
mA
mA
mA
mA
—
—
—
2
1
200
mA
mA
µA
—
—
—
10
7
20
µA
mA
µA
—
—
—
—
5
28
20
1
mA
mA
mA
µA
IDDA
—
—
2
10.0
mA
µA
IDDH
—
—
800
10
µA
–1.0
–10
1.0
10
y
Operating supply current, crystal/PLL clocking(3)
Master mode
Single-chip mode
Wait mode
Doze mode
Stop mode
OSC and PLL enabled
OSC enabled, PLL disabled
OSC and PLL disabled
ISTBY
FLASH memory supply current(4)
Read
Program
Erase or mass erase
Stop mode
IDDF
in
ar
RAM memory standby supply current
Normal operation: VDD > VSTBY – 0.3 V
Transient condition: VSTBY –0.3 V > VDD > VSS + 0.5 V
Standby operation: VDD < VSS + 0.5 V
Analog supply current
Normal operation
Stop mode
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Parameter
ESD supply current
Normal operation
Stop mode
DC injection current(4), (5), (6)
VNEGCLAMP = VSS – 0.3 V, VPOSCLAMP = VDD + 0.3
Single pin limit
Total MCU limit, includes sum of all stressed pins
IIC
mA
1. Refer to Table 23-5 through Table 23-10 for additional PLL, QADC and FLASH specifications.
2. Current measured at maximum system clock frequency (unless indicated otherwise), all modules active, and default drive
strength with matching load.
3. Current measured at fSYS = 32 MHz derived from 8.00 MHz crystal and PLL, all modules active, and default drive strength
with matching load.
4. All functional non-supply pins are internally clamped to VSS and their respective VDD.
5. Input must be current limited to the value specified. To determine the value of the required current-limiting resistor, calculate
resistance values for positive and negative clamp voltages, then use the larger of the two values.
6. Power supply must maintain regulation within operating VDD range during instantaneous and operating maximum current
conditions. If positive injection current (Vin > VDD) is greater than IDD, the injection current may flow out of VDD and could
result in external power supply going out of regulation. Ensure external VDD load will shunt current greater than maximum
injection current. This will be the greatest risk when the MCU is not consuming power. Examples are: if no system clock is
present, or if clock rate is very low which would reduce overall power consumption. Also, at power-up, system clock is not
present during the power-up sequence until the PLL has attained lock.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
617
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
23.8 PLL Electrical Specifications
Table 23-5. PLL Electrical Specifications
(VDD = 2.7 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, TA = TL to TH)
System frequency (2)
External reference
On-chip PLL frequency
Min
Max
fref_Crystal
fref_ext
fref_1:1
2
2
10
10
10
33
Loss of reference frequency(3), (4)
0
3/64
in
ar
fsys
Unit
MHz
33
33
MHz
fLOR
100
250
kHz
fSCM
0.5
15
MHz
tCST
—
10
ms
VIHEXT
VDD –1.0
2.0
VDD
VDD
V
VILEXT
VSS
VSS
1.0
0.8
V
XTAL output high voltage
IOH = 1.0 mA
VOL
VDD –1.0
—
V
XTAL output low voltage
IOL = 1.0 mA
VOL
—
0.5
V
5
30
pF
Self-clocked mode frequency(4)
Crystal startup time(5), (6)
EXTAL input high voltage
Crystal mode
All other modes (1:1, bypass, external)
EXTAL input low voltage
Crystal mode
All other modes (1:1, bypass, external)
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
PLL reference frequency range
Crystal reference(1)
External reference
1:1 mode
Symbol
y
Characteristic
XTAL load capacitance
PLL lock time(4), (7)
tLPLL
—
200
µs
Powerup to lock time(4), (5), (8)
With crystal reference (includes P5 time)
Without crystal reference
tLPLK
—
—
11
200
ms
µs
1:1 clock skew (between CLKOUT and EXTAL)(9)
tSkew
–2
2
ns
Duty cycle of reference(4)
tdc
40
60
% fsys
Frequency unlock range
fUL
–1.5
1.5
% fsys
Frequency lock range
fLCK
–0.75
0.75
% fsys
Continued on next page
Advance Information
618
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
PLL Electrical Specifications
Table 23-5. PLL Electrical Specifications (Continued)
(VDD = 2.7 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, TA = TL to TH)
Characteristic
Min
Max
Unit
CJitter
—
—
5
0.01
% fsys
in
ar
y
1. When the MFD in the PLL is set to 000, the minimum crystal reference frequency is 3 MHz.
2. All internal registers retain data at 0 Hz.
3. “Loss of reference frequency” is the reference frequency detected internally, which transitions the PLL into self-clocked
mode.
4. Self-clocked mode frequency is the frequency that the PLL operates at when the reference frequency falls below fLOR with
default MFD/RFD settings.
5. This parameter is characterized before qualification rather than 100% tested.
6. Proper PC board layout procedures must be followed to achieve specifications.
7. This specification applies to the period required for the PLL to relock after changing the MFD frequency control bits in the
synthesizer control register (SYNCR).
8. Assuming a reference is available at powerup, lock time is measured from the time VDD and VDD are valid to RSTOUT
negating. If the crystal oscillator is being used as the reference for the PLL, then the crystal start up time must be added to
the PLL lock time to determine the total start-up time.
9. PLL is operating in 1:1 PLL mode.
10. Jitter is the average deviation from the programmed frequency measured over the specified interval at maximum fsys.
Measurements are made with the device powered by filtered supplies and clocked by a stable external clock signal. Noise
injected into the PLL circuitry via VDD and V SS and variation in crystal oscillator frequency increase the CJitter percentage
for a given interval.
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
CLKOUT period jitter(4), (5), (7), (10) measured at fsys max
Peak-to-peak jitter (clock edge to clock edge)
Long term jitter (averaged over 2 ms interval)
Symbol
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
619
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
23.9 QADC Electrical Characteristics
The QADC electrical characteristics are shown in Table 23-6,
Table 23-7, and Table 23-8.
Table 23-6. QADC Absolute Maximum Ratings
Min
Max
Unit
Analog supply, with reference to VSSA
VDDA
–0.3
6.0
V
Internal digital supply(1) with reference to VSS
VDD
–0.3
4.0
V
Reference supply with reference to VRL
VRH
–0.3
VSS – VSSA
–0.1
VDD differential voltage(2)
VREF differential voltage
VRH to VDDA differential voltage(2)
VRL to VSSA differential voltage
VDDH to VDDA differential voltage
Maximum input current(3), (4), (5)
6.0
V
0.1
V
in
ar
VSS differential voltage
y
Symbol
VDD – VDDA
–6.0
4.0
V
VRH – VRL
–0.3
6.0
V
VRH – VDDA
–6.0
6.0
V
VRL – VSSA
–0.3
0.3
V
VDDH – VDDA
–1.0
1.0
V
IMA
–25
25
mA
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Parameter
1. For internal digital supply of VDD = 3.3 V typical
2. Refers to allowed random sequencing of power supplies
3. Transitions within the limit do not affect device reliability or cause permanent damage. Exceeding limit may cause permanent
conversion error on stressed channels and on unstressed channels.
4. Input must be current limited to the value specified. To determine the value of the required current-limiting resistor, calculate
resistance values using V POSCLAMP = V DDA + 0.3 V and VNEGCLAMP = –0.3 V, then use the larger of the calculated values.
5. Condition applies to one pin at a time.
Advance Information
620
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
QADC Electrical Characteristics
Table 23-7. QADC Electrical Specifications (Operating)
(VDDH and VDDA = 5.0 Vdc ± 0.5 V, VDD = 2.7 to 3.6 V, VSS and VSSA = 0 Vdc,
fQCLK = 2.0 MHz, TA within operating temperature range)
Parameter(1)
Min
Max
Unit
VDDA
4.5
5.5
V
VSS–VSSA
–100
100
mV
Reference voltage low(2)
VRL
VSSA
VSSA + 0.1
V
Reference voltage high (2)
VRH
VDDA –0.1
VDDA
V
VRH–VRL
4.5
5.5
V
VINDC
VSSA –0.3
VDDA +0.3
V
Analog supply
VREF differential voltage
in
ar
Input voltage
VIH
0.7 (VDDA)
VDDA +0.3
V
VIL
VSSA – 0.3
0.4 (VDDA)
V
VHYS
0.5
—
V
VOL
—
0.8
V
VOH
VDDH –0.8
—
V
Reference supply current, dc
Iref
—
250
µA
Reference supply current, transient
Iref
—
2
mA
Load capacitance, PQA and PQB
CL
—
50
pF
Input current, channel off(5)
PQA
PQB
IOFF
–200
–150
200
150
nA
Total input capacitance(6)
PQA not sampling
PQB not sampling
Incremental capacitance added during sampling
CIn
—
—
—
15
10
5
Input high voltage, PQA and PQB
Input low voltage, PQA and PQB
Input hysteresis, PQA and PQB(3)
Output low voltage, PQA and PQB(4)
IOL = 2.0 mA
Output high voltage, PQA and PQB(3)
IOH = –2.0 mA
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
VSS differential voltage
y
Symbol
pF
1. QADC converter specifications are only guaranteed for VDDH and V DDA = 5.0 V ± 0.5 V. V DDH and VDDA may be powered
down to 2.7 V with only GPIO functions supported.
2. To obtain full-scale, full-range results, VSSA <= VRL <= V INDC <= VRH <= VDDA
3. Parameter applies to these pins:
Port A: PQA[7:0]/AN[59:58]/ETRIG[2:1]
Port B: PQB[7:0]/AN[3:0]/AN[51:48]/AN[Z:W]
4. Full driver (push-pull).
5. Maximum leakage occurs at maximum operating temperature. Current decreases by approximately one-half for each 8°C to
12°C, in the ambient temperature range of 50°C to 125°C.
6. This parameter is characterized before qualification rather than 100% tested.
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
621
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
Table 23-8. QADC Conversion Specifications (Operating)
(VDDH and VDDA = 5.0 Vdc ± 0.5 V, VDD = 2.7 to 3.6 V, VSS and VSSA = 0 Vdc,
VRH–VRL = 5 Vdc ± 0.5 V, TA within operating temperature range, fsys = 16 MHz)
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
fQCLK
0.5
2.1
MHz
CC
14
28
QCLK
cycles
Conversion time
fQCLK = 2.0 MHz(1)
Min = CCW/IST =%00
Max = CCW/IST =%11
tCONV
7.0
14.0
µs
Stop mode recovery time
tSR
—
10
µs
—
5
—
mV
AE
–2
2
Counts
IINJ(10)
–1
1
mA
—
—
8x10 –5
8x10 –5
µ
QADC clock (QCLK) frequency(1)
Absolute (total unadjusted) error(3), (4), (5), (6)
fQCLK = 2.0 MHz(2)
Two clock input sample time
Disruptive input injection current(7), (8), (9)
in
ar
Resolution(2)
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Conversion cycles
Current Coupling Ratio(11)
PQA
PQB
K
Incremental error due to injection current (12)
All channels have same 10 k < RS < 100k
Channel under test has RS = 10k,
IINJ = IINJMAX, IINJMIN
EINJ
Source impedance at input (13)
RS
CSAMP
Incremental capacitance during sampling (14)
y
Parameter
+1.0
µ
Counts
+1.0
Counts
—
100
kΩ
—
5
pF
—
—
1. Conversion characteristics vary with fQCLK rate. Reduced conversion accuracy occurs at max fQCLK rate. Using the QADC
pins as GPIO functions during conversions may result in degraded results.
2. At VRH – VRL = 5.12 V, one count = 5 mV
3. Accuracy tested and guaranteed at VRH–VRL = 5.0 V ± 0.5 V
4. This parameter is characterized before qualification rather than 100% tested.
5. Absolute error includes 1/2 count (~2.5 mV) of inherent quantization error and circuit (differential, integral, and offset) error.
Specification assumes that adequate low-pass filtering is present on analog input pins — capacitive filter with 0.01 µF to
0.1 µF capacitor between analog input and analog ground, typical source isolation impedance of 10 KΩ.
6. Input signals with large slew rates or high frequency noise components cannot be converted accurately. These signals may
affect the conversion accuracy of other channels.
Notes continued on next page
Advance Information
622
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
in
ar
y
7. Below disruptive current conditions, the channel being stressed has conversion values of $3FF for analog inputs greater
than VRH and $000 for values less than VRL. This assumes that VRH < VDDA and VRL > VSSA due to the presence of the
sample amplifier. Other channels are not affected by non-disruptive conditions.
8. Exceeding limit may cause conversion error on stressed channels and on unstressed channels. Transitions within the limit
do not affect device reliability or cause permanent damage.
9. Input must be current limited to the value specified. To determine the value of the required current-limiting resister, calculate
resistance values using V POSCLAMP = VDDA + 0.5V and VNEGCLAMP = – 0.3 V, then use the larger of the calculated values.
10. Condition applies to two adjacent pins.
11. Current coupling ratio, K, is defined as the ratio of the output current, IOut, measured on the pin under test to the injection
current, Iinj, when both adjacent pins are overstressed with the specified injection current. K = IOut/ Iinj The input voltage
error on the channel under test is calculated as Verr = Iinj * K * RS.
12. Performance expected with production silicon.
13. Maximum source impedance is application-dependent. Error resulting from pin leakage depends on junction leakage into
the pin and on leakage due to charge-sharing with internal capacitance.
Error from junction leakage is a function of external source impedance and input leakage current. In this expression,
expected error in result value due to junction leakage is expressed in voltage (V errj):
Verrj = R S * IOFF
where IOFF is a function of operating temperature.
Charge-sharing leakage is a function of input source impedance, conversion rate, change in voltage between successive
conversions, and the size of the filtering capacitor used. Error levels are best determined empirically. In general, continuous
conversion of the same channel may not be compatible with high source impedance.
14. For a maximum sampling error of the input voltage <= 1 LSB, then the external filter capacitor, Cf >= 1024 * Csamp. The
value of C samp in the new design may be reduced.
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
QADC Electrical Characteristics
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
623
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
23.10 FLASH Memory Characteristics
The FLASH memory characteristics are shown in Table 23-9 and
Table 23-10.
Table 23-9. SGFM FLASH Program and Erase Characteristics
(VDDF = 2.7 to 3.6 V, TA = TL to TH)(1)
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
fsys(R)
0
—
33
MHz
fsys(P/E)
0.15
fCLK
150
System clock (program/erase)
—
33
MHz
—
200
kHz
in
ar
FLASH statemachine clock
1. TL is defined to be –40°C and TH is defined to be 85°C
Table 23-10. SGFM FLASH Module Life Characteristics
(VDDF = 2.7 to 3.6 V, TA = TL to TH)
Parameter
Symbol
Value
Unit
Maximum number of guaranteed program/erase cycles(1)
before failure
P/E
1,000(2)
Cycles
Data retention at average operating temperature of 85°C
Retention
10
Years
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
System clock (read only)
y
Parameter
1. A program/erase cycle is defined as switching the bits from 1 → 0 → 1.
2. Reprogramming of a FLASH array block prior to erase is not required.
Advance Information
624
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
External Interface Timing Characteristics
23.11 External Interface Timing Characteristics
Table 23-11. External Interface Timing Characteristics
(VDD = 2.7 V to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, TA = TL to TH)
Characteristic(1), (2)
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
CLKOUT period
tcyc
30
—
ns
2
CLKOUT low pulse width
tCLW
0.5 tcyc – 1
—
ns
3
CLKOUT high pulse width
tCHW
0.5 tcyc – 1
—
ns
4
All rise times
tCR
—
3
ns
5
All fall times
tCF
—
3
ns
6
CLKOUT high to A[22:0], TSIZ[1:0] valid(3)
—
7
ns
7
CLKOUT high to A[22:0], TSIZ[1:0] invalid
tCHAI
0
—
ns
8
CLKOUT high to CS[3:0] asserted(3)
tCHCA
—
7
ns
9
CLKOUT high to CS[3:0] negated
tCHCN
0
—
ns
10
CLKOUT high to CSE[1:0] valid
tCHCEV
—
7
ns
11
CLKOUT high to CSE[1:0] invalid
tCHCEI
0
—
ns
12
CLKOUT high to TC[2:0], PSTAT[3:0] valid
tCHTV
—
12
ns
CLKOUT high to TC[2:0], PSTAT[3:0] invalid
tCHTI
0
—
ns
CLKOUT high to R/W high hold time
tCHRWH
0
10
ns
CLKOUT high to R/W valid write
tCHRWV
0.25 tcyc
0.25 tcyc + 6
ns
CLKOUT high to OE, EB asserted(3), (4), (5)
tCHOEA
0.25 tcyc
0.25 tcyc + 8
ns
CLKOUT high to OE, EB read negated
tCHOEN
0
6
ns
CLKOUT low to EB write negated(4)
tCLEN
0.25 tcyc
0.25 tcyc + 6
ns
CLKOUT low to SHS low
tCLSL
0
7
ns
CLKOUT high to SHS high(6)
tCHSH
0
7
ns
CLKOUT low to data-out low impedance write/show
tCHDOD
0
—
ns
21
CLKOUT high to data-out high impedance
write/show(4), (6), (7)
tCHDOZ
2
10
ns
22
CLKOUT low to data-out valid write
tCLDOVW
—
8
ns
CLKOUT low to data-out valid show(8)
tCLDOVS
—
15
ns
13
14
15
16
17
17A
18
19
20
22A
in
ar
tCHAV
y
1
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
No.
Continued on next page
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
625
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
Table 23-11. External Interface Timing Characteristics (Continued)
(VDD = 2.7 V to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, TA = TL to TH)
Characteristic(1), (2)
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
tCHDOIW
2
—
ns
CLKOUT high to data-out invalid write/show(6), (7)
24
Data-in valid to CLKOUT high read
tDIVCH
17
—
ns
25
CLKOUT high to data-in invalid read
tCHDII
0
—
ns
26
TA, TEA asserted to CLKOUT high
tTACH
0.25 tcyc + 9
—
ns
27
CLKOUT high to TA, TEA negated
tCHTN
0
—
ns
y
23
in
ar
1. All AC timing is shown with respect to 50% V DD levels, unless otherwise noted.
2. Timing is not guaranteed during the clock cycle of mode and/or setup changes (for example, changing pin function between
GPIO and primary function, changing GPIO between input/output functions, changing control registers that affect pin
functions).
3. A[22:0], TSIZ[1:0], CS[3:0] valid to R/W (write), OE, EB asserted (minimum) spec is 0 ns. This parameter is characterized
before qualification rather than 100% tested.
4. Write/show data high-Z to OE asserted (minimum) or from EB negated (write — maximum) spec is 0 ns. This parameter is
characterized before qualification rather than 100% tested.
5. To prevent an unintentional assertion glitch of the EB pins during a synchronous reset (and before the reset overrides
configure the chip in a stable mode), leave the port output data register bits associated with the EB GPO default of 1 and do
not pull the pins down with a current load.
6. SHS high to show data or write data invalid (minimum) spec is 0 ns. This parameter is characterized before qualification
rather than 100% tested.
7. Write/show data high-Z and write/show data invalid is 0 ns for synchronous reset conditions.
8. tCLDOVS value reflects maximum specification for any bus cycle. For non-FLASH read cycles, tCLDOVS is specified at 8 ns
maximum.
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
No.
4
1
5
CLKOUT
2
3
Figure 23-1. CLKOUT Timing
Advance Information
626
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
External Interface Timing Characteristics
CLKOUT
7
6
A[22:0]
TSIZ[1:0]
9
8
CS3–CS0
10
11
12
y
13
in
ar
TC[2:0],
PSTAT[3:0]
14
R/W (READ)
15
R/W (WRITE)
16
17
OE
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
CSE[1:0]
17A
EB[3:0] (WRITE)
EB[3:0] (READ)
SHS
18
19
22
23
D[31:0] (WRITE)
20
21
24
25
D[31:0] (READ)
26
27
TA/TEA
Figure 23-2. Clock Read/Write Cycle Timing
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
627
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
CLKOUT
7
6
A[22:0]
TSIZ[1:0]
8
9
CS3–CS0
10
11
CSE[1:0]
13
y
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
12
14
R/W (READ)
15
R/W (WRITE)
in
ar
TC[2:0],
PSTAT[3:0]
17
16
Pr
el
im
OE
17A
EB[3:0] (WRITE)
EB[3:0] (READ)
SHS
18
19
22
23
D[31:0] (WRITE)
20
21
24
25
D[31:0] (READ)
27
26
TA/TEA
Figure 23-3. Read/Write Cycle Timing with Wait States
Advance Information
628
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
External Interface Timing Characteristics
CLKOUT
7
6
A[22:0]
TSIZ[1:0]
CS3–CS0
10
11
12
y
13
in
ar
TC[2:0],
PSTAT[3:0]
14
R/W (READ)
15
R/W (WRITE)
OE
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
CSE[1:0]
EB[3:0]
18
19
SHS
22A
23
D[31:0] (WRITE)
20
21
TA/TEA
Figure 23-4. Show Cycle Timing
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
629
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
23.12 General Purpose I/O Timing
Table 23-12. GPIO Timing(1)
(VDD = 2.7 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, TA = TL to TH)(2)
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
CLKOUT high to GPIO output valid
tCHPOV
—
20
ns
G2
CLKOUT high to GPIO output invalid
tCHPOI
0
—
ns
G3
GPIO input valid to CLKOUT high
tPVCH
10
—
ns
G4
CLKOUT high to GPIO input invalid
tCHPI
2
—
ns
—
20
ns
tCHPAOV
GA2 CLKOUT high to PQA output invalid
GA3 PQA/PQB input valid to CLKOUT low
GA3 CLKOUT low to PQA/PQB input invalid
in
ar
GA1 CLKOUT high to PQA output valid
y
G1
tCHPAOI
0
—
ns
tPAVCH
10
—
ns
tCHPAI
2
—
ns
1. GPIO pins include: Ports A–I, edge port (including INT functions), SPI, SCI1, and SCI2 (including SCI functions), and timer 1
and timer 2 (including timer functions).
2. All AC timing is shown with respect to 50% V DD levels unless otherwise noted.
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
No.
CLKOUT
G1
G2
GA1
GA2
GPIO OUTPUTS
PQA OUTPUTS
G3
G4
GPIO INPUTS
GA3
GA4
PQA/PQB INPUTS
Figure 23-5. GPIO Timing
Advance Information
630
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
Reset and Configuration Override Timing
23.13 Reset and Configuration Override Timing
Table 23-13. Reset and Configuration Override Timing
(VDD = 2.7 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, TA = TL to TH)
Parameter(1)
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
RESET input asserted to CLKOUT high
tRACH
10
—
ns
R2
CLKOUT high to RESET input negated
tCHRN
2
—
ns
R3
RESET input assertion time(2)
tRIAT
5
—
tcyc
R4
CLKOUT high to RSTOUT valid(3)
tCHROV
—
20
ns
R5
RSTOUT asserted to configuration overrides asserted
tROACA
0
—
ns
R6
Configuration override setup time to RSTOUT negated
tCOS
20
—
tcyc
R7
Configuration override hold time after RSTOUT negated
tCOH
0
—
ns
R8
RSTOUT negated to configuration override high
impedance
tRONCZ
—
1
tcyc
in
ar
y
R1
1. All AC timing is shown with respect to 50% V DD levels, unless otherwise noted.
2. During low-power STOP, the synchronizers for the RESET input are bypassed and RESET is asserted asynchronously to
the system. Thus, RESET must be held a minimum of 100 ns.
3. This parameter also covers the timing of the show interrupt function.
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
No.
CLKOUT
R1
R2
R3
RESET
R4
R4
RSTOUT
R8
R5
R6
R7
CONFIGURATION OVERRIDES
(RCON, D[28, 26, 23:21, 19:16])
Figure 23-6. RESET and Configuration Override Timing
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
631
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
23.14 SPI Timing Characteristics
Table 23-14. SPI Timing Characteristics
(VDD = 2.7 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, TA = TL to TH)
Function(1)
Min
Max
Unit
fop
DC
DC
1/2 x fsys
1/2 x fsys
System
frequency
2
2
2048
—
tcyc
tcyc
1/2
1
—
—
tsck
tcyc
tLag
1/2
1
—
—
tsck
tcyc
tWSCK
tcyc − 30
tcyc − 30
1024 tcyc
—
ns
tSU
25
25
—
—
ns
tHigh
0
25
—
—
ns
tA
—
1
tcyc
Slave MISO disable time
tDIS
—
1
tcyc
Data valid after SCK edge
Master
Slave
tV
—
—
25
25
ns
tHold
0
0
—
—
ns
Operating frequency
Master
Slave
1
SCK period
Master
Slave
tSCK
2
Enable lead time
Master
Slave
tLead
3
Enable lag time
Master
Slave
4
Clock (SCK) high or low time
Master
Slave
5
Data setup time, inputs
Master
Slave
6
7
8
9
10
in
ar
—
Data hold time, inputs
Master
Slave
Slave access time
Data hold time, outputs
Master
Slave
y
Symbol
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
No.
11
Rise time
Input
Output
tRI
tRO
—
—
tcyc − 25
25
ns
12
Fall time
Input
Output
tFI
tFO
—
—
tcyc − 25
25
ns
1. All ac timing is shown with respect to 50% VDD unless otherwise noted. Timing is based on wired-OR mode being off. With
wired-OR mode on, timing will depend on pullup value.
Advance Information
632
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
SPI Timing Characteristics
SS(1)
OUTPUT
2
1
SCK
CPOL = 0
OUTPUT
11
4
12
SCK
CPOL = 1
OUTPUT
6
MISO
INPUT
MSB IN2
BIT 6 . . . 1
9
LSB IN
y
5
9
MOSI
OUTPUT
10
BIT 6 . . . 1
in
ar
MSB OUT2
LSB OUT
Notes:
1. SS output mode (DDS7 = 1, SSOE = 1)
2. LSBF = 0. For LSBF = 1, bit order is LSB, bit 1, ..., bit 6, MSB.
A) SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 0)
SS(1)
OUTPUT
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
3
4
1
2
12
11
11
12
3
SCK
CPOL = 0
OUTPUT
4
4
SCK
CPOL = 1
OUTPUT
5
MISO
INPUT
6
MSB IN2
BIT 6 . . . 1
10
9
MOSI
OUTPUT PORT DATA
LSB IN
MASTER MSB OUT2
BIT 6 . . . 1
MASTER LSB OUT
PORT DATA
Notes:
1. SS output mode (DDS7 = 1, SSOE = 1)
2. LSBF = 0. For LSBF = 1, bit order is LSB, bit 1, ..., bit 6, MSB.
B) SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 1)
Figure 23-7. SPI Timing Diagram (Sheet 1 of 2)
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
633
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
SS
INPUT
1
12
11
11
12
3
SCK
CPOL = 0
INPUT
4
2
4
SCK
CPOL = 1
INPUT
8
BIT 6 . . . 1
MSB OUT
SLAVE
5
10
10
SLAVE LSB OUT
6
MOSI
INPUT
SEE
NOTE
in
ar
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
MISO
OUTPUT
9
y
7
BIT 6 . . . 1
MSB IN
LSB IN
Note: Not defined, but normally MSB of character just received
A) SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 0)
Pr
el
im
SS
INPUT
3
1
2
12
11
11
12
SCK
CPOL = 0
INPUT
4
4
SCK
CPOL = 1
INPUT
SEE
NOTE
7
MOSI
INPUT
8
10
9
MISO
OUTPUT
SLAVE
MSB OUT
5
BIT 6 . . . 1
SLAVE LSB OUT
6
MSB IN
BIT 6 . . . 1
LSB IN
Note: Not defined, but normally LSB of character just received
B) SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 1)
Figure 24-7. SPI Timing Diagram (Sheet 2 of 2)
Advance Information
634
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
OnCE, JTAG, and Boundary Scan Timing
23.15 OnCE, JTAG, and Boundary Scan Timing
Table 23-15. OnCE, JTAG, and Boundary Scan Timing
(VDD = 2.7 to 3.6 V, VSS = 0 V, TA = TL to TH)
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
1
TCLK frequency of operation
fJCYC
dc
1/2 x fsys
MHz
2
TCLK cycle period
tJCYC
2
—
tcyc
3
TCLK clock pulse width
tJCW
25
—
ns
4
TCLK rise and fall times
tJCRF
0
3
ns
5
Boundary scan input data setup time to TCLK rise
tBSDST
6
Boundary scan input data hold time after TCLK rise
tBSDHT
y
Characteristics
7
TCLK low-to-boundary scan output data valid
8
TCLK low-to-boundary scan output high Z
9
—
ns
24
—
ns
tBSDV
0
40
ns
tBSDZ
0
40
ns
TMS, TDI, and DE input data setup time to TCLK rise(1)
tTAPDST
7
—
ns
10
TMS, TDI, and DE input data hold time after TCLK rise(1)
tTAPDHT
15
—
ns
11
TCLK low to TDO data valid
tTDODV
0
25
ns
12
TCLK low to TDO high Z
tTDODZ
0
9
ns
13
TRST assert time
tTRSTAT
100
—
ns
14
TRST setup time (negation) to TCLK high
tTRSTST
10
—
ns
15
DE input data setup time to CLKOUT rise(1)
tDEDST
10
—
ns
16
DE input data hold time after CLKOUT rise(1)
tDEDHT
2
—
ns
17
CLKOUT high to DE data valid
tDEDV
0
20
ns
18
CLKOUT high to DE high Z
tDEDZ
0
10
ns
in
ar
5
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
No.
1. Parameters 9 and 10 apply to the DE pin when used to enable OnCE. Parameters 15 and 16 apply to the DE pin when used
to request the processor to enter debug mode.
2
3
3
VIH
TCLK INPUT
VIL
4
4
Figure 23-8. Test Clock Input Timing
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
635
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
TCLK
VIH
VIL
5
6
INPUT DATA VALID
DATA INPUTS
7
OUTPUT DATA VALID
DATA OUTPUTS
8
DATA OUTPUTS
y
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
7
OUTPUT DATA VALID
in
ar
DATA OUTPUTS
Figure 23-9. Boundary Scan (JTAG) Timing
TCLK
VIH
VIL
9
TDI
TMS
DE
10
INPUT DATA VALID
Pr
el
im
11
OUTPUT DATA VALID
TDO
12
TDO
11
OUTPUT DATA VALID
TDO
Figure 23-10. Test Access Port Timing
TCLK
14
TRST
13
Figure 23-11. TRST Timing
Advance Information
636
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
MOTOROLA
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
OnCE, JTAG, and Boundary Scan Timing
CLKOUT
VIL
VIH
15
16
INPUT DATA VALID
DE
INPUT
17
OUTPUT DATA VALID
DE
18
y
17
OUTPUT DATA VALID
in
ar
DE
Figure 23-12. Debug Event Pin Timing
Pr
el
im
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
DE
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
MOTOROLA
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.freescale.com
Advance Information
637
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc.
Pr
el
im
in
ar
y
Freescale Semiconductor, Inc...
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
Advance Information
638
MMC2114 • MMC2113 • MMC2112 — Rev. 1.0
Preliminary Electrical Specifications
For More Information On This Product,
Go to: www.fre

advertisement

Was this manual useful for you? Yes No
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Related manuals

Download PDF

advertisement